Desain LRT PDF
Desain LRT PDF
Desain LRT PDF
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Section Page
1.0 GENERAL.....................................................................................................................1
1.1 INTRODUCTION...........................................................................................................1
1.1.1 Purpose ...........................................................................................................1
1.1.2 Scope ..............................................................................................................1
1.1.3 Procedures and Application ............................................................................2
1.1.4 Abbreviations, Acronyms ................................................................................3
1.1.5 Project Management .......................................................................................3
1.1.6 Sustainable Building Policy .............................................................................4
1.1.7 Background .....................................................................................................4
1.2 GENERAL DESIGN PHILOSOPHY..............................................................................5
1.2.1 Public Involvement ..........................................................................................5
1.2.2 Land Use .........................................................................................................5
1.2.3 Aesthetics/Arts Program .................................................................................6
1.2.4 Accessibility .....................................................................................................6
1.2.5 Safety and Security .........................................................................................6
1.2.6 Operation and Maintenance ............................................................................7
1.3 LOCAL CLIMATIC CONDITIONS .................................................................................8
1.4 VALUE ENGINEERING/RISK MANAGEMENT ............................................................9
1.5 SAFETY MANAGEMENT AUDIT PROGRAM ..............................................................9
1.6 COMMISSIONING AND TESTING .............................................................................10
1.6.1 General..........................................................................................................10
1.6.2 Activation .......................................................................................................10
1.6.3 Overhead Catenary System Certification ......................................................10
1.7 STANDARD RECORD DOCUMENTS .......................................................................11
1.7.1 Plan of Record Drawings General Requirements .........................................11
1.7.2 Operation and Maintenance Manuals General Requirements......................12
1.7.3 Other Documentation Requirements.............................................................20
4.3.1 General..........................................................................................................14
4.3.2 Gradient.........................................................................................................15
4.3.3 Vertical Curves (VC) .....................................................................................15
4.3.4 Vertical Tangents ..........................................................................................16
4.3.5 Asymmetrical Vertical Curves .......................................................................16
4.4 COMBINED HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL CURVES .............................................16
4.5 VERTICAL CURVE RESTRICTIONS .........................................................................16
4.6 SUPPLEMENTARY REFERENCE INFORMATION (FOR INFORMATION ONLY) ..17
8.10.1 General..........................................................................................................40
8.10.2 Identity Management .....................................................................................41
8.10.3 DNS, DHCP and IP Address Management ...................................................41
8.10.4 Security .........................................................................................................41
8.10.5 Remote Access .............................................................................................42
8.10.6 Monitoring and Alarming ...............................................................................42
8.10.7 Configuration Management ...........................................................................42
8.10.8 Software ........................................................................................................42
8.10.9 Software Updates and Lifecycle....................................................................44
8.10.10 Logging, Big Data and Analytics ...................................................................44
8.11 FARES SYSTEM ........................................................................................................45
8.12 BUILDING MANAGEMENT SYSTEM (BMS) .............................................................45
8.12.1 BMS Definitions .............................................................................................46
8.12.2 Nomenclature General Structure ..................................................................46
8.12.3 General Description ......................................................................................47
8.12.4 BMS Operation and Maintenance Manuals ..................................................49
8.12.5 BMS Equipment Requirements .....................................................................49
8.12.6 Requirements for the BMS Monitoring and Control of Systems ...................50
8.12.7 Control Logic Software, Graphics and Alarming Requirements ...................54
8.12.8 Training .........................................................................................................55
8.12.9 Documentation ..............................................................................................55
8.13 CCTV ..........................................................................................................................55
8.13.1 Applicable Codes, Standards, Regulations and Practices ............................55
8.13.2 Product Acceptability .....................................................................................56
8.13.3 Naming conventions ......................................................................................56
8.13.4 Architecture ...................................................................................................56
8.13.5 Archiving - Video Archiver Servers ...............................................................79
8.13.6 Multicast Scheme ..........................................................................................80
8.13.7 Alarm Connections ........................................................................................80
8.13.8 Monitoring and Alarming ...............................................................................80
8.13.9 Remote Management and Access ................................................................82
8.13.10 Cameras & Programming ..............................................................................83
8.13.11 Required site coverage / CCTV Camera Views ..........................................105
8.13.12 Cabling methods .........................................................................................108
8.13.13 Camera Poles..............................................................................................109
8.14 PA/VMS .....................................................................................................................109
8.14.1 General........................................................................................................109
8.14.2 Existing PA/VMS System ............................................................................109
8.14.3 Applicable Codes, Regulations and Standards...........................................111
8.14.4 Functional Requirements ............................................................................111
8.14.5 Location Considerations ..............................................................................112
8.14.6 System and Component Design Requirements ..........................................112
8.14.7 Interfacing Requirements ............................................................................114
8.14.8 Amplifiers.....................................................................................................115
8.14.9 Signs ...........................................................................................................115
8.14.10 Installation and Design of Signs ..................................................................116
8.14.11 Naming Conventions ...................................................................................117
8.14.12 Microphones ................................................................................................117
8.14.13 Integration to the Central Phone System ....................................................117
8.15 TELEPHONE SYSTEMS ..........................................................................................117
8.15.1 General........................................................................................................117
8.15.2 Functional and Phone Equipment Requirements .......................................117
8.15.3 Naming conventions ....................................................................................118
8.15.4 Extension convention ..................................................................................118
8.15.5 Monitoring of devices ..................................................................................118
8.15.6 Automated Device Testing ..........................................................................118
8.15.7 Integration to PA/VMS .................................................................................118
8.15.8 Redundancy ................................................................................................118
8.15.9 Phones ........................................................................................................119
8.15.10 Phone System Cabling Methods .................................................................120
8.15.11 Phone System Powering Methods ..............................................................121
8.15.12 Phone programming ....................................................................................121
8.15.13 Central management of all help phone devices ..........................................121
8.15.14 Enclosures, Panels and Backboards ..........................................................121
8.15.15 Call recording ..............................................................................................121
8.15.16 Camera Behavior with Help phones............................................................122
8.15.17 Caller ID conventions ..................................................................................122
8.15.18 Distribution Design Requirements...............................................................122
8.16 RADIO SYSTEMS.....................................................................................................122
8.16.1 General........................................................................................................122
8.16.2 Portable radios ............................................................................................123
8.16.3 Mobile Radios..............................................................................................124
8.16.4 Installation standards ..................................................................................124
8.16.5 Tunnel Radio system ..................................................................................124
8.16.6 Industry Specs for all devices .....................................................................124
8.16.7 Network connection to AFRRCS .................................................................125
8.16.8 Redundancy ................................................................................................125
8.16.9 Console Programming ................................................................................126
8.16.10 Call recording ..............................................................................................126
8.16.11 Monitoring of devices ..................................................................................126
8.16.12 Talk groups..................................................................................................126
8.16.13 DAS .............................................................................................................127
8.16.14 BDAs ...........................................................................................................127
8.16.15 Radiax and installation ................................................................................128
8.16.16 Coax and installation ...................................................................................128
8.16.17 Coverage expectations ...............................................................................129
8.16.18 Ground Level Stations (including terrestrial coverage) ...............................129
8.16.19 BER measurements ....................................................................................129
8.16.20 Radio System Replacement........................................................................129
8.17 SIGNALS NETWORK ...............................................................................................130
8.17.1 Conventions ................................................................................................130
8.17.2 Architecture .................................................................................................130
8.17.3 Device requirements ...................................................................................130
8.17.4 Redundancy ................................................................................................130
8.17.5 Monitoring of Devices ..................................................................................130
8.17.6 Signals Fibre Backbone ..............................................................................130
8.18 TRACTION POWER NETWORKS ...........................................................................131
8.18.1 EPCOR RACIs ............................................................................................131
8.18.2 Architecture .................................................................................................131
8.18.3 Naming conventions ....................................................................................131
8.18.4 Transfer Trip ................................................................................................131
9.0 STRUCTURES..............................................................................................................1
9.1 GENERAL .....................................................................................................................1
9.1.1 Introduction......................................................................................................1
9.1.2 Applicable Codes, Standards, Practices and Reference Guidelines ..............1
9.1.3 Structure Categories .......................................................................................2
9.1.4 Load Factor Method for Design.......................................................................2
9.1.5 Application of Loadings ...................................................................................2
9.2 BRIDGES ......................................................................................................................3
9.2.1 Dead Loads .....................................................................................................3
9.2.2 Live Loads .......................................................................................................4
9.2.3 Vertical Loads..................................................................................................4
9.2.4 Horizontal Loads .............................................................................................4
9.2.5 Derailment Loads ............................................................................................5
9.2.6 Longitudinal Forces Due to Acceleration/Deceleration and Rail Restraint .....5
9.2.7 Centrifugal Forces ...........................................................................................5
9.2.8 Vehicle Collision Loads ...................................................................................6
9.2.9 Vibration and Deflection Control .....................................................................6
9.2.10 Fatigue ............................................................................................................6
9.2.11 Thermal, Wind, Snow, Shrinkage, Creep Loading Considerations .................6
9.2.12 Related Structural Considerations ..................................................................6
9.2.13 Inspection and Maintenance Manual ..............................................................7
9.3 BUILDINGS ...................................................................................................................8
9.3.1 Loads and Forces............................................................................................8
9.3.2 Related Structural Considerations for Type II and Type III LRT Stations .......8
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
1.0 GENERAL
Page
1.0 GENERAL 1
1.1 INTRODUCTION 1
1.1.1 Purpose 1
1.1.2 Scope 1
1.1.3 Procedures and Application 2
1.1.4 Abbreviations, Acronyms 3
1.1.5 Project Management 3
1.1.6 Sustainable Building Policy 4
1.1.7 Background 4
1.2 GENERAL DESIGN PHILOSOPHY 5
1.2.1 Public Involvement 5
1.2.2 Land Use 5
1.2.3 Aesthetics/Arts Program 6
1.2.4 Accessibility 6
1.2.5 Safety and Security 6
1.2.6 Operation and Maintenance 7
1.3 LOCAL CLIMATIC CONDITIONS 8
List of Figures
Figure 1.1 – Cover & Spine Layout for O & M Manual
List of Appendices
Appendix l – Standard Record Documents Additional Requirements
Appendix ll – Website Links to Prime Reference Documents
1.0 GENERAL
1.1 INTRODUCTION
1.1.1 Purpose
The LRT Design Guideline manual is prepared to provide information and direction to the City
of Edmonton staff, consultants, and contractors who are involved in the design of Edmonton’s
LRT system. It outlines standards governing the designs of various elements on Edmonton’s
LRT System. In addition, project-specific drawings standards, CADD standards, Design
Briefing Reports and a Quality Assurance / Quality Control Manual must be prepared, and
adhered to during the engineering and construction phases of LRT projects.
In addition to the forgoing, other specific guideline and standards documents have been
prepared to guide the design activities and the preparation of contract documents and are
referenced throughout this manual. Requests for these documents should be directed to the
Project Office.
The last update to the Design Guidelines was completed in 2011, referred to as the 2011
edition. This update reflects design issues and variances that were addressed during the
construction phase of the NLRT extension to NAIT.
Designs should be conceived within an atmosphere of fiscal responsibility. Designs should be
guided in maintaining low operating costs, minimizing capital costs (i.e.: design, construction,
mitigation, aesthetics…), and minimizing public and community disruption. These
requirements must be balanced with the need to ensure public safety and access,
environmental impacts, system reliability, and maintenance requirements.
1.1.2 Scope
This chapter provides general background on past LRT development in Edmonton, outlining
the collaborative approach to be taken on LRT plan development. It also presents the general
design philosophy and principles that guide the planning, design, and construction of the LRT
System. In addition, it provides an overview of the commissioning process associated with
making a newly constructed segment operational, and details of project closeout document
requirements (plan of record drawings and operating and maintenance manuals).
In addition to this chapter there are eighteen (18) specific design component chapters as
follows:
Vehicles
Clearances and Right-of-Way
Track Alignment
Trackwork
Traction Power
Signals
Communications & Control
Structures
Stations and Ancillary Facilities
Electrical Systems
Mechanical Systems
Corrosion and Stray Current Control
Impact Mitigation, Aesthetics and ROW Control
Accessibility
Safety and Security
Utilities
Streets Design
Parkades
Where appropriate, each chapter is supported by figures, diagrams, and tables at the end of
each chapter. In some instances, applicable reference documentation will form an appendix
to the chapter. Each chapter is to be as comprehensive and complete as possible.
Notwithstanding the forgoing, due to the complexity of the topics, specific referencing to other
chapters or other related reference documents still occurs throughout a chapter.
It is the intent of the City to also develop design guidelines for LRT Shop and Yard facilities for
inclusion in this document at a later date.
Approval of the detailed design and the issuance of a building permit. The contract
documents generally stipulate that the Contractor is for applying for and obtaining the
building permit.
It is recommended that an informal process also be followed. This should take the form of on-
going consultation with the Planning and Development – Safety Code Section, Plan
Examiners during the detailed design phase to deal with issues as they arise during the
design development. The objective of the informal process is to ensure that the issuance of
the building permit is more or less a formality and should minimize the requirement for
changes during and after the facility contract award. An appropriate number of drawings and
specifications will be provided by the PMO.
The LRT Project Office is accountable to the City through the LRT D & C acting on behalf of
ETS, as the operator of the LRT system.
1.1.6 Sustainable Building Policy
In June of 2007 City Council adopted Sustainable Building Policy #C532 – Leadership in
Energy and Environmental Design (LEED Silver) which states as follows:
Note: LEED provides a complete framework for assessing building performance and meeting
sustainability goals. Based on well-founded scientific standards, LEED emphasizes state of the art
strategies for sustainable site development, water savings, energy efficiency, materials selection and
TM
indoor environmental quality. The LEED Green Building Rating System is a voluntary, consensus-
based national standard for developing high-performance, sustainable buildings.
In LEED, for new construction and major renovations for commercial buildings, there are 69 possible
points and buildings can qualify for four levels of certification. Silver is the second level of certification
(33-38 points). It should be noted however that LRT Stations are not considered to be buildings under
the LEED Policy. However, the overall LRT project should strive to meet sustainability goals using best
practices.
1.1.7 Background
At the time of publication of the 2017 Edition of the Design Guidelines Edmonton’s LRT
system included two lines:
Capital Line
The Capital Line with 21 km of double track providing access between Clareview (139 Avenue
and 43 Street) and Century Park at 111 Street just north of 23 Avenue.
On the north side the surface portion of the alignment is 7.8 km in length and predominately
runs in the CN ROW from Clareview toward the City’s downtown core. From 95 Street
underground alignment, (including the DBM Bridge), is 4.7 km long and travels under the
downtown area, across the river on the DBM Bridge to the underground University Station.
The section south of the University Station is comprised of 390 m of tunnel, 120 m of portal
and 200 m of surface alignment (including station approaches) coming back to grade at Health
Sciences Station just north of 83 Avenue on the west side of 114 Street.
South of Health Sciences the line (8.1 km in length) is predominately at-grade to Century
Park. Grade separations with roadways are provided at Belgravia Road (underpass), with the
southbound lanes of 111 Street south of 61 Avenue (underpass) and an overpass of
Whitemud Drive on 111 Street.
There are fifteen stations along the 21 km route provide access for LRT patrons to the LRT
trains.
Metro Line
The Metro Line is a 3.3 km double track extension which diverges from the Capital Line at
Churchill Station and continues to NAIT where it terminates just north of Princess Elizabeth
Avenue.
North of Churchill Station the Metro Line is underground in twin tunnels for 600 m before
coming to grade through the portal east of MacEwan Station. From MacEwan to NAIT
Stations, the line runs at grade.
In response to the development of the overall principles outlines in Section 1.2.1 seven major
landscaping design principles were formulated and will be incorporated into the landscaping
development of the LRT corridor and its components. These are; (1) safety, (2) maintenance,
(3) neighborhood integration and impact mitigation, (4) buffering, (5) aesthetics, (6) fiscal
responsibility, and (7) stakeholder involvement..
1.2.3 Aesthetics/Arts Program
City Policy C458C, outlines the guidelines by which public art is to be included in the project
budget and the means by which it is to be incorporated. It states in part:”
“The City of Edmonton will dedicate 1% of the qualifying construction budget to cover the
costs of implementing City Policy C458C.”
In part, the purpose of the policy is to “Improve the livability and attractiveness of Edmonton:
increase public awareness and appreciation of the arts; stimulate the growth of the arts and
arts-related business, use public are to help meet urban design objectives of municipal
developments; and to encourage public art in private developments through example.”
1.2.4 Accessibility
Barrier-free design will be undertaken for all sites and as determined by the stakeholder
involvement process. The design must utilize the following documents or resources to ensure
a barrier-free design:
Barrier-Free Design Guide - Barrier-Free Design Advisory Committee of the Safety
Codes Council and Alberta Municipal Affairs.
Universal Design for Barrier - Free Park Development, City Community Services,
Policy C463 – Accessibility, City Corporate Guide.
City of Edmonton Advisory Board on Services for Persons with Disabilities.
Refer to Chapter 15 – Accessibility for further details. Specific accessibility issues are also
noted with the various chapters as deemed appropriate.
Consultants should incorporate in their designs practical and cost effective theft prevention
measures. They should ensure that the security provisions of construction specifications are
stringent. Regular and frequent inspections of Contractors laydown/work areas must be
carried out to ensure that stored materials and equipment are properly secured.
1.2.6.1 Maintenance
The use of conservative design procedures.
The use of materials and products especially designed or suited for heavy usage is
required.
As a general rule, simple, standard, off-the shelf high quality components are preferred to
complex or elaborate building components that are prone to higher incidence of failure
and require more maintenance.
The design of the facility will be such as to make any maintenance procedures as
convenient as possible to carry out.
Use materials and equipment that are waterproof and able to withstand water penetration.
Provide utility services at the station exterior to accommodate the maintenance of
landscaped areas.
Minimize or eliminate bird roosting areas in outdoor stations.
1.2.6.4 Flexibility
The design of LRT structures should be able to accommodate possible future extensions,
facility upgrades, equipment, and new uses (i.e. kiosks) that may be added to the system.
Underground station design should be able to accommodate connections to future
adjacent development.
LRT tunnels should make provision for future turnouts.
Service rooms should be sized to handle all necessary equipment plus an allowance for
the possibility of future equipment being added.
Sufficient capacity should be provided to handle additional electrical loads.
The design will allow for alternate access in the event of closure of escalators, elevators,
entrances etc. for station maintenance or upgrades.
Accommodate snow removal and storage adjacent to LRT facilities and ROW.
The degree of flexibility to be incorporated will be at the discretion of the ETS.
1.2.6.5 Combustibility
Due to restrictive locations of underground stations, extreme care and consideration
should be taken in the selection of materials and finishes.
Combustible elements within the facility are to be minimized.
1.2.6.6 Collaboration
Comprehensive and continual consultation is required with ETS during the design
construction and commissioning phases of the project.
Comprehensive consultation is required with the Advisory Board for Persons with
Disabilities during the design and commissioning phases of the project.
City Departments or agencies involved in the maintenance of LRT facilities must be
involved in design development reviews and the commissioning phase of the project. In
addition they are to be provided with POR plans and O & M documentation.
1.6.2 Activation
Start-up and activation work must be performed by an independent agency (referred to as the
Activation Agent) approved by ETS.
The building mechanical system must be checked in both static and dynamic modes to ensure
compliance with the design intent and the mechanical contract documents.
The Activation Agent:
Reports directly to the Mechanical Consultant.
Must complete his work prior to substantial completion being issued by the Contractor.
The LRV must be equipped with camera equipment for monitoring the pantograph dynamic
position relative to the stagger of the contact wire.
The operation of the system must be monitored after commissioning until the Consultant is
satisfied that no deficiencies exist and no remedial actions are required.
Table 1.1
Notes:
1. CADD Manual updates to provide POR format and distribution prior to preliminary engineering on
any extension project. *Variable distribution requirements to be verified by Project Office.
2. 11 x 17 *prints bound in a binder designated Plan of Record Drawings. The spine and front of the
binder will contain the same information as described in Section 1.6.2.3 for the O & M Manuals.
3. There are instances whereby the POR (i.e. schematics) may be incorporated into the O & M
manuals.
4. At the direction of LRT D&C additional sets of drawings and CD’s for certain contracts may be
required for institutional stakeholder groups.
5. POR drawings in electronic and paper format are to be submitted to ETS no later than 60 days after
completion of construction.
Volume 7 – Controls
Note: If more than one binder is required for one discipline it will have an alpha designation such as A,
B, C etc. Refer to Appendix I, Standard Record Documents Additional Requirements.
A Consultant with a contract package with limited mechanical, electrical, and HVAC
components may produce a combined O & M Manual. The Consultant must first have written
approval from the Project Office to produce a combined document.
Six (6) 215 x 280 mm capacity extension type expanding spine catalogue binders, for each
volume must be provided. They are to be bound in heavyweight dark blue fabricord (Ontario
Buckham, OBV-460) debossed hot stamped in white lettering on front and spine. Each copy
will be permanently numbered 1 to 6. Binders should be of sufficient capacity to hold system
data while in the closed position (not expanded - maximum width 75 mm).
The number of volumes can be increased and renumbered as necessary.
1.7.2.5 Manual Cover and Spine Layout
The information to be provided on the binder cover and spine is listed below.
- Operation and Maintenance Manual
- Project Name
- Work Package Descriptor and Contract Number
- Volume Number / Discipline
- Month & Year (Substantial Completion Certificate is issued)
- Name of Owner (The City of Edmonton) Cover only
- Name of Project Manager Cover only
- Name of Consultant Cover only
- Name of General (Prime) Contractor Cover only
- Set X of 6 Spine only
Smaller tabs with various colors as noted below are used to divide each System Group
into various sections.
Layout
Title Page (white)
Contains the same information as embossed on the front cover of the binder. Page is inserted
into a clear plastic cover.
Table of Contents (white tab)
Indicates the information contained in the manual by System Group and Section. Each
volume will have its own table of contents.
Introduction (to the manual) (white tab)
Provides a written description of the layout of the manual, its intended use, its purpose and
instructions on how to use the manual.
Scheduled Maintenance Summary Chart
Warranty/Scheduled Maintenance/Breakdown Maintenance Log Sheets:
Sample Maintenance Sheet
Blank Maintenance Sheet
List of Drawings
List of Specifications
Equipment Schedules
Consultant, Contractor, Supplier Lists (grey tab)
The full identification requirements for the consultants, contractors, suppliers are:
- Legal company name
- Full address and postal code
- Telephone number including area code
- Facsimile number
- Email address of designated contact
Safety in Maintenance (Red)
This section of the manual is intended to provide a basic overview of safety and first aid
procedures, as well as to stress certain basics when developing an in-house safety program.
It is in no way intended to be contrary to occupational health and safety regulations, or internal
safety procedures.
Contractor Guarantee/Warranty Certificates (Green)
Both a "sample" and a "blank" warranty/breakdown maintenance/scheduled maintenance log
sheet are to be included in this section with instructions on how to complete the forms.
System Group Section
The following is the standard layout for each System Group Section:
General Requirements for Division Numbers 2 through 17:
The System Group items that are listed under each Division are generally representative of
those that are found in most contracts. The Consultant, in conjunction with the Contractor, will
make the final determination of the work items to be included along with the tab section
numbering system. Using Division 16 Electrical as an example, the System Group would be
1.0 Power and Distribution, 2.0 Lighting, 3.0 Life Protection, etc.
Further to the example of Electrical would be the Sections under the System Group ‘Power
and Distribution’ of 1.1 Incoming Electrical Power Services, 1.2 Secondary Power Distribution,
etc.
Within each of the Sections would be the four chapter tabs:
Dark Orange– Description of the Section (system), its basic operation and summary of its
intended function
Blue – Components (Manufacturers product data, schedules, directories, schematics,
maintenance items or bulletins)
Yellow – Shop Drawings
Green – Test Results
List of Divisions
Division 2 – Sitework
Demolition
Excavation
Backfill
Site Grading
Paving and Surfacing
Landscaping
Survey – as built
*Trackwork
*Note: Will generally require a separate O&M manual.
Division 3 – Concrete
Expansion Joints
Concrete floor finishes
Restoration and cleaning
Special finishes
Division 4 – Masonry
Concrete Masonry
Expansion Joints
Restoration and cleaning
Division 5 – Metals
Metal Fabrications
Expansion Control Joints
Sole plates
Bearings
Ornamental Metal
Division 6 – Wood and Plastic
Millwork
Laminated plastic
Architectural Woodwork
Division 7 – Thermal and Moisture Protection
Waterproofing – membrane & fluid
Membrane roofing
Roof accessories – skylights & hatches
Bituminous damp proofing
Built-up single membrane roofing
- Miscellaneous Systems
Refer to Appendix I Standard Record Documents Additional Requirements, 2. Division 16
Electrical
*Division 17 – BMS Controls
*Note: Will generally require a separate O&M Manual.
The following topics are to be covered in the BMS division of the Manual and will be tabbed in
accordance with the following major sections:
- Design Intent
- Description of System
- System Start-Up
- Operation of the System
- Maintenance Requirements
Design Intent
This section outlines the design intent and provides a system overview that describes the
relationships between the hardware, operating system, control software and other control
components.
Description of System
This section will provide a detailed description of all system components, hardware, parts, and
software. It should be presented in accordance with the following tabbed subsections:
1. DIVISION 15 - MECHANICAL
Plan of Record drawings must identify location of fire dampers, major control lines, access
doors, tagged valves and actual room names or numbers.
In general, the Mechanical O&M manual has three volumes as follows:
Volume 2A – Mechanical Operations
This volume is organized as follows:
Introduction
Is in accordance with Section 1.7.2 the general requirements.
Table of Contents
Is in accordance with Section 1.7.2 the general requirements.
Consultants, Contractors and Suppliers
Is in accordance with Section 1.7.2 the general requirements.
Mechanical Systems
List of Mechanical Drawings
Description of Systems
Provide a complete and accurate description of the installed systems as follows:
- A detailed system description and a description of components comprising that
system.
- An explanation of how the mechanical components interface with electrical
components to complete the system.
- Location of thermostats, controllers, or operating switches used.
- Summer or winter operating variances.
- Controller operating set points and control application programs.
Operating Division
An accurate and detailed description of the operation of major components must be
provided as follows:
- Information on how to energize components.
- The exact locations of switches and controls.
- The way in which components interface with other components.
- The operation of controls including the operational sequence.
- The operational changes for summer or winter operation, and how to accomplish the
changeover.
- The complete operating sequence, and safeguards to check if equipment goes off
line.
2. DIVISION 16 - ELECTRICAL
In general, Division 16 is organized as follows:
Title Page
Is in accordance with Section 1.7.2 General Requirements.
Table of Contents
Is in accordance with Section 1.7.2 General Requirements.
Introduction
ROW Telephones
Emergency Phones
Elevator Phones
Washroom Access Phones
Information Phones
Public Pay Phones
4.4 CCTV
Platform Cameras
Transit Centre Cameras
ROW Cameras
CCTV and BMS
Matrix Switches
Video Transmission (Ethernet/IP)
Digital Video Recorders (DVR’s)
4.5 Public Address
Station and Platform Components
Sequence of Operation
4.6 Variable Messaging System (VMS)
VMS System
VMS Signs and Locations
4.7 Ticket and Fare Validation
Operation and Wiring Requirements
4.8 Miscellaneous Systems
Reserved for Future
3. TRACTION POWER
3.1 Traction Power Substations
In addition to the requirements outlined in Section 1.7.1 one set of Plan of Record drawings
must be left at the substation.
The O&M manuals will provide the following in addition to the standard requirements.
Note: The following was taken from Sections 2.4 and 2.5 of the Traction Power Substations Electrical
Standards and Design Guidelines Manual. They were modified to provide additional requirements only.
Electrical Systems
Provides a detailed description of the equipment installed and a list of all supplies
including a list of the drawings used, along with a brief description of each drawing.
Detailed procedures are outlined for all systems and related equipment covering the
following:
- Equipment manufacturer’s scheduled maintenance sheets and check lists.
Scheduled maintenance sheets shall include detailed daily, monthly and yearly
scheduled maintenance requirements.
- Maintenance safety suggestions and procedures.
- Final shop drawings including schematics and wiring diagrams.
- List of all major trades, subtrades and suppliers including names of equipment
supplied and by whom, addresses, phone numbers, facsimile numbers and contact
persons.
- All data necessary to compile a complete comprehensive Preventative Maintenance
program. Data gathered shall be neatly hand-written on forms.
- Spare/replacement parts lists for all of the above. Copies of the electrical contractor’s
data collection sheets available during tendering period when requested.
- Test results as outlined in other sections of this standard.
Certification and Testing
Contains certification information and copies of all tests performed on the equipment
installed indicating acceptance of the installation including the Final Inspection Certificate
from the authority having jurisdiction (EPCOR Inspection Services).
Shop Drawings and Maintenance Manuals
This section contains detailed information on all equipment and materials used within the
Substation Room under separate sub sections as outlined in the Table of Contents.
3.2 Traction Power Overhead Catenary System
Note: The following was taken from OCS Engineering Standards Manual and modified to provide
additional requirements only.
4. SIGNALS
All Plan of Record drawings related to the field installation of signal equipment must include
the dimensioned position of all buried and embedded conduit runs.
All LRT signal system O&M manuals must include the following additional requirements*:
Note: Source is the Engineering Standards Manual for signals (Omnia).
escrow. All relevant contact information for the company holding the code in escrow must
be provided to ETS.
1
Chapter 2 – Revision Tracking Form
2
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
2.0 VEHICLES
Page
2.0 VEHICLES 1
2.1 INTRODUCTION 1
2.2 RAIL STANDARDS AND OTHER DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS 1
2.2.1 Flammability, Smoke, and Toxicity Considerations 1
2.2.2 Environmental Considerations 1
2.2.3 Shock and Vibration Considerations 1
2.2.4 Electromagnetic Interference Considerations 1
2.2.5 Track Design Considerations 2
2.3 LIGHT RAIL VEHICLES 2
2.3.1 General 2
2.3.2 U2 Light Rail Vehicle 3
2.3.3 SD160 Light Rail Vehicle 6
2.3.4 Design Vehicle 9
2.4 AUXILIARY EQUIPMENT 9
2.4.1 Equipment Description 9
2.4.2 Work Train Characteristics 9
2.5 STATIC AND DYNAMIC ENVELOPE CONSIDERATIONS 10
List of Figures
Figure 2.1 - U2 LRV General Characteristics
Figure 2.2 - SD160 LRV General Characteristics
Figure 2.3 - Design LRV General Characteristics
Figure 2.4 - Work Train General Characteristics
2.0 VEHICLES
2.1 INTRODUCTION
For the most part, information contained in this chapter is specific to the U2 and SD160 light
rail vehicles and other auxiliary equipment currently being operated by Edmonton Transit.
When new vehicles and equipment are acquired in the future, this equipment will meet all
requirements related to the operational and physical limitations of the existing stations, right-
of-way infrastructure, and maintenance areas.
This chapter is divided into several sections:
● Section 2.2 lists rail environment design considerations in terms of both industry
standards and ETS generated documents.
● Section 2.3 provides a description of the U2 and SD160 vehicles and highlights their
major characteristics.
● Section 2.4 lists rail borne auxiliary equipment used at ETS and the heaviest loadings of
this equipment.
Chapter 3, Clearances and Right-of-Way, provides the criteria for the development of
Edmonton’s Design Vehicle and the clearances that are required for the fixed infrastructure to
allow unimpeded passage along the trackway.
Due to the ongoing acquisition of new vehicles and equipment, and modifications to the
existing vehicles and equipment, Design Consultants must verify with ETS that this guideline
reflects the current status of the fleet.
2.2 RAIL STANDARDS AND OTHER DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS
The overhead catenary wires supply LRV consists with short duration DC current well into the
kiloampere range. This current generates magnetic fields around the catenary wiring and
track negative current return paths.
High Frequency EMI occurs when the current flow is momentarily broken as the LRV’s
pantograph crosses an insulated section on the overhead catenary wire. This break in the
current flow causes radio frequency (RF) noise to be radiated by the catenary. Similar high
frequency EMI arcing may also occur when there is severe icing on the overhead wire in the
winter.
The U2 LRVs generate electric fields with high frequency switching transients as the
camshafts and other equipment make and break electrical contacts within the LRV. The
SD160 LRVs contain IGBT based power electronic inverters that switch large currents at high
frequencies. This switching action is a further source of electromagnetic interference. The
SD160 LRVs also contain a variety of other low power electronic devices that can act as
sources of EMI.
All of these sources have the potential of affecting sensitive electronic equipment located in
facilities immediately adjacent to the LRT ROW.
No specific electromagnetic emission data was available from Siemens for the U2 LRVs.
However, a 2007 study by Turner Engineering Corporation (ETS-LRV-VEN-0009) was
undertaken to assess the impact of the Edmonton U2 LRV on sensitive electronic equipment
including MRIs within the University of Alberta area. The study concluded that the U2 vehicles
will not generate sufficiently high levels of EMI interference to adversely affect the operation of
the equipment located in the University area.
2. Fifty-seven (57) SD160 light rail vehicles were purchased in two sets (EDM IV and EDM
V) and delivered in 2009 and 2012 respectively. These vehicles are an AC propulsion
technology and generate tractive effort using variable voltage variable frequency drives
supplying power to three-phase induction motors.
The U2 and SD160 cars are six-axle double-ended high- floor articulated cars resting on two
powered bogies and one non-powered bogie. Both vehicles are designed for high platform
loading and offloading of passengers while operating in consists of up to five cars in length.
The vehicle car bodies are of a lightweight welded steel design. LAHT steel side sheets have
been welded to a frame type super structure. This car body shell has been coated with body
filler and sanded to create a smooth ripple free surface prior to painting. The cab ends are
manufactured of reinforced fiberglass, which have been attached to the steel shell of the car
body.
Due to the significant difference in technology between them, the two vehicle types are
incompatible in terms of running in mixed U2/SD160 train consist for the purpose of revenue
activities. In an emergency it is possible for vehicles from one fleet to mechanically couple with
and “dead-tow” vehicles from the other fleet.
2.3.2 U2 Light Rail Vehicle
2.3.2.1 Vehicle Type
The U2 vehicle used by ETS was jointly designed and manufactured by Siemens and Duewag
in Germany. Duewag was responsible for the structural and mechanical portions of the vehicle
design while Siemens designed the light rail vehicles electrical equipment and systems.
Under the original contract the Edmonton U2 vehicles were designated as RTE and delivered
in three series; RTE1 (14 cars), RTE2 (3 cars) and RTE3/4 (8/12 cars).
2.3.2.2 Vehicle Dimensions
Refer to Figure 2.1 for the U2 vehicle governing dimensions and general characteristics.
2.3.2.3 Vehicle Capacity and Weight at a given Passenger Loading
Passenger weight loading was calculated using 68 kg per passenger. This resulted in the
following loadings for the U2 Fleet:
Passenger Loading
Loading Mass of loaded U2 Passengers
Passenger Distribution
Onboard
AW0 34,900 kg Empty none
AW1 39,184 kg 63 passengers fully seated load + driver
fully seated load + driver + 4
AW2 45,780 kg 160 passengers
standees/m2
fully seated load + driver + 6
AW3 49,112 kg 209 passengers
standees/m2
258 passengers fully seated load + driver + 8
AW4 52,444 kg
(crush load) standees/m2
Figure 2.1 also shows the distribution of the AW4 load to each bogie.
2.3.2.4 Door Control
The U2 LRV has four double bifolding doors per side for a total of eight doors per car. The
bifold panels in each doorway are electrically driven and controlled by electro-magnetic locks.
With the bifold doors open, the doorway width is 1340 mm and the doorway height is 1920
mm. This opening is divided by a vertical center stanchion containing the door push button
switch and an optical obstruction sensor.
The doors are unlocked and the side selected by the Motorman through panel switches in the
active cab. Once unlocked and selected, the doors can be opened individually by passengers
using the stanchion mounted pushbutton switches located in each doorway. A driver’s access
door feature allows the Motorman to only select and release the doors immediately adjacent to
the active driver’s cab.
2.3.2.5 Accessibility Features
Each U2 LRV is equipped with two automated access ramps in the “A” carbody. When the
handicapped access pushbutton is pressed, the ramp lowers and aligns itself with the edge of
the station platform using two optical sensors. The ramp will return to the up position prior to
the door closing on the next door close cycle. An extension on the outside edge of the ramp
helps to reduce the horizontal gap between the station platform and vehicle.
A curved yellow stanchion replaces the stainless steel straight stanchion at each ramp access
door. This curved stanchion facilitates the moving of mobility devices in and out of the LRV.
The passenger seats situated between the ramp access doors and the articulation joint have
been arranged longitudinally to provide additional space for mobility devices to maneuver.
The ramp operation adds approximately eleven (11) seconds to the door open, door close
cycle.
2.3.2.9 Electrical
Power Collection
Vehicle power is collected from the overhead catenary system by a pantograph mounted close
to the articulation section on the roof of the “A” car of the LRV. A surge arrestor is mounted
close to the pantograph to protect against over voltages and lightning strikes.
The overhead catenary supply is protected against short circuits and overloads occurring on
the light rail vehicle by a vehicle-mounted 2-pole automatic circuit breaker.
Operating Voltages and Current Draw
The U2 LRV will operate at a nominal line voltage of 660 VDC (+20% to –30%). The
maximum current draw for each LRV motor is adjusted to 420 amps while accelerating. There
are two motors per LRV for a total current draw of 840 amps during acceleration.
Auxiliary Power Supply
All thirty-seven (37) car U2 vehicles have power electronic based auxiliary converters supplied
by Transtechnik. These converters will operate from the 660 VDC supply and provide the
following outputs; 3-phase 220 VAC/100 Hz (1 kVA), 3-phase 220 VAC/50 Hz or 176 VAC/40
Hz (switchable) (4 kVA), 3-phase 19.6 VAC/100 Hz (.5 kVA), and a 27.9 VDC (2.7 kW) low
voltage power supply and battery charging circuit for the 24 VDC battery.
Automatic Controls
The LRV is equipped with an automatic train control device to prevent collisions and unsafe
operating speeds. If the vehicle passes a red wayside signal, the automatic train control will
apply a Mandatory Brake (an irrecoverable forced brake stop).
Each vehicle is equipped with a dead-man switch which must be actively engaged by the
Operator when a train is in a driveable mode to prevent the train applying a Mandatory Brake.
Each bogie has an electrically released/spring applied disc brake system that is used to
bring the car to a final stop. These disc brakes are applied after dynamic braking has
reduced the LRV speed to 5 to 7 km/h.
● Track Brake System
Each bogie is equipped with two track brakes that are used in emergency conditions.
These track brakes are electromagnetic brakes that contact the rail when energized.
There are three braking rates used on the LRV. They are:
Maximum Service Brake rate 1.3 m/s2
Mandatory Brake rate 1.7 m/s2
Emergency Brake rate 2.7 m/s2
During a mandatory braking event where dynamic braking fails to achieve an acceptable
deceleration rate of 1.7 m/s2 the track brakes will activate to increase braking effort.
2.3.2.11 Suspension
The primary suspension is comprised of 8 rubber chevrons, whereas the secondary
suspension is 4 double coil springs with lateral and vertical shock absorbers.
The maximum suspension vertical deflection at AW4 loading is 38 mm. There is no horizontal
movement.
Figure 2.2 also shows the distribution of the AW4 load to each bogie.
2.3.3.11 Electrical
Operating Voltages and Current Draw
The SD160 will operate on the ETS track system at a nominal line voltage of 660 V DC (+20%
to –30%).
Power Collection
Power to the vehicle is collected by a pantograph mounted on the roof of the A carbody close
to the articulation section.
Auxiliary Power Supply
An auxiliary power supply supplies power for the vehicle’s miscellaneous electrical equipment.
Low-voltage power will be supplied as part of the AC auxiliary power source. The design of
the low-voltage power supply will be integrated with that of the AC auxiliary power source to
minimize weight and to maximize performance.
Automatic Controls
The SD160 LRV is equipped with an automatic train control device to prevent collisions and
unsafe operating speeds. If the vehicle passes a red wayside signal, the automatic train
control will apply a Mandatory Brake (an irrecoverable forced brake stop). This braking mode
is unrecoverable until the vehicle comes to a complete stop.
Each vehicle is equipped with a dead-man switch. The deadman switch must be actively
engaged by the Operator when a train is in a driveable mode to prevent the train applying a
Mandatory Brake.
2.3.3.12 Vehicle Performance Characteristics
Motors
The propulsion system is a dual redundant system to ensure maximum reliability. It
incorporates under-frame mounted, variable voltage, variable frequency drives to control two
(2), three-phase induction motors on each of the two powered bogies.
Speed/Propulsion
i) Speed Characteristics
Maximum design speed = 80 km/h
Maximum operating speed = 70 km/h
ii) Acceleration
The average acceleration rate is 1.32 m/s2. Acceleration is load compensated up to AW3.
iii) Jerk Limits
The maximum rate at which acceleration can change is 1.3 m/s3.
Braking
The SD160 LRV has three braking systems.
● Dynamic Braking System
Controlled dynamic braking is continuously available from maximum vehicle speed down
to a speed of 5 km/h or less. Dynamic braking is regenerative or rheostatic depending on
the receptivity of the overhead catenary system.
● Friction Brake System
The friction braking system is an electronically controlled, electric-hydraulic system,
functioning as the ultimate braking system on the light rail vehicle and acting as a backup
to dynamic braking during normal service braking and as the primary braking system
during emergency stops and while parked.
For vehicle loading above AW2 the friction braking system supplements dynamic braking
to ensure requested braking rates are achieved.
● Track Brake System
The track brake system is used in emergency conditions. Each bogie has two
electromagnetic track brakes that contact the rail when energized.
There are three braking rates used on the LRV. They are:
Maximum Service Brake rate 1.34 m/s2
Mandatory Brake rate 1.7 m/s2
Emergency brake rate 2.65 m/s2
Braking rates are load compensated up to AW3. At weights above AW3, the braking rate is
reduced proportional to the weight of the vehicle.
2.3.3.13 Suspension
The vehicle’s primary suspension is chevron elastomeric springs. In addition, each truck
bolster is supported by a secondary suspension system consisting of coil springs.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
3.1 INTRODUCTION 1
List of Figures
Figure 3 – U2 Static Envelope
Figure 3.1B – SD160 Static Envelope
Figure 3.2 – Design Vehicle Dynamic Envelope
Figure 3.3 – Curvature Effects Design Vehicle
Figure 3.4 – Curvature Effects Table of Calculated Values
Figure 3.5 – Superelevation Effects on Curves U2 Vehicle
Figure 3.6 – Superelevation Effects Table of Calculated Values
Figure 3.7 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (Open)
Figure 3.8A – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (Shared Use)
Figure 3.8B – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Embedded Track (Shared Use)
Figure 3.9 – Clearance Requirements at Station Platform
Figure 3.10 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (TBM Tunnel)
Figure 3.11 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (SEM Tunnel)
Figure 3.12 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (Underground Single
Box)
Figure 3.13 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (Elevated Structure)
Figure 3.14 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (Retained Cut)
Figure 3.15 – Clearance Envelope Level Tangent Track (Retained Fill)
Figure 3.16 – Vertical Clearance to Overhead Catenary
Figure 3.17 – Vertical Clearance to Utilities Crossing Overhead Catenary
Figure 3.18A – Typical Section Combined Major Trackway Elements Shared Use
ROW
Figure 3.18B – Typical Section Embedded Mainline Trackway Elements Shared
Use ROW
Figure 3.19 – Typical Section Combined Major Trackway Elements TBM Tunnel
Figure 3.20 – Typical Section Combined Major Trackway Elements Underground
Single Box
Figure 3.21 – Typical Section Combined Major Trackway Elements Elevated
Structure
Figure 3.22 – Typical Section Combined Major Trackway Elements
Portal/Retained Cut
Figure 3.23 – Typical Section Combined Major Trackway Elements Type lll
Station with Roof)
APPENDIX l – ROW Widths Worksheet (Worksheet for Minimum and Preferred ROW
Widths for a Sample of Typical LRT Mainline Level Tangent Trackway Cross
Section Configurations).
3.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter provides guidelines and criteria for Clearances and Right-of-Way. Definitions
and terminology for both topics are presented at the outset. These definitions and terms will
be used consistently throughout these LRT Design Guidelines.
Section 3.3, along with the accompanying figures, sets out the minimum acceptable
dimensions required to assure that proper clearances are provided between ontrack vehicles
and adjacent trackway elements, structures or obstructions.
The clearance figures are supplemented with a number of general cross-sectional figures that
illustrate the majority of the major LRT related elements and components that have to be
accommodated within the LRT right-of-way.
The chapter concludes with a description of the factors that should be considered by the
Consultant when defining the LRT right-of-way limits.
Trackwork Installation and Maintenance Tolerances define the allowable deviations of the
installed track from the design track centreline and the allowable tolerances for maintenance.
Structural Clearances are the minimum horizontal and vertical clearance requirements for
different trackway elements. The structural clearance requirements for different trackway
elements may vary significantly.
The trackway element consultant is responsible for determining the structural clearances in
accordance with the LRT Design Guidelines.
Design Vehicle Running Clearance Envelope is defined as the space occupied by the
Design Vehicle Dynamic Envelope plus additional dynamic clearance requirements, as
applicable, for curvature, superelevation, structural clearances and the effects of wayside
factors including allowable manufacturing and maintenance tolerances.
The definitions / terminology in the following sections, 3.2.2 and 3.2.3, are commonly used on
the Edmonton LRT System.
Exclusive Use is an operating environment whereby the LRT alignment has exclusive and
unimpeded use of the ROW. It is not shared with any other mode. The trackway is grade
separated or separated / protected by a fence or barrier.
The only portions of Edmonton’s LRT system that falls within this category are the
underground tunnels from downtown to the University and the grade-separated bridge
crossing in river valley.
Semi-exclusive Use is an operating environment whereby the LRT alignment is located in a
separate ROW where motorists, pedestrians and bicyclists cross at designated controlled
crossings only.
The SLRT extension south of Health Sciences Station to Century Park Station is an example
of this type of operating environment.
Shared Use is the operating environment where the LRT alignment is shared with other
modes such as:
Roadway – the roadway is located beside and parallel to the LRT alignment or the LRT
alignment is located within the road median.
Railway – the railway is generally located beside and parallel to the LRT alignment.
Walkway/Bikeway (also referred to as a shared use path) – located beside and parallel to
the LRT alignment.
Frequent at-grade roadway and pedestrian crossings are evident that may require active or
passive control measures.
An example of this operating environment is the northeast LRT corridor from Clareview Station
to 95 Street.
Mixed Use is the operating environment whereby the LRT alignment is integrated with
vehicular, pedestrian and bicycle traffic. There are no barriers or buffers providing a
separation with the LRT alignment.
Edmonton currently does not have an example of this operating environment.
3.3 CLEARANCES
The ability to ensure the safe passage of LRV’s within the LRT ROW is of utmost concern to
ETS. The provision of adequate clearances will be rigorously monitored during both the
design and construction phase of the LRT project.
All designs must meet or exceed the minimum clearance criteria contained herein.
Clearances greater than those shown should be provided whenever this can be achieved
without adversely influencing the cost of the facility under consideration.
Horizontal clearance dimensions are always measured in a horizontal plane irrespective of
any superelevation in the track. They are to apply along a line projected perpendicular to the
reference track centreline.
Vertical clearances are all measured in a vertical plane to the reference track centreline
elevations.
Section 3.2 provides a number of industry-wide clearance related definitions and terms for the
Consultant’s reference. The following section provides additional terminology and the
methodology for determining the vehicle minimum running clearance requirements to be
applied on the Edmonton LRT System.
Note: The criteria presented in these Guidelines is primarily based on the U2 LRV. The design
consultants for the trackway, stations and other structural elements must check the minimum clearances
based on the SD160 LRV and identify any conflicts that will require resolution early in the design
process.
Additional Clearances
The minimum running clearance requirements for bored tunnels must provide additional
clearance due to curvature and superelevation. On curved track with superelevation, the
bored tunnel centreline does not coincide with the track centreline. A vertical and horizontal
shift of the tunnel alignment will occur relative to the track centerline. The shift in tunnel
alignment can be determined in the formulae given in Figure 3.5.
Catwalk and Utility Fixtures on Tunnel Wall
The minimum running clearance requirements in the bored tunnel must also consider the
presence of a catwalk, utility fixtures and the operating requirements of the overhead catenary
system.
In a bored tunnel, the minimum running clearance to the concrete topping of the catwalk is
determined by both the Design Vehicle dynamic envelope (refer to Figure 3.2) and the
curvature effects of both the Design Vehicle dynamic envelope and the LRV dynamic outline
(refer to the table in Figure 3.4).
The concrete duct bank (under the catwalk) is considered to be a permanent structure. The
minimum running clearance must be determined in accordance with the DVDE (refer to
Figures 3.10 and 3.11).
The following table provides a summary of the minimum and preferred ROW widths for a
typical LRT surface running configurations. It is recommended that LRT ROW limits be
established to accommodate preferred ROW widths wherever possible. The preferred widths
provide the Designer with some flexibility in accommodating *unforeseen circumstances that
may arise during the alignment design and construction phases. Designing to the minimum
(while accommodating the clearance criteria and elements described in Section 3.5.2) does
not provide any flexibility for accommodating *unforeseen ROW issues.
Note: Unforeseen circumstances can include, but is not limited to the following: topography variations;
ground conditions dictate that the design of the base of the ballast curb be wider than typical; pedestrian
gates/fencing placement is non-typical; decision made at design phase to locate one of ductbanks
outside of trackway; service vehicle access to trackway or to ductbanks outside and inside trackway may
not follow the typical design approach.
There will be LRT alignment design configurations whereby LRT elements and components
must be located to the side of the LRT trackway. In these instances the centerline of trackway
is offset from the centerline of the ROW on a number of the typical ROW cross-sections listed
in the Summary Table and Appendix 1. The Trackway/ROW Planner/Designer must confirm
the component location/requirements and related ROW width with ETS before finalizing the
preliminary LRT ROW and the related establishment of the limits of the adjacent subdivision
plans.
Details of the derivation of minimum and preferred ROW width requirements are provided in
Appendix I.
Note: Figures have not been developed for all of the cross-section configurations listed in the tables. If
included in the Guidelines they are referenced.
Summary Table
Minimum and Preferred ROW Widths for a Sample of Typical LRT Mainline Level
Tangent Trackway Cross Section Configurations
2E Basic Curbed Trackway with Noise Wall and Shared Use 18,495 18,995
Path -one side
2F Type 3 Station with 9 m Platform, Curbed Trackway and 26,755 27,255
Noise Wall and MUT on one side
2G Basic Curbed Trackway at Pocket Track 22,260 23,160
3 TRACKWAY IN MEDIAN OF 4 – Lane ARTERIAL ROAD
3Ai) Curbed Trkwy. No Left Turns at Intersections 12,700
Aii) Curbed Trkwy. All Ped Crossings Allowed (refer to Fig. - 24,025
18.2)
Aiii) Curbed Trkwy. Ped Crossings one Side Only Allowed - 22,625
(refer to Fig. 18.3)
Aiv) Curbed Trkwy. No Ped Crossings Allowed (refer to Fig. - 21,220
18.4)
3B LRT Station with 9 m Platform Ped Crossing one Side Only 30,020
Allowed (refer to Fig. 18.5)
3C LRT Station with 9 m Platform No Ped Crossings Allowed - 28,530
(refer to Fig. 18.6)
3D Curbed Trackway at Pocket Track (subject to Ped Crossing - TBD
condition 3B or 3C)
4 TRACKWAY BESIDE OPERATING RAILWAY
Provide a min. of 6000 mm offset from centre of R/R track to TBD TBD
centerline of closest LRT track.
Note: Horizontal curves, cut or fill condition will increase ROW requirement. Typically ROW width will be
established when Trackway vertical and horizontal alignment preliminary design is finalized.
The limits of the permanent ROW will be vertical or horizontal planes and must be defined
using simple curves and tangents only. *Spiral curves are not to be used. Chords may be
used under special conditions with the prior approval of ETS.
Note: Refer to Alberta Land Surveyors Manual of Standard Practise regarding Railway Surveys
Normally for surface running conditions the upper or lower limit of ROW is not defined. If an
upper and lower limit is required (e.g. LRT running in tunnel under private property) it should
be described by the elevations of horizontal planes.
3.6.1.2 Easement
An easement is a non-possessing interest held by one party in the land owned by another
party whereby the first party is allowed the partial use of the land for a specified purpose.
There are various types of easements as follows:
Permanent surface easement with defined lateral limits. If required, upper and lower limits
may also be described.
Permanent underground easement. It encompasses the total LRT facility located below
the surface of the ground. In addition to lateral limits, upper and lower limits are also
described.
Permanent aerial easement. This type of easement completely encompasses the aerial
portion of the LRT facility. Lower, lateral, and if required upper limits are described.
Construction Easement. It is established to allow a Contractor the use of a specified
portion of private property for construction purposes. It is temporary in nature with a pre-
determined duration for occupancy.
Utility Easement. This is an easement that is required for the installation of LRT related
utilities. They are to be treated as right-of-way. They must be in accordance with the
utility agency regulations.
Appendix l
Worksheet for Minimum and Preferred ROW Widths for a
Sample of Typical LRT Mainline Level Tangent Trackway Cross
Section Configurations.
Figure 3.6
*Note:
Design Vehicle's top corner = 3401 mm from top of rail
U2's top corner = 2912 mm from top of rail
U2's floor level = 943 mm from top of rail at AW4 loading
Siemens SD160 floor level = 937 mm from top of rail at AW4 loading
Siemens SD160's top corner ( at camera position) = 3115 mm from top of rail
1of1
Appendix l Minimum and Preferred ROW Widths for Sample of Typical LRT Mainline Level Tangent Trackway Cross Section Configurations
1-TRACKWAY OPEN AREA Minimum Preferred 2 -TRACKWAY BESIDE ARTERIAL/COLLECTOR RD (cont'd) Minimum Preferred
ROW mm ROW mm Details of Dimensions ROW mm ROW mm Details of Dimensions
1A - Basic Trackway with Ditches - (refer to Figs. 3.7 & 5.4) 2C - Basic Curbed Trackway
i) Min. distance from centreline of trackway to ROW limit: 6607(2250+1800+1557+1000)+1500+500+500=9107 2250-dist. from centre of trackway to centre of track:1800-dist fr.centre of track to top edge ballast Min. distance from Trkwy center to farside ROW Limit: 2250+2300+650+500=5700 2250 - distance from Trkwy centre to centreline of track
Min. ROW: 9107x2=18215 rd'd (based on 3:1 sideslope) 18,215 1557+1000-dist. Fr. top edge of ballast to bottom of ditch:6607 dist. Fr. Centre of trkwy to center of ditch Min. distance from track center to BOC: 2250+2300+300+1500=6350 2300 - distance from centreline of track to trackside top edge of ballast curb
(Option available to locate all ductbanks between tracks or Comm ductbank at top of ditch slope) 1500 - 3:1 min sideslope farside of ditch Min ROW: 5700+6350 = 12050 (All ductbanks located between tracks) 12,050 650- width of base of ballast curb
500 - rounding at top of ditch 500- min offset from ballast curb base to farside ROW limit
500 - minimum offset from rounding to min. LRT ROW limit Pref. dist. fr. Trkwy centre to farside ROW limit - provide 1000 offset from outside of ballast curb =6200 1500 - dist. from outside top edge of ballast curb to LRT ROW Limit (Fig.3.8)
Pref. dist. From Trkwy centre to BOC - 2250+2300+300+5000=9850
ii) Preferred distance from Track Center to ROW Limit:6607+1750+500+1000=9857 6607 - dist. From centre of trkwy to centre of ditch Preferred ROW: 6200+9850=16050 16,050 1000-preferred offset from ballast curb base to farside ROW limit
Preferred ROW: 9857x2=19715 (based on 3.5/1 sideslope) 19,715 1750 -31/2:1 preferred sideslope farside of ditch (Comm ductbank located between roadside ballast curb and BOC) 5000- preferred distance from top of ballast curb to BOC (refer to Fig3.8)
(Option available to locate all ductbanks between tracks or Comm ductbank at top of ditch slope) 500 - rounding at top of ditch 2D - Basic Curbed Trackway at Track Crossover
1000-preferred offset from rounding to preferred ROW limit Min. distance from Trkwy center to farside ROW Limit: 2250+2300+650+500=5700 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track
1B - Basic Trackway with subdrains (refer to Fig.3.7) Min.dist. from Trky center to BOC of road 2250+2300+300+1225+500=6575 2300-distance from centreline of track to track side of ballast curb
i) Abs. Min. distance from centreline of trackway to ROW limit: 2250+1800+1200+500=5750 2250 - distance from centreline of trkwy to centreline of track Min ROW: 5700+6575=12275 12,275 300-width of top of tapered ballast curb
Abs. Min. ROW: 5750x2=11500 11,500 1800 - distance from centreline of track to top outside edge of track ballast (Comm Ductbank between road and tracks. All other ductbanks located between tracks) 650-width of base of tapered ballast curb
(All ductbanks located between tracks, width marginally adequate to house wayside equip. 1200 - distance from top edge of ballast to the outside edge of subdrain 500- min offset from base of ballast curb to farside ROW limit
500 - minimum offset from outside edge of subdrain to min. LRT ROW Limit Preferred dist. from Trkwy center to farside ROW limit 2250+2300+650+1000=6200
ii)Preferred distance from Tkwy centre to ROW Limit:2250+1800+1200+1000=6250 Preferred dist. from Track Center to BOC of road 2250+2300+300+4000=8850 1225-width of blower pad
Preferred ROW: 6250x2=12500 (All ductbanks between tracks) 12,500 1000 - preferred offset from outside of ductbank to LRT ROW limit Preferred ROW: 6200+8850=15050 15,050 1000-preferred offset from base of ballast curb to farside ROW limit
iii) Preferred dist.from Trkwy centre to ROW Limit on ductbank side:2250+1800+1200+1950+500+1000=8700 1950 - distance from outside edge of subdrain to centre of typical 1000 comm. ductbank (Provides exclusive service vehicle layby, comm ductbank between trackway and road 4000- distance from to edge of ballast curb to edge of road travelled lane (layby width)
Preferred ROW: 6250+8700=14950 14,950 500-distance from centre of ductbank for farside edge of ductbank and switch blower pad in service vehicle layby)
(Locate Comm. Ductbank on one side of Trackway and provide 1000 offset to ROW Limit) 1000 - preferred offset from farside edge of ductbank to preferred LRT ROW limit
1C - Basic Curbed Trackway (refer to Fig 3.8) 2E - Basic Curbed Trackway with Noise Wall and MUT on one side
i) Min. distance from trackway center to ROW Limt 2250+2600+1500=6350 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track (Based on Typical 114 Street North of 76 Ave.) 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track
Min. ROW: 6350x2=12700 12,700 2600 - distance from centreline trackway to outside top edge of 300 ballast curb Min. distance from Track center to farside ROW Limit:2250+2300+295+500+3000+500=8845 2300 - distance from centreline of track to trackside face of noise wall cap
(All ductbanks located between tracks) 1500 - distance from outside top edge of ballast curb to LRT ROW Limit Min. distance from track center to BOC:2250+7400=9650 295 - width of noise wall cap
Min ROW: 8845+9650=18495 18,495 500 - distance from MUT side face of noise wall cap to trackside edge of MUT
ii) Preferred distance from trky centre to ROW limit 2250+2600+5000=9850 5000 - distance from outside top edge of ballast curb to LRT ROW Limit (Comm Ductbank between track and road. All other ductbanks located between tracks) 3000 - min. width of MUT
Preferred ROW: 9850x2=19700 19,700 review 5000 - from Fig 3.8 500-min. offset from edge of MUT to ROW limit
(Locate Comm. ductbank on one side of Trkwy) 7400 - distance from road side track centreline to back of road curb (BOC)
1D - Basic Trackway with subdrains at Track Crossover Preferred ROW: 18495 - 500 +1000=18995 18,995 1000-preferred offset from MUT to ROW limit
i) With switch blowers on one side distance from trkwy centre to 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track
min. ROW limit is: 2250+1800+1200+300+1225+500=7275 1800 - distance from centreline of track to top outside edge of track ballast 2F - Type 3 Station with 9 m platform, Curbed Trkwy, Noise Wall and MUT on one side
Distance from track centre opposite switch blower to min. ROW limit: 2250+1800+1200+500=5750 1200 - distance from top edge of ballast to the outside edge of subdrain Min.dist. from track center to farside ROW limit: 4500+1405+2300+950+295+500+3000+500=13450 4500-platform width of 9000 divided by 2
Min. ROW: 7275+5750 = 13025 13,025 300-offset from subdrain to nearside edge of switch blower pad Min./pref. dist. from track centre to BOC 4500+1405+7400=13305 1405-distance from platform edge to track centre
1225 - width of switch blower pad Min ROW: 13450+13305=26755 26,755 2300 - distance from centreline of track to trackside face of cat pole base
ii) With sevice vehicle layby on switch blower side distance from track centre to 500 - minimum offset from outside edge of blower pad to LRT ROW Limit (Noise Wall and MUT on one side of station. All ductbanks routed under station platform) 7400 - distance from track centreline to back of road curb (BOC)
min. ROW limit is: 2250+1800+1200+4000+500=9750 950-width of cat pole base
Distance from track centre on opposite side of switch blower to ROW Limit:2250+1800+1200+500=5750 295- width of noise wall cap
Min.ROW: 9750+5750=15500 15,500 4000 - width of service vehicl layby measured from outside of subdrain 500 - distance from MUT side face of noise wall cap to trackside edge of MUT
(Comm. Ductbank can be accommodated outside trackway on service veh.layby side) 3000 - width of MUT
500-min. offset from edge of MUT to ROW limit
iii) Provide preferred 1000 offset from subdrain to ROW Limit for Configuration 1D ii) opposite side only
Preferred ROW: 15500+500=16000 16,000 Add 500 offset to provide preferred offset of 1000 on side opposite service vehicle layby Preferred ROW: 26755 - 500+1000 =27255 27,255 1000-preferred offset from MUT to ROW limit
Longtitudnal dist. req'd to transition ROW to basic trackway width (50+100+20+50=220m) 50- transition distance from basic trackway to station and trackway width
1E - Trackway Configuration 1C (Basic Curbed) with *SUP on one side 100- platform length 4 car trains
Min. dist. From Trkwy center to ROW limit on SUP side: 2250+2600+3050+3000+500=11400 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track 20-additional platform length to accommodate one more car
Distance from track centre on side opposite to SUP to ROW limit:2250+2300+650+500=5700 2600 - distance from centreline trackway to outside top edge of ballast curb
Min ROW: 11400+5700=17100 17,100 3050 -distance from outside edge of ballast curb to trackway edge of SUP 2G - Basic Curbed Trackway at Pocket Track
(Comm. ductbank can be located between ballast curb and SUP) 3000 - width of SUP Min.dist. from track center to farside ROW limit: 4500+1405+2300+650+500=9355 4500-platform width of 9000 divided by 2
650 - width of base of ballast curb Min/pref. dist. from track centre to BOC 4500+1405+7400=13305 1405-distance from platform edge to track centre
*Note: "SUP" - Shared Use Path (Formely "MUT" - Multi-Use Trail) 500 - minimum offset from outside edge of SUP to LRT ROW Limit Min ROW: 9355+13305=22660 22,660 2300 - distance from centreline of track to trackside face of cat pole base
(All ductbanks and switch blowers located in trackway, distance to BOC adequate to accommodate 650-width of base of ballast curb
Preferred ROW: 11400+2250+2300+650+500+1000 (500+500)=18100 18,100 1000-preferred offset from outside edge of SUP to LRT ROW Limit service vehicle layby) 500- min. offset from edge ballast curb to farside ROW limit
7400 - distance from roadside track centreline to back of road curb (BOC)
1000-preferred offset from edge of signal base to ROW limit
1F - Type 3 Station with 9 m platform and Curbed Trackway (refer to Fig.3.23) Preferred ROW: 9355 - 500+1000+13305=23160 23,160
Abs. min. distance from platform centre to ROW limit:4500+1405+2300+650+950+350=10155 4500 - platform width 9000 divided by 2
Abs. min ROW: 10155x2=20310 20,310 1405 - distance from platform edge to centreline of track 3 - TRACKWAY IN MEDIAN OF ARTERIAL ROAD Minimum Preferred
(Ductbanks routed under station platform, Cat masts on outside of ballast curb along length of platform) 2300 - distance from centreline trkwy to inside edge of ballast curb ROW mm ROW mm Details of Dimensions
650-width of base of ballast curb All ductbanks located in median of roadway and between or alongside of tracks
950-diameter of catenary mast foundation Min ROW - is distance between trackside of New Jersy Barriers (NBJ) on both sides of median.
350 - abs. min. offset from outside edge of cat. mast base to LRT ROW Limit Median ROW widths may increase - dependent on pedestrian volumes at Ped X-ings
2300 - distance from outside top edge of ballast curb to LRT ROW Limit
Preferred distance from platform center to ROW limit 4500+1405+2300+650+950+1000=10805 3A(i) - Basic Curbed Trackway No left turns at intersections
Preferred ROW: 10805x2=21610 21,610 1000-preferred offset from outside edge of cat mast base to LRT ROW Limit Refer to Configuration 1C for ROW width
Min. LRT ROW: 12700 12,700
Longtitudnal dist. req'd to transition ROW to basic trackway width (50+100+20+50=220m) 50- transition distance from basic trackway to station and trackway width
100- platform length 4 car trains 3A(ii) - Curbed Trackway All ped crossings allowed (refer to Fig. 18.2)
20-additional platform length to accommodate one more car Distance from trackway centreline to farside edge of left turn bay: 7250+1460+3300=12010 7250-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on left turn bay side
1G - Trackway Configuration 1B (with subdrains) at Pocket Track Distance from trackway centreline on opposite side to trackside edge of through lane:10550+1460=12015 1460-offset from back of NJB to left turn bay lane marking/trackside edge of through lane
Min. distance from trackway centerline to farside ROW limit 4500+1405+1800+1200+500=9405 4500 - platform width 9000 divided by 2 Preferred LRT ROW: 12010+12015=24025 24,025 3300-width of left turn bay
Min. distance to ROW limit on Serv. Veh lay side 4500=1405+1800+1200+4000+500=13405 1405 - distance from platform edge to centreline of track 10555-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on through lane side
Min. ROW: 9405+13405=22810 22,810 1800 - distance from centreline of track to top outside edge of track ballast
(Track centers based on station platform width of 9000) 1200 - distance from top edge of ballast to the outside edge of subdrain 3A(iii) - Curbed Trackway Ped crossings one side only allowed (refer to Fig. 18.3)
(Switch blowers located between tracks. All ductbanks located in trackway) 4000 - width of service vehicl layby Distance from trackway centreline to farside edge of left turn bay: 5850+1460+3300=10610 5850-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on left turn bay side
500 - minimum offset from outside edge subdrain/service vehicle layby to LRT ROW Limit Distance from trackway centreline on opposite side to trackside edge of through lane:10550+1460=12015 1460-offset from back of NJB to left turn bay lane marking/trackside edge of through lane
LRT ROW: 10610+12015=22625 22,625 3300-width of left turn bay
Preferred ROW: 22810+1000 (500+500)=23810 23,810 1000-preferred offset from outside edge of subdrain/service veh. Layby to LRT ROW Limit 10555-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on through lane side
2 -TRACKWAY BESIDE ARTERIAL/COLLECTOR RD Minimum Preferred 3A(iv) - Curbed Trackway No Ped crossings allowed (refer to Fig.18.4)
ROW mm ROW mm Details of Dimensions Distance from trackway centreline to farside edge of left turn bay: 5850+1460+3300=10610 5850-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on left turn bay side
Distance from trackway centreline on opposite side to trackside edge of through lane:9150+1460=10610 1460-offset from back of NJB to left turn bay lane marking/trackside edge of through lane
Open Trackway with Ditches - Configuration generally not applicable in urban area LRT ROW: 10610+10610=21220 21,220 3300-width of left turn bay
9150-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on through lane side
2A - Basic Open Trackway with sudrains
Min.distance from Trkwy center to farside ROW limit 2250+1800+1200+500=5750 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track 3B - LRT Station w/ 9m Platform Ped crossing one side only (refer to Fig.18.5)
Min.distance from Trkwy center to BOC of road 2250+1800+1200+1000=6250 1800 - distance from centreline of track to top edge of track ballast Distance from trackway centreline to farside edge of left turn bay:9500+1460+3300=14260 9500-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on left turn bay side
Min. ROW: 5750+6250=12000 12,000 1200 - distance from top edge of ballast to the outside edge of subdrain Distance from trackway centreline on opposite side to trackside edge of through lane:14210+1460=15760 1460-offset from back of NJB to left turn bay lane marking/trackside edge of through lane
(All ductbanks located between tracks) 500- min. off set from outside edge of subdrain to far side ROW limit LRT ROW: 14260+15760=30020 30,020 3300-width of left turn bay
1000 - distance from outside edge of subdrain to BOC (back of curb) 14210 -distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on through lane side
Preferred distance from Trkwy center to farside ROW limit 2250+1800+1200+1000=6250 3C - LRT Station w/ 9m Platform No Ped crossings (refer to Fig.18.6)
Preferred distance from Trkwy center to BOC of road 2250+1800+1200+4300=9550 4300-distance from outside edge of subdrain to BOC Distance from trackway centreline to farside edge of left turn bay:9500+1460+3300=14260 9500-distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on left turn bay side
Preferred ROW: 6250+9550=15800 15,800 1000-preferred offset from outside edge of subdrain to farside ROW limit Distance from trackway centreline on opposite side to trackside edge of through lane:12810+1460=14270 1460-offset from back of NJB to left turn bay lane marking/trackside edge of through lane
(Comm ductbank on road side of trackway between subdrain and BOC) LRT ROW: 14260+14270=28530 28,530 3300-width of left turn bay
12810 -distance from center of trackway to back of NJB on through lane side
2B - Basic Trackway with Subdrains at Track Crossover
Min.dist. from Trkwy center to farside ROW limit 2250+1800+1200+500=5750 2250 - distance from centreline of trackway to centreline of track 3D - Curbed Trackway at Pocket Track
Min.dist. from Trkwy center to BOC of road 2250+1800+1200+300+1225+500=7275 1800 - distance from centreline of track to top edge of track ballast Dependent if Cross-section 3B or 3C above are implemented. TBD
Min. ROW: 5750+7275=13025 13,025 1200 - distance from top edge of ballast to the outside edge of subdrain
(All ducbanks in trackway, service vehicles occupy curb lane) 300 - distance from outside edge of subdrain to edge of blower pad 4 - TRACKWAY BESIDE OPERATING RAILROAD
1225 - width of blower pad; 500-min.offset from outside edge of blower pad to BOC Provide 6000 mm distance between the centreline of the railroad track and the centre of the closests TBD
LRT track. Width of LRT ROW will be dependent on application of configurations previously described.
Preferred distance from Trkwy center to farside ROW limit 2250+1800+1200+1000=6250 4000 - distance from track side of blower pad to edge of road travelled lane
Preferred distance from Trkwy center to BOC of road 2250+1800+1200+300+4000=9550 1000 - preferred offset from outside edge of subdrain to farside ROW limit
Preferred ROW: 6250+9550=15800 15,800
(Provides exclusive service vehicle layby; comm ductbank between trkwy and road; switch blower pad
in service vehicle layby)
Chapter 4 – Revision Tracking Form
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
List of Figures
Figure 4.1 - LRV Acceleration Data (Graph and Table)
Figure 4.2 - Summary of Horizontal Alignment Standards (Table)
Figure 4.3 - Vu Versus Eu for Given Ea and Curve Radius (Table)
Figure 4.4 - Superelevation Versus Radius and Unbalanced Speed (Table)
Figure 4.5 - LRV Articulating Joint Limits
Figure 4.6 - Summary of Vertical Alignment Standards (Table)
List of Diagrams
Diagram 1 - Horizontal Curve and Spiral Nomenclature
Diagram 2 - Sag Vertical Curve Nomenclature
Diagram 3 - Crest Vertical Curve Nomenclature
Diagram 4 - Superelevation Runoff for Transition Spiral
Diagram 5 - Superelevation Runoff for Compound Spiral
4.1 GENERAL
4.1.1 Introduction
This chapter defines the general requirements for the geometric design of the track alignment
for the Edmonton LRT System. The desired minimum and maximum criteria are based on
industry practices and passenger comfort. The absolute minimum and maximum criteria are
based on safety considerations and have potential impacts in terms of maintenance costs,
noise, wheel and track life. Extensive use of absolute minimum and maximum design criteria
can result in service problems and unacceptable maintenance costs.
The absolute minimum criteria herein are set as limits and must be met unless approval is
otherwise obtained from the ETS. They are not intended to be used as the standard
throughout the system.
Guidelines are presented for horizontal and vertical alignment, survey control and vehicle
clearances. They have been derived through experience and accepted engineering practices
to suit the requirements of the Edmonton LRT System.
The fundamental objective of track geometric design is to identify the appropriate range of
geometric parameters that satisfies the physical horizontal and vertical constraints within the
given right-of-way. Track alignment design should not be carried out for any given segment of
track without considering how the adjacent segments will be influenced. Often the design
adjustments will have an impact on the operational characteristics, passenger comfort,
construction cost and maintenance cost, etc. of the adjacent segments.
The overall objective of track alignment optimization is to:
Ensure that the lateral acceleration experienced by the passenger is within acceptable
limits (refer to Section 4.2.3.2).
LRV will not experience negative unbalanced lateral acceleration through the identified
range of operating speeds.
The general factors influencing the alignment design have been listed in the preceding section
4.1.3. In addition to those, the following factors should also be considered in carrying out
track alignment design:
Station spacing
Stopping distance
Speed Profiles for the track alignment
Track superelevation requirements (the appropriate combination of actual and unbalanced
superelevation) and LRV attainable speed
Track separation and trackwork configuration
During the preliminary engineering design phase, the conceptual track alignment should be
optimized in accordance with the following procedure:
Mathematize alignments based on the Survey Control Network
Analyze the horizontal and vertical alignment with respect to operation and system
requirements
Develop track charts showing horizontal curve information corresponding with the vertical
alignment profiles
Calculate the maximum allowable unbalanced speed in accordance with the curve radii
Develop the comprehensive speed profile based on the track charts and vehicle
performance. For Vehicle Acceleration data, refer to Figure 4.1. For Stopping Distance
(Dynamic and Worst Case) data, refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual,
Section 3.6.
Optimize the attainable operating speeds to avoid abrupt changes in operating speeds
between curves over short distances. Gradual changes in operating speeds are
preferred. Track alignment should be optimized between stations to meet the overall
system operation requirements and operating speeds. Maximum operating speed upon
entering station is 40 km/h.
Adjust actual track superelevation to the optimized operating speeds and to eliminate the
possibility of a negative superelevation condition on the designed curves.
Note: Negative unbalanced lateral acceleration is undesirable, and results in excessive wheel and rail
wear and reduction in passenger comfort.
Design speed is determined by geometry, station spacing, safety, and signal system
constraints. All tracks should be designed for the maximum design speed dictated by the
geometric and operational constraints of the section under consideration.
The maximum design speed for the LRV on mainline should not exceed 80 km/h.
The maximum design speed for the Work train on mainline should not exceed 40 km/h.
The maximum design speed on yard track should not exceed 15 km/h except for vehicle
testing track where the maximum design speed will be dictated by geometric and safety
constraints (refer to Chapter 5 Trackwork, Section 5.2.3.2).
Where the LRT line crosses a trolley bus line, the design speed may be restricted by the
maximum allowable rate of change of height for the pantograph (refer to Chapter 6, Traction
Power Section 6.5.3.8).
4.1.5.2 Acceleration/Deceleration
The time and distance required to bring the LRV to maximum operating speed following a stop
or speed reduction, will directly affect the overall running time and system capacity. The time
and distance required for the LRV to accelerate influence the determination of appropriate
track superelevation and operating speed in maintaining system operational efficiency. The
time and distance required for the LRV to decelerate are critical in order to maintain the safe
stopping distance.
The selection of the combined actual and unbalanced superelevation for a given track
alignment must take into consideration the attainable speed of the LRV based on the vehicle
acceleration and deceleration characteristics (refer to Figure 4.1(i)).
Notations:
CC = Centre of circular curve PT = Point of change from circular
curve to tangent
CS = Point of change from circular
curve to spiral Rc = Radius of circular curve
c = Degree of circular curve in arc Rs = Instantaneous radius of spiral
definition Curve
Es = Total external distance of a SC = Point of change from spiral to
spiralized Curve circular curve
k = Tangent distance from TS or ST = Point of change from spiral to
ST to PC or PT of the shifted tangent
circular curve
S.T. = Short tangent of spiral
LC = Total length of circular curve in
Ts = Total tangent distance from TS
arc
or ST to PI
Ls = Total length of spiral
TS = Point of change from tangent to
L.T. = Long tangent of spiral spiral
p = Offset from main tangent to PC Xs = Tangent distance from TS to
or PT of the shifted circular SC or ST to CS
curve
Ys = Tangent offset at SC or CS
PC = Point of change from tangent to
∆ = Total deflection angle of spirals
circular curve
and circular curve
PI = Point of intersection of main
∆c = Deflection angle of circular
tangents
curve
PIs = Point of intersection of main
θs = Deflection angle of spiral in
tangent and tangent through
radians
SC or CS point
2 4 6
X s L s 1 ........
5729.578 s s s
Dc
R 10 216 9360
3 5 7
s s s s
Ts R p tan k Ys L s ....
2 3 42 1320 75600
1
1 2 4 s
6
E s R p k Ls ........
s s
1 p
cos
2
2 60 2160 131040
3 5
c 2 s s s
p Ls .............
s
Ls 100 100
Dc D c
12 336 15840
1 Ls
Ls 2 R s s
2 R
Ys Ys
L.T. X s S.T.
tan s sin s
Notations:
A = Algebraic difference in grades PVC = Beginning of vertical curve
e = External distance from curve to PVI = Point of vertical intersection
PVI
PVT = End of vertical curve
G1 = Incoming vertical grade in
X = Horizontal distance from PVC
percentage
Y = Vertical distance from PVC
G2 = Outgoing vertical grade in
percentage N = Point along the vertical curve
LVC = Length of vertical curve
K = Rate of change in grade
The track alignment is used as the reference line (by all other consultants) by which the
design of all other major system components are carried out. The linear nature of track
alignment components and stringent trackwork construction tolerances warrant a need to
maintain the geometric integrity of the existing system and planned extensions. Prior to the
commencement of preliminary design work, a Survey Control Network must be established by
a certified Alberta Land Surveyor to ensure all system components are tied together properly.
The horizontal alignment must be mathematized in accordance with the established Survey
Control Network.
4.2.1.2 Control Criteria
The horizontal control for all alignments must be based on the Alberta Survey Control grid,
which uses a sea level datum and a 3° Mercator Projection. All intersections and curve data
points are to be coordinated to this grid. Dimensions and chainages shown on the drawings
must be correct at existing ground level (top of rail). Distances obtained by inversing
coordinates must be corrected by a factor to yield the correct dimensions at existing ground
level datum. This correction factor has two components. One component corrects for the
difference in elevation between sea level and ground level and is essentially constant
throughout the Edmonton area. The second component corrects for the effects of the earth’s
curvatures and varies as the distance from the reference meridian on which the 3° Mercator
Projection is based. This second component varies significantly over the Edmonton area.
The Consultant must ensure that correct combined factor for converting the grid coordinates to
ground coordinates or vice versa is used on each portion of the alignment under
consideration.
It is the responsibility of the track alignment consultant to verify the record drawings of the
existing system components and to ensure they are tied to the Survey Control Network
established for the portion of alignment under consideration.
Note: The Project Manager for the South LRT Extension Project prepared a Reference Document titled
Survey Control Network, July 2004. It describes in detail the survey control network for Sections 1A and
1B. It is available upon request from the ETS.
The reference line for the alignment design will be the track centreline. A separate chainage
will be run along the centreline of each track. All dimensions, clearances, etc., pertaining to
the track must be referred to the centreline. The reference track centreline must be tied to the
established Survey Control Network.
4.2.1.4 Track Centres
The minimum track separation on tangent is 4.5 m at track centres. Track separation less
than 4.5 m may cause the vehicle dynamic clearance envelope to encroach on wayside
equipment such as catenary and signal support masts located between the tracks.
The minimum track separation is dependent on the physical dimensions and truck
configuration of LRV and on-track auxiliary maintenance equipment used in the system. For
tracks located on curves, it is the responsibility of the track alignment consultant to verify and
ensure there is no encroachment to the minimum vehicle running clearance envelop by any of
the trackway and structural elements. As such, this will entail a dynamic vehicle clearance
analysis on the basis of bi-directional train movement.
Refer to Chapter 3, Clearance and Right-of-Way, Section 3.3.3, Minimum Vehicle Running
Clearance Envelope.
Refer to Chapter 5, Trackwork, Section 5.2.3.3 Minimum Track Separation and Fouling Point.
4.2.1.5 Field Checks
Field checks should be incorporated as part of the Testing and Commissioning Program.
Field checks may be necessary to verify that wayside equipment installed on tunnel walls and
within curved sections of the alignment does not intrude into the vehicle dynamic clearance
envelope.
If required, distances, clearances, and intersection points of crucial importance should be field
checked, prior to constructing the track, by laying out the relevant portion of the alignment on
site or by using a mock-up dynamic vehicle template mounted on the testing vehicle.
4.2.2 Tangent Sections
4.2.2.1 Tangent Length Between Reverse Curves
Mainline absolute minimum tangent length between reverse curves depends on the vehicle
and effect on passenger ride quality. The criterion for the Edmonton LRT System is based on
the truck configuration. It ensures that the front axle on the leading truck does not enter a
curve of one direction while the rear axle of the trailing truck is within a curve in the reverse
direction. The absolute minimum tangent length between reverse curves on mainline is 10 m
(refer to Chapter 2, Vehicles; Figure 2.1).
The absolute minimum tangent length between reverse curves will only be considered:
At special trackwork installations
Areas where speed reductions are placed
In spiral transition curves provided that for at least one of the spirals, the spiral offset
distance from tangent for the first 1/3 of spiral transition is less than 5 mm.
The desired minimum tangent length between reverse curves should be the length of the LRV
(25 m) or a travel distance over 2 seconds, whichever is greater.
4.2.2.2 Tangent Length between Curves in the same Direction
For curves orientated in the same direction, it is preferable to incorporate a compound curve
or compound spiral rather than to have a short tangent between curves. If a tangent is
required, the minimum tangent length requirement for the reverse curves will apply.
4.2.2.3 Tangent at Stations
Horizontal alignment should be tangent through the entire length of station platform and
extending a minimum of 15 m beyond each end of the platform (refer to Chapter 3,
Clearances and Right-of-Way, Section 3.3.3.1).
As a general guideline, the absolute minimum un-superelevated tangent length beyond each
end of station platform is usually based on the greater of:
The longest maintenance vehicle with rigid body frame – one-car length. This is currently
the VMB (13.0 m).
The Edmonton LRV – front end of the SD160 LRV to the centre of the rear axle of the
truck at the articulating joint (12.7 m).
The absolute minimum horizontal tangent length beyond the station platform will not be
relaxed unless the end of the platform is tapered to meet vehicle dynamic clearance
requirements. If a design variance is proposed, the track alignment consultant must provide a
vehicle dynamic clearance analyses to substantiate the variance request for review by ETS.
4.2.2.4 Tangent at Special Trackwork
All special trackwork should be located on tangent track. The absolute minimum tangent
length ahead the point of switch and beyond the last long ties, should be 5 m. This is to
ensure the truck is straightened out to minimize the angle of attack by wheel flange prior to
entering the special trackwork area. If vehicle movement would entail a reverse curve
movement the criterion for tangent length between reverse curves will apply.
In direct fixation track structure where there is good control of track installation tolerances and
minimal differential movement between track components, the absolute minimum tangent
ahead the point of switch and beyond the heel joint of the frog, may be reduced to 3 m, except
where vehicle movement would entail a reverse curve movement.
4.2.3 Curved Lines
4.2.3.1 Circular Curve
All curves are to be defined by arc definition and specified by radius in metres. Larger radii
are to be used whenever possible to improve ride comfort qualities. The circular curve design
criteria for the Edmonton LRT System are as follows:
Mainline Track
The desirable minimum circular curve radius is 180 m. Circular curve with radius less than the
desirable minimum will result in higher maintenance costs, reduced rail life and increased the
probability of rail squeal.
The following must be analyzed when any deviation from this standard is being considered:
The impact on operating speed, safety and maintenance
Mitigation of noise and vibration
Influence on vehicle dynamic clearances to trackway elements
Yard Track
The absolute minimum circular curve radius is 35 m.
4.2.3.2 Spiral Transition Curves
Spiral transition curves should be used on all mainline track curves with a radius less than
1500 m. The minimum length of spiral curve to be provided should be the greatest of the
computed value from equations (1), (2) and (3) as follows:
a. Based on the criterion for the rate of change in superelevation of 30 mm/s (refer to
4.2.3.5):
Ls
E a Rate t , and t
v
Where v is velocity in m/s
Rate L s 30 Ls
Therefore Ea
v 0.278 v
Ls
E a 108
V
Ea V
Ls (1)
108
Where, Ls = Length of spiral curve in m
Ea = superelevation in mm
V = maximum speed in km/h
b. Based on the maximum acceptable lateral acceleration for unbalanced superelevation Eu
on a circular curve of 0.067 g and a comfortable rate of change of lateral acceleration of
0.03 g/s (refer to 4.2.3.5), the minimum time period to attain the full acceleration of 0.067
g will be 0.067/0.03 or approximately 2 seconds.
1000
Therefore, L s V 2 0.556 V
3600
If operating with an unbalanced superelevation less than the maximum unbalanced
superelevation permitted, then length of spiral necessary to ensure passenger comfort
can be reduced proportionally as follows:
Eu
L s 0.556V
E u max
Eu Eu V
Therefore, L s 0.556V (2)
100 180
Where, Ls = Length of spiral curve in m
Eu = unbalanced superelevation in mm
V = maximum speed in km/h
Based on the truck spacing
L s 15 m (3)
Note: The minimum spiral length is equal to the LRV truck spacing (7.7 m). The desirable minimum
spiral is twice the LRV truck spacing. This is consistent with the general industry practice.
The criterion for compound circular curves is similar to that for tangent-to-curve transition
(refer to Section 4.2.3.2). Although less severe, they must still address passenger comfort
and vehicle design in torsion. Where circumstances dictate the use of compound curves, the
circular curves must be linked by spiral curves conforming to Section 4.2.3.2 provided the
compounding ratio between the large radius and smaller radius does not exceed 1.15. Where
compounding ratio is greater than 1.15, a compound spiral should be used.
The compound spiral should be used to connect the two circular curves to avoid abrupt
change in curvature, wherever possible.
4.2.3.4 Compound Spiral
The minimum compound spiral inserted between a pair of superelevated circular curves
should be the greater of the following:
E1 - E 2 V
Ls (4)
108
Eu1 - Eu2 V
Ls (5)
108
L s 15 m
General
Superelevation will be attained linearly throughout the full length of the spiral transition curve
or throughout the full length of the runoff for circular curves, by raising the rail farthest from the
curve centre, while maintaining the top of the inside rail at the profile grade.
Note: Applying the superelevation as noted implies appropriate measures will be taken in tunnel
sections with superelevated curves as the centreline of the tunnel will not coincide with the centreline of
the track. The centreline of the tunnel must be displaced towards the centre of curvature (refer to
Chapter 3, Clearances and Right-of-Way; Figure 3.5) to accommodate vehicle clearances.
Superelevation Runoffs
The superelevation runoff for spirals will be accomplished within the length of spiral plus a
distance of Tv beyond each end of the spiral transition points (i.e. TS and SC or CS and ST),
as shown in Diagrams 4 and 5.
TS Spiral SC
Tangent Circular Curve
Ls = Lr
Tv Top of
Tv
High Rail
PVI
E
CS Compound Spiral SC
Circular Curve Circular Curve
Ls = Lr
Tv Tv High Rail
High Rail
PVI
E1
Tv
E2 Tv
Low Rail Grade Line
Rail is too stiff to conform to a sudden transition in the rate of change of elevation at the spiral
transition points. To avoid creating a kink and inducing stresses in the running rail, a parabolic
vertical curve should be used to adjust the runoff elevation at the spiral transition points.
Depending on the length of spiral and the actual superelevation, the required tangent length
(Tv) of the parabolic vertical curve should be between 2 m and 4 m.
Superelevation runoffs for circular curves can be used instead of spiral transition curves in the
following exceptional instances:
The intersection angle is too small to necessitate a spiral
In special areas where conditions limit the length of spiral
In the above instances, the runoff length should be the same length as the spiral. The spiral
length is determined by satisfying the requirements of Section 4.2.3.2 and substituting the
runoff length for the length of spiral. The runoff is to be located equally on either side of the
curve or preferably within the tangent.
Rate of Change in Superelevation
The maximum rate of change of elevation is 30 mm per second for the maximum speed of
train operation on the curve.
Actual Superelevation Ea
The maximum actual superelevation (Ea) permitted is 100 mm.
Equilibrium Superelevation Ee
When the operating speed is calculated based on an equilibrium condition, the wheels are
bearing equally on the rail with no lateral thrust. The equilibrium superelevation (Ee) creates a
resultant force Fr, at right angle to the plane of top of rail, counteracting the centrifugal force
Fc. The equilibrium condition can be determined in the following equations:
Centrifugal Force Fc acting radially outward:
2
wV
Fc
gR
Where, w = Weight of vehicle
V = Speed of vehicle in km/h
R = Radius of curve in m
g = Acceleration due to gravity, 9.81 m / s²
In an equilibrium condition:
Fc w
Ee B
2
BVb
Ee
gR
By converting speed from km/h to m/s
2
1505 Vb
Ee
9.81 12.96 R
2
Vb
E e 11.83 (6)
R
Where, Ee = Equilibrium superelevation (i.e. actual superelevation
of outer rail in a balanced condition in mm)
Vb = speed for balanced superelevation in km/h
R = radius of the circular curve in m
Balanced Speed Vb
The balanced speed is determined by substituting Ea equal to 100 mm as follows:
1/2
Ea R
Vb (7)
11.83
However, trains are likely to run at different speeds on the same track, a certain amount of
flexibility is allowed to obtain a range of optimal operating speed.
The maximum acceptable lateral acceleration for unbalanced superelevation on a circular
curve is 0.067 g (based on maximum allowable unbalanced of 100 mm).
The desirable range of rate of change of lateral acceleration of 0.03 g/s or less is considered
acceptable to provide a comfortable ride (refer to TCRP Report 57, Track Design Handbook).
As a design guideline, an unbalanced superelevation Eu of up to 100 mm is permitted in
determining an optimal range of safe operating speed for the alignment under consideration.
Unbalanced Speed Vu
The maximum allowable unbalanced speed shall be determined by substituting Eu equal to
100 mm in the following equation:
1/ 2
E a E u R
Vu (8)
11.83
Where, Ea = Actual superelevation of outer rail in mm
Eu = Unbalanced superelevation in mm
Vu = Unbalanced speed in km/h
In tie and ballast structure, superelevation should not be introduced at a distance closer than 3
m ahead of the switch point or before the last long tie.
In direct fixation track structure, superelevation should not be introduced at a distance closer
than 3 m ahead of the switchpoint or 3 m beyond the heel joint of the frog.
4.3 VERTICAL ALIGNMENT
4.3.1 General
Vertical track alignment is comprised of tangential gradients joined together by parabolic
vertical curves.
For mainline track next to parallel major roadways the gradient will be dependent on the
roadway profile in order to minimize the elevation differential between the road and the track.
Intersections of the vertical alignment of track and the road should be designed to match as
closely as possible to provide for the smooth crossing of LRV’s and vehicular traffic for safety
and comfort.
In yard and non-revenue tracks where operating speed is low, desirable gradients will be at or
near 0%.
4.3.1.1 Control
The vertical control for all track structures and related components are based on bench marks
established by the Government of Canada or the Province of Alberta. All elevations are to be
referenced to Geodetic Datum and indicated in meters to three decimal places.
Gradients are to be referred to the horizontal track centreline and to the top of the low rail for
all elevation controls.
4.3.2 Gradient
4.3.2.1 Mainline Track
The desirable grade for storage track and yard track is 0.0%.
The maximum grade for storage track and yard track should not be more than 0.5%.
4.3.2.4 Shop track
K 25
(ii) on curves with unbalanced superelevation
K 50
(iii) Where speed is restricted to less than 50 km/h
K 15
c. Based on the vertical acceleration (refer to TCRP Report 57, Track Design Handbook)
For crest curves:
2
LVC 0.0047AV (12)
For sag curves:
2
LVC 0.0025AV (13)
Where, A = Algebraic difference in grades in percent
V = speed in km/h
4.3.4 Vertical Tangents
Based on car length the minimum length of tangent grade between vertical curves should be
25 m.
4.3.5 Asymmetrical Vertical Curves
An asymmetrical vertical curve is a compound vertical curve with no intervening tangent length
between the two vertical curves.
In areas where there are existing vertical or geometric constraints, asymmetrical vertical curve
may be permitted. Asymmetrical vertical curves should not be used in areas where the
vertical curve overlaps with tight horizontal curve, unless the rate of change in vertical curve K
is greater than 50. Where speed is restricted to less than 50 km/h, the rate of change in
vertical curve K may be reduced to 15.
4.4 COMBINED HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL CURVES
Vertical alignment is dependent on the horizontal alignment. In laying out the vertical
alignment, it is considered good practice to avoid overlapping a vertical curve with a horizontal
curve. This condition will produce a twisting (roller coaster) effect. If the overlapping condition
cannot be avoided, the rate of change in vertical curve should be made as generous as
possible. As a minimum, the rate of change in vertical curve, K under the overlapping
condition should not be less than 50. However, where speed is restricted to less than 50
km/h, the rate of change in vertical curve may be reduced to 25.
4.5 VERTICAL CURVE RESTRICTIONS
Vertical curves are not permitted within the limits of special trackwork.
A vertical curve should not be introduced at a distance closer than 3 m ahead of the switch
point or before the last long tie.
In direct fixation track structure, a vertical curve should not be introduced at a distance closer
than 3 m ahead of the switch point or 3 m before the heel joint of the frog.
Figure 4.6 provides a summary of the vertical alignment standards.
60 -1.0%
3.0%
0.0%
50
1.0%
40 2.0%
6.0%
Speed (km/hr)
3.0%
30
4.0%
20
5.0%
10 6.0%
0
0 100 200 300 400 500 600 700
Distance (m)
FigureFig. 3.1
4.1 (i) - U2
(i) Acceleration Curve
GRADE ACCEL TO 0-25 kph 0-35 kph 0-45 kph 0-55 kph 0-65 kph 0-75 kph 0-80 kph 0-85 kph SETTLED
MOTOR SPEED
CURVE TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST. TIME DIST.
(m/sec 2) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (sec) (m) (kph) (sec) (m)
2.0% 0.92 7.5 26 11.0 60 17.5 135 29.0 300 63 68.0 960
1.0% 1.00 7.0 24 10.5 50 15.5 115 27.0 270 60.5 820 74 90.0 1400
0.0% 1.10 6.5 22 9.5 45 13.5 98 22.0 213 35.0 430 52.0 750 73.0 1220 110.0 2070 85 110.0 2070
-1.0% 1.19 5.8 20 8.5 43** 12.5 85 18.5 185** 27.5 305 40.0 550 47.0 700 83.0 1530 > 85
-2.0% 1.28 5.4 19 7.5 40 11.0 75 17.5 170 24.5 290 33.0 470 39.0 580 45.0 720 *
-3.0% 1.37 5.1 18 7.0 35 10.5 75 15.0 140 20.5 230 27.5 375 32.0 470 37.0 585 *
-4.0% 1.46 4.7 17 6.5 33 9.5 67 13.0 115 18.0 200 23.5 305 27.0 380 30.0 450 *
-5.0% 1.55 4.5 16 6.2 30 9.0 60 12.0 100 16.0 170 21.0 255 23.5 310 26.0 370 *
-6.0% 1.65 4.2 15 6.0 29 8.5 57 11.5 97 15.0 165 19.0 245 21.0 280 23.0 340 *
Absolute 10
Minimum
Figure 4.2
0 0 4 6 7 8 9 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17
5 4 6 7 8 9 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18
10 6 7 8 9 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18
15 7 8 9 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19
20 8 9 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19
25 9 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19
30 10 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20
35 10 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20
40 11 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20
45 12 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21
50 12 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21
55 13 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22
60 13 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22
65 14 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22
70 14 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23
75 15 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23 23
80 15 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23
85 16 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23 24
90 16 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23 24 24
95 17 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23 24 24 24
100 17 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 21 21 22 22 22 23 23 23 24 24 24 24
0 0 5 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21
5 5 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21
10 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22
15 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22
20 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23
25 10 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23
30 11 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24
35 12 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24
40 13 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24
45 14 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25
50 15 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25
55 15 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26
60 16 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26
65 17 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27
70 17 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27
75 18 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27 27
80 19 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27 27 28
85 19 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27 27 28 28
90 20 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27 27 28 28 28
95 20 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27 27 28 28 28 29
100 21 21 22 22 23 23 24 24 24 25 25 26 26 27 27 27 28 28 28 29 29
0 0 6 8 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25
5 6 8 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26
10 8 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27
15 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27
20 11 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28
25 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28
30 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29
35 15 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29
40 16 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30
45 17 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30
50 18 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31
55 19 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32
60 20 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32
65 20 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33
70 21 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33
75 22 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33 33
80 23 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33 33 34
85 23 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33 33 34 34
90 24 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33 33 34 34 35
95 25 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33 33 34 34 35 35
100 25 26 27 27 28 28 29 29 30 30 31 32 32 33 33 33 34 34 35 35 36
0 0 7 9 11 13 15 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29
5 7 9 11 13 15 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30
10 9 11 13 15 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31
15 11 13 15 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31
20 13 15 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32
25 15 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33
30 16 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33
35 17 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34
40 19 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35
45 20 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35
50 21 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36
55 22 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36
60 23 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37
65 24 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38
70 24 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38
75 25 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38 39
80 26 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38 39 39
85 27 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38 39 39 40
90 28 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38 39 39 40 40
95 28 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38 39 39 40 40 41
100 29 30 31 31 32 33 33 34 35 35 36 36 37 38 38 39 39 40 40 41 41
0 0 7 10 13 15 16 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33
5 7 10 13 15 16 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33
10 10 13 15 16 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34
15 13 15 16 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35
20 15 16 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36
25 16 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37
30 18 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37
35 19 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38
40 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39
45 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39
50 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40
55 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41
60 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41
65 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42
70 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43
75 28 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43 43
80 29 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43 43 44
85 30 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43 43 44 44
90 31 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43 43 44 44 45
95 32 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43 43 44 44 45 46
100 33 33 34 35 36 37 37 38 39 39 40 41 41 42 43 43 44 44 45 46 46
0 0 8 11 14 16 18 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
5 8 11 14 16 18 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37
10 11 14 16 18 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
15 14 16 18 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38
20 16 18 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39
25 18 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40
30 20 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41
35 21 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42
40 23 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42
45 24 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43
50 25 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44
55 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45
60 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45
65 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46
70 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47
75 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47 47
80 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47 47 48
85 33 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47 47 48 49
90 34 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47 47 48 49 49
95 35 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47 47 48 49 49 50
100 36 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 42 43 44 45 45 46 47 47 48 49 49 50 51
0 0 9 12 15 18 20 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39
5 9 12 15 18 20 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
10 12 15 18 20 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
15 15 18 20 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
20 18 20 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
25 20 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44
30 21 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45
35 23 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
40 25 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46
45 26 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47
50 28 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48
55 29 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49
60 30 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50
65 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50
70 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51
75 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 52
80 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 52 53
85 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 52 53 53
90 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 52 53 53 54
95 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 52 53 53 54 55
100 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 46 47 48 49 50 50 51 52 53 53 54 55 55
0 0 9 13 16 19 21 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41
5 9 13 16 19 21 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42
10 13 16 19 21 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
15 16 19 21 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44
20 19 21 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45
25 21 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46
30 23 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47
35 24 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
40 26 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49
45 28 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
50 29 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51
55 31 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51
60 32 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52
65 33 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53
70 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54
75 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54 55
80 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54 55 55
85 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54 55 55 56
90 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54 55 55 56 57
95 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54 55 55 56 57 58
100 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 51 52 53 54 55 55 56 57 58 58
0 0 10 15 18 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46
5 10 15 18 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47
10 15 18 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48
15 18 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50
20 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51
25 23 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52
30 25 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53
35 27 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54
40 29 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55
45 31 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56
50 33 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57
55 34 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57
60 36 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58
65 37 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59
70 39 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60
75 40 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60 61
80 41 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60 61 62
85 43 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
90 44 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
95 45 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 64
100 46 47 48 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 64 65
0 0 11 16 20 23 25 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51
5 11 16 20 23 25 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52
10 16 20 23 25 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53
15 20 23 25 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54
20 23 25 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55
25 25 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57
30 28 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58
35 30 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59
40 32 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60
45 34 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61
50 36 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62
55 38 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
60 39 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
65 41 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65
70 42 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66
75 44 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67
80 45 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68
85 47 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69
90 48 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70
95 49 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
100 51 52 53 54 55 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72
0 0 12 17 21 24 27 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55
5 12 17 21 24 27 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56
10 17 21 24 27 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57
15 21 24 27 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59
20 24 27 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60
25 27 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61
30 30 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62
35 32 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63
40 35 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65
45 37 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66
50 39 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67
55 41 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68
60 42 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69
65 44 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70
70 46 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71
75 47 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72
80 49 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73
85 50 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74
90 52 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75
95 53 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76
100 55 56 57 59 60 61 62 63 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77
0 0 13 19 23 26 29 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58
5 13 19 23 26 29 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60
10 19 23 26 29 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61
15 23 26 29 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63
20 26 29 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64
25 29 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65
30 32 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67
35 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68
40 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69
45 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70
50 41 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72
55 43 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73
60 45 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74
65 47 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75
70 49 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76
75 51 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76 77
80 52 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76 77 78
85 54 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79
90 55 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80
95 57 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80
100 58 60 61 63 64 65 67 68 69 70 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80
0 0 14 20 24 28 31 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62
5 14 20 24 28 31 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63
10 20 24 28 31 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65
15 24 28 31 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66
20 28 31 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68
25 31 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69
30 34 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71
35 37 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72
40 39 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73
45 42 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75
50 44 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76
55 46 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77
60 48 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78
65 50 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
70 52 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
75 54 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
80 55 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
85 57 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
90 59 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
95 60 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
100 62 63 65 66 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80
0 0 15 21 25 29 33 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65
5 15 21 25 29 33 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67
10 21 25 29 33 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68
15 25 29 33 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70
20 29 33 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72
25 33 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73
30 36 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74
35 39 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76
40 41 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77
45 44 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79
50 46 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
55 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
60 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
65 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
70 55 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
75 57 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
80 58 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
85 60 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
90 62 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
95 64 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
100 65 67 68 70 72 73 74 76 77 79 80
0 0 15 22 27 31 34 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68
5 15 22 27 31 34 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70
10 22 27 31 34 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72
15 27 31 34 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73
20 31 34 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75
25 34 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77
30 38 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78
35 41 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
40 43 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
45 46 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
50 48 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
55 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
60 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
65 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
70 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
75 59 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
80 61 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
85 63 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
90 65 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
95 67 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
100 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
0 0 16 23 28 32 36 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72
5 16 23 28 32 36 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73
10 23 28 32 36 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75
15 28 32 36 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77
20 32 36 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78
25 36 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
30 39 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
35 42 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
40 45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
45 48 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
50 51 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
55 53 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
60 55 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
65 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
70 60 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
75 62 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
80 64 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
85 66 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
90 68 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
95 70 72 73 75 77 78 80
100 72 73 75 77 78 80
0 0 17 24 29 33 37 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74
5 17 24 29 33 37 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76
10 24 29 33 37 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78
15 29 33 37 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
20 33 37 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
25 37 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
30 41 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
35 44 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
40 47 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
45 50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
50 53 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
55 55 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
60 58 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
65 60 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
70 62 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
75 64 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
80 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
85 69 71 73 74 76 78 80
90 71 73 74 76 78 80
95 73 74 76 78 80
100 74 76 78 80
0 0 17 24 30 35 39 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77
5 17 24 30 35 39 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
10 24 30 35 39 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
15 30 35 39 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
20 35 39 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
25 39 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
30 42 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
35 46 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
40 49 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
45 52 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
50 55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
55 57 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
60 60 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
65 62 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
70 65 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
75 67 69 71 73 75 77 79
80 69 71 73 75 77 79
85 71 73 75 77 79
90 73 75 77 79
95 75 77 79
100 77 79
0 0 18 25 31 36 40 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
5 18 25 31 36 40 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
10 25 31 36 40 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
15 31 36 40 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
20 36 40 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
25 40 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
30 44 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
35 47 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
40 51 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
45 54 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
50 57 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
55 59 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
60 62 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
65 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
70 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
75 69 72 74 76 78 80
80 72 74 76 78 80
85 74 76 78 80
90 76 78 80
95 78 80
100 80
0 0 19 26 32 37 41 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
5 19 26 32 37 41 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
10 26 32 37 41 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
15 32 37 41 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
20 37 41 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
25 41 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
30 45 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
35 49 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
40 52 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
45 55 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
50 58 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
55 61 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
60 64 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
65 67 69 72 74 76 78 80
70 69 72 74 76 78 80
75 72 74 76 78 80
80 74 76 78 80
85 76 78 80
90 78 80
95 80
100
0 0 20 28 34 39 44 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
5 20 28 34 39 44 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
10 28 34 39 44 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
15 34 39 44 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
20 39 44 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
25 44 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
30 48 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
35 52 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
40 55 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
45 59 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
50 62 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
55 65 68 71 73 76 78 81
60 68 71 73 76 78 81
65 71 73 76 78 81
70 73 76 78 81
75 76 78 81
80 78 81
85 81
90
95
100
0 0 21 29 36 41 46 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
5 21 29 36 41 46 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
10 29 36 41 46 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
15 36 41 46 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
20 41 46 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
25 46 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
30 51 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
35 55 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
40 58 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
45 62 65 68 72 74 77 80
50 65 68 72 74 77 80
55 68 72 74 77 80
60 72 74 77 80
65 74 77 80
70 77 80
75 80
80
85
90
95
100
0 0 22 31 38 43 48 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
5 22 31 38 43 48 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
10 31 38 43 48 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
15 38 43 48 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
20 43 48 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
25 48 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
30 53 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
35 57 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
40 61 65 68 72 75 78 81
45 65 68 72 75 78 81
50 68 72 75 78 81
55 72 75 78 81
60 75 78 81
65 78 81
70 81
75
80
85
90
95
100
0 0 23 32 39 45 51 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
5 23 32 39 45 51 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
10 32 39 45 51 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
15 39 45 51 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
20 45 51 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
25 51 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
30 55 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
35 60 64 68 72 75 78 82
40 64 68 72 75 78 82
45 68 72 75 78 82
50 72 75 78 82
55 75 78 82
60 78 82
65 82
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
0 0 24 33 41 47 53 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
5 24 33 41 47 53 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
10 33 41 47 53 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
15 41 47 53 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
20 47 53 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
25 53 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
30 58 62 67 71 74 78 82
35 62 67 71 74 78 82
40 67 71 74 78 82
45 71 74 78 82
50 74 78 82
55 78 82
60 82
65
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
0 0 24 35 42 49 55 60 65 69 73 77 81
5 24 35 42 49 55 60 65 69 73 77 81
10 35 42 49 55 60 65 69 73 77 81
15 42 49 55 60 65 69 73 77 81
20 49 55 60 65 69 73 77 81
25 55 60 65 69 73 77 81
30 60 65 69 73 77 81
35 65 69 73 77 81
40 69 73 77 81
45 73 77 81
50 77 81
55 81
60
65
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
0 0 25 36 44 51 57 62 67 72 76 80
5 25 36 44 51 57 62 67 72 76 80
10 36 44 51 57 62 67 72 76 80
15 44 51 57 62 67 72 76 80
20 51 57 62 67 72 76 80
25 57 62 67 72 76 80
30 62 67 72 76 80
35 67 72 76 80
40 72 76 80
45 76 80
50 80
55
60
65
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
Figure 4.4
Maximum 0.5
Maximum 0.5
Figure 4.6
5.4.7 4th paragr. Updated current condition of Metro Line guard rail.
5.7.9 1st paragr. Clarified rail lubricators used on running rails and
guard rails.
Figures Figure revision Fig 5.3C, Fig 5.3D, Fig 12A, Fig 5.12C
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
5.0 TRACKWORK
Page
5.0 TRACKWORK 1
5.1 INTRODUCTION 1
5.2 GENERAL STANDARDS AND SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS 1
5.2.1 General System Requirements 1
5.2.2 Track System Classification 1
5.2.3 Applicable Design Standards and Governing Criteria 2
5.2.4 5.2.4 Electrical Isolation 4
5.2.5 Noise and Vibration Attenuation 4
5.3 TRACK STRUCTURE (INCLUDING YARD TRACK) 5
5.3.1 General 5
5.3.2 Rail Deflection 5
5.3.3 At-Grade (Surface) Track 6
5.3.4 Track in Portals and Tunnels 7
5.3.5 Track on Aerial Structures 8
5.3.6 Embedded Track 8
5.3.7 Track Transitional Requirements 9
5.4 SPECIAL TRACKWORK 10
5.4.1 General Requirements 10
5.4.2 Turnouts 10
5.4.3 Crossovers 12
5.4.4 Diamonds 13
5.4.5 Sliding Rail Joints 13
5.4.6 Lateral Restraining Devices 14
5.4.7 Guard Rails 14
5.4.8 Restraining Rails 14
5.5 GRADE CROSSINGS 15
5.5.1 Road Crossings 15
5.5.2 Pedestrian Crossings 15
5.5.3 Requirements 15
5.5.4 Service Life and Maintenance 16
5.5.5 Corrosion Protection 16
5.6 TRACK COMPONENTS 16
5.6.1 Running Rails 16
5.6.2 Fastening Devices 18
5.6.3 Ties 20
5.6.4 Ballast 23
5.6.5 Sub-ballast 23
5.6.6 Subgrade 23
5.6.7 Ballast Curb 24
5.7 OTHER TRACKWORK MATERIALS (OTM) 24
5.7.1 Switch Machines 24
5.7.2 Switch Blowers 24
5.7.3 Switch Point Detectors 25
5.7.4 Hold-down Bars 25
List of Figures
Figure 5.1 – Light Rail Vehicle Wheel Profile
Figure 5.2 – Work Train Standard A.A.R. Wheel Profile
Figure 5.3A – Typical 1:40 Canted Direct Fixation Fastener and Anchoring
Assembly
Figure 5.3B – Cast-in-place Plinth
Figure 5.3C – Typical 650 mm x 1200 Precast Plinth
Figure 5.3D – Typical 820 mm x 1200 mm Precast Plinth
Figure 5.4 – Ballasted Track At-grade – Mainline and Yard (Open)
Figure 5.5 – Ballasted Track At-grade – Mainline (Confined)
Figure 5.6 – Ballasted Track At-grade – Median Running
Figure 5.7 – Ballasted Track At-grade on Concrete Slab – Mainline (Confined)
Figure 5.8 – Ballasted Track on Concrete Slab – Station Structure
Figure 5.9 – Direct Fixation on Concrete Slab – Double Box/Portal Structure
Figure 5.10 – Direct Fixation on Concrete Slab – TBM Tunnel Structure
Figure 5.11 – Direct Fixation/Ballasted Track – Aerial Structure
Figure 5.12A – Typical Embedded Mainline Track with Guard Rail
Figure 5.12B – Typical Embedded Mainline Track without Guard Rail
Figure 5.12C – Typical Embedded Track Road/Pedestrian Crossing with Guard Rail
Figure 5.12D – Typical Embedded Mainline Track with Track Drains
Figure 5.12E – Typical Embedded Shop Track
Figure 5.12F – Typical Embedded Track with Guard Rail and Anchor Bolts
Figure 5.13 – Typical Rail Beam – Pit Track
Figure 5.14 – Typical Transition Tie Layout
Figure 5.15 – Typical Transition Slab Details
Figure 5.16 – Turnout and Crossover Data for Curved Split Switches – AREMA
Standard
Figure 5.17 – No. 5 Turnout UIC Standard
Figure 5.18 – No. 8 Turnout UIC Standard
Figure 5.19A – Type-1 Guard Rail Mounting Bracket for Embedded Track
Figure 5.19B – Type-2 Guard Rail Mounting Bracket for Direct Fixation
Figure 5.19C – Type-3 Guard Rail Mounting Bracket for Wood Tie
Figure 5.20A – Typical Restraining Rail Layout Plan
Figure 5.20B – Typical Restraining Guard Rail Fasteners
Figure 5.21 – Typical At-Grade Road Crossing
Figure 5.22A – Typical At-Grade Pedestrian Crossing
Figure 5.22B – Detectable Warning Surface – 2500 mm Pedestrian Crossing
Figure 5.22C – Detectable Warning Surface – 3100 mm Pedestrian Crossing
Figure 5.22D – Detectable Warning Surface – 5000 mm Pedestrian Crossing
Figure 5.23A – 100 lb ARA-A Tee Rail
Figure 5.23B – 115 lb RE Rail
Figure 5.23C – 67R1 (Ph37a) Girder Rail
Figure 5.23D – Modified UIC-33 Guard Rail
Figure 5.24 – Typical Shim Details for Direct Fixation Fastener
Figure 5.25 – Typical Wood Tie Details
Figure 5.26 – Typical Concrete Tie Details
Figure 5.27 – Typical Lateral Track Bracing Details
Figure 5.28 – Ballast Curb Typical Details
Figure 5.29 – Typical Bollard and Chain Fence
Figure 5.30 – CPG & CPF wheel Alignment
Figure 5.31 – Typical Hold-Down Bar
Figure 5.32 – Typical Switch Point Protector
Figure 5.33 – Typical Rail Anchor on Cast-in-place Plinth
5.0 TRACKWORK
5.1 INTRODUCTION
This chapter presents the general requirements, guidelines and criteria for the design of track
and trackwork components for the Edmonton LRT System. These guidelines have been
developed to assist the consultant to facilitate the design process. All aspects of track and
related track components are discussed including rail, special trackwork, support structures,
fastening devices, and related hardware.
These guidelines have evolved from AREMA (American Railway Engineering and
Maintenance Association) practices. However, with the introduction of the European UIC
(International Union of Railways) design standards, new design technology, and through
experience, the guidelines have been modified to better suit the requirements of Edmonton’s
LRT System.
It is a requirement that technology used in trackwork design development be proven for a
minimum of two (2) years of revenue service in a LRT system similar to Edmonton’s.
Compatibility with Edmonton’s existing technology is also essential.
Trackwork components should generally comply with Edmonton’s current trackwork
standards. These guidelines will form the basis for the trackwork design and evaluation of
alternative systems. Any variance from these guidelines will require approval in writing from
ETS.
Mainline track or Primary Track consists of track constructed for the purpose of carrying
revenue passengers and should be constructed of continuous welded rail (CWR).
Secondary track consists of track constructed for the purpose of temporary storage, staging
and branching off the mainline (e.g. pocket track and lead track off the mainline to the
Maintenance Yard). Secondary track must be constructed to mainline track standards.
Yard track consists of tracks constructed beyond the lead track off the mainline.
Yard track does not carry revenue passengers. In general, its purpose is for routing and
switching trains around the Maintenance Yard or for storing trains outside the Maintenance
Facilities. Yard track should be constructed of jointed rail on tie and ballast track structure.
Embedded track consists of the track structure which is completely covered by pavement
materials except for the top of rail and flangeway. The embedment materials, including the
design of flangeway and rail used, are tailored to specific site circumstances, such as road
crossing, pedestrian crossing and in-street track within a shared ROW.
Shop track consists of pit tracks and embedded tracks constructed within the building limits of
the Maintenance Facilities. Shop track should be constructed of Continuous Welded Rail
(CWR) with direct fastening system embedded in in-fill concrete or mounted directly on steel
beams.
As a minimum, all track and trackwork should be designed in accordance with current
governing codes, regulations, standards and practices as follows:
American Railway Engineering and Maintenance Association - AREMA
American Society for Testing and Materials - ASTM
Canadian Standards Association - CSA
International Union of Railways - UIC
Consideration must be given to the design vehicle size, load and performance, and horizontal
and vertical vehicle dynamic clearances as noted in Chapters 2 and 3 of these Guidelines.
All tracks should be designed for the maximum design operating speed dictated by the
geometric and operational constraints of the section under consideration.
The maximum design speed for LRVs on mainline is 80 km/h.
The maximum design speed for Work Trains on mainline is 40 km/h.
The design speed for the LRV on yard track is 15 km/h, whereas the yard operating speed for
both the LRV and the Work Train is 10 km/h. Yard test tracks may require a higher design
operating speed.
The maximum design wheel load of the Design LRV is *5800 kg rounded (refer to Figure 2.3).
* 23,063 ÷ 4 = 5766 kg
The maximum design wheel load of the Work Train is *8000 kg rounded (refer to Figure 2.4).
* 32,200 ÷ 4 = 8050 kg
5.2.3.3 Minimum Track Separation and Fouling Point
Where possible, the trackwork consultant should maintain a minimum distance of 4.5 m
between track centers. Fouling point restrictions based on the vehicle dynamic clearances of
bi-directional train movement to all trackway elements must be taken into consideration.
Edmonton’s LRT System currently utilizes 100 lb ARA-A rail and 115 lb RE rail installed in
accordance with the following criteria:
Track gauge for mainline tangent track is 1435 mm +3/-1 mm, measured 16 mm below the
top of railhead.
Track gauge for curved track is 1435 mm +3/-1 mm. If necessary, gauge adjustment may
be considered in sharp curves on mainline to minimize wheel binding.
Special trackwork should be designed to the standard gauge of 1435 mm +3/-1 mm.
No gauge widening is required in the yard and shop track.
Refer to Table 5.3 for track gauge construction tolerances.
Refer to Section 5.3.3.1 regarding the use of 115 lb RE rail.
Direct fixation fasteners and concrete ties should be designed so that adjustments can be
made to newly installed trackwork as follows:
i. Direct Fixation Fastener
Lateral track adjustments of +/- 15 mm in increments of 3 mm should be provided. A
positive serrated fastening design for lateral adjustment is preferred.
Vertical adjustment of direct fixation fasteners should be achieved by shimming. Steel
shim thickness ranging from 1 mm to 20 mm should be used. Combinations of a
maximum of three shims are permitted to make up a maximum shimming height of 25
mm.
ii. Concrete Cross Ties
Provision should be made to allow minor gauge adjustment to compensate for concrete tie
shoulder casting tolerances and future rail wear. Insulators of varying widths should be
used to provide flexibility for gauge adjustment.
Zero to 1:40 rail cant transitioning between turnouts and the connecting tracks should take
place a minimum of 3 m ahead of the point of switch. This distance should be increased if
necessary to avoid placing the cant transitioning at insulated joint locations. Insulated joints
are too rigid to conform to changes in cant.
Tapered shims, elastomeric grout pads or concrete crossties with built-in variable canted rail
seats should be used to accomplish the rail cant transition over a distance of 3 m, allowing the
rail to twist in its natural form.
Rail cant transitioning is not required at the transition point between the yard and the shop
track due to the slow train speeds in this area.
5.2.3.8 Flangeways
Flangeway dimension requirements are a function of the wheel profile (refer to Figure 5.1) and
curve radius used. The wheel flange width and the back-to-back wheel flange distance
determine the appropriate wheel flange clearance. The determination of an appropriate
flangeway width should also take rail-mounted maintenance equipment requirements and
pedestrian crossing safety standards into consideration.
The flangeway depth must be sufficient to accommodate dirt and debris without causing wheel
lift.
The flangeway width through the frog and corresponding guard rail must be designed to
prevent excessive lateral wheel movement at the point of wheel transfer. Excessive lateral
wheel movement will result in premature wear of the wing rail and frog point.
The following are the flangeway requirements:
Frog flangeway – 47 mm (width) x 52 mm (depth)
Guard rail flangeway in special trackwork – 45 mm (width) x 52 mm (depth)
Guard rail flangeway in curves – adjustable width to compensate for rail wear and
operating speed x 52 mm (depth)
Road grade crossing flangeway – 65 mm (width) x 52 mm (depth)
Pedestrian crossing flangeway – 65 mm (width) x 52 mm (depth)
The above requirements are industry standards for the standard AAR wheel profile used on
the LRT Work Train (refer to Figure 5.2).
5.3.1 General
Mainline track on grade in accessible areas should be of concrete tie with Pandrol clip (or
approved fastener) and ballast construction. Yard track on grade in accessible areas should
be of timber tie, screw spike and ballast construction.
Track laid in areas where access is restricted (e.g. in tunnels, on aerial structures, or inside
buildings) should be the direct fixation. Cementitious grout pads as direct fixation foundation
must not be used. The pre-cast or cast-in-place concrete plinth upon which the direct fixation
fasteners are anchored should be poured or grouted in separately after the main slab has
been cast. Figure 5.3A illustrates a typical installation of direct fixation fastener on concrete
plinth.
Tracks installed in major roadways, in close proximity to businesses, should consider the use
of embedded structure (refer to Section 5.3.6.1).
Depending on the location optimized for the installation of special trackwork, mainline special
trackwork can be installed on tie and ballasted track structure or on track slab utilizing
elastomeric grout pads (refer to Section 5.4.1).
To ensure the proposed trackwork system is compatible with the existing Edmonton LRT
System, other alternate track structures will not be permitted unless the advantages in terms
of performance, overall cost and maintenance requirements can be proven. Any proposed
alternate track structure must have a proven revenue service record of at least 2 years on a
LRT system similar to Edmonton.
The maximum allowable rail deflection should not exceed 2 mm on mainline track structure. A
deflection exceeding 2 mm may cause premature failure of track components.
5.3.2.1 Fastener Spacing
Direct fixation fasteners on concrete structures or plinths should be spaced at 750 mm. On
curved track the fasteners should be installed radially from the centre of the curve.
The maximum allowable direction fixation fastener spacing for 100 lb ARA-A rail section is 800
mm. Spacing greater than 800 mm may cause excessive deflection.
Similarly, the maximum allowable direction fixation fastener spacing for 115 lb RE rail section
is 800 mm. Spacing greater than 800 mm may cause excessive deflection.
Note: Refer to Section 5.3.3.1 and later sections in this chapter for guidelines pertaining to the use of
100 lb ARA-A and 115 lb RE rail.
Tie spacing is dependent on the maximum allowable rail deflection and maximum bearing
pressure at the interface layers that makes up the recommended track structure.
Concrete tie spacing should be 675 mm, unless otherwise specified.
Wood tie spacing should be 560 mm, unless otherwise specified.
Should there be a change in tie spacing, the trackwork consultant must verify the rail
deflection and bearing pressure exerted at the track structure interfaces. As a minimum,
bearing pressures at the track structure interfaces should conform to the following AREMA
recommendations:
Concrete tie - bearing pressure at the ballast/tie interface should not exceed 585 kPa (or
85 psi)
Wood tie – bearing pressure at the ballast/tie interface should not exceed 448 kPa (or 65
psi)
The bearing pressure at the subgrade/sub-ballast interface should not exceed 138 kPa (or
20 psi)
Note: The above guidelines are based on AREMA’s recommended maximum bearing pressure values.
However, a detailed analysis of allowable bearing capacity may be necessary to determine the granular
depth (ballast and sub-ballast) required for the allowable load to be transferred to the subgrade.
Wood tie and ballast track structure is generally used in the yard and should be installed as
shown in Figure 5.4.
The rail fastening system should consist of a base-plate complete with HDPE baseplate pad,
spring clips, screw spikes and spring lock washers.
100 lb ARA-A CWR (refer to Figure 5.23A) is installed on wood tie and ballast for mainline
surface track between Clareview and Health Sciences Stations. 100 lb ARA-A jointed rail is
installed at the D.L.MacDonald Transit Yards.
115 lb RE CWR (refer to Figure 5.23B) is installed on concrete tie and ballasted tracks for the
South LRT Extension from Health Sciences to Century Park Stations, and on concrete plinths
as well as embedded for the Metro Line LRT Extension from just north of Churchill to NAIT
Station.
To be consistent with Edmonton LRT trackwork system, all future LRT mainline extensions
should be constructed of 115 lb. RE rail section.
Wood ties should be spaced at 560 mm centre to centre. Closer tie spacing may be
warranted on curves with radius less than 300 m if deem necessary through track structure
analysis.
5.3.3.2 Concrete Ties and Ballast on Subgrade
Concrete tie and ballast track structure on compacted subgrade, as shown in Figures 5.5 and
5.6, is the preferred option for track constructed at grade.
The rail fastening system for precast concrete ties should consist of cast-in-place cast iron
shoulders, spring clips, rail pads and insulators for the fastening of 115 lb RE rail section.
Refer to Section 5.6.1, Running Rail and Section 5.6.3.4, Concrete Cross Ties for details.
Concrete ties should be spaced at 675 mm centre to centre. Closer tie spacing may be
warranted on curves with radius less than 300 m if deemed necessary through track structure
analysis.
Concrete tie and ballast track structure on concrete slab, as shown in Figures 5.7 and 5.8,
should be used in areas where there are depth restrictions preventing construction of a full
granular trackbed.
Minimum ballast depth under the tie is 225 mm.
At isolated locations where there are depth restrictions, the absolute minimum ballast depth
under the tie is 175 mm. Ballast depth of less than 175 mm will not allow the ballast to be
machine tamped effectively.
Direct fixation track on concrete slab as shown in Figure 5.9 should be used in portal transition
sections.
Direct fixation track on concrete slab as shown in Figure 5.10 should be used in tunnels.
Typically it is specified that the tunnel contractor or the installer of the base slab make
provision for concrete plinths by providing recesses in the concrete tunnel invert. The
concrete plinth should be connected to the invert concrete with a series of stirrups or by rebars
connecting to threaded inserts. The concrete plinth system can be designed as cast-in-place
or pre-cast system. The trackwork consultant should evaluate the two options based on the
economies of scale, constructability, quality and maintainability of the end product.
The top of concrete plinth should be level with the 1:40 inward rail cant being incorporated in
the direct fixation fastener.
Inserts for the direct fixation fastener connections should be cast in the concrete plinth. Epoxy
coated inserts are preferred over cast-in-place anchor bolts for maintainability.
Direct fixation fasteners are connected to the concrete plinth with anchor bolts to match the
cast-in-place inserts. Running rails should be fastened to the direct fixation fasteners with the
use of spring clips. Refer to Section 5.3.2.1 for direct fixation fastener spacing and Section
5.6.1 Running Rail, for details.
5.3.4.2 Other
Ballasted track structure on concrete slab can be installed in tunnel sections. This option must
be reviewed and approved by ETS. If necessary, vertical barriers should be provided to retain
the ballast in place.
Direct fixation track on concrete slab as described in Section 5.3.4.1 is the preferred track
structure for aerial structures. This track structure for aerial structures is shown in Figure 5.11.
Restraining rails must be installed in the gauge side of both rails for the purpose of restricting
the travel distance of a derailed vehicle.
5.3.5.2 Other
Ballasted track on concrete slab may be considered for installation on aerial structures,
provided maintenance and safety concerns are satisfactorily addressed.
5.3.6 Embedded Track
5.3.6.1 Embedded Mainline Track
Embedded mainline track in an urban setting environment integrated with road traffic on a
shared ROW should be constructed of resilient rubber rail boot or elastomeric grout for
mitigating potential stray current leakage and attenuating noise and vibration impacts. Pre-
cast concrete in-street ties or composite ties can be used to secure the track gauge and
elevation, and form an integral part of embedded track structure. The 115 lb. RE “Tee” rail is
the preferred rail section to be used throughout any embedded mainline track section rather
than the use of girder rail. Girder rail is more expensive and not readily available in North
America, and snow removal in a narrow grooved flangeway has proven to be a major
undertaking for other systems with severe winter condition. Typical embedded mainline track
structures with and without guard rail system are shown in Figures 5.12A and 5.12B.
The installation of embedded mainline track using elastomeric grout as an alternative option
will require the forming of channels in the concrete slab to accommodate the running rails.
The trackwork consultant should evaluate the appropriate embedded track options for review
by ETS.
Embedded mainline track at-grade should have provisions of trackway cross drains at the
limits of each road crossing and/or at intermediate track intervals of no greater than 50 m.
Drainage should be designed for every recess (i.e. switches, switch machines, lubricators
etc.). The trackwork consultant should work in conjunction with the trackway drainage
consultant to determine the drainage requirements for the embedded mainline track. Refer to
Figure 5.12D for typical cross drain details.
5.3.6.2 Embedded Shop Track
Embedded tracks are constructed in maintenance facilities for the purpose of allowing
maintenance equipment access across the shop floor. A typical embedded shop track
structure is shown in Figure 5.12E.
Rail fasteners for embedded shop track should be non-resilient and spaced at 1.5 m on
centre. Rails should be laid as CWR. The fastening system must be designed to secure rails
at the proper gauge, line and elevation once rails are embedded in concrete.
Gauge rods are normally used to maintain track gauge and form an integral part of the
anchoring system. Vertical adjustments should be made by shimming. Gauge rods used in
signalized territory must be electrically isolated.
Embedded shop tracks should be in-filled with grout or concrete. The field side in-fill grout or
concrete elevation should be set 10 mm below the top of running rail to avoid false flanging.
The minimum flangeway width for embedded tracks in maintenance facilities is 65 mm to
accommodate AAR wheels as used on the track maintenance equipment.
5.3.6.3 Pit Tracks
Pit tracks are required for maintenance purposes. They provide access for maintenance
personnel to inspect and maintain equipment installed in the undercarriage of the LRV.
The current pit track system used by ETS is comprised of rails directly fastened to the top of
steel “I” beams. Removable plates are installed on the field sides of pit tracks to allow access
to the undercarriage of LRVs from the side. The typical pit track structure is shown in Figure
5.13.
Transition ties are typically used at approaches to bridge structures and at wood to concrete
tie interfaces. Transition ties are of varying lengths. To provide a gradual change in load
distribution under the ties, the longer ties are placed near the stiffer end of the track structure
as shown in Figure 5.14.
5.3.7.2 Transition Slab
A transition slab (vs. transition ties) is the preferred option for transferring track stiffness from
direct fixation to tie and ballast. This option is shown in Figure 5.15.
Designed concrete slabs may also be installed at other track support structure interfaces
where space restrictions do not allow transition ties to be used.
The following table presents the maximum allowable speeds through turnouts under AREMA
and UIC guidelines.
No. 5 Yards and service areas (Figure 15 km/h maximum 23 km/h maximum
5.18 and 5.20)
(based on Eu = 65 mm) (based on Eu = 100 mm)
On Mainline track where space
restrictions are imposed by track
geometry. Slow order must be
imposed at 15 km/h maximum.
Turnout geometry is influenced by the design of switch points and heel spread. Because the
turnout curves for standard AREMA turnouts do not incorporate true tangential geometry,
switch entry angles for these turnouts typically range from 1 to 3 degrees (refer to Figure
5.16).
To minimize the impact created by the wheel flange on the switch points, UIC and other
European Standards have placed an emphasis on reducing switch entry angles to almost
zero. Special rolled rail sections are used for switches to allow sufficient undercutting in order
for the switch points to be fitted tangentially to the stock rails at the turnout entry points.
Tangential turnout geometry enables longer lead distances and larger turnout radii to be
achieved. This reduces the wheel impact on the curved switch point and the overall
maintenance requirements for switches. For future LRT Extensions, UIC is the preferred
design standard for tangential turnouts as illustrated in Figures 5.17 and 5.18.
The minimum turnout curve radius for any turnout installed as part of mainline operation must
not be less than be 50 m.
For cost reasons, standard North American turnouts are the preferred turnout design for yard
track.
In general, it is a good practice to locate turnouts on tangent track with 0% grade and without
vertical curvature. Vertical grade introduces a superelevated track condition for diverging train
movement running uphill and an undesirable under-balanced track condition for the diverging
train movement running downhill and should be avoided. For a No. 8 turnout curve on a 3%
grade, there is an elevation difference of 5.6 mm between the frog point and the running rail.
With the diverging train movement running downhill in an under-balanced condition, the wheel
set tends to shift toward the frog point and/or ride against the guard rail. Locating the turnout
on slope greater than 3% with diverging train movement running downhill is not acceptable
unless the travel speeds are reduced to ensure safe operating conditions across the frog.
If it is necessary to locate a turnout on a vertical grade, the trackwork consultant should
determine the acceptable cross-level difference induced by the vertical grade on the turnout
curve. The assessment should be based on the type of track structure, the special trackwork
configuration and turnout size. Turnouts on direct fixation systems are installed with tighter
tolerances and will be subject to less differential track movement. The difference in elevation
across the frog and running rail through the turnout will have less impact on turnouts installed
on direct fixation systems.
The criteria as shown in the following Table 5.2 are based on the acceptable elevation
differences across the frog and running rail through the turnout, the type of track structure and
the special trackwork configuration. These criteria must be observed when locating turnouts
on grades.
5.4.3 Crossovers
Crossovers are used to diverge or switch train movements from one track to another.
Single crossovers are made up of two turnouts, typically of the same size to avoid introducing
a curve between the two turnouts.
Double crossovers (sometimes referred to as a scissors crossover) are required when there
are space restrictions. They are comprised of four turnouts (typically of the same size), and a
diamond.
Unless there are space restrictions or restrictions in track geometry, the use of two single
crossovers are preferred rather than a double crossover. Diamonds require high
maintenance. Also, the use of double crossover limits operational flexibility during
maintenance.
5.4.3.1 General Requirements
General requirements for crossovers are similar to those listed for turnouts (Section 5.4.2).
However, greater restrictions are imposed on crossovers by the more rigid geometry and track
separation layouts.
The dimensional data for crossovers located on vertical grades greater than 1% should be
adjusted for construction layout purposes to account for the error introduced when laying out
the crossover (on a grade) in accordance with the coordinate system (on a level plan). This is
to ensure that the crossover geometry and trackwork components will not be compromised by
a forced fit during the course of installation (refer to Table 5.2).
5.4.4 Diamonds
Diamonds allow tracks to cross each other. A diamond consists of four wheel transferring
points (or frog points). Diamonds are expensive to construct and require a high level of
maintenance. They should be avoided, if possible. If absolutely necessary, the general
requirements are:
The preferred option is to locate the double crossover diamond on tangent parallel track to
avoid a customized design. The trackwork consultant should also consider the proximity
of track separation in order to avoid an unsafe operating condition of having the LRV
wheels crossing the unrestrained frog gaps of the diamond and turnout at the same time.
Double crossover diamonds may be located on horizontal curves. They will however be
higher in cost, require more frequent maintenance and will affect ride quality.
A diamond located on a curve should be curved (i.e. curved diamond) to closely match the
radius of the intersected design track. The intent is to avoid the introduction of short
broken back curves and minimize the impact on ride quality (refer to Chapter 4, Track
Alignment Section 4.2.2.2 Tangent Length between Curves in the same direction).
Curved diamonds should be designed to be fully guarded to maintain a safe operating
condition during wheel transfer over a series of unrestrained frog gaps of a diamond.
The existing ETS design standard is to use rigid frogs in turnouts and diamonds. The
wheel transfer gaps for rigid frogs should be as small as possible to minimize wheel
impact.
The maximum crossing angle of diamonds on mainline should be equivalent to twice the
No. 8 turnout angle.
The maximum crossing angle of diamonds in yard track should be equivalent to twice the
No. 5 turnout angle.
are typically placed at the transition from the bridge abutment to the moveable bridge deck.
Sliding rail joint requirements should be determined jointly by the trackwork and structural
consultant.
Sliding rail joints are typically fabricated from the same the rail section as the running rail. For
constructability purposes, the sliding rail joint baseplates should incorporate the same rail cant
as the connecting track.
At-grade road crossings should be constructed on a well compacted granular fill to provide
adequate support to withstand both high vehicular traffic volumes and heavy vehicular wheel
loads.
Pre-cast concrete planks with rubber rail seals on hardwood composite ties is the preferred
option. This option is best suited for mitigating the potential for stray currents at road
crossings. Refer to Corrosion Protection Study, 2005 by Corrpro Canada Inc.
In extremely high traffic volume locations, other grade crossing designs with proven
performance records may be considered.
A typical at-grade road crossing design is shown in Figure 5.21.
5.5.1.2 At-grade Road Crossings on Curved Track
At-grade road crossings on curved track with radius less than 150 m should be constructed
with embedded mainline track structure.
Refer to Sections 5.3.6.1 for embedded mainline track requirement; 5.4.7 for guard rail
requirement and; 5.7.8 for track lubricator requirement on curved track.
5.5.3 Requirements
The specific requirements for both types of grade crossings are:
Match the general approach grade and preferably be slightly higher than the approach to
promote a positive drainage away from the grade crossing area. The approaches should
be ramped up to match the grade crossing.
Intersect the road at as close to a right angle as possible to minimize road vehicular
vibration caused by staggered wheel impact, and to maximize sight lines for the LRV
operator, pedestrians and road traffic.
Be level and parallel to the plane of the rails, extending a minimum of 1 m from the field
side of the track(s).
Be located clear of turnouts and right-of-way equipment.
Grade crossings must be adequately drained. Normally, buried perforated drainage pipe
running underneath the road crossing parallel to the LRT track connecting to either the
drainage system or stand-alone reservoirs is required. In addition, geotextile should be
provided under grade crossings to direct water towards the sub-drains and prevent
migration of fine materials upward to the ballast layer.
In addition, the following factors should be considered in the design:
Rail joints should be kept clear of the crossing.
Multiple crossings should have the same grade across all rails.
Rubber or other approved flangeways must fit snug and not allow dirt and debris to pass
through to the fastening system.
Where necessary to locate the grade crossing in a curve, track superelevation should be
avoided, if possible, in order to provide a smooth crossing for both vehicular and
pedestrian traffic.
The flangeway must accommodate the wheels of the LRV and other rail-mounted
equipment (refer to Section 5.2.3.8).
Incorporate a rubber rail boot for embedded at-grade road crossings to mitigate potential
stray currents.
5.5.4 Service Life and Maintenance
The design service life should be a minimum of 25 years. There is a high maintenance cost
associated with grade crossing rehabilitation and rehabilitation work normally requires a total
closure of the roadway.
Ease of maintenance is an important consideration when designing grade crossings in order
to minimize the disruption to road traffic during maintenance.
The grade crossing panel design should be modular and interchangeable for ease of
maintenance and to minimize closure times of the roadway and LRT track.
Embedded at-grade road crossings on sharp curves should be designed with sacrificial guard
rails to reduce the wear on the outside rail. Guard rails should be installed independent of the
running rail for the ease of change out without disturbing the running rail. Running rail should
be accessible on both the gauge and field sides of the rail.
Running rail for mainline track, including embedded mainline track, should be rolled 115 lb RE
(57.2 kg/m) rail (refer to Figure 5.23B).
Running rails on mainline should be CWR to:
Minimize long term maintenance
Rail used for the manufacture of special trackwork on mainline should be rolled 115 lb RE
(57.2 kg/m) rail or approved Grade 900A carbon steel manufactured in accordance with the
UIC 860-0 Specification.
For welding purposes, UIC rail, if used in the manufacture of special trackwork, should have a
rail cross section and metallurgy closely matched to the 115 lb RE section used on the
Edmonton LRT System. To minimize the number of transition welds for connecting the
special trackwork to mainline, the use of 115 lb RE rail section is the preferred option for the
fabrication of all special trackwork components.
Girder rail used in the manufactured of in-street special trackwork for shop track should have a
flangeway width to accommodate both the LRV wheel and work train standard A.A.R. wheel.
In areas where there are high impact loads, rail should be hardened to a range of 320 to 340
Brinell Hardness, to a minimum penetration depth 15 mm below the rail surface.
Asymmetrical rail sections are acceptable for the fabrication of switch points.
Any proposed alternate rail section and its metallurgy require review and approval by ETS.
5.6.1.3 Secondary Track/Yard Track/Shop Track
Rail for secondary track should be 115 lb RE (57.2 kg/m) CWR rail.
Rail for yard track should be 100 lb ARA-A (49.8 kg/m) or 115 lb RE (57.2 kg/m) CWR or
bolted rail.
Rail for shop track should be 100 lb ARA-A (49.8 kg/m) or 115 lb RE (57.2 kg/m) CWR or
67R1 (Ph37a) girder rail (refer to Figure 5.23C) which has been used in ROW Building at D.L.
MacDonald Maintenance Facility.
Elastomeric bonded plate type fasteners should be used for direct fixation track.
The plate type fastener should meet the following requirements:
Incorporation of a built-in 1:40 inward cant
Overall plate thickness of not more than 40 mm, nor less than 35 mm
Overall plate width of 180 mm +/- 10 mm
Overall plate length of 355 mm +/- 10 mm
Ability to provide lateral rail adjustments of +/- 15 mm in increments of 3 mm
Ability to provide vertical rail adjustment to a maximum of 25 mm achieved through
insertion of steel shims under the plate
Vertical spring stiffness of the fastener shall be within the range 17.5 kN/mm to 24.5
kN/mm
Ability to isolate electrical current from the running rail
Direct fixation fasteners should be chosen on the basis of the following criteria:
Ability to withstand the rail/structure interface forces
Ability to achieve and maintain the desired rail tolerances
Ability to prevent rail buckling under high temperatures
Ability to permit the rail to move longitudinally due to structural flexure or thermal
expansion
Ability to withstand wear and fatigue
Ability to reduce noise and vibration to an acceptable level
Ability to withstand local environmental conditions without the need to replace
components
Low maintenance requirements
The anchoring assemblies connect the direct fixation fastener to the reinforced concrete
structure. The objective is to design a system that is cost effective and minimizes long term
maintenance.
A minimum of two anchoring assemblies is required per fastener. Each anchoring assembly
consists of a female insert, an anchor bolt complete with a flat washer and a spring washer.
The anchor bolt must be designed to remain in tension at all times to ensure the bolt will not
be loosened or be placed in bending under service conditions.
The design of the anchoring assembly should consider the following:
Adequate concrete embedment depth for the female insert is required to resist pull-out
caused through the anchor bolt tensile forces or rail force moments.
The anti-rotation capability of the female insert must be sufficient to restrain the design
bolt torque.
The tensile strength of the anchor bolt must be adequate to apply the proper clamping
force required to provide resistance against the rail overturning moment.
i. Inserts
Female inserts as shown in Figure 5.3A are cast directly into the concrete base slab as
the hold-down connection for the mating anchor bolts. The insert should be designed and
installed to match the bearing surface of the plinth.
Inserts should be epoxy coated.
Typical insert parameters are as follows:
Overall block out depth for insert embedment should not be more than 140 mm, nor
less than 130 mm.
Overall insert length of 105 mm +/- 5 mm
Minimum depth of threads of 75 mm +/- 1-5 mm
The Inserts should be designed to accommodate A325, M22 anchor bolts (see
5.6.2.3.2)
The ultimate tensile strength of the insert should be equal to or exceed the ultimate
tensile strength of the mating anchor bolt
ii. Anchor Bolts
The primary function of the anchor bolts is to provide lateral restraint against loading.
Anchor bolts are also subject to a small amount of upward rail force.
Anchor bolts should meet the following criteria:
ASTM designation A325, Specification for High Strength Bolts for Structural Joints
and should have a class 2 thread fit
Nominal diameter of 22 mm
A minimum thread engagement of 50 mm with the insert
The overall anchor bolt length is dependent on the thickness of the fastener and washer
assemblies, and the maximum permissible fastener shimming height. The trackwork
consultant should verify the optimal overall anchor bolt length required for the fastening
assemblies. It may be necessary to use two different lengths of anchor bolts to account
for the allowable shimming height:
Standard length to accommodate shimming heights of up to 12 mm
Longer length to accommodate shimming heights from 12 mm to 25 mm
iii. Washer Assembly
The washer assembly consists of a flat washer and a spring washer. The flat washer is
design to sit flat against the fastener to provide a full bearing surface for the spring washer
and anchor bolt.
The spring washer should be designed to keep the anchor bolt in tension at all times. The
washer spring rate should be between 1.05 kN/mm and 1.23 kN/mm.
5.6.2.4 Spring Clips
Spring clips are an integral part of the rail fixation system for both direct fixation and ballasted
track structures.
The spring clip should have the following characteristics:
Ability to hold gauge
Ability to resist rail rollover
Ability to resist longitudinal rail moment
Elastic resiliency
Appropriate toe load
Electrical isolation
Reasonable service life under all operating conditions and environmental exposure
Relatively maintenance-free
Compatible with the existing components
Bolted type clips require high maintenance (subject to loosening and fatigue failure due to
vibration) and therefore should not be considered as a suitable option except for special
trackwork installations where they may be necessary.
Screw spikes complete with lock washers should be used to fasten the baseplates on wood
ties. Screw spikes should be 22 mm x 175 mm.
To avoid splitting, wood ties must be predrilled to accept screw spikes.
Steel shims are used as required on direct fixation track to raise the rail to its design vertical
alignment. Shims are typically produced in 1 mm, 3 mm, 6 mm, 10 mm and 20 mm thickness.
Steel shims of 1 mm (20 gauge) and 3 mm (11 gauge) thickness should be manufactured from
galvanized steel, coating designation G60 (458 g/m2), in accordance with the requirement of
ASTM A527-80.
Steel shims of 6 mm, 10 mm and 20 mm thickness should be manufactured from hot-rolled
plate steel in accordance with the requirement of CSA G40.21M, Grade 260.
The thickness requirements are inclusive of galvanizing. Steel shims should be hot dip
galvanized in accordance with the latest edition of CSA G164-M, “Hot Dip Galvanizing of
Irregularly Shaped Articles”. Galvanizing should be applied to a minimum 610 g/m² coating on
both sides after manufacture.
The shape, size and configuration of the steel shims should conform to the outline of the direct
fixation rail fasteners (refer to Figure 5.24 shows the shim size that fits the latest L.B. Foster
D.F. Fastener used in the system).
5.6.3 Ties
The classification of ties used in the Edmonton LRT System is as follows:
5.6.3.1 Wood Crossties
Wood crossties used on mainline and in yard track should be pressured treated softwood,
preferably fir, conforming to AREMA recommendations (refer to Figure 5.25). In areas where
maintenance access is restricted and it is difficult to replace ties, hardwood ties should be
considered, preferably oak.
All wood crossties should be pressured treated in accordance with AREMA Manual for
Railway Engineering, Chapter 30, for Ties and Wood Preservation.
The standard nominal dimensions for wood crossties are:
Depth – 180 mm (7”)
Width – 230 mm (9”)
Length – 2600 mm (8’-6”)
Anti-splitting devices should be installed at the tie ends on all hardwood ties. Anti-splitting
devices should conform to AREMA requirements.
Current track design generally includes protection against stray electrical currents. The use of
wood ties in itself is insufficient to protect against stray currents. Consideration should be
given to isolating the rail from the surrounding track structure in areas adjacent to
underground utilities, ducts and other structures. Insulators should be placed at the base of
the tie plate and insulating thimbles should be positioned in the screw spike holes to isolate
the screw spikes from the base plate. Conventional rail anchors projecting into the ballast will
also create a stray current leakage path. This issue should be considered during the
trackwork design phase.
Wood switch ties should be pressured treated hardwood, preferably oak. Switch ties normally
come as a set to suit the size and the general layout of the turnout. The track designer in
conjunction with the special trackwork supplier should determine the appropriate layout for the
switch ties.
The standard nominal dimensions for wood switch ties are:
Depth – 180 mm (7”)
Width – 230 mm (9”)
Length – varies according to the layout
All wood switch ties should be pressured treated in accordance with AREMA Manual for
Railway Engineering, Chapter 30, for Ties and Wood Preservation.
Wood transition ties should be used at transition points between wood and concrete ties (refer
to 5.3.7.1 – Transition Ties).
Wood transition ties should be pressured treated hardwood, preferably oak, spaced at 500
mm on centre.
The standard nominal dimensions for wood transition ties are:
Depth – 180 mm (7”)
Width – 230 mm (9”)
Length: varies according to the layout (refer to Figure 5.14).
Wood transition ties should be pressured treated in accordance with AREMA Manual for
Railway Engineering, Chapter 30, for Ties and Wood Preservation.
5.6.3.4 Concrete Crossties
The precast concrete crossties should be designed to conform to practices specified in CSA
A23 and should provide:
Cast iron rail seat shoulders to fit the base of the 115 lb RE rail section
An inward rail cant of 1:40
A rail gauge tolerance of +/- 1 mm
A rubberized rail seat pad providing a nominal thickness of 6 mm
Electrical isolation
Unless otherwise specified, adjustments designed to permit gauge widening can be
considered.
The shoulders provide lateral restraint to maintain track gauge and are designed to accept
spring clips. Shoulders should conform to the testing requirements for concrete ties as
outlined in the current AREMA Manual Railway Engineering, Chapter 10 “Concrete Ties”.
Shoulders, spring clips, insulators and rail seat pads are an integral part of the concrete tie
design and should be provided as part of the tie package by the concrete tie supplier.
To improve the lateral stability of conventional smooth bottom ties in sharp curves, tie spacing
in curves with a radius less than 300 m may be reduced by 75 mm, if necessary. A track
structure analysis may be warranted prior to making tie spacing adjustments (refer to Section
5.3.2.2 for typical tie spacing).
Concrete crossties designed with variable canted rail seat can be used for rail cant transition
from zero cant at special trackwork to the standard 1:40 rail cant in the track system.
A typical concrete crosstie is shown in Figure 5.26.
Concrete switch ties are customized items designed specifically for a given turnout at a given
turnout location to match the special switch plates.
Concrete switch ties require precision casting of anchor bolt inserts. The precise layout must
be pre-determined by the special trackwork supplier and coordinated with the concrete tie
supplier for tie casting.
Concrete switch ties are the preferred option for mainline turnouts, subject to a maintenance
cost-benefit versus economies of scale analysis.
5.6.3.6 Composite Crossties
5.6.4 Ballast
At the minimum, ballast used for the tie installation should comply with the requirements of
current AREMA Manual for Railway Engineering, Chapter 1 “Roadway and Ballast” as
specified for concrete tie installations.
Ballast should be a clean 100% crushed rock with a hard, durable, dense, angular particle
stone providing sharp corners with a minimum of flat and elongated pieces. These properties
will provide stability, durability and proper drainage. Granites and quartzites are the preferred
aggregate types. Dolostone is not permitted.
The ballast specification should to provide a 100% crushed ballast conforming to the AREMA
No. 3 gradation.
Ballast depth should be placed to a minimum of 225 mm below the bottom of the tie.
Before preparing a ballast specification for mainline the consultant should review the
requirements with ETS.
Ballast of finer gradation should be used in transition slab area where the space between the
bottom of tie and the slab restricts the tamping of ballast effectively.
5.6.5 Sub-ballast
Sub-ballast should have suitable mechanical, permeability, chemical and environmental
characteristics and comply with the current AREMA Manual for Railway Engineering, Chapter
1 “Roadway and Ballast” as specified for Sub-ballast. Acceptable sub-ballast materials
include crushed stone or crushed gravel and sands, or a mixture of these materials.
A minimum depth of 275 mm of sub-ballast should be placed on top of the subgrade,
extending a minimum of 600 mm beyond the edge of the ballast.
The top surface of the sub-ballast should be graded to a minimum 3% cross slope to promote
positive drainage toward the side ditches or sub-drains.
Sub-ballast should be compacted to 100% maximum dry density.
The sub-ballast layer should meet the following requirements:
Be sufficiently impervious so that most of water penetrating through the ballast is diverted
to the side ditches to prevent the saturation of subgrade.
Be sufficiently pervious to so that water seepage or capillary water entering the sub-
ballast is drained away to prevent water from accumulating below the sub-ballast.
Possess sufficient strength to support the dynamic load distributed by the ballast section
and be able to effectively transfer the load to the subgrade.
The main objectives of the sub-ballast are to provide a stable platform for placing ballast and
to prevent surface water retention rutting.
5.6.6 Subgrade
The subgrade’s stability and its ability to sustain and distribute loads are dependent on the soil
characteristics, its geometric configuration and the system drainage design.
The basic geometric features of the subgrade are: width of top of subgrade or bottom of cut;
height of fill or depth of cut; side slope of fill or cut; and cross slope.
The width of the subgrade is determined by the width of the ballast layer.
Adequate drainage is essential to maintain the subgrade’s stability and its ability to sustain the
design pressure exerted by the wheel load. Drainage should be provided either through track
designed by the supplier based on the rail vehicle weight and estimated speed. Reference
TCRP Report 155 Chapter 5.11 for design direction of friction end stops.
The following factors should be considered:
Rail mounting requirements for the friction elements on the design rail section
Required sliding distance beyond the point of impact
Electric flash butt welding can be used as an alternate for welding rail strings. This may be
the preferred option if production speed savings are able to offset the higher implementation
costs.
All rail welding requires stringent testing and inspection. The testing and inspection
requirements are as follows:
i. Qualification Testing
Prior to production welding, qualification test welds must be performed to qualify the weld
kits, welding set-up, welding process and procedures, and welding crews for the work.
The following tests must be complete on at least one sample test weld:
Visual and Magnetic Particle Inspections in accordance with ASTM B709
Ultrasonic Testing by a qualified independent testing agency
Slow Bend Test on one passed test weld in accordance with AREMA, Volume 1,
Chapter 4, Figure 2-50.
ii. Production Weld Testing
All production welds must be inspected visually, ultrasonically and by magnetic particle
testing before the tracks are put into service.
All production welds must be tested by an independent testing agency.
iii. Weld Repair
Defective welds detected in the finished track must be replaced. The preferred method of
replacing welds is to cut out the defective weld and insert a new section of rail, not less
than 4.5 m long, joining the new section with aluminothermic welds. The new welds must
be inspected and tested.
iv. Weld Finishing and Tolerances
Mainline + 3 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm
- 1 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm
Secondary + 3 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm
- 1 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm
Yard + 3 mm + 3 mm + 12 mm + 3 mm + 12 mm + 3 mm
- 3 mm - 3 mm - 12 mm - 3 mm - 12 mm - 3 mm
Shop + 3 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm
- 3 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm
Special + 3 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm + 6 mm + 3 mm
Trackwork
- 1 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm - 6 mm - 3 mm
To ensure truck stability of the LRV’s the ground rail profile must be provided in accordance
with the ground rail profiles shown in Figure 5.30.
Note: The ground rail profile is independent of the rail type. The design and location of the wheel/rail
contact band is the same regardless if the rail is 115 lb RE or 100 lb ARA-A.
6.2.2.5 Telus phone Clarified phone lines required for main and
lines standby metering communications
6.2.2.10 2nd paragraph Added positive feeder line and bypass switches to
list of bonding exceptions.
1
Chapter 6 – Revision Tracking Form
6.2.5 1st paragraph Added requirement for protection and arc flash
studies; added requirement to determine PPE.
6.4 4th bullet Clarified one spare conduit for positive feeder.
2
Chapter 6 – Revision Tracking Form
Figures Updated 6.1A, 6.1B, 6.1C, 6.2A, 6.2B, 6.2C, 6.2D, 6.3B,
6.3C, 6.3D, 6.5
3
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
List of Figures
Figure 6.1A - Typical TPSS and Equipment Layout Original Line
Figure 6.1B - Typical Utility Complex with TPSS and Equipment Layout SLRT
Extension
Figure 6.1C - Typical Utility Complex with TPSS and Equipment Layout NLRT
Extension
Figure 6.1D - Portable TPSS and Equipment Layout NLRT Extension
Figure 6.2A - Typical Power Distribution Single Line Diagram Original and Critical
TPSS
Figure 6.2B - Typical Power Distribution Single Line Diagram SLRT Extension
Figure 6.2C - Typical Power Distribution Single Line Diagram NLRT Extension
Figure 6.2D - Portable Substation Single Line Diagram NLRT Extension
6.1 GENERAL
6.1.1 Introduction
This chapter outlines the design guidelines for the Edmonton LRT Traction Power System.
Topics include:
Traction Power Substations (TPSS)
Traction Power Distribution Systems (TPDS)
Overhead Catenary System (OCS)
Grounding and Bonding
The design consultant must use these guidelines to establish the LRT traction power system
elements, layout, rating and configuration.
Facility electrical systems (including lighting) and duct bank design guidelines are presented in
Chapter 11, Electrical Systems.
The current catenary system utilizes a catenary contact/messenger system powered by 700V
DC substations (no load) that are spaced, approximately every 1.5 km along the LRT corridor.
Several of the substations are incorporated into the existing passenger LRT stations. As
stated in Chapter 2, Vehicles, the LRV fleet consists of Siemens/Duewag U2 LRVs with DC
propulsion systems and Siemens SD-160’s with AC propulsion systems (refer to Chapter 2
Vehicles). In some areas, additional power cables or messenger wires have been installed in
parallel to the catenary to support five car operations.
New extensions and future projects must include consideration in the design of the Traction
Power System for the possibility of:
The utilization of double or parallel messenger wires or power cables for the Overhead
Catenary System.
Power system capacity to allow for new SD-160 LRVs and existing U2 LRVs to operate as
five car trains for headway design and operation consistent with the design of the signal
system.
Half acceleration operations with a substation out of service.
Operational and architectural requirements in primarily a suburban residential setting.
This includes factors such as noise, speed, overall appearance of the system, code
clearances, etc.
AT – Auto-tension
BMS – Building Management System
BWA – Balance Weight Assembly
EMT – Electromagnetic Tubing
EMF – Electromagnetic Field
Floating Ground is a designated term that describes the grounding in a system that does not
have connection to earth-ground. Since the track rails are isolated from earth with no
intentional ground to earth, it is also referred to as floating ground in the system.
Feeder Switch is an electrical switch (which is normally left closed) that connects the power
distribution cables to the overhead catenary wires.
Protective Ground is a temporary ground designed for the grounding of electrical conductors
during temporary circuit isolations.
Stray Current is a small amount of current that flows through paths other than the intended
main traction power system circuit.
Tie Switch is an electrical switch (which is normally left open) that connects two adjacent
traction power circuits.
EPCOR Utilities Inc. “EPCOR” is the utility service provider to Edmonton’s LRT system.
In addition to the *high level guidelines that are presented in this chapter, ETS has prepared
several detailed and specific LRT design criteria, standards and guideline documents that are
to be used by the Traction Power System design consultants to obtain additional detailed
design criteria.
*Note: The LRT Design Guidelines for Traction Power are a high level summary of the documents listed
below.
Electrical Standards/Engineering Design Manual for Substation Electrical
Equipment.
This document includes only the requirements for the facilities serving the Traction Power
and the substation building itself. This Manual will be referred to throughout these
Guidelines as the SS Electrical Equipment Manual.
LRT Overhead Traction Power Engineering Standards and Design Guidelines
This document only includes the requirements for LRT overhead traction power facilities.
This document will be referred to throughout these Guidelines as the Overhead TP
Manual.
The LRT Overhead Traction Power Standards Drawings.
This document contains all of the drawings related to the LRT Overhead Traction Power
Standards and will be referred to in these Guidelines as the Overhead TP Standards
Drawings.
The TPSS converts the AC power from the Utility to DC power for the LRT system and
includes the following primary elements:
Dual AC power feeds from the Utility service provider with auto transfer system.
AC switchgear
Traction power transformer and rectifier units
DC switchgear
125 V DC protection and control power system
Positive and negative disconnect switches
DC positive and negative power cables
Negative ground switch
PLC substation controller
SCADA system
During the design, the consultant should determine a spare parts list for each component, and
discuss with ETS for agreement.
6.1.5.2 Traction Power Distribution System (TPDS)
The TPDS connects the substation’s positive circuit to the OCS and the negative circuit to the
rails and includes the following primary elements:
DC positive and negative feeder cables
Positive feeder switches
Positive tie switches
During the design, the consultant should determine a spare parts list for each component, and
discuss with ETS for agreement.
The OCS provides the positive circuit contact for the LRVs and include the following primary
elements:
OCS masts (poles)
OCS hardware
Contact and messenger wires
During the design, the consultant should determine a spare parts list for each component, and
discuss with ETS for agreement.
Full acceleration scenarios simulate the worst case conditions that could occur during normal
operations where two, five-car trains simultaneous accelerate away from the same platform in
opposite directions. With all substations in service, the traction power system is to be
modeled to ensure that the voltage level supplied to the trains remains above the system low
voltage limit of 480 V DC. The traction power system is to be designed for the following
operational conditions:
Five (5) minute headway between trains and 2.5 minute headway for overlapping lines.
Five-car SD-160 trains.
75 kW auxiliary power (based on duty cycle analysis of LRV).
LRV in reduced power mode (Torque taper point at 20 km/h).
82 kN maximum tractive effort.
1.43 m/s² maximum acceleration (full power).
AW4 loading (13.35 t).
6.1.6.2 Half Acceleration Design Criteria (Reduced Operation)
The Half Acceleration scenarios simulate the traction power system with a mainline substation
removed from service. With the substation out of service and bypassed, the two adjacent
substations feed the affected overhead catenary section. In the affected section the trains
operate at Half Acceleration. Outside the affected area, the trains operate normally at full
acceleration.
To simulate the maximum traction power loading under these conditions, trains traveling in
both directions are to be simultaneously stopped and started at the midpoint of the affected
section. This test is performed to ensure that the traction power system voltage measured at
the pantograph for each train is maintained above the minimum allowed voltage of 480 V DC.
The Half Acceleration analysis is to be repeated for each new substation.
For Half Acceleration simulations the following vehicle parameters are lowered:
41 kN maximum tractive effort (half tractive effort).
0.715 m/s² maximum acceleration (half acceleration).
All other vehicle parameters are the same as the Full Acceleration criteria.
A System Load Flow Study must be conducted to determine the optimum location and rating
of the substations to ensure that:
The system DC voltages are maintained above the 480 V DC minimum LRV operating
voltage level.
The rail to ground voltage does not exceed the maximum permissible limits.
The distribution system conductors are adequately designed to carry normal and
contingency system load without overheating.
Adequate short circuit protection can be provided.
Refer to Section 2.23 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional considerations.
6.2.2.2 Substation Types
The TPSS will be designed to house the following systems and related essential equipment:
Dual utility feeds (main and standby) with an auto transfer system
Utility metering equipment
AC switchgear
Rectifier transformer
Rectifier and interphase transformer
1000 V DC switchgear
Negative disconnect switch
Negative ground switch
125 V DC battery bank and chargers
125 V DC control power system
Local PLC HMI annunciation panel
SCADA system
Fibre patch panel
Substation grounding system to include adequate ground grid
Fire alarm and intrusion detection systems
Heating and ventilation systems
Station service equipment
Card access reader and panel
First aid kit
Eye wash station
Some substations may also include a signal room housing signal relay and electrical
equipment including emergency generator. Refer to Chapter 7 Signals, Section 7.5.12 for
further details.
For typical TPSS building footprints and equipment layout refer to Figures 6.1A through 6.1C
and related drawings in the SS Electrical Equipment Manual.
In some cases the substations may be located in a critical LRT operating area. These areas
may include a main line section in which train frequency is increased (less than every 5
minutes) or near connection points where two LRT segments merge to a single line. In these
instances it is preferred to have dual transformer and rectifier units in the substation for added
redundancy and power capability. If dual transformers are provided, either unit should be
capable of carrying the entire load of the substation.
6.2.2.4 Building Structure
The structural design guidelines for a stand-alone building are provided in Chapter 9,
Structures. For guidelines related to other building components and elements refer to:
Chapter 10, Stations and Ancillary Facilities
Chapter 11, Electrical Systems
Chapter 12, Mechanical Systems
The substation doors must be equipped with:
Non-removable hinge pins.
Panic bars on all man-doors for emergency exit.
Dead bolt locks (locks are to be fitted for special substation master key as per existing
LRT TP substations).
Intrusion detection.
All man doors equipped with a card access reader (CAS).
Concrete walls and floor must be adequately sealed to prevent build up dust which can
negatively impact operation of the equipment.
6.2.2.5 Building Services
Section 10 of the SS Electrical Equipment Manual outlines the building services requirements
for:
Building electrical and lighting
Emergency lighting
Fire alarm
BMS
SCADA
Card access reader
Telus phone lines for:
o Primary Utility metering communications with EPCOR (13.8 kV AC Service).
Main feed.
Standby feed.
o Secondary Utility metering communications with EPCOR (600 V AC Service).
o 1 Spare line.
ETS communication phone lines for:
o Regular telephone at desk for maintenance personal.
o Dedicated line for building management system.
o ETS Operations radio.
o 1 Spare line.
Note: Section 10 of SS Electrical Equipment Manual states that a minimum of six telephone service
lines must be installed in each TPSS. The Designer must confirm these requirements with the telephone
service provider early in the design phase of the substation.
Adequate heating and ventilation must be provided to at each substation to maintain the
indoor temperature between 13°C and 25°C. The heating and ventilation systems must be
powered through the TPSS station service supply.
Detailed design considerations and requirements for heating and ventilation are outlined in
Section 11.0 of the SS Electrical Equipment Manual.
6.2.2.7 Incoming 13.8 kV Utility Service
Each TPSS should be fed from two primary feeders originating from different utility
substations, or, as a minimum, from different supply buses in the same substation. The two
feeders will be designated as “main” and “standby” and will be terminated at the AC
switchgear in the TPSS.
The TPSS AC switchgear provides switching and control for the main – standby scheme and
must be equipped with main and standby breakers and an auto transfer system. In the
instance that the main supply is lost, the system will automatically transfer over to the standby
supply.
In addition to the two feeds from the utility service provider, a separate emergency power feed
must be made available to the substation to provide the building lighting, building security, and
heating in the case of a total power outage. This emergency feeder may be a connection to
an emergency generator located in the substation, or in a nearby passenger station, or to a
portable emergency generator.
Refer to Figures 6.2A thru 6.2D. Figure 6.2A is a typical power distribution single line diagram
applicable for the substations constructed between University and Clareview LRT stations.
Figure 6.2B is a typical power distribution single line diagram applicable for the South LRT
Extension. Figure 6.2D is a typical power distribution single line diagram applicable for the
North LRT Extension as generally described in above paragraphs.
Each substation must be equipped with an auxiliary power supply system to provide nominal
125 V DC power to the AC and DC switchgear protection and control systems. The auxiliary
supply will include a battery bank and battery charger. The battery bank ensures power is
provided to the control circuits if there is a utility power failure. The battery bank shall provide
full control power for a minimum of 8 hours.
6.2.2.9 Conduits
The following are the general design requirements for TPSS conduits:
EMT conduit must be used for all indoor applications.
Galvanized rigid steel conduit must be used for all outdoor above-grade service and ducts
attached to the face of the tunnel walls.
PVC conduit must be used for underground, concrete encased, or direct buried
installations.
Rigid PVC schedule 40 conduit may be used for added mechanical protection where
required.
Rigid steel must not be used to sleeve single conductor cables.
Where possible, conduit penetrations through structures should be grouped. The
minimum size of conduit installations must be 25 mm.
All conduit installations must provide a minimum of 25% spare capacity for future
wire/cable runs.
Dedicated feeder ducts must be provided for each individual positive feeder between the
TPSS and the OCS line.
Dedicated feeder ducts must be provided for the negative feeders between the TPSS and
the rail.
For each positive and negative feeder, the 25% spare capacity must be provided in
unused spare conduits of the same size as the used conduits. This provides redundancy
for a cable failure that renders a conduit unusable.
6.2.2.10 Grounding
Effective grounding of the electrical system is required for personnel safety, equipment
protection, prevention of static charges, fault protection, neutral grounding, operation and
coordination of protective relays, and instrumentation and communication equipment
interference protection.
All equipment and enclosures within the TPSS (with the exception of the DC switchgear,
rectifier enclosures and positive feeder line and bypass switches) must be bonded to ground
to eliminate touch potential. All grounding conductors must be sized and installed in
accordance with the CEC. The maximum TPSS ground resistance must be one ohm.
Refer to Figures 6.3A through 6.3C for illustrations of typical grounding systems.
Detailed design considerations and requirements for grounding and bonding are outlined in
Section 8.0 of the SS Electrical Equipment Manual.
The 15 kV AC switchgear includes the equipment required for the monitoring and controlling of
the main and standby incoming AC feeder breakers and AC rectifier breakers for the primary
power supply for the traction power system. The switchgear contains utility metering
equipment, utility metering disconnect switch, AC breakers, auxiliary power and protective
equipment. The switchgear must be of metal-clad design as per IEEE C37 20.2.
Where dual AC feeders are available the AC switchgear will utilize a main-standby scheme
with an auto transfer system.
Standard ratings for the AC switchgear are:
Rated nominal voltage: 13.8 kV
Rated maximum voltage: 15 kV
Minimum main bus continuous current: 1200 amps
Rated frequency: 60 Hz.
Basic Impulse Level: 110 kV
Fault Interrupting Capacity: 31,000 A (750 MVA) (to be confirmed by a System Short
Circuit Study)
The AC switchgear must conform to the latest edition of the EPCOR Customer Connection
Guide. The following are some of the key items that must be designed into the switchgear.
Utility metering cells are required for each incoming service.
Metering transformers are to be installed on the load side of the circuit breakers and must
be capable of being isolated electrically from both supply and load. On services with the
possibility of an alternate source, or an onsite generator, gang operated isolating switches
with contact operation verifiable by direct visible means must be installed after the cabinet
for the current transformers and before transformers or other equipment.
Provision must be made for installation of the potential transformers in a drawer type
cabinet with high and low potential opening devices. These drawers must fully extend the
depth of the cabinet. The cabinet must be built of adequate strength to support 3 potential
transformers and must exist at floor level. A hinged door with provision for sealing to be
installed to provide access to the potential transformers. Pin type contacts are not
acceptable.
Detailed design considerations and requirements are outlined in Section 3.0 of the SS
Electrical Equipment Manual.
6.2.3.2 DC Switchgear
The DC switchgear functions as the control and protective equipment for the distribution of DC
power to the LRVs. The originally installed DC switchgear included two main DC breakers fed
from two rectifiers, and four high speed, single pole circuit breakers for the positive feeders to
the OCS. The switchgear and rectifiers are to be isolated from ground either by a glastic
sheet, or non-conducting epoxy floor. A special ground-fault protection scheme has to be
setup for the switchgear as it will be isolated from ground. Protective relaying for each DC
feeder breaker, and the incoming rectifier breakers must be contained in the DC switchgear.
The switchgear is metal clad and will be built in accordance with IEEE 37.20.
The current NLRT extension project includes DC switchgear that incorporates the negative
disconnect switch, rectifier and inter-phase transformer into the lineup with the four DC circuit
breakers.
Standard ratings for the latest DC switchgear are:
Nominal voltage: 750 V DC
Maximum voltage: 1000 V DC
60 Hz withstand voltage: 3700 V AC (RMS)
DC withstand voltage: 5200 V DC
Continuous current rating: 6000 A
Main breaker current rating: 6000 A
Feeder breaker current rating: 4000 A
Peak closing and latching current: 200 kA
Rated short circuit current: 150 kA
Detailed design considerations and requirements are outlined in Section 4.0 of the SS
Electrical Equipment Manual.
6.2.3.3 Traction Power Rectifier
As with transformers, the original substations have been upgraded with dual 1500 kW and
2000 kW heavy traction service rectifiers operating in parallel. Newer substations have been
designed using single 2000 kW rectifiers.
The rectifiers must be naturally ventilated traction power rectifiers with silicon disc-type diodes.
There are two three-phase bridges connected in a Circuit 31 configuration.
Standard ratings for the latest rectifiers are:
Output: 2000 kW, 600 V DC, 3333 Amps, Continuous
Overload rating of 150%: 5000 Amps for 2 hours
Overload rating of 300%: 10000 Amps for 1 minute
Cooling maximum temperature: 45°C
Equipment operating temperature: 35°C
The rectifiers must include the following features:
N-1 rating
Natural convection-cooling
Full wave diode bridges providing 12-pulse rectification.
Designed to meet NEMA RI-9 specification for Heavy Traction service
After 100% full load temperatures are reached the rectifier must withstand, without
damage, the following additional overloads: 150% load for two hours and 300% load for
one minute at the end of the two hours.
Be complete assemblies consisting of all rectifier elements, heat sinks, internal buses,
fuses, diode failure and over temperature protection, rectifier over temperature protection,
and all necessary components matched to the traction power transformer.
Detailed design considerations and requirements are outlined in Section 5.0 of the SS
Electrical Equipment Manual.
6.2.3.4 Rectifier Transformers
The original LRT substations have been upgraded to 1.5 and 2.0 MVA rectifier transformers
operating in parallel and are designed to provide 100% redundancy during normal operations.
The rectifier transformer pair must be able to accommodate the maximum anticipated load for
five car operations.
Newer substations are utilizing a single 2.0 MVA transformer.
In addition, the rectifier transformer must meet the following requirements:
Designed to meet NEMA RI-9 specification for Heavy Traction service
After 100% full load temperatures are reached the transformer must withstand, without
damage, the following additional overloads: 150% load for two hours, 300% load for one
minute at the end of the two hours.
Have a dual winding secondary in a ∆ – Y configuration (IEEE C57.18.10 Circuit 31 with a
30% phase displacement to feed the 6 phase – 12 pulse rectifier. This setup helps reduce
the system harmonic current distortion.
Be dry-type and self-cooled.
Include temperature monitoring devices with adjustable alarm and trip contacts.
Designed to accommodate all the scenarios, for all the possible train consists, as listed in
section 6.1.6.
Designed such that the transformer and rectifier are a matched assembly.
Standard ratings for the latest rectifier transformer are:
Nominally rated at 2000 KVA (this rating must be verified prior to commencement of final
design).
Type: ANN
Primary Phases: 3
Secondary Phases: 6
Frequency: 60 Hz
Class: 220 insulation (150°C rise above 40°C Ambient)
Primary Basic Impulse Level (BIL): 110 kV
Secondary Basic Impulse Level (BIL): 45 kV
Primary voltage: 13.8 kV delta
Secondary voltage: 519 V delta, 519/300 Wye or
Taps (offload): +2x2.5%, -5x2.5% primary
Note: The latest LRT extension included three additional transformer taps in addition to the
standard five primary taps to allow the system to be operated at a higher voltage in the future if
required. These three additional taps have been added at -7.5%, -10%, and -12.5%.
Primary to secondary wye impedance: 6%
Primary to secondary delta impedance: 6%
Winding material: Copper
Voltage regulation not greater than 6% from 1% load to full load
Further design considerations and requirements are outlined in Section 6.0 of the SS
Electrical Equipment Manual.
A direct-current auxiliary power system is used for the basic substation controls, relaying,
SCADA equipment, communication equipment, and alarm functions. The system consists of a
storage battery bank, matched battery charger, and DC distribution panel.
The battery and battery circuits should be properly designed, safeguarded and maintained,
and the emergency requirements should be carefully estimated to ensure adequate battery
performance during emergencies or loss of utility for eight hours. The batteries shall be of low
hydrogen emission design for indoor installation.
The battery charger must be independent of the condition of the battery bank. It must support
the full DC power output as long as AC is available. If a standby generator or alternate feed
system is available, the battery charger must be fed from that source to improve reliability and
availability of the auxiliary supply.
The basic requirements for the battery bank are:
Nominal system voltage of 125 V DC.
Minimum stored energy capacity should be adequate to supply the load demand for eight
hours after a utility outage.
The charger must include ground detection, alarm mode, and temperature compensation.
Float and equalization capability
Low and high voltage alarms
Charger failure alarm
The sizing of the DC auxiliary power supply must be based on a duty-cycle evaluation of the
entire auxiliary system load.
Bus bars and bus connectors must be made of tin plated copper, and be sized as follows:
For 700 V DC switchgear – 6000 A continuous
For 13.8 kV AC switchgear – 1200 A continuous
Local annunciation must be provided by the PLC display unit for the following functions:
AC breakers status
DC breakers status
Rectifier diode alarm
Rectifier diode trip
Relay trip warning
Status of control power
Rectifier diode temperature alarm and trip
Frame fault trip
Rail overvoltage alarm and trip
AC over/under voltage
DC over voltage
Rectifier over voltage
DC door open trip
Reverse current trip
Tx winding temperature alarm and trip
Rectifier over temperature alarm and trip
Negative disconnect switch status
Feeder and tie switch status
Ground switch status
A dedicated fibre optic circuit from the LRT Communications backbone must be provided for
communications with the EPCOR Control Centre to each TPSS for the following signals:
Remote operation and status indication of all 15 kV breakers.
15 kV circuit breaker relays status/trip information.
Remote operation and status indication of all DC circuit breakers.
Rectifier negative disconnect switch position.
Transformer over-temperature.
Rectifier over-temperature.
Rectifier fuse failure.
Negative overvoltage.
Utility power failure.
Rail ground switch status.
Feeder and tie switch status.
In addition the following building status information must be communicated from the BMS:
Substation intrusion alarm
Building inside temperature
Fire alarm
Manhole high water level
Fire alarms must be interlocked with the HVAC system as per the Alberta Building and Fire
Codes. The Intrusion Alarm system must initiate indoor and outdoor building lights. Status
and alarm signals may also be sent directly to monitoring locations at ETS facilities such as
the LRT Control Centre at Churchill Station and the EPCOR Control Centre.
All substations must be equipped with adequate smoke detectors and fire alarm systems.
Ventilation and heating ducts will also include smoke detectors installed with automatic shut-
off capabilities.
6.2.4.4 Intrusion Alarm
Standalone substations must be equipped with a full intrusion detection alarm system, with
remote monitoring capabilities.
Integrated substations must have remote monitoring capabilities installed on all entrance
doors.
Both types of TPSS must have all man doors equipped with a card reader (C-Cure system)
The track to ground potential must be monitored to ensure that public and right of way
personnel are protected against unsafe rail to ground voltages. In the SLRT substations a
negative ground switch and the substation PLC measure negative (rail) to ground voltage.
The two devices offer the following staged protection:
The ground switch will close if the negative to ground voltage exceeds 45 V for longer
than five seconds. Above 60 V the switch will operate in 160 ms. If the voltage exceeds
100 V and is sustained longer than 360 ms the PLC will mass trip the substation and
transfer trip to the adjacent substations.
On future LRT extensions the substation PLC must be designed with a time delay to ensure
coordination with the negative ground switch.
6.2.6.2 Circuit Reclosing
In the event of a positive feeder breaker trip due to a momentary fault on the overhead
catenary system, three attempts will be made to re-close the circuit. Through a resistance
bridge the DC bus voltage is applied between the positive catenary line and negative rails.
The relay compares the voltage across the bridge to a pre-set value and determines if it is
safe to energize the OCS. In the case that the re-close attempts fail, the re-closing relay must
lock out.
6.2.6.3 Reverse Current Protection (DC Rectifier Breaker)
A reverse current relay must be installed on the DC rectifier breakers to monitor possible
back-feed current from adjacent substations. Defective rectifier diodes are the primary cause
of reverse direction to normal current flow.
6.2.6.4 Rate-of-Rise of Current
The load currents on the LRT system are typically quite high and short lived (as the train
passes by), but are predictable. One method to discriminate between load current and fault
current is to measure the current rate of change. Typically, a very high rate of change
indicates fault condition. The current rate-of-rise feature is used to detect distance faults with
peak current values below the overcurrent settings. The device must be adjustable with
respect to current and time, to allow certain loads to be picked up without interrupting the
circuit.
6.2.6.5 DC Switchgear Frame Fault Protection
The frame fault protection grounds the DC switchgear through a single point monitored by an
protection relay. The DC switchgear and rectifier must be isolated completely from ground
using insulative materials. In the event the switchgear or the rectifier main bus faults to the
frame, this protective relay will detect the fault sending a trip signal to the substation PLC.
The PLC will initiate a mass trip, clearing all of the 15 kV AC and 1000 V DC breakers in the
substation and send a transfer trip to the adjacent substations.
Each rectifier unit will have current limiting fuses in series with a surge suppressor to protect
the diodes. A device to detect fuse failure, and subsequently alarm both locally and through
the SCADA system, will also be installed.
6.2.6.7 Rectifier Base Load Resistor
A base load resistor must be incorporated into the rectifier design to ensure the rectifier output
voltage does not become excessive during periods of no load.
6.2.6.8 Transformer Thermal Protection
The rectifier transformers must utilize a two-stage thermal alarm and trip protection scheme.
The protection device will alarm both locally and through the SCADA system.
A protection trip of any DC feeder breaker must initiate a transfer trip to the breaker feeding
the same OCS section in the adjacent substation. The new standard for existing adjacent
substations is to have feeder 1 of one substation supplying power to the same OCS section
that feeder 3 of the adjacent substation is supplying. Similarly, feeder 2 of one substation
supplies power to the same OCS section as feeder 4 of the adjacent substation. When a
substation is removed from service, the transfer trip protection shall communicate between the
two adjacent substations supporting the OCS section with the substation out of service.
6.2.6.10 Emergency Trip Stations
Emergency trip stations must be provided in all substations. Activating the emergency trip
station will trip the main incoming AC breakers and the DC feeder breakers. Operating the trip
station will also send a transfer trip to the adjacent substations de-energizing the catenary on
both sides of the substation. The emergency trip stations are to be located near each man
door in an area that is easily accessible within the substations, and must be clearly identified
as an emergency trip station. The trip station must be designed with a guarded pushbutton to
prevent accidental operation of the button.
Conductor size to be a minimum size of 500 kcmil stranded copper with ampacity as per
system design.
Insulation to be 2 kV AC/2.5 kV DC XLPE.
Conductor size to be a minimum size of 500 kcmil stranded copper with ampacity as per
system design.
Insulation to be 2 kV AC/2.5 kV DC Low Smoke Zero Halogen (LSZH).
For additional guidelines refer to Section 3.1 of the Overhead TP Manual.
Conductor size to be a minimum size of 500 kcmil stranded copper with ampacity as per
system design.
Insulation to be 2 kV AC/2.5 kV DC XLPE.
Conductor size to be a minimum size of 500 kcmil stranded copper with ampacity as per
system design.
Insulation to be 2 kV AC/2.5 kV DC Low Smoke Zero Halogen (LSZH).
The OCS consists of the conductors, including the contact wire and supporting messenger
wire, jumpers, fixed and auto-tensioned terminations, in-span fittings and associated hardware
located over the track. It is from these devices that the LRV collects power by the contact
between the pantograph and the contact wire (refer to Figure 6.5).
Edmonton’s LRT system is electrified by a minimum of one 4/0 contact wire supported from
and bonded to a single 4/0 messenger wire. In tunnel areas, the messenger wire runs
separate from but parallel to the contact wire. In newer construction areas, the messenger
wire size has been increased to 500 kcmil. Where the OCS has electrical support issues
additional cable or wire may be installed overhead or underground. The current return circuit
is via the rails.
In open route areas, the contact wire is suspended from a messenger wire centered over the
track by wire clips and insulated brackets. In both underground tunnel and open route
construction, the contact wire is staggered on either side of the pantograph centreline. The
supporting brackets for tunnel construction usually alternate on either side of the centreline
(refer to Chapter 3 Clearances and ROW, Figure 3.10).
The support subsystem consists of all the infrastructure required to keep the OCS in position
above the track. This includes foundations, masts, guys, insulators, cantilever head spans,
and any other assemblies and components required to support the catenary system. The
support subsystem must adhere to the designed configuration and allowable loading,
deflection and clearance requirements.
For more detailed information on the support subsystem refer to Sections 5, 6 and 7 of the
Overhead TP Manual.
Specific studies that may have to be conducted as part of the engineering design process are:
Behaviour of conductors, including conductivity, ampacity, tensile strength, and thermal
effects.
Stray current analysis and mitigation.
Behaviour of supporting structures under static and dynamic loading.
Electrical interference with electronics devices.
Electrical interference with Health & Safety standards.
Impact of LRV and TPSS noise in populated areas.
Impact of LRT on traffic patterns in shared-right-of-way.
The need for any of these studies will be determined jointly with ETS.
6.5.3.2 OCS Design Operating Speed
Speed criteria to be used in the design of the OCS is shown below: For specific OCS speed
information, see Sections 5.1 and 5.2 of the Overhead TP Manual.
LRV Mainline
Maximum design speed: 90 km/h
Maximum train speed 80 km/h
Normal maximum operating speed: 70 km/h
LRV Maintenance and Storage Yard
Maximum design speed: 30 km/h
Normal yard operating speed: 10 km/h (Test track is 40 km/h)
Note: OCS speed criteria differs from speeds stated in Chapters 2, 4 and 5 for LRV and Work Train
speed criteria. The speed criteria given in those chapters relate to track design.
Critical Speed
Critical Speed is defined as the LRV speed at which resonance is generated on the catenary
wires resulting in uncontrolled vertical movements of the pantograph.
The catenary system must be designed so that the critical speed is in excess of 100 km/h.
Reduced critical speed is allowed in areas such as crossovers that have a restricted operating
speed. In these areas, the critical speed must be at least 1.5 times greater than the posted
vehicle maximum speed.
6.5.3.3 Temperature
*Note: The above temperature ranges for tunnel sections are approximate and may not be
representative of the actual temperatures that are dependent on tunnel length, depth, proximity to
passenger stations and portals and whether or not both tunnels are open ended.
6.5.3.4 Pantograph
The pantograph is the current collector mounted on top of the LRV. This spring loaded device
produces a constant upward force on the contact wire throughout its operating range. The
response to changes in elevation deteriorates in the lower operating ranges. New
pantographs, differing from those mounted on the U2 LRVs, will be used on the new SD-160
LRVs.
The general operational characteristics for the U2 LRV pantographs are:
Nominal static upward force: 70 N
Standard operating range: 4070 mm to 6880 mm above TOR
Height of pantograph in the down position: 3680 mm above TOR
Total length of carbon strip: 960 mm (operating width)
Total length of pantograph: 1700 mm
Total width of carbon strip: 34 mm
Total depth of carbon strip: 19 mm
The general operational characteristics for the SD-160 LRV pantographs are:
Nominal static upward force: 93 N
Standard operating range: 3960 mm to 6880 mm above TOR
Height of pantograph in the down position: 3785 mm above TOR
Total length of carbon strip: 1081 mm (operating width)
Total length of pantograph: 1700 mm
Total width of carbon strip: 60 mm
Total depth of carbon strip: 19 mm
The design of the overhead contact wire layout must consider the dynamic movement of the
LRV in accordance with the Design Vehicle Dynamic Envelope (refer to Figures 3.2A and
3.2B). The required clearances of the LRV at the catenary supporting structures and in
space-restricted areas, such as tunnels, must be met.
Refer to Section 4 and 5.4 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional information.
6.5.3.5 Conductor Characteristics
Edmonton’s LRT system uses 4/0 copper cadmium (alloy 80) wire for contact wire. It provides
good conductivity and high tensile strength. The messenger wire is a minimum 4/0 stranded
hard drawn copper. New construction uses a minimum 500 kcmil messenger wire. In some
sections a separate parallel messenger wire is used to provide increased electrical support for
the system.
Refer to Section 3 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional conductor guidelines and criteria.
6.5.3.6 Design Safety Factors
The design must ensure that the system will not be overloaded or suffer from structure failure.
The minimum requirements outlined in CSA C22.3 No. 8, and CSA C22.3 No. 1 pursuant to
the Alberta Electrical Utility Code must be met or exceeded.
For additional details refer to the table ”Minimum Design Factors of Safety for New LRT
Construction” contained in Section 5.8 of the Overhead TP Manual.
The pantograph operating range dictates the allowable range of contact wire heights. The
absolute minimum contact wire height above TOR must be 4200 mm and meet the
requirements outlined in CSA-C22.3 No. 1 & No. 8, pursuant to the Alberta Electrical Utility
Code. Contact wires must be installed within the standard maximum and minimum nominal
heights lists. If special circumstances require the contact wire to be outside of this range,
speed restrictions may be necessary.
Absolute Minimum Contact Wire Height: 4200 mm above TOR
Standard Normal Operating Contact Wire Height: 5500 mm above TOR
Minimum Contact Wire Height at Road Crossings: 5700 mm above TOR
Maximum Nominal Contact Wire Height: 6500 mm above TOR
Refer to Section 4.0 and 5.11 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional details.
6.5.3.8 Contact Wire Gradient
The contact wire gradient is defined as the rate of change in elevation of the contact wire with
respect to the TOR. Where possible, the contact wire grade should match the grade of the
track for a contact wire gradient of zero.
The following table presents the recommended maximum gradient as per CSA C22.3 No. 8.
The gradient must not exceed 2.0% (1:50), under any circumstances.
Speed Max. Gradient
Yard (10 km/h) 2.0% (1:50)
50 km/h 1.3% (1:77)
75 km/h 0.8% (1:125)
90 km/h 0.67% (1:150)
6.5.3.9 Clearances
Electrical Clearances
Electrical clearances must meet all applicable code requirements and should satisfy the
operational limits of the LRVs and related maintenance equipment. Refer to the applicable
figures in Chapter 3 Clearances and Right-of-Way (for the various clearance requirements
discussed below) along with Figure 6.6. Also refer to Section 4 of the Overhead TP Manual.
Mechanical Clearances
Catenary locations are fixed and are entirely dependent on track alignment.
A considerable number of mounting brackets are required. This is a consideration for
locating civil, architectural, and mechanical equipment particularly in tunnels.
Space above the LRVs and below the tunnel or structure ceiling is reserved for catenary
installations. Equipment being considered for installation in this space must be
coordinated with and approved by the OTPS designer.
Pipes, ducts or cables approved for installation on the ceiling must cross at right angles to
tracks on the ceiling.
Equipment Restrictions
Non-traction power equipment must not be installed above the catenary.
Non-traction power equipment close to the 700 V DC overhead wires must have adequate
clearance from energized parts in order to provide adequate safety to personnel and avoid
the need for de-energization.
If non-traction power equipment has been installed above the OCS, maintenance or repair
of this equipment will require de-energizing of the overhead wire system to gain access
and may require removal of the catenary.
Underground Utility Clearances
Minimum clearances between LRT mast and anchor foundations and underground utilities
must comply with CSA C22.3 No. 7 and the Alberta Electrical Utility Code.
Recommended clearances are shown in Section 4.3 of the Overhead TP Manual. Where
there is a difference between the manual and the code, the higher clearance must govern.
If minimum clearances cannot be met, the Designer must coordinate clearances with the utility
agency early in the design stage.
Mast Clearances on Tangent Track
The minimum clearance from centreline of track to face of mast must be *2070 mm.
The minimum clearance to balance weights on mast in swing position must be *1995 mm.
*Note: The track separation (center to center) has been reduced from 4570 mm (N.E. Line) to 4500 mm
for the SLRT extension. In addition the clearance distance from centerline of track to the face of
catenary mast has been reduced from 2170 mm to 2070 mm. This reduction will allow for variations in
mast diameter and installation tolerances. The absolute minimum clearance distance from centerline of
track to the BWA has also been reduced from 2040 mm to 1995 mm. A wider separation is preferred,
space permitting. (Space was initially set to ensure that a person was clear of the mast and the LRV if
caught in the middle).
Mast Clearances on Curved and Super-elevated Track
Additional clearance to that stated for Tangent Track is required on curves to account for out
swing of vehicle ends, for in swing of vehicle between tracks and for vehicle cant from track
super elevation (refer to Chapter 3, Clearances and Right-of-Way, Section 3.3.2).
The OCS designer must determine the applicable span length on tangent and curved tracks
as per CSA C22.3 No. 8 clause 5.3.2.
Additional factors and criteria that must also be considered in the design are outlined in
Section 5.17 of the Overhead TP Manual.
6.5.3.11 Stagger & Displacement
In general, the contact wire is supported over the track and is staggered a maximum of 250
mm on either side of the pan centreline. Stagger is required to evenly distribute wear across
the pantograph’s carbon current collector. When identifying the stagger limits, the dynamic
effect (horizontal movements) of the pantograph when it is extended higher than 5500 mm
from TOR, must also be considered.
Refer to Sections 5.14 and 5.15 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional factors and design
criteria.
6.5.3.12 Overlap Transition Spans, Crossovers and Turnouts
An overlap transition span is an area where one catenary tension section ends and another
begins and the LRV pantograph makes a transition between them. Both tension lengths are
anchored out of running in-board or out-board of the tracks. The overlap arrangement must
be designed to provide a smooth transfer of pantograph from one contact wire to the next over
a standard overlap length of 2 m. This overlap region is referred to as the transition span.
More information is available in Section 5.21 of the Overhead TP Manual.
For catenary serving track crossovers and turnouts the wires must be mechanically
independent of main line tension section. The design must ensure that the following
requirements are met:
At cross-overs (track switches), a separate tension length is required for the cross-over
track.
The cross-over tension length must run parallel with the main line in an overlap region and
then be anchored out of running either inboard or outboard of the tracks.
Catenary transition span masts beside track crossover switches must be precisely located
to ensure that contact wires have correct alignment across the crossover.
Section isolators located in crossover movement must provide adequate clearance from
crossing pantograph.
Catenary support masts must be adequately set back from the divergent track, ensuring
sufficient clearance envelope for the movement of the train (refer to Section 6.5.3.9,
Clearances).
See Section 5.37 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional information on track crossovers
and turnouts.
The Designer must consider the following factors when establishing the wire tensioning
system to be used and the related wire tension.
The allowable maximum operating speed of the system is limited by the critical speed,
which is directly proportionate to the wire tension.
The ability of wind to blow the contact wire off the pantograph (wind blow-off effect) which
is directly related to tension in the contact and catenary messenger wires.
6.5.4.3 Wire Tensioning Equipment
The wire tensioning system must be designed to an ultimate design loading of five car SD-160
trains and five car U2 trains operating at five minute headways. The wire tensioning system
can consist of either balance weight assemblies or spring tension equipment, as specified by
the Designer. Wire tensioning assemblies are to be mounted out of running one span away
from the overlap transition span, either in-board or out-board of the tracks, supported with
standard anchorage assemblies. The designed tension length must be limited by the
available spring or balance weight operating ranges and the rotational range of the other
catenary support arms.
Refer to Section 5.23 of the Overhead TP Manual for more specific details on wire tensioning
equipment.
Balance Weight Assemblies (BWA)
The BWA is a mechanism that maintains constant tension on the catenary wires while
accommodating wire expansion/contraction due to temperature fluctuations. The current
standard balance weight tensioning equipment is a tension wheel assembly that utilizes
different diameter drums to produce a 3:1 mechanical advantage. The balance weight
required is one third of total line tension supported and vertical movement of the balance
weight stack is 3 times greater than thermal expansion of attached catenary wires.
Spring Tensioners
Spring tensioners are suitable only for very short tension lengths, such as crossovers, where
there is a speed restriction. To facilitate installation they are typically installed with
turnbuckles on the mast side of the line insulator.
The current ETS standard is Siemens size 120 and 180 tensioning springs. These
assemblies provide variable wire tensions lower than the standard constant contact wire
tension of 1300 kg achieved by the balance weight systems. Spring tension is typically in the
range of 600 kg to 1000 kg depending on the ambient temperature.
6.5.4.4 Midpoint Anchors (MPA)
The mid-point of each tension section must be sufficiently anchored to restrict cantilever arm
rotation. The midpoint anchor functions as the end anchorage point for each balance weight
tension length and is essential for the proper operation of the automatic tensioning equipment.
Refer to Section 5.22 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional guidelines and details
pertaining to midpoint anchors.
6.5.4.5 Terminations or Dead Ends
Catenary wires can be terminated or dead ended on freestanding or anchored poles, retaining
walls, buildings or bridge structures. There are two types of terminations:
Fixed termination – where the wires are attached directly onto supporting structures via a
two level insulator assembly.
Note: Special attention must be given to wires that terminate on structures that are occupied by the
public or are vehicular or pedestrian traffic bearing. All safety issues must be examined relative to
structural, electrical and mechanical clearance requirements.
Constant tension termination – where the wires are connected to a set of weights that
hang from a pulley system. Also known as an auto tension termination.
Insulation for all wire terminations or dead ends must comply with the following requirements:
Double insulation points must be provided for all catenary wire terminations. Consideration
should be given to avoiding functional interference with servicing equipment used for
maintenance purposes. Dead end and associated structures at end of line are to be located
with consideration of future expansion. These structures should not conflict with the future
track’s Design Vehicle Running Clearance Envelope, where possible.
Refer to Section 2.10 and 5.24 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional guidelines.
Tension Section
The tension section is defined as length of wire between two BWA’s that keep the
catenary wires at constant tension. A midpoint anchor is installed at the middle of the
tension section to partition the tension section into two tension lengths.
Tension Length
The tensioning length is the length of catenary wire between the MPA (or fixed termination)
and the tensioning device (BWA or spring). The tension length is restricted by the following:
The allowable thermal expansion of the contact and messenger wire.
The height of the support mast and maximum vertical displacement for the BWA.
Steady arm rotation.
Tension limits on the wires.
The Designer must specify the maximum length of a tension length for all new catenary
installations with due consideration for the effects of conductor heating under the ultimate
design loading of five car SD-160 trains or five car U2 trains operating on a five minute
headway.
6.5.5.2 Spans
In general, the maximum span allowed should be 55 m. The span, of either tangent or curved
lines, can be determined using the following limiting factors:
Contact and messenger wire tensions
Contact wire displacement limits and allowable wind blow-off
Minimum separation of 150 mm between messenger and contact wire at midspan
Radial loads on structures in curve
Cost considerations based on structure and foundation sizing, quantity and labour effort
for supporting structures on tangent line
For tunnel construction, the maximum allowable spacing between the elastic supports is 11 m.
For more details on spans, see Section 5.17 in the Overhead TP Manual.
System depth is defined as the separation between the messenger and contact wires at the
point of support. The nominal depth of the existing system is 900 mm with 4/0 messenger and
1600 mm with 500 kcmil messenger.
For the design of future LRT extensions, this nominal depth may vary depending on wire size,
wire tensions and minimum separation between contact and messenger wires at mid-span.
6.5.6.1 Masts
Octagonal, square or I shaped masts are used to support the overhead catenary wire on the
existing LRT system. It should be noted that a number of different styles of masts are
installed on the existing open LRT line. A description of each is provided in Section 6.11 of
the Overhead TP Manual.
On future LRT extensions where aesthetic considerations are a major issue, the Designer
must evaluate other alternative shapes.
Corrosion due to road salt and condensation is highly problematic. Mast designs must include
provision for drainage of moisture from any hollow sections. All mast and related elements
must be galvanized inside and out to prevent corrosion. Normally masts are not painted.
However if the mast is to be painted, due to aesthetic requirements, then the selected paint
long term durability and method of application has to be carefully reviewed. The painting shall
comply with the City of Edmonton painting standards.
Masts can be located between or on the outside of the tracks (refer to Figure 6.7).
Standard Classes of Masts
Mast design requirements vary by application on tangent or curved sections for different loads
such as;
Class I – Single cantilevers
Class II – Double cantilevers
Class III – Weight tensioning and dead end structures
Class IV – Double arm transition span structures
Masts must be designed in different strength classes as required to optimize the economics of
the system. The number of different mast designs must be limited by practical considerations
for simplicity and flexibility in application.
Refer to Section 6.4 of the Overhead TP Manual for additional guidelines.
Design Loads
LRT masts must be designed to withstand the following load conditions:
Effect of gravity acting on all components.
Typically, cantilever arms are clamped to the masts and are used to carry the overhead
catenary wires. There are several types of standard cantilever arms. The type to be used is
dependent on the LRT operating condition.
Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 5.30 of the Overhead TP
Manual.
6.5.6.3 Span Wires
In shop, service yards, tunnels, tight curves and other locations where space is limited, the
overhead contact (energized) wires can be suspended from steel span wire. Depending on
the application, head span or crossover spans may be used. Backbone span wires are used
in the North LRT extension to support pull-offs through small radius curves.
Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 5.29 of the Overhead TP
Manual.
Grade separations are generally of two types. The first is the arrangement where the LRT is
at grade and a vehicular or pedestrian bridge passes over it. In this instance the crossing
structure is generally referred to as an overpass or flyover.
The second condition is where the LRT is routed below the surrounding ground level or grade
to underpass a structure carrying vehicular and pedestrian traffic. The structural design
requirements are outlined in Chapter 9, Structures.
Design Considerations
Care should be taken in the design to isolate any electrified components from any
structures or supports.
All attachment wires must have at least two levels of insulation.
Any conductors attached to the roof of a structure must be mounted opposite to any
walkway.
A non-conducting material such as plastic sheeting must be considered for installation
between the underside of the bridge deck and the LRT energized wires.
The potential for the contact wire swinging from its normal position should be mitigated.
All electrical clearances must be as per CSA C22.3 No. 8 and CSA C22.3 No. 1 pursuant
to the Alberta Electrical Utility Code.
All exposed metal must be securely grounded.
Provision for protective screening where pedestrians are in close proximity to the OCS.
Protective Screening Device
Where the LRT is constructed below bridge structures or buildings, screening and/or fencing
must be provided where wires enter and leave the structure. This screening is to protect the
catenary wire and LRT trains from damage and to protect the public from accidental contact
with an energized wire. A minimum 3 m limit of approach for pedestrians is required (refer to
Figure 6.6).
All materials used to fabricate the screening device (mesh, etc.) must be constructed of
galvanized steel and properly grounded (refer to Figure 6.8).
The screen should be painted to match the color of the building or bridge structure in
order to blend in with the surrounding environment as much as possible.
Dropper wires, or hangers, are used to suspend the contact wire from the catenary messenger
wire in a flat profile. The Designer must ensure the contact wire is supported evenly
throughout the span. The dropper wires are to be isolated so that they do not create a
conductive path between the contact and messenger wires.
Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 5.19 of the Overhead TP
Manual.
Equalizing jumpers, also known as in-span jumpers or catenary bonds connect the contact
wire to the messenger wire at a standard spacing along the alignment. Their primary purpose
is to ensure that ampacity, voltage drop and wire heating are all within design limits.
The design must ensure the following requirements are met:
A sufficient number of jumpers are provided to satisfy the electrical requirements of the
system, ie. ampacity, voltage drop, wire heating, etc.
The jumpers are placed at a maximum spacing of 55 m and are at least 2 m from any
suspended equipment on the contact wire.
The jumpers conductivity must be the same or higher than the contact wire.
Jumpers must not be installed at locations near section isolators or splices. This type of
installation can create hard spots in the system that may cause damage to the pantograph
or any nearby equipment. Contact wire wear is also a factor at these hard spots.
Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Sections 2.12 and 3.6 of the Overhead
TP Manual.
6.5.7.3 Electrical Switches
Tie switches, also known as continuity jumpers, are normally open switches that connect two
adjacent catenary circuits when in the closed position. Tie switches are normally located near
section isolators.
Feeder switches provide a disconnect point between the substation and the OCS. Each
feeder switch connects to a specific positive electrical circuit. These switches are normally
located as close to the substation as possible to reduce cable lengths.
Both feeder and tie switches must have the following features:
DC voltage and current rated.
All copper current path.
Non-load break, non-fused.
Minimum short circuit and continuous current rating as specified by the TPS designer.
The existing system has these switches mounted close to the catenary, usually on catenary
masts. For the NLRT extension, these switches have been relocated to cabinets located at
the substation. They are interlocked with the associated feeder breaker to ensure that they
cannot be operated under load conditions.
The NLRT arrangement is preferred for future TPSS locations with pole mounted switches
only being used in special circumstances, such as crossovers.
Further details regarding switches can be found in Section 2.14 of Overhead TP Manual.
6.5.7.4 Section Isolators
Where two adjoining positive overhead contact wire circuits meet, a section isolator is used to
electrically separate them from each other. A tie switch must be installed across the section
isolator in order to connect to the two adjacent circuits during abnormal conditions, such as
substation maintenance, etc.
Section isolators must not be installed in an LRV acceleration zone to ensure that power is
constantly provided to the LRV during its acceleration period.
Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 2.15 and 5.38 of the Overhead
TP Manual.
6.5.7.5 Splices
A splice is a mechanical device used to connect two wires together. The use of catenary
splices must be minimized. If splices are required on contact wires, they must not be installed
near any catenary support structures.
The splice must meet the following general requirements:
Electrical – Rated ampacity equal to or greater than the conductor.
Mechanical – equal to or higher tensile strength than that of the wire.
Additional guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 2.19 of the Overhead TP Manual.
6.5.7.6 Conductors and Related Devices
The Designer must ensure that the selected conductors possess the characteristics that meet
the required design standards for ampacity, resistance, insulation level, tensile strength, etc.
These standards are documented in Section 3.0 of the Overhead TP Manual.
6.5.7.7 Surge Protection
The LRT traction power electrical system is an ungrounded (floating) system except for the
D.L. MacDonald Maintenance Yard and Shop tracks, which are grounded.
In general, grounding is required for the following elements:
All structures within the LRT system.
Catenary mounting hardware.
All utilities encased in metal conduit in tunnels
The existing system makes use of a continuous ground runner bonded to each support
structure to provide grounding. For the NLRT extension, a separate ground will be provided at
each structure using ground rods. The maximum allowable resistance for catenary masts is
10 Ω. A separate ground will also be provided for all lightning arrestors and the maximum
resistance will be 5 Ω. Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 2.13 of
the Overhead TP Manual.
6.5.7.9 Protective Grounds
Protective ground points, also referred to as “temporary” grounds are used for grounding the
catenary wires during maintenance or repairs. The protective ground points must be installed
at feeder switches, tie switches and sectionalizing switches.
Further design guidelines and criteria are presented in Section 2.13 of the Overhead TP
Manual.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
7.0 SIGNALS
Page
7.0 SIGNALS 1
7.1 GENERAL 1
7.1.1 Introduction 1
7.1.2 Abbreviations, Definitions, Nomenclatures 1
7.1.3 System Description 2
7.1.4 Applicable Codes, Standards, Regulations and Guidelines 3
7.2 PHILOSOPHY 4
7.2.1 Goals and Objectives 4
7.2.2 Operating Assumptions and Principles 5
7.2.3 Checked-Redundancy Principle 5
7.3 LRT SIGNAL SYSTEM OPERATION 6
7.3.1 Headway and Train Size 6
7.3.2 Direction of Running 6
7.3.3 Vehicles 6
7.4 LRT SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS 7
7.4.1 System Design 7
7.4.2 System Safety Principles 8
7.4.3 Speed Restrictions 8
7.4.4 Automatic Fixed Block Signalling 9
7.4.5 Determination of Block Location 11
7.4.6 CBTC System 11
7.4.7 Prevention of Side Collisions and Derailments 11
7.4.8 Grade Crossings 11
7.4.9 LRT Operation Functional Requirements 13
7.4.10 Wayside LRT Signal Equipment 13
7.4.11 Communication Requirements for LRT Control 13
7.4.12 Signal Aspects 13
7.4.13 ATS Interface 13
7.5 EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS 14
7.5.1 General 14
7.5.2 Numbering Schemes 14
7.5.3 Wayside Signals 15
7.5.4 Track Circuits 16
7.5.5 Powered Track Switches 17
7.5.6 Manual Track Switches with Switch Point Indication Interlocks 17
7.5.7 Route Key Switch 18
7.5.8 Interlocking 18
7.5.9 Central Traffic Control System 18
7.5.10 Grade Crossing Equipment 19
7.5.11 Bungalows, and Junction Boxes 20
7.5.12 Signal Room 20
7.5.13 Signal Room Power Supply 21
7.5.14 Wire and Cable 22
7.5.15 Spare Parts 23
7.5.16 Duct Banks 23
7.5.17 Knife Switches 23
7.0 SIGNALS
7.1 GENERAL
7.1.1 Introduction
This chapter provides the guidelines and general requirements that are needed by the signals
consultant, ETS and contractors for the design of the extensions to Edmonton’s LRT signal
system and its related components. These guidelines are supplemented by the engineering
standards contained in the Engineering Standards Manual LRT Signals. Throughout this
chapter it will be referred to as the “Signals Engineering Standards Manual”.
AFBS Automatic Fixed Block System
ATO Automatic Train Operation
ATP Automatic Train Protection
ATS Automatic Train Supervision
CBTC Communication Based Train Control
CWI Crossing Warning Indicator
EMC Electromagnetic Compatibility
FCU Field Control Unit
FIFO First in First out
HSS Health Sciences Station
LRT Light Rail Transit
LRV Light Rail Vehicle
MRC Manual Route Clearance
NB Northbound
OCC Operations Control Centre
SCSISB Small Computer System Interface Southbound
SERSCSI Signal Equipment Room Small Computer System Interface
SOPSER Standard Operation Procedure Signal Equipment Room
SPISOP Switch Point Indicator Standard Operation Procedure
TCSPI Track Circuit Switch Point Indicator
TPSSTC Traction Power Signal Station Track Circuit
TSRTPSS Temporary Speed Restriction Traction Power Signal Station
TWCTSR Train to Wayside Carrier Temporary Speed Restriction
VCSTWC Vital Computer System Train to Wayside Carrier
VMICSVCS Vital Microprocessor Interlocking Control System Vital Computer System
WSCVMICS Wayside Signal Case Vital Microprocessor Interlocking Control System
ZCWSC Zone Controller Wayside Signal Case
ZC Zone Controller
7.1.2.2 Definitions
Convergence area Is the area where the Capital line trains and the Metro line trains run on
the Capital line track, physically Churchill Junction to the Health Sciences Tail track.
Failsafe is defined as a system whereby no single point of failure can result in an unsafe
condition. No latent failures, which when combined with any subsequent failure will result in an
unsafe condition, can be permitted.
Flank protection is defined protection provided to a train from any conflicting movement that
would allow another train or other equipment to foul the track the protected train is on.
Non-vital describes or refers to an electrical circuit or a piece of equipment whose function
does not affect the safety of the train operation. Non-vital is not safety critical (refer to Section
7.2.1.1).
Office Centralized Non-Vital systems for managing day to day LRT operations and
maintenance activities.
Vital describes or refers to an electrical circuit or a piece of equipment whose function affects
safety.
Wayside – Refer to Chapter 3 Clearances and Right-of-way, Section 3.2.3.
Other definitions may be provided within this chapter.
7.1.2.3 Nomenclature
The Engineering Standards Manual LRT Signals, must be utilized to keep all new LRT
additions, where possible, consistent with the standard already in use on Edmonton LRT
system.
Edmonton’s LRT System currently consists of two double tracked lines; the Capital Line and
the Metro Line. The Capital Line is approximately 21 km in length and runs from Clareview
Station in the Northeast to Century Park Station in the South. Approximately 5.4 km is in twin
or common tunnel. The remaining portion is on surface or open line with the LRT under
passing CN Rail in northeast Edmonton. The surface line has a number of roadway crossings
controlled by crossing gates. Located along the line are fifteen (15) stations, six (6) of which
are underground. The Capital Line operates on a 4 car consists during peak periods, it can
also operate 5-car consists.
The Metro Line is a 3.3 km extension off the Capital Line and runs from Churchill Station in
downtown Edmonton to NAIT LRT Station in the Northwest. The Health Sciences Tail Track
on the Capital line is used for revenue turnback for the Metro line. The tracks are underground
in twin tunnels from Churchill Station to just before Grant MacEwan Station. There are three
(3) stations along the line all at surface level. The roadway crossings are controlled by
crossing gates. The length of the NAIT LRT Station restricts the Metro Line to operate with 3-
car consists.
The train control signal system is located in nine (9) signal equipment rooms (SER)
strategically located along the track right-of-way. Each signal room houses vital and non-vital
control systems that cover a portion of the territory along the main line. Each signal room is
capable of operating train movements within its territory automatically and independent of the
other SERs. The SERs locations and the territory are shown in the following table:
systems. This equipment must also be rated for use in harsh winter climatic conditions similar
to Edmonton.
7.1.4.1 Maintaining Current Codes, Standards, Regulations and Guidelines
At the time of design, codes, standards, regulations and guidelines referenced within these
Design Guidelines must be reviewed to ensure compliance with current codes, standards,
regulations, and guidelines. Where there is conflict, the designer is to seek clarification from
the City.
New and updated equipment or software along with related standards, codes, regulations and
guidelines can be adopted, as long as these are compatible.
Note: There may be a need to Grandfather standards applicable at the time the LRT system was
designed and constructed.
7.2 PHILOSOPHY
Safety is of primary importance in the operation of Edmonton’s LRT system. The design of the
high floor vehicle signal system, if not based around CBTC, must be based on the failsafe
Automatic Fixed Block System (AFBS) engineering design principles outlined in these
Guidelines.
A fully automatic safety critical and failsafe system must be employed to prevent hazardous
conditions from occurring during normal system operations. Safety Critical systems must be
designed to activate in the event of system or human error and the system must not hamper
the normal safe conditions in train traffic operation. All systems (safety critical or not) must be
designed fail safe to prevent an unsafe condition from occurring. No latent failure may result
in an unsafe condition when combined with any other failure. The system must ensure that
safe operating procedures and methods are maintained.
Refer to Signals Engineering Standards Manual Section 3.1.3 for examples of safety critical
failsafe elements.
7.2.1.2 Automatic Systems and Protection
For a safety critical design the required level of safety must prevent the following incidents
from happening:
Head to tail collisions between trailing and leading trains.
Head to head collisions with opposing trains.
Head to side collisions with other trains.
Collisions with vehicular and pedestrian traffic.
7.2.1.5 Collision Protection
All conceivable modes must be employed to protect against possible conflict and collision
between trains, fixed objects and other traffic under normal operations. To meet this goal,
automatic systems must be installed on the wayside and on the train that will prevent the
selection of conflicting routings, maintain adequate train separation and will bring about the
enforced and non-recoverable stopping of an encroaching train.
In an AFBS, the system is divided into blocks and permission to enter the block will not be
given unless free and unrestricted travel, free of conflicts, can be made to the end of the block.
7.2.1.6 Wayside Equipment
The signal wayside system must be designed to minimize the number of wayside boxes
distributed across the system. This is done to allow ease of maintenance and troubleshooting
given the harsh winter conditions in Edmonton.
The determination of the maximum operating speed is based on the following criteria:
Track alignment.
Civil works restrictions such as the track switch rating.
Safety reasons where the consequences of exceeding the posted speed are severe.
Passenger comfort.
Refer to Chapter 4 Track Alignment, Sections 4.1.3 to 4.1.5 and Chapter 6 Traction Power
Section 6.5.3.2 for additional considerations.
7.3.3.2 Speed Control
Under normal conditions, it is the Motorman who controls the speed of the train and obeys all
wayside train control signals and the instructions from the LRT Controller. However, at
various points along the ROW, speed check devices have been installed to confirm adherence
to the posted speed. These devices shall be installed before interlocking areas, stations or
other locations where it is determined that enforced braking is required. The intention of the
speed checks is to enforce a mandatory brake on the train, which according to the LRT Rule
Book requires the Motorman to report to LRT Control. The speed checks do not vitally
enforce a safe speed at the point of concern (e.g. at a turn-out). If a train exceeds the posted
speed limit at one of these locations the wayside speed check magnet will activate the
automatic magnet sensor on the train. This will automatically trigger the braking mechanism
on the train, and brings the train to a stop. See Section 7.4.3 of this chapter for more
information regard speed enforcement.
7.3.3.3 Propulsion System
For a description of the LRV propulsion system, refer to Chapter 2, and Section 3.6 of the
Signals Engineering Standards Manual.
7.3.3.4 Braking Characteristics
Existing LRVs are equipped with dynamic braking, track braking (magnetic), and disc brakes.
In order to improve the adhesion conditions of the track, sand can be spread in front of the first
axle of each powered truck (bogie) in the direction of travel. The sand control solenoids are
operated automatically during a slip/slide condition monitored by the propulsion control
system.
Additional braking and stopping information is available in Chapter 2 Vehicles, and the Signals
Engineering Standards Manual Sections 3.6.3 and 3.6.4.
7.3.3.5 Track Alignment Constraints
Gradient, horizontal and vertical curvature restrictions are presented in Chapter 4, Track
Alignment. Clearance requirements and restrictions are presented in Chapter 3 Clearances
and Right-of-Way.
The design and operation of the LRT signal system must allow for a worst case hazardous
situation. The system operation must be designed to achieve the safest operation possible
consistent with the required operational efficiency. Fully automatic safety critical failsafe
systems must be employed to prevent the occurrence of a hazardous condition during normal
system operations.
For any future LRT extensions, the new LRT vital logic control system must allow train
movements in both directions on one track, i.e. each track is fully bi-directional. It must also
allow trains to automatically turn back at all stations and at pocket tracks, should either
location be chosen to behave as the end-of-line station due to special circumstances.
As safety is of primary importance, the signal design must be based on safety critical
engineering design principles rated as SIL4 or equivalent.
Automatic systems must be installed both on the wayside and the LRT train that will prevent
the selection of conflicting routings, maintain safe train separation and will bring about the
enforced and non-recoverable stopping of an encroaching train.
The signal system for each LRT line is to be divided into fixed blocks or moving blocks.
Permission for a train entering a block must not be given unless free and unrestricted travel,
free of conflicts can be made to the end of the block and through the overlap area. A red
block signal will not turn green unless all the following conditions have been satisfied:
Tracks within the block and overlap block are not occupied,
The train is traveling in the correct direction,
The next block signal is operating properly, which means no signal lamp element is burnt
out,
No conflicting route into the block territory (including the overlap block),
Track switches are properly lined and locked for the route to be used both electrically and
mechanically.
7.4.2.2 Clearances
For the calculation of worst case stopping distances of the Edmonton LRV on level track and
on downgrade refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 3.6.
For the definition of Approach Track (call-on) Circuit and the calculation of the approach circuit
distance refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 3.11.
Within the Edmonton LRT, the speed restrictions are a requirement for divergent moves on
fixed block systems and shall be based on the LRT Guideline of 40 metres from the switch
points.
The speed restriction shall be enforced at grade crossings and critical curves. The monitoring
of these speeds will be achieved via speed checks or a speed supervision system. The speed
restriction will be set at the maximum operating line speed of 70 km/hr or as determined
through the requirements of the track design.
7.4.3.3 Speed Enforcement for Stations with Adjacent grade crossings
Speed checks shall be placed at both the entrance and the centre of all platforms with
adjacent grade crossings so as to provide monitoring that the train is decelerating
appropriately and in accordance with the proximity of the grade crossing. It shall also be used
to promote a maximum speed entry into a station regardless of adjacent grade crossing.
The normal condition of the block signal is a RED (non-permissive) indication. The signal will
not turn GREEN (permissive) unless it is safe to enter the block and the overlap is available.
Any train that passes a red block signal will be stopped automatically by the train trip stop
magnet associated with the block signal. Vital software must be designed using the check-
redundancy principles as defined in Section 7.2.3. These systems must be proved to be
independently safe from external influences such as, but not limited to EMI, interfaced
systems or sub-systems, and human operation from either the local control panel or central
train control.
7.4.4.2 Train Routing
A route is a combination of powered track switches, track, and field devices that allows a train
to pass through a switching area according to the designated signal system design.
A route is established when the switches are lined and locked and all conflicting traffic is
prevented from violating the “route”. Normally, a route path will start from the block entrance,
through the next block signal into the overlap block. It will end at the end of the overlap block
in the direction of current traffic.
Refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 3.12 for further detailed
information and standards.
Switch Position
The actual switch position must be reported via vital circuits to the territory vital logic in order
to determine whether the requested route is safely lined for the route to be used.
Power operated switches must not indicate position until mechanical locking is achieved.
Once the track switches are lined and locked (mechanically and electrically) in the proper
position for the route to be used then a route will be granted.
Interlocking
Conflicting routes must not be allowed into a particular section of track at any time. The block
signal will display GREEN once a route is confirmed. However, before the GREEN indication
can be displayed, the following conditions must be satisfied:
Tracks within the block and overlap block are not occupied,
The train is traveling in the correct direction,
The next block signal is operating properly, which means no signal lamp element is burnt
out,
No conflicting route into the block territory (including the overlap block and flank
protection),
Track switches are properly lined and locked for the route to be used both electrically and
mechanically.
Sectional Release on Interlocking
The release point of all switches in the interlocking must occur after a train vacates the last
detector circuit (switch track circuit) in the route, unless this point is foul of conflicting
movements. In the latter case, vacating the next track circuit (first track circuit after the switch)
must be used as the release point.
Sequential Track Circuit Clearing
This is a feature that ensures the track circuit that is left unoccupied behind a proceeding train
will not be cleared automatically unless the track circuit ahead is occupied.
This type of design is also sometimes referred to as a “tumble down track circuit clearing”
system. When sequential track circuit clearing is used in the signal design circuitry, a false
occupancy of a track circuit occurs when:
A Train enters into a territory and then backs out the same way as it entered. This is
because the last track circuit it occupied as it moved forward cannot be cleared because it
travels out the same way as it entered.
A NB train enters onto the SB track at Clareview Station. If this train continues to travel
north onto the unmonitored track (“dark” track), the NB track circuit next to the Clareview
platform (Track Circuit TC S13) will remain occupied until the next train goes south and
occupies track TC S14 (track circuit ahead of TC S13) and un-occupies TC S13.
Other examples of dark track are located at MYN and E-Track.
In these situations, a “track circuit reset” command can be issued from the ETS Control Centre
in an attempt to clear the false occupancy. While executing this command in a territory, all
track circuits in that SER territory will drop momentarily. This would cause a GREEN block
signal to drop to RED momentarily in front of an oncoming train; therefore when “sequential
track circuit clearing” design, is utilized it is essential to provide delay circuitry on the GREEN
block signals to prevent the GREEN signal from dropping to RED while executing the “track
circuit reset” command.
For installations utilizing audio frequency (AF) track circuits (including B-Points) and axle
counter blocks the concept of sequential track circuit clearing will continue to be utilized. It will
continue to be possible for a false occupancy to occur so some form of track circuit reset must
still be provided. This will not involve the momentary dropping of track circuits but rather a
vital software function that is capable of detecting and removing a false occupancy.
Generally, there are four levels of warning provided at grade crossings depending on the
traffic conditions.
Level 1 - Separated grade crossing
Level 2 - Railway Crossing Warning Devices
Level 3 - Traffic lights
Level 4 - Signage
Refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 6.2 for the levels of warning,
categories and their description.
7.4.8.2 Traffic Signal Pre-emption
For LRT tracks crossing roadways, other than railroad right-of-way, Transport Canada has no
jurisdiction; however it is ETS’s practice to adhere to the Transport Canada Grade Crossing
Standards. Refer to Section 6.3 of the Signals Engineering Standards Manual for additional
detail.
7.4.8.4 Control Design Criteria
Grade crossing signal control systems must be based on a failsafe design principle. This
ensures that any failure of the grade crossing signal control system must activate the red
flashing lights and bells and cause all equipped gate arms to descend.
Grade crossing protection must provide a minimum of 20 seconds warning time prior to the
arrival of a train at the nearest edge of the crossing. The required time may require to be
increased based on the geometry of the crossing. Refer to the Signals Engineering Standards
Manual, Section 6.4.2 for more detailed criteria for warning time.
All grade crossing protection must be activated by track circuits to allow adequate warning
time for trains approaching from all directions and routing on all tracks. A combination of track
circuits and timers must be employed if track circuits alone fail to meet the operating
requirements. Refer to Chapter 18 Streets Design, Section 18.5 Grade Crossing Safety.
7.4.8.5 Power
All grade crossing protection equipment must provide failsafe operation on a DC power
system with battery back-up. Normal power to the enclosure that houses all of the control
equipment and batteries can be AC power. To charge the batteries, the AC power must be
rectified. Refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual for detailed information on
grade crossing protection and the number of hours of back-up battery power that must be
provided.
7.4.8.6 Call-On Signals
A two aspect (amber and green) call-on signal must be provided at the wayside to inform the
Motorman that the grade crossing protection has been activated as requested. The call-on
signal must be located at a distance from the crossing that is greater than the worst-case
braking distance for a train traveling at posted speed. A train stop magnet associated with the
call-on signal will initiate train braking if the train has failed to stop for the amber signal.
7.4.8.7 Pedestrian-Only Grade Crossings
Call-on signals are not required at pedestrian-only grade crossings but Crossing Warning
Indicators (CWI) must be provided to inform motormen that crossing protection has been
activated. A CWI is a white dwarf signal mounted to the outside of the track and is flashes
when the crossing protection has been activated, once the gates are confirmed down the CWI
will be steady lit.
For detailed design criteria on grade crossing protection, refer to the Signals Engineering
Standards Manual, Section 6.0. Also refer to Chapter 18 Streets Design, Section 18.5.
7.4.8.8 Clearances
The location of all grade crossing protection equipment must comply with the static and
dynamic clearance requirements presented in Chapter 3 of these Guidelines.
commands via the ATS system to Wayside Equipment within this Local ATS Area of Control
only.
ATS server machines run the server side ATS application for the Edmonton LRT system.
There are two ATS Servers and one of them is active and the other one is in passive mode.
The operating system of the ATS server is capable of switching channels to the redundant
link. These network interfaces are combined together through 3rd-party NIC teaming software
and both appear to the network as a single virtual interface. Any fail-over between these
interfaces is transparent to the network and to the application.
All signal system extensions must be compatible with the existing ATS system unless a totally
new Control and Monitoring System is to be installed that is compatible with all other
equipment in the existing system.
Most equipment on the line is identified by the chainage location of the equipment in reference
to the chainage zero reference point south of Churchill Station.
Signals (Block and Call-on) and speed checks have a unique identifier, indicating the track
(NB or SB) and the distance it is from the chainage datum point (south of Churchill Station).
For detailed information on the identification of signal equipment refer to the LRT Signals
Engineering Standards Manual, Section 2.
Track switches are identified by a 3 digit number as follows:
Even numbers are for the SB tracks i.e. Switch #488 is the switch on the SB track north of
University Station
Odd numbers are for the NB tracks i.e. Switch #533 is the switch on the NB track north of
Belvedere Station
7.5.2.2 Consistency
Any extension on existing lines must follow the numbering scheme of that line. New lines may
have a new numbering scheme that is in accordance with the Signals Engineering Standards
Manual, Section 2.0. The numbering system for all new wayside signal equipment must be
consistent with the existing numbering scheme as described above.
The numbering scheme for control wiring terminations and signal control must be also be
consistent with the existing system (refer to the LRT Signals Engineering Standards Manual).
7.5.2.3 Switches and Signals
Refer to detailed information provided in the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Sections
2.7.1 and 2.7.4 as well as the previous Section 7.5.2.1.
7.5.2.4 Track Circuits
Track circuits are designated by the track direction (NB or SB) plus an arbitrary number. The
number of track circuits must be sequential and in an ascending order in one direction as the
distance increases from Churchill Station. For example, TC S10 to TC S22 or TC N10 to TC
N22 runs from Central Station to University Station.
For a track switch, where the switch is, must be named after the switch number i.e. TC488 for
SW #488.
For additional detail, refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 2.7.2.
7.5.2.5 Bungalows and Junction Boxes
Based on failsafe signal design principles, filament signal lamps must be monitored by cold
filament check. RED light or an AMBER light must have double element incandescent lamp,
the principal and the secondary element. A “signal disturbed” alarm must be issued as soon
as the principal element has burnt out.
All signal lights must be lit and complete with proper lenses and filters. The power supply for
the LRT signal lights must come directly from the SER or WSC controlling that particular
signal. The outgoing power must not be grounded (isolated power). Hoods on signal lights
must be provided so that glare from the sun will not interfere with the Motorman’s vision. For
future signal requirements LED signal aspects must be used, light-out detection must be
provided via cold filament check with status information sent to the ATS system. LED light-out
alarm must be failsafe. LED light-out must be equivalent to a red signal.
For additional detail refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 3.7.
Label all new block signal and grade crossing protection call-on signal lights with white letters
and numbers on black background to match existing.
Provide clear labelling for all new track switches and speed checks so that it is easily identified
by the Motorman.
7.5.3.3 Location of Wayside Equipment
Location of all wayside equipment must be clear from the dynamic movement of the LRV’s.
For detailed information of on static and dynamic clearances (refer to Chapter 3, Clearances
and Right-of-way and the figures contained therein).
7.5.4 Track Circuits
7.5.4.1 General
Each fixed block track circuit along the LRT ROW must be monitored by a vital track circuit
device in the SER.
An audio frequency track circuit operates using specific audio frequencies. Adjacent track
circuits utilize different frequencies so that track circuits can be distinguished from one another
without the need for insulated joints. The occupancy is picked up in the SER by a solid-state
circuit board rather than a physical relay but it too must operate in a failsafe manner. Audio
frequency track circuits can be used in conjunction with insulated joints to improve the
resolution of the track circuit limits. This is generally done at block signals and within special
track work (crossovers).
7.5.4.2 Impedance Bonds
An Impedance Bond is a transformer that injects a track circuit signal onto the track so that it
can be monitored to detect the presence of a train. The impedance bond also allows the 660
VDC nominal traction power return via the tracks. The traction return power can be of a
magnitude of thousands of amperes so impedance bonds must be rated accordingly.
All LRT extensions using track circuits for train detection must be provided with the following:
Impedance bonds and insulated joints to define the limits of track circuits.
Vital track circuit devices for the detection of train occupancy.
Between each set of adjoining insulated tracks, impedance bonds must be installed with the
centre taps via high current carrying cables to carry the 660 VDC nominal traction power
return from track to track and back to the traction power substation rectifiers. The size and
number of cables shall be designed in conjunction with the Traction Power system design.
Cable connections must be corrosion protected.
At a cross-over, the SB track and NB track are physically joined. Insulated joints must be
installed at both rails midway of the cross-over between the SB straight run track and NB
straight run track in order to separate the two straight run track circuits. The track switch
associated with each straight run track must be bonded to the rails to ensure low resistance
for the traction return power at the switch. Thermite-welding or approved bolt-on technologies
are used to connect the bonding cable to rails. For detailed information on location of bonding
cables refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual.
Methodologies shall be implemented to discourage theft of the bonds.
7.5.4.4 Cross-bonding
Where there is an insulated joint, the rails must be insulated from the steel bolts and nuts.
Bonding cables must be connected to rails with thermite-welded connectors, or Cembre
connectors, where possible. Other rail connection technologies may be considered as an
option provided that the connector is rated for minimum 1000 A DC.
7.5.4.6 Broken Rail Detection
Power feeding the wayside powered track switch motor, must come directly from the SER or
bungalow controlling that particular switch machine. The status of the powered track switch
must be reported to the SER at all times. Status condition must include switch normal, switch
reverse, switch locked, and alarm status. Alarm status must include switch disturbed or trailed
conditions.
All motorized track switches must also allow field and manual operation. There will be a key
located inside the "H" fixture to enable the push buttons located also inside the "H" fixture.
These push buttons will initiate the switch machine movement from the field. To manually
operate the switch machine, insert the hand crank which will also cut the power to the switch
machine thus preventing the switch machine from movement due to a command from the
office.
7.5.5.2 Embedded in Street
The motorized track switch shall be well protected, electrically isolated and bonded to ground
so that the public is not exposed to live power.
The motorized track switch gear must be insulated and heated to permit operation in a -40°C
ambient temperature. The switch gear assembly must also be rust-proof and weather-proof.
switch disturbed. If it is out of its normal position, the signal system must prevent all train
movements routed through that particular switch.
7.5.8 Interlocking
7.5.8.1 General
The vital computerized control system consists of an ElectroLogIXS VLC microprocessor with
both vital and non-vital processing capability. Vital input/output (I/O) cards must be utilized for
driving signals and switch machines while non-vital communications and protocols provide an
interface to the ATS system. Power for the total system must be backed-up by UPS and
generator backup power.
The vital computerized control system is able to communicate with its adjacent SERs to
exchange vital block information. This communication will be a fully redundant network. The
communication between territories must be considered as an integral part of the vital system.
The ATS system is classed as a non-vital system and not safety critical because it does not
have the capability to directly control wayside equipment. The vital logic system directly
controls the wayside equipment. However, when the vital logic system in the SER requires
human intervention, the ATS system must be able to put the territorial vital logic system in
manual operating mode. LRT Control must be able to send command requests from the ETS
Control Centre to the territorial vital logic control system for execution. The vital control
system must mitigate any controls received to ensure only safe results occur. Refer to the
following section 7.5.9 for additional details.
General
The ATS carries out such tasks as data acquisition, monitoring, presentation, and data
archiving function.
It must also assist in performing tasks such as manual train routing, train tracking functions,
and processing of train and crew data.
Functions within the ATS exist to allow for information storage and retrieval, playback of rail
operations, and simulation of rail operations.
The ATS system includes report generation functions, user interface displays of the LRT
network, and a repository of online documentation.
System Software
Future releases of ATS software must be built on the ETS approved versions.
Network Infrastructure
The ATS system must be distributed over several LRT facilities using a redundant network.
Basic Requirements
The existing ATS servers at the University Server Room record the status of all wayside signal
equipment and all control activities on the ATS system. Administrators of the ATS system can
retrieve all recorded data or play back the event recorded in the system. Any proposed LRT
extensions must be able to provide the same information to the existing ATS system.
System Uniformity
Any new signal systems connected to the ATS system must function identically to the existing
systems. The steps that a user must perform to execute a command on the ATS must be the
same, regardless of the signal system to which the command is being issued. All future LRT
Signal control systems must be compatible with the existing ATS system in all aspects. Any
signal contractor commissioned to extend the existing signal system must budget funds to the
supporting ATS software vendor to perform any required software updates to the ATS
software, graphical user interface and gateway devices. Whenever possible, the
communications protocol between the vital field processing equipment and the ATS must be a
common protocol (e.g. Genisys).
LRT trains must have absolute priority and pre-emption at all grade crossings, the pre-emption
allows flushing of road traffic, and a traffic light phase that holds road traffic and allows for
train operation.
To ensure LRT priority, all grade crossing signals must be equipped with red flashing lights
and bells. If a road crossing includes a pedestrian crossing, additional protection must be
added as described in section 7.5.10.2.
Crossing construction must be in accordance with the Signals Engineering Standards Manual.
Flashers
300 mm LED Red flashing lights along with railroad crossing signs must be installed to provide
grade crossing protection for roads and sidewalks as indicated in the Signals Engineering
Standards Manual.
Bells
According to Transport Canada grade crossing standards, bells are required for all grade
crossings. Grade crossing bells in accordance with the AREMA standard or that have a
proven service record in Edmonton’s environmental conditions must be installed on crossing
signal masts as indicated in the Transport Canada Crossing Regulations. Each bell must
have an adjustable volume and be set at a level that complies with section 6.5.6 of Signals
Engineering Standards Manual. The placement, direction, and sound level of the bells may be
considered. Safety of motorists and pedestrians at LRT crossings is the primary concern and
will be the determining factor in designing the crossing warning system configuration.
Gate Arms
Grade crossings shall be equipped with active grade crossing gate arms. Gate mechanism
and gate arm assembly construction shall be in accordance with the Signals Engineering
Standards Manual. Gate arms shall be perpendicular to the roadway while in the horizontal
position. The tip of the gate arm must be a minimum of 3.66 m (12 ft.) away from the nearest
rail while in the horizontal position.
7.5.10.2 Pedestrian-Only Grade Crossings
For pedestrian-only grade crossings, protection must be added in the form of crossing signals
equipped with 8-3/8” red flashing lights, railway crossing signs (80% size), bells and
pedestrian swing gates and active grade crossing gate arms.
7.5.11 Bungalows, and Junction Boxes
All bungalows and junction boxes must be corrosion and weather-proof with heat and
insulation provided, if necessary for the equipment installed at that location. Bungalows shall
have HVAC and shall allow for venting of the battery gas and a safe air exchange rate.
All bungalows and junction boxes must be sealed to prevent access of insects and rodents.
All bungalows and junction boxes for the wayside LRT signal equipment must be clear of the
dynamic clearance envelope as described in Chapter 3, Clearances and Right-of-Way.
The existing signal control system is divided into 9 territories as described in Section 7.1.2.1.
For LRT, the vital logic signal control system (refer to Section 7.1.2.2), must be an electronic
interlocking installed in a SER controlling the wayside signal equipment for that specific
territory. It is integrated with the existing vital relay logic system and the ATS system to form
an integrated LRT signal system compatible to the existing system.
Refer to the Signals Engineering Standards Manual, Section 4.0 for the detailed requirements
for signal room equipment.
Each SER must have an emergency generator dedicated to provide power to all of the signal
room equipment in the event of a power outage.
7.5.12.2 Signal Room Requirements
Climate Control
All equipment installed in the SER must be capable of operating over a temperature range of
0°C to 35°C.
The HVAC system must maintain the room temperature at 20 C all year. Humidity and dust
control is also required to protect sensitive electronic equipment and relays. Battery venting
and safe air exchange shall be considered with the HVAC design.
Computers
A local control panel/computer referred to as the system administration work station for
emergency access to the new LRT territory vital computerized signal control system should be
provided. Also required are datalogger computers or ModBus Converter units to connect the
any new signal control system to the ATS system.
Communications Room
Communication linkages are vital components in the LRT vital signal control system. It is a
collapsible fibre optic communication network which can be added to any future fibre node
network system. Sufficient space should be provided to house the following communication
equipment LRT vital signal control system,
Connection to SER vital logic system
Connection to ATS system
Telephone system
In the event that the communication room is used by other systems, such as Fare Collection,
CCTV, radio and PA, additional space shall be provided.
7.5.13 Signal Room Power Supply
7.5.13.1 Sources
All LRT wayside signal lighting equipment, track switch motors, speed checks, track circuit
monitoring equipment and other essential equipment must be powered directly from the signal
room emergency power.
Step-down power transformers and battery rectifiers are to be provided as required.
7.5.13.3 Ground Isolation
Grounding and bonding systems shall meet AREMA Communications and Signals Manual,
Part 11.
Ground fault detection and alarms must be required to monitor all outgoing ungrounded power
system. All ground fault alarms are to be reported to the ETS Control Centre via the ATS
system.
Proper use and interconnection of Surge Suppression Devices (SPD) shall be provided for all
power and control circuits entering and exiting an SER Bungalow.
Wire and cable shall be in accordance with the Canadian Electrical Code, Table 19 and
AREMA Communications and Signals Manual Part 10.3 and install cable according to AREMA
manual Part 10.4. The physical and electrical properties of the external signal cable and the
related test methods and procedures may comply with the CP-100 SCM-S-0930-01,
Specification for 600V Polyethylene Insulated and Jacketed Railway Signal Cable.
CSA C22.2 No. 75, Thermoplastic-Insulated Wires and Cables standard should be used for
wire and cable insulation.
The insulation material on external cables should be properly vulcanized black ethylene
propylene rubber compound (EPR) or other AREMA compliant material as accepted by the
City. The insulation shall have moisture, chemical, mechanical and heat resistance
characteristics, suitable for an installed temperature of -40°C and maximum continuous
operating temperature of 90°C.
The insulation material of wires shall be Ethylene Tetrafluroethylene (ETFE) Fluorocarbon
Resin, clean stripping, suitable for continuous temperature of 150°C. The insulation shall
meet the dimensional, electrical and physical properties in AREMA Communications and
Signals Manual, Part 10.3.24.
Cables and wires installed in areas designated by the City as tunnel sections and confined
public areas:
Cables and wire should comply and be installed in conformance with NFPA 130-8.6.7
Cables and wire should be Low Smoke, Halogen Free type compliant with AREMA
Communications and Signal Manual Part 10.2.13
Cables and wire should be tested Boeing Specification Support Standard BSS-7239 and
comply with the following maximum gas release limits:
o Carbon Monoxide (CO) - 3500 ppm;
o Carbon Dioxide (CO2) - 90000 ppm;
o Hydrogen Fluoride (HF) - 200 ppm;
o Nitrogen Dioxide (NO2) - 100 ppm;
o Hydrogen Chloride (HCl) - 500 ppm;
o Hydrogen Cyanide (HCN) - 150 ppm;
o Sulphur Dioxide (SO2) - 100 ppm;
o Hydrogen Bromide (HBr) - 100 ppm.
Fibre Optic
All new fibre optic cable strands must be compatible with the existing fibre strands.
Existing fibre optic strands are single mode, 1310 nm bi-direction type, with fusion splices and
SC connectors at fibre node patch panels.
For additional standards refer to Chapter 8 Communications and Control, Section 8.8.4.3.
Wire Identification
All control conductors must be labelled and tagged at both ends to identify the source and
destination.
Colour coding should be used where possible.
All wires must have manufacturer’s name, month and year of manufacture, wire number,
for multi-conductor cable, if not colour coded.
Wire Testing
NFPA 262 - Standard Method of Test for Flame Travel and Smoke of Wires and Cables for
Use in Air-Handling Spaces should be used for testing wires.
All conduits running under the rails must be insulated to avoid accidental grounding or shorting
out of the rails thus causing nuisance false occupancy of the track circuit.
7.6.1 Trackwork
Posted or allowable speed is affected by radius of curves, vertical grades and super elevation.
Speed monitoring and control may be required.
7.6.2 LRV’s
Placement of signals, junction boxes, and speed checks will be affected by the LRV clearance
profile and braking including the Guaranteed Emergency Brake Rate (GEBR) characteristics.
The interface between the Train Borne Equipment and the LRV is categorized into Motorman,
mechanical, electrical (discrete) and electrical (communications). Commands to subsystems
may be shared by more than one subsystem (e.g. emergency brake train line is shared by the
disc brakes and propulsion units).
7.6.3 EMC
Any interfacing equipment or system, including its track circuits where applicable, must be
electromagnetically compatible with the worst-case conducted and inductive emissions from
the ETS LRVs and traction power system and overhead contact wire, as well as from City and
neighbour radio systems.
Any equipment for interface purposes should conform to IEEE STD 1100-1999,
Recommended Practice for Powering and Grounding Sensitive Electronic Equipment.
Emissions of signal equipment shall conform with EN50121-4:2006, “Railway applications
Emission and immunity of the signalling and telecommunications apparatus.
7.6.4 Power
Ratings/specification of transformers must match available power source.
7.7 RESPONSIBILITIES
7.7.1 Signal System Contractor
The Contractor must provide the following:
The detailed system design specification of the any new LRT signal systems. The design
must be compatible to the existing Edmonton LRT signal systems. Refer to Section 7.7.3
for Design Deliverables and Contractors Submittals.
The supply and installation all other equipment and material necessary for a fully
functional signal system, including, but may not be limited to:
o electronic interlocking computers
The Contractor must provide the preliminary design to ETS for review and approval prior to
the preparation of detailed construction plans and specifications.
In the process of developing the detailed plans and specifications (based on the approved
preliminary design), the Contractor must submit the documents to ETS for review and
approval.
The Contractor must not provide further submittals to ETS until the previous submittal has
been reviewed and commented on by ETS and the Contractor has incorporated the previous
review comments in the forthcoming submittal. It is the Contractor’s responsibility to keep
track of all submittals and comments from ETS.
The Contractor must submit drawings and system descriptions to ETS for review and approval
in both electronic format and hard copy. It is the responsibility of the Contractor to keep track
of their submittal and ensure ETS’s comments have been incorporated in the upcoming
submittals.
The Contractor must not purchase any equipment until approval has been granted in writing
by ETS. ETS’s signature on the Contractor’s submittals does not release Contractors from the
responsibility of ensuring the proper operation and the integrity of the installation of the system
equipment.
firmware provided. Software test documentation should be in accordance with IEEE Standard
829, Standard for Software Test Documentation.
Proper testing and commissioning test plans, procedures and schedule for testing should be
laid out for ETS review and acceptance before performing any testing in the field. All
prerequisite acceptance tests must be performed prior to the applicable integration test.
Independent, qualified and experienced test personnel should perform the tests or supervise
the testing. Valid calibration certificates must be provided for all the test instruments, certified
by an authorized laboratory.
The original testing documents and test reports should be submitted to ETS as a part of
testing document package.
The Contractor must not ship any LRT signal equipment until factory tests have been
completed, accepted and signed off by the City or the Engineer.
The results of testing and commissioning must be assembled in the O&M Manuals (refer to
Chapter 1 General, Section 1.7.2)
The training material will become the trainee’s reference document. The Instructor or Author
who prepares the training material must not assume that the trainee knows any part of the
system prior to training. To assist the trainee in understanding the subject matter better,
provide numerous examples.
ETS reserves the right to copy all training manuals and aids for use in future ETS conducted
training courses.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
List of Figures
Figure 1 - Handhole Lid Integrated into Platform
Figure 2 - Preferred Access Hatch
Figure 3 - Above Platform Layout
Figure 4 - Preferred Cable Layout in Cable Tray
Figure 5 - CCTV Interface Subsystems
Figure 6 - Tunnel Intrusion Detection System Physical Layout
Figure 7 - Varifocal Lens Selection
Figure 8 - Varifocal Lens Models
Figure 9 - CBTC under “Existing train tracking & user inputs”
List of Appendices
APPENDIX A SYSTEM INTERFACE MATRIX
APPENDIX B TYPICAL EMERGENCY PHONE DETAILS
APPENDIX C TYPICAL STATION CCTV SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
APPENDIX D COMMUNICATIONS INFRASTRUCTURE COMPONENTS
APPENDIX E TYPICAL COMMUNICATIONS ROOM LAYOUT
APPENDIX F COMMUNICATION ROOM RACK & CABLE TRAY LAYOUT
APPENDIX G TYPICAL COMMUNICATIONS AND SIGNAL VAULT
APPENDIX H INDUSTRY STANDARDS AND CODES
Acronym Description
AM&PW Asset Management and Public Works Buildings and Facilities Maintenance
Section
BER Bit-Error-Rate
DA Directory Access
HWx Heating Water Systems Monitoring and Control where “x” = system numbers
IP Internet Protocol
MUx Make-up air systems monitoring and control where “x” = system number
PCoIP PC-over-IP
SPK Speaker
TEL Telephone
8.2 CERTIFICATIONS
8.3 INTRODUCTION
The LRT communications system is designed to link the Control Centre located at Churchill
Station and related equipment facilities with LRT stations, traction power substations (TPSS)
and LRT signaling facilities throughout the LRT system. These facilities are not manned. The
system must have the capability for LRT staff to remotely monitor and control, when
necessary, passengers, intruders and equipment that are in these facilities.
The primary communications system is comprised of a number of subsystems as follows:
contacts or analog signals. This system is used to give the control room operators a complete
overview and picture of the status of all stations in the LRT system.
8.3.5 Public Address (PA) and Variable Message Sign Systems (VMS)
The PA/VMS system is to provide the capability for the control center staff to make
announcements to patrons in all LRT stations and interconnected to the PA system is the
VMS, which displays visual messages at LRT station platforms (refer to Section 8.14).
8.5.1 General
General Guidelines for the Design of Light Rail Transit Facilities in Edmonton - 2009
LRT Design Guidelines For ETS Edmonton Transit System – Final Issue July 2011
Naming Conventions Best Common Practice, Issue 1.0”, dated January 2016
Solution Integration and Deployment Report Version 5.2 - March 1, 2011
8.5.2 BMS
LRT Network Overview Schematic.
8.5.5 CCTV
APTA IT-RP-001-08 V1.3 - Technical Recommended Practice for: The selection of
Cameras, Digital Recording Systems, Digital High Speed Train-lines and Networks for use
in Transit related CCTV systems – American Public Transportation Association 2007
8.5.8.1.1 General:
i. The design objective is to minimize the number of components utilized in the
communication systems.
ii. All systems must be designed with integration in mind. Physical segregation of common
system equipment in all communication rooms is to be avoided.
iii. All operator functions must be capable of being installed and utilized on shared operator
workstations in control. Individual workstations for various programs are to be avoided.
iv. A critical component of any communications system is the ability to centrally monitor and
assure that the system is operating as designed. Any solution installed in the ETS
environment must have a monitoring and assurance solution incorporated as part of the
main system design.
v. All new systems must include a Design Services Document (DSD) to describe how the
system functions within the ETS system.
vi. Consistency from one site to another must be applied. The organization and layout of
most types of communications facilities is well established and must be followed in
deployment of new sites.
vii. The Total Cost of Ownership (TCO) must be considered will all solutions to be deployed.
The driving factor in selecting any solution must not be the one time up front cost.
Keeping maintenance costs to a minimum must be the priority when deciding on any
solution.
viii. Any interconnections between systems will preferably be driven by software connections
as opposed to hardware interconnects. If software is to be used, there must be a
supportable model to ensure the links will not be broken when either system on each side
of the link is upgraded.
ix. Redundancy is an important consideration for every point in the system: power, cooling,
network connections and local hardware.
8.5.8.1.2 IT Rooms
i. Standardization of equipment cabinets in each communication room is required to ensure
cabinets and their layouts are the same from one Communications room to another.
ii. When multiple cabinets must be used in a location, consideration must be given to a
central patching bay for connections of devices between cabinets. The goal is to ensure
that only standard length (6 or 10 foot) patch cords are needed to plug anything in at any
location and these cables do not need to be in overhead cable trays. The goal is to
install once and not touch again. Appropriate future capacity needs to be planned in to
ensure this goal will be realized for the longer term.
iii. Each room must be constructed with the nature of the equipment being housed in it
under consideration. Ensuring that all communications rooms have vapor barriers to
keep humid air in, all floors and ceiling tiles are dust free and proper cooling solutions in
place are the basic considerations for any communications facility.
8.5.8.1.3 Equipment, Devices and Components
i. All equipment must be remotely manageable both in band and out of band. This means
IP interfaces must exist on all equipment related to the communication system from the
UPS to the individual devices and also include the ability to carry out remote power
cycling of all devices.
ii. All servers are to be centrally located in the two main datacenters at USR and DLM. ETS
is in the process of introducing a third data center at City Hall. Any servers that are
required will be located in cooperation with ETS and must be approved by ETS prior to
install.
iii. Any new devices that are currently not used by ETS and are being proposed as part of a
project must be reviewed by ETS and an accompanying Best Common Practice (BCP)
document must be created and submitted to ETS.
iv. All components in the communications rooms must be capable of being 19 inch rack
mounted and capable of being densely installed. Individual units that each have their own
power supply (such as media converters that do not share a power supply for multiple
runs) are not acceptable. Only chassis based solutions with redundant power supplies
are to be used.
8.5.8.1.4 Powering
i. All communications equipment must be UPS fed and, where possible, generator fed.
Any exceptions will be noted in each individual section in these guidelines. This includes
all endpoints as well as headend equipment and satellite wiring closets.
ii. Power and data to be carried on the same cable where possible to allow for centralized
management of all end devices down to the power level. Ideally, all end devices should
be able to be remotely power cycled. This arrangement will also allow for centralized
power from a UPS generator source. PoE is to be used for device locations within 90 m
of a central switch and powered fibre solutions should be considered for any device
beyond 90 m and closer than 3 km.
iii. The goal for UPS power must be to power everything from one central UPS per station.
Individual satellite units for smaller cabinets must be avoided as much as possible. Any
exceptions must be reviewed by ETS prior to installation.
8.5.8.1.5 Cabling
i. All structured cabling installations must follow BICSI standards and Cat 6 cable runs in
excess of 90m will be deemed unacceptable.
ii. ETS uses a cable connection and rack layout documentation system called Patch
Manager. All as-built documentation must be added to this system as part of any project
that requires changes to the cabling system or adds new equipment in communications
cabinets.
iii. All patch cables must be separated into copper and fibre and kept separate within
communications cabinets and cable management raceways. Copper is kept to the left
side and fibre is kept to the right side. All power connections are to be organized in the
rear of the cabinet.
iv. All indoor backbone fibre splicing is to be done in a wall mounted splice enclosure with
factory pre terminated pigtails. All outdoor FOSC fibre splicing must be completed using
fusion splicing methods. Spurs and other intra facility runs can be done the same way
and alternative methods such as rack mounted splice cassettes will also be considered.
All methods for fibre installation proposed by the contractor must be approved by ETS
prior to installation.
v. The majority of sites utilizing a lower number of fibre strands must use SC-APC type fibre
connectors. Any high density locations such as multiple fibre backbone meet-me
locations, datacenters and control rooms must use LC-APC connectors. The connector
types used at any site for any project must be approved by ETS prior to installation.
8.5.8.1.6 Wireless Solutions
i. Wireless solutions can be used but must be considered carefully. If the project is
Greenfield, there is little to no reason to use wireless when wired can be used. The
preferred approach to wireless is to set up wireless “pods” with a central radio connected
to a managed switch providing service to devices within a 90 m radius of the central
cabinet. UPS power must be supplied at the cabinet. The use of Individual radios on
multiple poles for transmission back to a central base station is not acceptable.
8.5.8.1.7 Software Systems
i. Single sign-on must be used wherever possible for applications and end device access.
LDAP, AD and RADIUS are the currently accepted methods to accomplish this.
ii. Central management software suites should exist for all end devices to be installed. For
example, ETS utilizes many AXIS products from cameras to encoders and all of these
devices can be centrally managed by the Axis Management System.
iii. All workstations are to be centrally located either in the control room datacenter or the
main ETS datacenters. The currently accepted technology to utilize central workstations
is PCoIP. Other methods can be considered but will need prior approval by ETS before
being installed.
iv. Centralized Monitoring solutions should exist for all key system operational performance
indicators such as CPU, memory, bandwidth, hardware status, application status, log file
analysis, power utilization from the local device and other points such as the generators,
electrical distribution panels and UPS must be included. HVAC utilization as well as
temperature and humidity of all communications facilities must also be included.
8.5.8.2 General Design Requirements
The following are the general requirements that must be taken into consideration for each of
the communications subsystems:
i. The existing LRT communications system is comprised of a variety of different
technologies and equipment. When possible, equipment at new stations should be the
same as what is currently being used. If certain equipment is no longer available, provide
an acceptable alternative that can be used with the current system or plan on replacing
all obsolete and incompatible equipment to accommodate the new equipment.
ii. Investigate preferences or plans in place (to be confirmed with ETS operations
personnel) that will impact selection of equipment. Meetings between the Designer and
stakeholders must be conducted at the earliest stage of design to clarify the proposed
work and systems being offered. The final design must be consensus based and
inclusive of planning, changes and upgrades that are concurrent to LRT operations.
iii. Where possible, systems should be specified that are capable of being maintained,
repaired, modified, and updated by City of Edmonton staff, or by one of a number of local
qualified contractors. It is not desirable to be limited to one source for maintenance,
repair, and upgrading.
iv. Much of the new communication equipment currently being manufactured is
microprocessor based technology. Uninterruptible power supplies (UPS) are required for
this equipment to prevent loss of data, or problems associated with the restarting of the
devices.
v. Where possible, specifications should be based on open standards for interoperability.
Specifications should include bid evaluation criteria that comply with this requirement.
The use of environmentally hardened* electronic equipment will address some of the
environmental factors presented in the section below. The use of this class of equipment
is encouraged.
*Note: Environmental hardening generally refers to enhancements that are made to electronics in order
that they can withstand the “elements”. Enhancements can include water-tight, water-proof; dust-tight or
dust-proof; rugged enclosure or housing, increased allowable operating temperature range, RFI
shielding effectiveness, etc.
iv. Arrival/departures of trains at surface stations or noise from activities from adjacent
developments/land-uses can create high ambient noise levels.
v. Way radios used by LRT staff have the potential for affecting sensitive electronic
equipment.
vi. Lighting levels vary dramatically dependent on the type of station (underground or
surface) and the time of day.
vii. Water leakage and high humidity levels in underground stations and in tunnels can be
problematic.
Refer to Chapter 1 General, Section 1.3 for local climatic conditions.
Avoid the zone of electromagnetic interference caused by the overhead catenary power
system.
Computer flooring may be required. Alternative arrangements such as overhead racking
should be investigated.
Anti-static floor tiles are to be used where desks and chairs are located. Carpet is suitable
for the other areas (to assist in noise reduction).
Cable tray or raceways should be placed under the flooring to manage the large number
of interconnection cables that are required.
Task lighting, with dimming capability as required.
Area lighting, with dimming capability as required.
A relatively low ambient light level is necessary, to control glare from computer monitors.
Light levels should be adjustable to higher levels when maintenance is required in the
room.
Traditional ballast fluorescent lighting is not recommended.
Lighting levels to be in accordance with ETS accepted standards.
Noise attenuation measures are required both on the walls and ceilings in order to reduce
the noise levels generated from: staff conversations, telephone and radio conversations,
ringing phones etc.
Air conditioning is required. Vents should be placed in locations that do not blow directly
on staff. The air conditioning equipment must be capable of keeping the facility cool and
comfortable 24 hours a day notwithstanding the large amount of electronic equipment in
service. Additional cooling for any equipment hot spots is to be considered separately.
Alberta code fire protection is required. A pre-action sprinkler system is acceptable.
8.6.3.2 UPS/Generator
i. A minimum redundancy level of N+1 for the UPS must be provided. However, two
physical UPS units would be a better alternative and fed from redundant distribution
systems.
ii. The UPS is used as a method to ensure that the drop in voltage that occurs when the
generator takes over does not cause the equipment to restart. As such, the UPS needs
to be sized to accommodate the load but only a short run time such as 2 hours.
iii. The UPS needs to be flexible enough to be able to accommodate future growth such as
having a large frame size but starting with a smaller UPS electronics unit. The system
needs to be able to be expanded in capacity by adding additional units as the datacenter
requirements warrant.
iv. The generator must be sized to accommodate the entire load of the datacenter plus
some additional future capacity.
v. Both the generator and UPS must be able to be remotely monitored on the IP network.
8.6.3.3 Cooling
i. All cooling methods must follow industry standard hot aisle/cold aisle in-row cooling
methodologies.
ii. Either redundant HVAC units (a minimum of 2) need to be provisioned or multiple in-row
units can be provisioned in order to ensure cooling availability in the event of equipment
malfunction or maintenance of a unit.
iii. All blank areas of the cold side of a cabinet are to have blanking panels. Rear mounted
switches may need special ductwork to allow for the flow of cold air to the intakes.
iv. Cooling of the room must be designed in such a way as to cool the equipment and not
the room.
v. Cooling needs to be designed in a flexible manner as the UPS described above. It must
be able to be expanded as the heating loads in the room increase with the installation of
new equipment.
vi. The cooling system must also bet capable of increasing the humidity in the room to
acceptable levels.
8.6.3.4 Structured Cabling
i. All fibre terminations must be single mode and use LC patch panels.
ii. All fibre must go to a dedicated two post rack at the end of each row for interconnections.
iii. Each server cabinet will have a minimum of a 24 strand fibre run from it to the fibre
termination rack and have a top of cabinet patch panel.
iv. Each network cabinet will have a minimum of a 144 strand fibre run from it to the fibre
termination rack.
v. All copper connections must go to a dedicated two post rack at the end of each row for
interconnections. This rack is independent and is located adjacent to the fibre
termination cabinet.
vi. Each server cabinet will have a minimum of 24 copper connections from the cabinet to
the interconnection rack.
vii. Each network cabinet will have a minimum of 96 copper connections from the cabinet to
the interconnection rack.
viii. High density 48 port in one rack unit patch panels are to be used for all copper jacks in
the interconnection rack and the network cabinets.
ix. Overhead basket tray or cabinet integrated tray systems may be used to get cables to
and from the cabinets. Fibre and copper cables shall be run is separate dedicated
overhead raceways.
x. The goal would be to use multi-stranded fibres as much as possible to minimize the
number of cables in the tray. As well, consideration should be given to factory made
cabling bundles for easy plug and play installation of both copper and fibre.
xi. Overall, the goal is to cable once and minimize future adds. All cables should be
installed as cleanly as possible to allow for easier troubleshooting and maintenance.
xii. All cables are to be labeled according to ETS labeling standards and align with ANSI/TIA-
606-B standards.
8.6.3.4.1 Cabinets
i. All cabinets must be extra deep and extra wide (800 mm Wide X 1200 mm Deep). The
currently used standard is Panduit server cabinets for servers and network cabinets for
network equipment.
ii. The height can vary depending on the space but they must be a minimum of 42 RU high.
iii. Server Cabinets must have front blanking panels to cover the vertical space caused by
the cabinet being wider and cable management fingers on the rear two posts.
iv. Network cabinets must have cable management fingers on all four posts and the front
rails be pushed back to accommodate the network connections on the front of network
equipment.
v. All network cabinets must have slack spools in the cable management area to allow for
management of cable slack.
vi. All cabinets must come with PDU brackets to accommodate 4 PDUs (two per side in the
rear).
vii. Chimneys are acceptable for hot aisle containment if the room can accommodate the
extra height.
viii. Card access on each cabinet should also be considered with input from ETS.
ix. All cabinets need to be securely fastened to the floor.
x. All cabinets need to be grounded to a central busbar according to ANSI/TIA 607B.
xi. Each cabinet should contain a busbar to ground each piece of equipment.
xii. Double lug ground bars must be used for all grounding.
xiii. Cabinets can be black or white but they must all be of the same color. Coordinate with
ETS.
xiv. Cabinets should all match dimensions to create a uniform look of all cabinets. Mixing and
matching various sized cabinets must be avoided. This could also interfere with the In-
Row cooling strategy.
8.6.3.4.2 Flooring/Structure
i. Raised flooring should generally be avoided if the space is brand new and does not
already have a raised floor. If a raised floor exists, it should only be used to distribute
cold air. Cabling in the underfloor space should be avoided if possible.
ii. All flooring should have antistatic tiles that are grounded to the central busbar.
iii. Dust needs to be kept to an absolute minimum. Sticky flooring pads need to be
positioned at each entrance for dirt control of people walking into the room.
iv. All walls, ceilings and floors must include proper vapour barriers to keep humidity in the
room at optimal levels so as not to overtax the humidity generating equipment.
8.6.3.4.3 Fire Suppression Methods
i. Due to the sensitive nature of the equipment in the datacenter, any fire suppression
method must allow for the extinguishing of fires without the use of water. The goal is to
extinguish the flame and keep the equipment running.
xii. All cabinets must include card access on all locks if critical location, all locks shall be
keyed alike utilizing a master key system.
xiii. All communications rooms must include a contractor shelf that is to be used to put
contractor laptops on. This shelf shall be folded on the wall to maximize space. Above
the shelf, four Cat 6 jacks need to be installed that run to the main communications
cabinet for maintenance needs without having to open the cabinet door.
xiv. All cabling (fibre and copper) needs to be installed to the main communications cabinet
and any other cabinets must have at least 48 ports of copper connections to the main
communications cabinet.
8.6.4.1 Main Communications Room
All main communications rooms shall be a minimum of 42 m2. Room configuration other than
square or rectangular are acceptable as long as same square meter size as indicated is
maintained. In these configurations, the room must be designed to accommodate the required
number of 4 post, server depth racks and allow access from all four sides of the rack. This
means a minimum of 1 m from all sides of the rack. When multiple racks are deployed, they
may be bolted together. Anti-Static mats must be deployed on at least the front and rear sides
of the cabinet extending out a minimum of 0.75 m from the cabinet edge.
The ceiling must be a minimum height of 4.0 m in order to accommodate a full 45 RU rack and
cable tray with waterfalls into each rack. Main Communications Rooms are preferred to be
located on the station itself, either on the platform or in the basement.
A minimum of two cabinets must be installed in each main communications room. One is for
the communications equipment and the second is for power distribution of a powered fibre
solution.
As powered fibre solutions start to become more mainstream, the likelihood of needing any
other locations for distribution equipment will decrease. This means that wiring closets and
secondary communications rooms will not be needed. The only thing that may end up being
installed in these locations is a wall mount junction box containing the power distribution
blocks and the fibre splice points as a means of device aggregation.
ii. Provision may need to be made for 120 V AC input on audio amplifiers. Verification of
the acceptable input voltages of the equipment being installed needs to be made prior to
designing the power distribution.
iii. Every cabinet must have 2 redundant circuits distributed within the cabinet by an IP
capable PDU. This must have the ability to be able to be remotely shut down individual
outlets as needed. Wiring closets will only have one circuit.
iv. The UPS must be centralized for the station and all communications locations must have
UPS fed circuits.
v. The UPS must be used to bridge that gap between when the utility power goes away and
the generator power comes online.
vi. All power components feeding the communications equipment must be connected to the
OSS network for remote monitoring and limited control functions. This includes the Main
distribution meter, generator, UPS and PDUs. Network drops are to be provided to each
of these devices for connection to the OSS network. As some of these devices are in
electrical rooms, consideration should be given to using a hardened industrial access
switch in the room and optical isolating its uplink to the main communications room via
fibre.
times. Going forward, once this infrastructure is in place, vendors will no longer be able to
provide anything from these three categories in their solutions. They must run their
applications on the ETS provided infrastructure and work closely with ETS to ensure that their
needs are met.
Note: Confirmation is required that the cables are sized in accordance with the latest known
requirements of ETS. In addition, any ducting that requires sub-ducts requires a minimum of two sets of
Maxcell within one 103 mm conduit.
Auxiliary fibre cables used to interconnect other locations within the station footprint and
adjacent structures must follow these guidelines:
i. All auxiliary fibres are to be a minimum of 24 strands.
ii. All auxiliary fibres are to be single-mode.
iii. Auxiliary fibres can utilize the OSE or cassette style installation.
iv. At a minimum these auxiliary fibre would connect the communications room to the
platform or TPSS (depending on the communication room location) and any transit center
location co-located with the LRT station.
The buffer tube assignments for all fibres are available on request and working in conjunction
with ETS, documentation is available for the current assignments.
Another desired goal of centralized PoE is to achieve centralized power distribution and UPS
backup of all end devices. All of the PoE injection devices must be UPS backed up by the
central station UPS. Individual UPS units are not acceptable.
ETS has traditionally used Axis 60 W PoE outdoor PTZ cameras for outdoor use as they are
rated to -50°C. Recently, ETS has piloted a 30 W equivalent with the tradeoff that it is only
rated to -30°C. ETS still has limited experience with the reliability of this camera so use of the
60 W camera model is still recommended in new installs. The main driver to move away from
the higher power camera is the fact that 60 W PoE devices are more difficult to find than 30 W
products. Consultation with ETS as to the current standards at the time of installation must be
completed prior to starting any design.
New semi-managed media converters are also being explored that convert fibre to copper and
output up to 60 W PoE. They are dumb devices but have the ability to cycle the 60 W PoE
output if the input data signal goes away. These devices connect directly to an SFP port on
the upstream switch and when the SFP is disabled, the end device is power cycled. This
works in terms of management of single devices but does not give the manageability to
provide access to disparate devices in the same area due to the lack of VLAN support. Other
manageable devices are being considered to fill this role. Combining this with hybrid power
and fibre cable, a viable alternative to remotely powering devices from one central
communications room is available for design. This is still under investigation and may be
introduced as a standard at a future date.
i. Distance between PA cables and any Telephone, Cat 6, or power cable is maximized.
ii. ISP Fibre cables and jumpers are physically isolated from copper cabling.
iii. Cables entering or exiting tray are protected with water falls.
iv. The signal ground bar is electrically isolated from other metal. No. 6 wire with lugs to
connect from the ground bar to the rack ground must be used. This provides a secure
but easy to remove connection.
v. 208 V AC and 24/48 V DC distribution is placed in conduit with j-boxes placed in each
cabinet location. Flex conduit is used to connect the j-box and rack.
vi. Cable trays in publicly accessible areas must be completely enclosed with tamper
resistant tops.
8.7.16 Environmental
Due to the sensitive nature of the equipment housed within the communications room, the
environment must be maintained similar to an office environment as a minimum requirement.
Heating and ventilation requirements are given in Chapter 12 Mechanical Systems, Table 3.
8.7.17 Grounding
Ground in a DC rail system is different than other environments. Ground loops and noisy
equipment are common. To mitigate these effects the following measures must be taken:
Provide two ground systems as follows:
i. A chassis ground, which would tie into the building traditional ground system along with
other systems in the building.
ii. A signal ground, which consists of either a separate ground rod or a larger than code
ground cable tied directly to the building ground grid. The primary reason for this is that
signals and traction power systems can feed noise back through the ground system.
iii. Oversized main ground bus bars should be used, ERICO TMGB-A25L33PT or approved
equivalent.
iv. Resistance to earth from each *TGB should be 10 ohms or less for chassis ground and 5
ohms or less for signal ground.
In addition to the firewall, ETS will be moving to full encryption of all individual networks across
the LAN and WAN to ensure all data is secure when it leaves a facility on its way to the
datacenters.
8.7.19.4 Compute Environment
ETS is moving to a converged compute environment and standardization of all underlying
server hardware. Vendors will no longer be allowed to supply their own equipment but must
be able to work with ETS to ensure the server hardware required will fit into the ETS
environment. This environment is still a work in progress and the latest ETS standards will
apply. Refer to the ETS BCP on the converged compute environment for more details.
8.8.2 Quality
8.8.2.1 Manufacturer Selection Requirements
All cable manufacturers must be approved by ETS. The selected manufacturer must provide
all data required for evaluation by ETS and must make the arrangements for any required
demonstrations and tests. Qualifications must be based on the following criteria:
8.8.2.2 Past Performance and Experience
The cable manufacturers must demonstrate previous successful experience in supplying wire
and cable specified herein. A list of such installations must be provided for each cable
manufacturer to be considered.
The number of years of experience required for the contractor must be confirmed with ETS.
ii. Conductors and cable inner/outer jacketing must be insulated with Polyethylene (PE),
Polyolefin (XLPO), or Cross-linked Polyethylene (XLPE or UL type XHHW-2) that will
meet the following minimum requirements:
a. Sunlight Resistant
b. Flame Test Rated FT4
c. CSA cold impact/bend test at -40 deg C
d. Suitable for direct burial
e. Rated for wet/dry environments with temperature range from -40°C to +70°C.
iii. Cables must meet all other requirements of direct burial outside plant cables as listed by
ANSI/ICEA for the intended application (i.e. control wiring, telephony, or broadband).
iv. Cables exposed or installed aerially must be rated for installations to -50°C.
v. Cables installed in tunnels or other confined spaces, intended for personnel or public use,
must not use Polyethylene (PE) and must comply with the following Toxicity.
Requirements (Boeing Specification Support Standard BBS-7239):
a. Carbon Monoxide (CO) < 3500 ppm
b. Carbon Dioxide (CO2) < 90000 ppm
c. Hydrogen Fluoride (HF) < 200 ppm
d. Nitrogen Dioxide (NO2) < 100 ppm
e. Hydrogen Chloride (HCl) < 500 ppm
f. Hydrogen Cyanide (HCN) < 150 ppm
g. Sulfur Dioxide (SO2) < 100 ppm
h. Hydrogen Bromide (HBr) < 100 ppm
8.8.4.1.2 Procurement & Installation Requirements
i. All outside plant cables, more than 300 m in length, must be ordered cut to length from
the manufacturer and delivered on separate reels.
ii. Cable must be labeled as follows (outer jacket must be marked with the following
information):
a. Cable Manufacturer
b. Number of Pairs/Conductors
c. Cable Function (i.e. telephone, SCADA, etc.)
d. Halogen Free, Low Smoke. (if applicable)
e. Date Coded (MMYY).
f. Sequential Marking (a mark every foot or metre). Marking must be made in
contrasting colour, either black or white, and indented into the jacketing.
iii. Cables delivered to site or the contractor’s site office must be stored in a covered
warehouse facility.
iv. Prior to installation, all conduits must be rodded, mandrelled, and cleaned. Bells must be
placed upon all conduit ends. Sharp edges, that the cable may be pulled over, must be
protected. Pulling eyes and cable racking must be added to all manholes.
v. Installers must use breakaway swivels set to a pulling tension 95% or less than the
manufacturer’s maximum rated pulling tension. When pulling multiple cables, only those
cables directly tied to the swivel must be added to capacity of the swivel.
vi. When preparing to pull or lay cable, cable must not be placed or dragged upon the
ground. Tarps must be used to protect cable during preparation. Cables must not be
pulled through a cable tray or trough.
vii. A 15 m service loop must be placed in manholes approximately every 300 m and at each
cable end.
viii. Cables must be labeled with cable ID at each cable end, in each pull box and in each
manhole.
ix. Cable must not be spliced in manholes. If a splice is required, a pad or pole mounted
cabinet must be installed with a minimum of 150 mm above ground level or flood level,
whichever is higher.
x. All outside plant copper cables must be terminated within 15 m of the building entrance
All outside plant copper cables must be terminated on gas-tube protector (lightning
protectors) blocks similar to Porta Systems 175BCXN-400
xi. Cable armor, or shields, must be grounded only on the north or west end of the cable
(single end grounding) to prevent ground loops.
8.8.4.1.3 Testing
i. Cable must be tested at least three times as follows:
a. At the manufacturer’s facility prior to shipment.
b. After receipt by contractor or agency prior to installation.
c. After installation.
ii. Testing must test for basic continuity and any functionally important requirements such as
data throughput or cross-talk for higher frequency transmission cables. As a minimum
cable must be tested to meet the manufacturer’s stated performance requirements.
iii. Conductors with 600 V or better insulation and greater than 18 AWG must be megger
tested.
8.8.4.2 Data and Telephone Structured Cabling
All cable as described herein including, but not limited to:
8.8.4.2.1 UTP Cable
i. All horizontal data and voice cable to be 4 unshielded, twisted conductor pairs. Cable to
be CMP rated and certified by CSA as type PCC with a minimum FT6 flame test rating,
and in accordance with requirements of the Authority Having Jurisdiction.
ii. Cable to meet or exceed Cat 6 standards for 250 MHz as per ANSI/TIA-568-C.2 (2009)
Balanced Twisted-Pair Telecommunications Cabling and Components Standard.
8.8.4.2.2 Copper Analogue: Vertical Riser/Backbone
i. Unshielded Multi-pair Category 3 cable.
ii. Physical Description
a. Conductors: 25 pair 24 AWG solid copper conductors.
b. Cable Groups: formed into binder groups of pairs.
c. Insulation: thermoplastic-covered individuals; Riser-rated overall jacket, complying
with requirements of CEC.
d. Colour coding: each conductor colour coded in accordance with industry standard
colour scheme for 25 pair, 50 pair, 100 pair, and 200 pair cables. Each conductor
tracer-coloured.
iii. Transmission Characteristics:
a. DC Resistance: Maximum 94 Ohms / km.
b. Mutal Capacitance: Maximum 262 pF/ 100 m @ 1 MHz
c. Characteristic Impedance: 100 Ohms ± 15%.
d. Attenuation, maximum:
1. 2.2 dB/ 100 m @ 772 kHz
2. 2.6 dB/ 100m @ 1 MHz
e. 5 Near End crosstalk coupling loss between pairs within a 25-pair binder group
equal to or greater than:
8.8.4.2.4 Testing
Test all runs upon completion of permanent terminations, using instrumentation acceptable to
ETS or their Consultant. Before commencing testing, submit sample test data sheets and
information with respect to test instrumentation to be used.
i. Acceptable Test Instruments:
a. Copper: Fluke DSX-5000 or approved equal.
ii. Copper test instruments to meet the requirements of ANSI/TIA-1152 (2009)
Requirements for Field Test Instruments and Measurements for Balanced Twisted-Pair
Cabling.
iii. Test instrument firmware to be latest version as supplied by test device manufacturer.
iv. Copper Media:
a. All tests required for system to be Certified Cat 6 by Manufacturer. Test all
permanent and channel links to ANSI/TIA-568C.2 Category 6 250 MHz using
methods per ANSI/TIA-1152(2009).
b. Before recording results, compare readings to predicted values based on cable
specification and run length, using connector and patch cord losses as part of
predicted value. Retest runs with:
1. Resistance and capacitance readings more than 10% above predicted values.
2. NEXT values 3 dB lower than predicted values.
3. Attenuation values 2 dB higher than predicted values.
4. Re-terminate or re-install and retest as necessary to correct excessive
variations.
8.8.4.3 Fibre Optic Cables
Outside plant cables must be used for installation in metropolitan underground ducts, cable
trays, open air and subway systems or other areas where uncontrolled temperature and
humidity exist and/or where cable may be exposed to water and pest damage. Cable must be
of loose tube, gel filled design having buffer tubes, central dielectric member, and *aramid
yarn outer core strength member(s). Due to potential placement of outside plant fibre cables
adjacent to power conductors, cables must not contain any metal parts, pieces or attributes.
Note: (Aramid any of a group of lightweight but very strong heat-resistant synthetic aromatic polyamide
materials that are fashioned into fibres, filaments, or sheets and used especially in textiles and plastics.)
iii. Prior to installation all conduits must be rodded, mandrelled, and cleaned. Bells must be
placed upon all conduit ends. Sharp edges, which cable may be pulled over, must be
protected. Pulling eyes and cable racking must be added to all manholes.
iv. Installers must use breakaway swivels set to a pulling tension 95% or less than the
manufacturer’s maximum rated pulling tension. When pulling multiple cables, only those
cables directly tied to the swivel must be added to capacity of the swivel.
v. When preparing to pull or lay cable, cable must not be placed or dragged upon the
ground. Tarps must be used to protect cable during preparation. Cables must not be
pulled through cable tray or trough.
vi. A 15 m service loop must be placed in manholes approximately every 300 m and at each
cable end.
vii. Cables must be labeled with cable ID at each cable end, in each pull box and in each
manhole.
viii. Cable must not be spliced in manholes. If a splice is required, a pad or pole mounted
cabinet must be installed with a minimum of 150 mm above ground level or flood level,
whichever is higher.
ix. All outside plant cables must be terminated within 15 m of the building entrance.
x. Fibres must not be field terminated. Only factory polished pigtails must be used to
terminate fibres.
xi. Fibres must be terminated with Telcordia compliant SC connectors in panels not
exceeding 72 fibres in a single panel.
8.8.4.3.3 Testing
Cable must be tested at least three times: first at the manufacturer’s facility prior to shipment;
second after receipt by contractor or agency prior to installation; and third after installation.
Tests must include the following:
i. Grading of all terminations by TIA/EIA-455-57B.
ii. End-to-end bi-directional power meter test at 1310 and 1550 nm for single mode fibre.
iii. Bi-directional OTDR test at 1310 and 1550 nm for single mode fibre.
iv. Optical Spectrum Analysis
a. Range: 1250-1650 nm.
b. Resolution: +/- 0.033 nm.
c. Accuracy: +/- 0.015 nm.
d. Power accuracy: 0.4 dB.
v. Chromatic Dispersion Analysis
vi. Range 1250 – 1650 nm.
a. Wavelength accuracy: 0.1 nm.
b. Dispersion accuracy: 1.6 ps/nm.
vii. Polarization Mode Dispersion Analysis both 1st and 2nd order
a. Range: 0 – 115 ps
b. Accuracy: +/- (0.020 +/- 2 % of PMD)
viii. Calculation of the following:
a. Span Loss (total loss of span from patch panel to patch panel)
b. Optical Loss margin defined as the additional loss that can be added to a fibre optic
span without adding additional bit errors or packet loss to any given circuit on the
optical MUX
c. Return Loss (as measured from a matching connector)
d. Splice Loss
e. Termination Loss
f. Physical distance to all fibre features correlated with actual track positioning
8.8.5 Station/Facilities
The cabling requirements for stations and facilities must differ in the following ways:
i. No hydroscopic gel must be used. If cables are known to be placed in a wet location,
additional protection must be obtained with water absorbing polymer tape.
ii. Fibre cables may utilize a tight-buffer configuration as well as loose tube.
iii. Cables installed in stations/facilities, intended for personnel or public use, must comply
with the following Toxicity Requirements (Boeing Specification Support Standard BBS-
7239):
a. Carbon Monoxide (CO) < 3500 ppm
b. Carbon Dioxide (CO2) < 90000 ppm
c. Hydrogen Fluoride (HF) < 200 ppm
d. Nitrogen Dioxide (NO2) < 100 ppm
e. Hydrogen Chloride (HCl) < 500 ppm
f. Hydrogen Cyanide (HCN) < 150 ppm
g. Sulfur Dioxide (SO2) < 100 ppm
h. Hydrogen Bromide (HBr) < 100 ppm
iv. Cable must be labeled, at each transition point, every 15 m, and at each end.
v. ISP fibre cables must be physically separated for protection.
vi. PA cables must be routed in a separate conduit system or shielded to prevent inductive
coupling and the introduction of noise into the PA system.
Cables placed in trays must be neatly placed with the maximum distance placed between
cables known to cause interference or inductive coupling. Diagram 8.7 below, Preferred
Cable Layout in Cable Tray, is an example of this application. Cable ties or lacing must be
used to hold cables in place.
8.10.1 General
There is an extensive array of electronic and computer equipment manufactured and supplied
by a variety of firms located in the ETS Control Centre.
Prior to commencing detailed design, the accuracy of the following information should be
confirmed with the ETS LRT Communications group.
i. Meridian 1 telephone handsets or current equivalent: Supplier Telus Communications,
Edmonton
ii. Programming of telephones: Telus Communications, Edmonton
iii. CCTV equipment, including monitors, keyboards, recording equipment: Chermik
Communications and Convergint Technologies
iv. CBTC equipment, including workstations, software, and display panel systems: Thales
v. BMS equipment, including workstations, software, and printers: ESC Automation,
Edmonton
vi. City of Edmonton corporate network workstations, including software and printers: City of
Edmonton IT Branch
vii. Radio system workstations, including software and printers: HARRIS
viii. SCADA workstations, including software and printers: EPCOR, Edmonton
ix. Fare equipment workstations, including software and printers: CUBIC, San Diego, CA
x. Key Systems Inc. – New York (Best Access Calgary is the closest local representative)
Due to the complex nature of, or the importance of certain systems, such as the CTC system
and the fare equipment system, LRT staff may direct and manage the purchase of the
equipment and software. Close consultation with the LRT staff is required early in the design
stage to ensure that the expected outcomes are achieved.
8.10.4 Security
All ETS servers and device must be hardened to ensure the strictest levels of security and
best practices for each particular operating system.
ETS uses a centralized secure network to allow communications to pass from internal
networks to external networks. Any passing of traffic from internal to external must be via
proxy through this Demilitarized Zone (DMZ). Direct connections from external networks to
internal networks is not allowed. These standards are maintained as per ISA 99 and APTA
communications standards.
In addition, the general principal of having ready management workstations always on inside
the ETS network and using remote desktop protocols to remotely control them is the only way
to maintain any devices. Contractor laptops or computer devices that are used outside of the
network cannot be directly connected to the ETS network environment.
8.10.8 Software
Software is a major and integral part of proper and good operations of communications. ETS
LRT Communications has standardized on the following software for overall operation and
deployment efficiency.
i. Operating Systems
a. Linux: Red Hat Enterprise Linux (RHEL) 7.3 64-bit or later
b. Windows: Microsoft Windows 2012R2 64-bit or later
c. Hypervisors: Red Hat Enterprise Virtualization (RHEV) 3 64-bit or later
d. Cloud Environment: Red Hat OpenStack (RHOS) 10 64-bit or later
No other software versions maybe substituted or replaced without the express approval,
in writing, from ETS LRT Communications.
ii. Virtualized Networking
a. Virtual Switches: Openvswitch 2.6.1 or later and Nuage Networks virtual platform
No other virtual switching maybe substituted or replaced without the express approval, in
writing, from ETS LRT Communications.
iii. Applications: All vendors must supply a 64bit based application. Applications must be the
latest, stable 64bit version if supplied by a third party software company. Third party
software vendor examples are Red Hat or Microsoft.
given how hot or cold it is outside, which in turn could trigger an updated train run schedule
and target TVM Maintenance teams to efficiently to refresh blank tickets in TVMs.
Hortonworks Data Platform (HDP) is a standardized suite such as Hadoop, Spark amongst
other tools, which allow for distribute processing of data whilst making the data available to
end users. Hortonworks Data Flow (HDF) allows for data to be imported into HDP from a
variety of sources.
Tableau Server is a business intelligence and analytics end user system, which allows
personnel to easily and efficiently, connect to HDP so to visualize and understand the data
being operated on.
Logs from systems are the single most important source of information about the health of the
system. When the systems are not working as desired this is the first place to look to
understand what maybe wrong with the system. ETS LRT Communications has employed
standard syslog to standardize and unify log management.
i. Observium must also be configured to be the syslog server and parse the logs.
ii. On Linux systems syslog must be pointed to Observium as the syslog server. All
application logs must be written to syslog.
iii. On Windows systems Datagram’s Syslog Agent must be installed and logs pointed to
Observium as the syslog server. All Windows Event Logs and logs from applications that
don’t leverage Windows Event Logs must be configured in the agent.
iv. All logs from the Observium syslog server must be exported to HDP using HDF.
with the security system and receives (using a dry contact) notification from the security
system if a security breach has occurred.
LRT Stations, TPSS, the LRT Maintenance Facility, LRT trackswitch/snow blower control
system, underground tunnels and pedways on the Edmonton LRT System are provided with
various building heating, ventilating, air conditioning, plumbing, electrical, security and fire
alarm systems which are all controlled and/or monitored by the BMS. Dedicated controllers
within each facility or building perform all of the control and monitoring functions for the
various building systems. They are remotely monitored using central operator work stations at
the ETS Control Centre.
The content of this section includes: industry standard Building Management System
abbreviations, definitions and nomenclature, a brief overview of the existing Building
Management System and its major components, as well as, the guidelines that will govern the
design of future expansion of the system.
Network switches are provided at each facility to allow for the interconnection of the individual
facility network into the Main Network. These switches are part of the shared core network
that runs all communications systems.
8.12.3.2 Facility Network
Each Station, TPSS building and the D.L. MacDonald LRT Maintenance Facility has its own
access layer switches that branch out to all locations that contain BMS controllers.
The networks within each facility, consists mainly of copper network cabling, except where
conventional copper network cabling (Cat 6) distances are exceeded. Where copper network
cabling distances are exceeded, fibre optic network cabling is utilized. Industrially hardened
Ethernet switches with optical fibre small form-factor pluggable (SFP) transceivers are to be
used to gather copper based signals for transmission over fibre to the main station network
switch.
Signal amplifying devices are not to be used to overcome cabling distance limitations of
copper type network cable. Individual fibre media converters are to be avoided unless
approved by ETS staff. All copper runs must also conform to BICSI/TIA standards for
installation as with any Cat 6 installation described in this document.
8.12.3.3 ETS Control Centre
Monitoring is conducted on a 24/7 basis from the ETS Control Centre (refer to Section 8.6 for
the Control Centre Facility Design Requirements).
The web page access to the main alarm system is accomplished via a shared ETS
workstation in the control room. Separate workstations are no longer used to accomplish
monitoring of the BMS system.
power supply for all local control panels. Individual or, central UPS power supplies, for the
secondary power system to the local control panels must be provided.
8.12.5.5 Expansion Capabilities
Stand-alone controllers must accommodate 25% spare input and 25% spare output point
capability for future input / output additions. Spare point capacity, through the future addition
of input / output expansion boards, is acceptable.
8.12.5.6 Local, Facility and Remote Operator Work Stations
OWS’s, connected to the facility network, are required where control or monitoring functions
are provided in the facility.
Maintenance monitoring for LRT Stations is done by the AM&PW Buildings and Facilities
Maintenance Section by connecting remotely to the BMS system through a VPN connection.
To support operations and maintenance activities, a dedicated remote desktop connection to
an OWS running on the BMS network is provided.
8.12.8 Training
Training must be provided to ETS staff for all new facilities and their related systems, including
the expansion of the existing system. BMS training will be limited to BMS architecture for any
new station and the control sequence strategies for new equipment.
8.12.9 Documentation
Documentation must include loop drawings.
8.13 CCTV
The CCTV system allows operations personnel and Controllers to remotely monitor and
record activities at all LRT stations and other designated locations.
This section presents the guidelines and criteria to be used in the design of the Closed Circuit
Television System for future LRT extensions, along with an overview of the existing system
and related components.
8.13.4 Architecture
The CCTV system is currently comprised of both legacy systems, which are in the process of
being upgraded, and the current standard Video Management System, Genetec Security
Center (v5.4/SR3/CU1 at time of writing). All system additions or modifications are to be done
as expansion of the Genetec Security Center architecture; no alternate video systems or
platforms are to be introduced.
The Genetec Security Center (GSC) system is constructed based on a “Failover / Redundant
Centralized” system model. The GSC system is comprised of a fully redundant Directory set,
the primary Management servers for the USP system, along with a number of Archivers
(Video recording servers) configured for redundant recording. These servers, which are all
virtual, are hosted on physical stacks located within 2 server rooms, one located at the DLM
site and the other at USR. In addition, there are several sites with on-site recording servers
(Archivers) due to limited WAN bandwidth availability at the time of their deployment; these
will be migrated to the centralized storage servers once the WAN bandwidth is increased.
Cameras, encoders, Input / Output Modules (Alarm Units), and Client Workstations located
throughout ETS facilities are all connected to the “CCTV” network via local switches
connected to the ETS Fibre network backbone. This network is used to connect all field
devices with the Genetec Servers (Directories and Archivers) for transport of video and other
data.
In addition to the Genetec Security Center VMS, ETS utilizes a centralized device
management platform for all CCTV field devices, such as cameras, encoders & Input / Output
Modules. This software allows an interface through which device status can be verified,
firmware updates can be applied and global programming configuration changes can be
deployed. This management software is provided by the hardware manufacturer and does not
allow for devices from disparate manufacturers. ETS has standardized on the use of Axis
Communications for all cameras, video encoders and input / output modules.
8.13.4.1 Video Encoders/Alarm Interface Units (for use with Analog Cameras)
The future expansion of the CCTV system will be interfaced to a centrally located enterprise
network switch. The enterprise switch connects to PC based NVR’s and video workstations.
In order to migrate from the legacy analogue CCTV systems which were in place to the
Genetec Security Center VMS, ETS has employed the use of Analogue Video Encoders.
These encoders receive analogue video signals and digitize them, converting them to IP video
streams which can then be handled by the VMS. Current specifications (as of August 2016)
are based on Axis Q74XX Series of encoders.
Any new camera deployment or system expansion will be done utilizing IP cameras. Video
Encoders are to be used only in the event that a site containing pre-existing analogue
cameras is to be added to the USP system.
Network Input / Output Audio Modules (aka Alarm Units), are used to provide an interface
between external dry contact “alarm points” and the USP system. No Alarm-point connections
are to be physically made directly to cameras or encoders, these must be connected to
Network I/Output Audio Module devices. Current specifications (as of August 2016) are based
on the Axis P8221.
8.13.4.1.1 Modular Video Encoders (Self-Contained)
Additional encoders must be capable of network connection and communication providing for
peer to peer communication. These modular encoders shall:
i. Be manufactured with an all metal casing
ii. Be equipped with a 100Base-T or 1000BASE-T (Gigabit) Ethernet interface
iii. Be equipped with either 1 or 4 analogue composite video inputs
iv. For each channel provide at least 3 streams of resolutions up to 720x480 (NTSC) pixels
at 30 frames per second per stream (up to 60 frames per second on single-channel
encoders)
v. Support simultaneous individually configured Motion JPEG and H.264 video streams for
each channel
vi. Support both unicast and multicast H.264 with support for both Constant and Variable Bit
Rate
vii. Include de-interlacing functionality
viii. For each channel accept static IP addresses as well as addresses provided by a DHCP
ix. Support both IPv4 and IPv6 based addresses
x. Be equipped with RS422/485 ports per video channel providing the ability to control third
part PTZ and dome cameras with support for guard tour and at least 100 presets
xi. Provide the ability to control PTZ devices from third party manufacturer using either RS-
422/RS-485 or up-the-coax control. (Up-the-coax on single-channel encoder only)
xii. Provide multiple user password levels, support for HTTPS and SSL/TLS and incorporate
IEEE 802.1X authentication for each channel
xiii. Include embedded event functionality, which may be triggered by:
a. alarm input
b. video loss
c. video motion detection
d. camera tampering
xiv. Event actions supported by the encoder shall include remote notification, including video
upload
xv. Be equipped with a built-in web server for each channel
xvi. Be supported by an open and published API
8.13.4.1.2 Chassis-mount Video Encoders Blades
Chassis-mount encoder blades shall:
i. Meet the following standards:
a. IEEE 802.1X (Authentication)
v. The Remote Task shall allow the connection to other workstations using a spy mode to
remain invisible to the remotely connected workstation.
vi. The functionality provided by the remote monitoring and control capability shall include:
a. Remote monitoring and control of the monitoring and alarm monitoring tasks.
b. Ability to remotely switch cameras, doors and zones into display tiles.
c. Ability to remotely control live and playback video.
d. Ability to remotely change the tile pattern.
e. Ability to remotely create and delete tasks.
f. Ability to remotely start/stop task cycling.
g. Ability to remotely go into full screen mode.
h. Ability to remotely save and reload the workspace.
8.13.4.2.3 Health Monitoring
i. The USP shall monitor the health of the system, log health-related events, and calculate
statistics.
ii. USP services, roles, agents, units, and client apps will trigger health events.
iii. The USP shall populate the Windows Event Log with health events related to USP roles,
services, and client apps.
iv. A dedicated role, the Health Monitoring Role, shall perform the following actions:
a. Monitor the health of the entire system and log events.
b. Calculate statistics within a specified time frame (hours, days, months).
c. Calculate availability for clients, servers, and video/access/ALPR units.
v. A Health Monitoring task and Health History reporting task shall be available for live and
historical reporting.
vi. A web-based, centralized health dashboard shall be available to remotely view unit and
role health events of the USP.
vii. Detailed system care statistics will be available through a web-based dashboard
providing health metrics of USP entities and roles, including Uptime and mean-time-
between-failures.
viii. Health events shall be accessible via the SDK (can be used to create SNMP traps).
v. When enabled, Active Directory shall manage user logon to the USP client applications
through the user’s Windows credentials. Logging to the USP shall utilize native Active
Directory password management and authentication features.
vi. It shall be possible to synchronize the following USP entities and their information from
Active Directory with the USP:
a. Users (username, first and last names, email address, and more).
b. User groups (user group name, description, and group email address).
c. Active Directory attributes to USP custom fields.
vii. When enabled, the addition, removal, or suspension of a user’s Windows account in
Active Directory shall result in the creation, deletion, or disabling of the equivalent user
account in the USP.
viii. Supported synchronization methods for additions, modification, and deletions of
synchronized entities shall include: on first logon (users only), manual synchronization,
and scheduled synchronization.
ix. The USP shall support user connections across independent organizations by connecting
to an external ADFS (Active Directory Federation Services) service using claims-based
authentication.
8.13.4.2.6 Zone Management
i. The USP shall support the configuration and management of zones for input point
monitoring via the Zone Manager Role. A user shall be able to add, delete, or modify a
zone if he or she has the appropriate privileges.
ii. A zone shall monitor the status of one or more inputs points. Zone monitoring or input
point monitoring shall be possible through the use of a controller and one or more input
modules. Inputs from video cameras or video encoders shall also be accessible via a
zone.
iii. Depending on the hardware installed, supervised inputs shall be supported. Depending
on the input module used, both 3-state and 4-state supervision shall be available.
iv. A schedule shall be defined for a zone indicating when the zone will be monitored.
v. Custom Events shall provide full flexibility in creating custom events tailored to a zone.
Users shall be able to associate custom events to state changes in monitored inputs.
vi. The ACS shall support one or more cameras per zone. Video shall then be associated to
zone state changes.
vii. Input / Output (IO) Linking:
a. Zone management shall support Input / Output (IO) Linking. IO Linking shall allow
one or more inputs to trigger one or more outputs.
b. IO Linking shall be available in offline mode when communication between the
server and hardware is not available.
c. Custom Output Behaviors shall provide full flexibility in creating a variety of complex
output signal patterns: simple pulses, periodic pulses, variable duty-cycle pulses,
and state changes.
d. Through the “trigger an output” action, the ACS shall support the triggering of
outputs with custom output behaviors
8.13.4.2.7 User and User Group Security, Partitions and Privileges Management
i. The USP shall support the configuration and management of users and user groups. A
user shall be able to add, delete, or modify a user or user group if he or she has the
appropriate privileges.
ii. The USP shall support user authentication with claims-based authentication using
external providers. External providers shall include:
a. ADFS (Active Directory Federation Services)
b. Common access rights and privileges shared by multiple users shall be defined as
User Groups. Individual group members shall inherit the rights and privileges from
their parent user groups. User group nesting shall be allowed.
iii. User privileges shall be extensive in the USP. All configurable entities for the USP,
including access control/video/ALPR, shall have associated privileges.
iv. Specific entities, such as cardholders, cardholder groups, and credentials shall include a
more granular set of privileges, such as the right to access custom fields and change the
activation or profile status of an entity.
v. Partitions:
a. The USP shall limit what users can view in the configuration database via security
partitions (database segments). The administrator, who has all rights and privileges,
shall be allowed to segment a system into multiple security partitions.
b. All entities that are part of the USP can be assigned to one or more partitions.
c. A user who is given access to a specific partition shall only be able to view entities
(components) within the partition to which he or she has been assigned. Access is
given by assigning the user as an accepted user to view the entities that are
members of a particular partition.
d. A user or user group can be assigned administrator rights over the partition.
vi. It shall be possible to specify user and user group privileges on a per partition basis.
vii. Advanced logon options shall be available such as dual logon and more.
viii. It shall be possible to specify an inactive period for the Monitoring UI after which time the
application shall automatically lock, while still preserving access to currently displayed
camera feeds.
xi. The DGM shall provide the ability to the operator to manage layers of entities display
over the map, being able to turn them on and off and changing the superposition order.
xii. The DGM shall offer built-in map data backup and restore for both map background and
layers of entities.
xiii. The DGM shall offer failover capabilities.
xiv. The DGM shall scale up to several thousands of entities on a single map and hundreds of
maps.
xv. The DGM shall provide a means to update a map background without affecting the map
object configuration.
xvi. The DGM shall offer a user friendly graphical map designer to configure the maps.
xvii. The DGM shall provide a user friendly and intuitive navigation that includes:
a. The ability to create hierarchies of maps to facilitate navigation within and between
various sites and buildings.
b. The ability to define favorites for recurrent position recall.
c. The possibility to create links between maps. The map links shall allow the link from
one map to multiple map representing the floors of a building.
d. A common user experience regarding navigation into the map for both GIS or private
maps.
e. A history log of positions.
xviii. It shall be possible to monitor the state of entities on the map. It shall be possible to
customize the icon of any entities represented on the map.
xix. The DGM shall display the actual video Field of View of camera. It shall be possible to
configure the FOV of a camera by entering the specification of the camera installation or
graphically by moving the boundaries of the Field of View.
xx. For PTZ cameras offering position feedback capability, the DGM shall:
a. Dynamically represent the accurate Field of View of the camera.
b. Allow the user to act on the PTZ by moving its field of view.
xxi. The DGM shall offer the ability to optionally set a graphical display notification of the
motion detection
xxii. The DGM shall offer a smart selection tool to access the video simply by clicking the
location the user wants to see, the DGM will automatically select the cameras that can
see this location and move the PTZ towards that location. This smart selection tool shall
take into consideration the obstacle and not display cameras that cannot see the location
because of a wall.
xxiii. It shall be possible to select a location by drawing a zone of interest on the DGM and
display all the entities that are part of that zone of interest at once.
xxiv. The user shall be able to select and display the content of multiple USP entities on the
map in popup windows.
xxv. It shall be possible to access live and playback video from the map.
xxvi. It shall be possible to monitor from the DGM all entities event notification. User shall be
able to turn on and off the notification per entity.
xxvii. The DGM shall offer the ability to fully operate alarm monitoring. It shall be possible
to:
a. Center the map on entities related to the alarm.
b. Visualize the Alarms notification on the map access the related video from the map
c. Trigger and receive alarms.
d. Act on the alarm from the DGM, including acknowledgements, forwarding, and
investigation.
e. Visualize that an alarm occurred in an underlying linked map.
xxviii. The DGM shall provide the following search capabilities:
a. Search and center by entity name.
b. From the Display of an entity in the USP locate the entity on the map and offer the
ability to select another one close-by.
xxix. Any update of map content by an administrator shall be immediately and dynamically
pushed to all DGM users.
c. DVTel.
d. GE ImpactNet.
e. Panasonic, Pelco ASCII, Pelco KBD-300, and Pelco P.
f. Radionics.
g. Samsung SSC-1000.
h. Videolarm.
xiii. The USP shall support the following list of joysticks and control keyboards:
a. Axis 295.
b. Axis T8310 Video Surveillance Control Board.
c. Panasonic WV-CU950 Ethernet keyboard.
d. Any USB joystick detected as a Windows Game Controller.
xiv. The USP shall allow for the configuration of a time zone for each camera connected to a
DVS. For playback review, users shall have the ability to search for video based on the
following options:
a. Local time of the camera.
b. Local time of the SSM.
c. Local time of the user’s workstation.
d. GMT Time.
e. Other time zone.
xv. Audio and Video storage configuration for the SSM shall either be:
a. Internal or external IDE/SATA/SAS organized or not in a RAID configuration;
b. Internal or external SCSI/iSCSI/Fibre Channel organized or not in a RAID
configuration;
c. Within the overall storage system, it shall be possible to include disks located on:
1. External PCs on a LAN or WAN.
2. Network Attached Servers (NAS) on a LAN or WAN.
3. Storage Area Networks (SAN).
xvi. The SSM shall not limit the actual storage capacity configured per server.
8.13.4.3.2 Configuration UI
i. The Configuration UI shall allow the administrator or users with appropriate privileges to
change video configuration.
ii. The Configuration UI shall provide the ability to change video quality, bandwidth, and
frame rate parameters on a per camera (stream) basis for both live and recorded video.
iii. The Configuration UI shall provide the ability to change video quality by a selection of
predefined video quality template.
iv. The Configuration UI shall provide the ability to configure brightness, contrast, and hue
settings for each camera on the same DVS.
v. The Configuration UI shall provide the capability to enable audio recording on DVS units
that support audio.
vi. The Configuration UI shall provide the ability to change the audio parameters, serial port
and I/O configuration of individual DVS units.
vii. The Configuration UI shall provide the capability to rename all DVS units based on
system topology and to add descriptive information to each DVS.
viii. The Configuration UI shall provide the ability to set recording schedules and modes for
each individual camera. The recording mode can be:
a. Continuous.
b. On motion and Manual.
c. Manual only.
d. Disabled.
ix. The Configuration UI shall support the creation of schedules to which any of the following
functional aspects can be attached:
a. Video quality (for each video stream per camera).
b. Recording (for each camera).
c. Motion detection (for each detection zone per camera).
d. Brightness, Contrast, and Hue (for each camera).
e. Camera sequence execution.
x. The Configuration UI shall support the creation of unlimited recording schedules and the
assigning of any camera to any schedule.
xi. The Configuration UI shall detect and warn user of any conflict within assigned
schedules.
xii. The Configuration UI shall provide the capability to set a PTZ protocol to a specific DVS
serial port and shall allow mixing domes of various manufacturers within a system.
xiii. User shall have the ability to configure a return to home function after a predefined period
of inactivity for PTZ cameras. This period of inactivity time shall be configurable from 1 to
7200 seconds.
8.13.4.3.3 Archiving
i. The Archiver (role) shall use an event and timestamp database for the advanced search
of audio/video archives. This database shall use Microsoft SQL.
ii. The Archiver shall protect archived audio/video files and the system database against
network access and non-administrative user access.
iii. The Archiver shall digitally sign recorded video using 248-bit RSA public/private key
cryptography.
iv. The Archiver shall offer a plug and play type hardware discovery service with the
following functionalities:
a. Automatically discover DVS units as they are attached to the network.
b. Discover DVS units on different network segments, including the Internet, and
across routers with or without network address translation (NAT) capabilities.
v. The Archiver shall have the capacity to configure the key frame interval (I-frame) in
seconds or number of frames.
vi. The Archiver shall provide a pre-alarm and post-alarm recording option that can be set
between one second and 5 minutes on a per camera basis.
vii. The Archiver shall provide the functionality of storing of video and audio streams based
on triggering events, such as:
a. Digital motion detection.
b. Digital input activation.
c. Macros.
d. Through SDK application recording.
viii. The Archiver shall perform video motion detection on each individual camera based on a
grid of 1320 motion detection blocks. All of the video motion detection settings are
configurable on schedule. A global sensitivity threshold is available to reduce motion
detection sensitivity when the video signal is noisy or when a lot of false hits are incurred.
Video motion detection itself can be set into four different modes:
a. Full Screen: All 1320 blocks on screen are activated, and a general threshold for the
overall motion in the entire image can be set and, when it is reached, it can trigger
recording and a motion event or a custom event.
b. Full Screen Unit: This is the same as the Full Screen, but the motion detection takes
place in the DVS.
c. Detection Zone: Six overlapping zones can be defined in the 1320 blocks on screen
with each of these zones having its own threshold, and, when that threshold is
reached, each one of them can trigger recording and a motion event or a custom
event. Each zone triggering its own event allows for the configuration of directional
motion detection events and other complex motion detection logic.
d. Detection Zone Unit: This is the same as the Detection Zone, but the motion
detection takes place in the DVS and only one zone is supported.
e. Disabled: No motion detection is performed on this camera.
ix. The Archiver shall be able to detect motion in video within 200 milliseconds and not only
on key frames.
x. The Archiver shall allow for multiple recording schedules to be assigned to a single
camera. Each schedule shall be created with the following parameters:
a. Recording mode:
1. Continuous.
2. On Motion/Manual.
3. Manual.
4. Disabled.
b. Recurrence pattern:
1. Once on specific days.
2. Specific days on a yearly basis.
3. Specific days on a monthly basis.
4. Specific days on a weekly basis.
5. Daily.
xi. Time coverage:
a. All day.
b. Specific time range(s).
c. Daytime or nighttime based on the times of sunrise and sunset that are
automatically calculated from the time of year and a geographical location.
Provision shall be given to offset the calculated sunrise or sunset time by plus or
minus 3 hours.
xii. The Archiver shall allow each camera (video source) to be encoded multiple times in the
same or different video formats (MJPEG, H.264, H.265), limited only by the capabilities of
each DVS.
xiii. Whenever multiple video streams are available from the same camera, users shall be
free to use any one of them based on their assigned usage. The standard video stream
usages are:
a. Live.
b. Recording.
c. Remote.
d. Low resolution.
e. High resolution.
xiv. The Archiver shall allow the video quality to vary according to predefined schedules.
Such schedules shall have the same configuration flexibility as the recording schedules
mentioned earlier. The video quality shall be based on, but not limited to, the following
parameters:
a. Maximum bit rate.
b. Maximum frame rate.
c. Image quality.
d. Key frame interval.
xv. The Archiver shall have the ability to dynamically boost the quality of the "recording
stream" (see previous bullet) based on specific events:
a. When recording is started manually by a user.
b. When recording is triggered by a macro, an alarm or detected motion.
xvi. The Archiver shall have the capacity to communicate with the DVS using 128 bits SSL
encryption.
xvii. The Archiver shall have the capacity to communicate with the DVS using HTTPS secure
protocol.
xviii. The Archiver shall have the capacity to receive multicast UDP streams directly from the
DVS.
xix. For network topologies that restrict the DVS from sending multicast UDP streams, the
Archiver shall redirect audio/video streams to active viewing clients on the network using
multicast UDP.
xx. The Archiver shall have the capacity to redirect audio/video streams to active viewing
clients on the network using unicast UDP or TCP.
xxi. The Archiver shall empower the administrator with a full range of disk management
options:
a. The Archiver shall allow the administrator to choose which disks to use for archiving
and to set a maximum quota for each.
b. The Archiver shall allow the administrator to spread the archiving of different
cameras on different disk groups (groups of disks controlled by the same controller)
so that archiving could be carried out in parallel on multiple disks.
xxii. The Archiver shall have the capacity to move video archives to the Azure Cloud. The
archives will be moved after a preset number of days.
xxiii. The Archiver shall offer the following options to clean up old archives, on a camera by
camera basis:
a. After a preset number of days.
b. Deleting oldest archives first when disks run out of space.
c. Stop archiving when disks are full.
xxiv. The Archiver shall allow important video sequences to be protected against normal disk
cleanup routines.
xxv. Users shall have the following options when protecting a video sequence:
a. Until a specified date.
b. For a specified number of days.
c. Indefinitely (until the protection is explicitly removed).
xxvi. The Archiver shall allow the administrator to put a cap on the percentage of storage
space occupied by protected video.
xxvii. The Archiver shall keep a log and compile statistics on disk space usage.
xxviii. The statistics shall be available by disk group or for the whole Archiver.
xxix. The statistics shall show the percentage of protected video over the total used disk
space.
xxx. The Archiver shall have the capacity to down-sample video streams for storage saving
purposes. The down-sampling options available are the following:
a. For H.264, MPEG-4, H.265, streams the down-sampling options are: all key frames,
1 fps, 2 sec/frame, 5 sec/frame, 10 sec/frame, 15 sec/frame, 30 sec/frame. 60
sec/frame 120 sec/frame.
b. For MJPEG streams the down-sampling options are: 15 fps, 10 fps, 5 fps, 2 fps, 1
fps, 2 sec/frame, 5 sec/frame, 10 sec/frame, 15 sec/frame, 30 sec/frame, 60
sec/frame 120 sec/frame.
xxxi. The Archiver shall support DVS with edge recording capabilities and offer the following
capacities:
a. The ability to playback the video recorded on the DVS at different speeds.
b. The ability to offload (video trickling) the video recorded on the DVS on schedule, on
event, or manually to store it on the Archiver.
c. It shall be possible to filter the video that is being offloaded using one or multiple of
the following filters:
1. Time interval.
2. Playback request.
3. Video analytic events.
4. Motion events.
5. Bookmarks.
6. Alarms.
7. Input pin events.
8. Unit offline events.
xxxii. The Archiver shall be provided with proven performance and scalability figures:
a. The Archiver’s performance shall be guaranteed during the rebuild of a disk from a
raid 5 disk group. The rebuild process shall not affect the recording and playback
capabilities.
b. The recommended server specification from the Genetec Security Center Hardware
Requirement shall allow Archiver to perform up to 300 cameras or 300Mbs
throughput first limit reached.
c. The high-performance archiver specification from the Genetec Security Center
Hardware Requirement shall allow Archiver to perform:
1. Up to 500 cameras or 500Mbs throughput first limit reached with a 1Gbs NIC.
2. Up to 700 cameras or 1300Mbs throughput first limit reached with a 10Gbs
NIC.
xxxiii. The Archiver shall provide the ability to encrypt the media stream coming from the
DVS including the video, audio and metadata.
a. Media encryption shall be optional and can be activated on a per DVS basis.
b. Media encryption shall be performed with AES-128.
c. Media encryption shall encrypt all video, audio and metadata at rest and in transit.
Once media encryption is turned on for a DVS all media stored or redirected by the
Archiver shall be encrypted and shall require the private key to be decoded.
d. It shall be possible to export the encrypted media into a non-encrypted ASF file.
8.13.4.3.4 Standby / Redundant Archiver
i. The Standby Archiver shall act as a replacement Archiver role on hot standby, ready to
take over the functions of the primary Archiver role. The failover will occur in less than 1
minute. No action from the user will be required.
ii. The Standby Archiver assigned to an Archiver role entity shall automatically provide
protection for all DVS connected to that Archiver role.
iii. The Standby Archiver shall protect the primary Archiver role against the following failures:
a. Server failure (hardware or software)
b. Storage failure, such as Archiver Role detects that it cannot read or write to any of
its allocated disks.
iv. Each Archiver role shall have priority value if multiple Archiver Roles fail at the same time
on the same standby server.
v. It shall be possible for any Archiver role in the system to be designated as another's
standby and vice-versa.
vi. The Standby Archiver shall have the ability to act as a Redundant Archiver.
vii. The Redundant Archiver shall maintain an exact copy of everything recorded by the
default Archiver, i.e. audio/video archives, events, and bookmarks.
viii. Redundancy shall be configured on a camera by camera basis.
ix. The Redundant Archiver shall have to ability to use a multicast video stream from the
DVS and shall not require an additional connection to any DVS.
8.13.4.3.5 Media Streaming
i. The Media Router Role shall be responsible for routing video and audio streams across
local and wide area networks from the source (e.g. DVS) to the destination (e.g. CSA).
ii. The Media Router Role shall support multiple transport protocols, such as unicast TCP,
unicast UDP, and multicast UDP.
iii. The Media Router shall support IGMP (Internet Group Management Protocol) to establish
multicast group memberships:
iv. IGMP v3, including SSM (Source-Specific Multicast) shall be supported.
v. The Media Router Role using Redirector Agents shall be responsible for redirecting a
stream from a source IP endpoint to a destination IP endpoint.
a. The Redirector Agents shall be capable of converting a stream from and to any
supported transport protocols:
b. Multicast UDP to Unicast TCP.
c. Multicast UDP to Unicast UDP.
d. Unicast TCP to Multicast UDP.
e. Unicast UDP to Multicast UDP.
vi. It shall be possible to limit the number of concurrent live and playback video redirections
for each Redirector Agent in order to better control the bandwidth across multiple sites.
vii. It shall be possible to protect the Media Router Role against hardware or software
unavailability by configuring another Media Router Role to act as a hot standby server.
viii. Multiple Redirector Agents shall be used on a large USP installation to increase the
service availability and to provide automatic load balancing.
v. The USP shall offer an interface for displaying all video archive transfer requests. This
interface shall display all the current, requested and scheduled video transfer requests. It
shall be possible to edit, trigger, and cancel video archive transfers from this interface.
8.13.4.4 Client Software Applications (CSA)
8.13.4.4.1 Overview
i. The Client Software Applications (CSA) shall provide the user interface for USP
configuration and monitoring over any network and be accessible locally or from a remote
connection.
ii. The CSA shall consist of the Configuration UI for system configuration and the Monitoring
UI for monitoring. The CSA shall be Windows-based and provide an easy-to-use
graphical user interface (UI).
iii. The Server Administrator shall be used to configure the server database(s). It shall be
web-based and accessible locally on the SSM or across the network.
iv. The CSA shall seamlessly merge access control, automatic license plate recognition
(ALPR), and video functionalities within the same user application.
v. The USP shall use the latest user interface (UI) development and programming
technologies, such as Microsoft WPF (Windows Presentation Foundation), the XAML
markup language, and the .NET software framework.
vi. All applications shall provide an authentication mechanism, which verifies the validity of
the user. As such, the administrator (who has all rights and privileges) can define
specific access rights and privileges for each user in the system.
vii. Logging on to a CSA shall be done either through locally stored USP user accounts and
passwords or using the operator’s Windows credentials when Active Directory integration
is enabled.
viii. When integrated with Microsoft’s Active Directory, the CSA and USP shall authenticate
users using their Windows credentials. As a result, the USP will benefit from Active
Directory password authentication and strong security features.
ix. The CSA shall support multiple languages, including but not limited to the following:
English, French, Arabic, Czech, Dutch, German, Hebrew, Hungarian, Italian, Japanese,
Korean, Norwegian, Persian (Farsi), Polish, Portuguese (Brazilian), Simplified and
Traditional Chinese, Russian, Spanish, Swedish, Thai, Turkish and Vietnamese.
x. To enhance usability and operator efficiency, the Configuration UI and Monitoring UI shall
support many of the latest UI concepts, such as:
a. A customizable Home Page that includes favorite and recently used tasks.
b. Task-oriented approach for administrator/operator activities where each type of
activity (surveillance, visitor management, individual reports, and more) is an
operator task.
c. Consolidated and consistent workflows for video, ALPR, and access control.
d. Single click functionality for reporting and tracking. The Monitoring UI shall support
both single-click reporting for access control, ALPR, and video, as well as single-
click tracking of areas, cameras, doors, zones, cardholders, elevators, ALPR
entities, and more. Single-click reporting or tracking shall create a new task with the
selected entities to report on or track.
xi. Configuration UI and Monitoring UI Home Page and Tasks
a. The Configuration UI and Monitoring UI shall be task-oriented.
b. A task shall be user interface design patterns whose goal is to simplify the user
interface by grouping related features from different systems, such as video and
access, in the same display window. Features shall be grouped together in a task
based on their shared ability to help the user perform a specific task.
c. Tasks shall be accessible via the Home Page of either the Configuration or the
Surveillance CSA.
d. Newly created tasks shall be accessible via the Configuration UI or the Monitoring UI
taskbar.
e. Similar tasks shall be grouped into the following categories:
1. Operation: Access control management, LRP management, and more.
2. Investigation: Video bookmark/motion/archive reports, access control activity
reports, visitor activity reports, alarm reports, ALPR activity reports, and more.
3. Maintenance: Access control and video configuration reports, troubleshooters,
audit trails, health-related reports, and more.
f. An operator shall be able to launch a specific task only if he or she has the
appropriate privileges.
g. The Home Page content shall be customizable through the use of privileges to hide
tasks that an operator should not have access to and through a list of favorite and
recently used tasks. In addition, editing a USP XML file to add new tasks on the fly
shall also be possible.
g. Single click functionality for reporting and tracking. The Monitoring UI shall support
both single-click reporting for access control, ALPR, and video, as well as single-
click tracking of areas, cameras, doors, zones, cardholders, elevators, ALPR
entities, and more. Single-click reporting or tracking shall create a new task with the
selected entities to report on or to track.
iv. Monitoring UI Home Page and Tasks
a. Similar tasks shall be grouped into the following categories:
1. Operation: Access control/LRP/video surveillance, visitor management,
mustering, access control and video alarm monitoring, and more.
2. Investigation: Video bookmark/motion/archive reports, access control activity
reports, visitor activity reports, alarm reports, ALPR activity reports, and more.
3. Maintenance: Access control and video configuration reports, trouble-shooters,
audit trails, and more.
v. Dynamically Adaptive UI, Dashboard, and Widgets
a. The Monitoring UI shall dynamically adapt to what the operator is doing. This shall
be accomplished through the concept of widgets that are grouped in the Monitoring
UI dashboard.
b. Widgets shall be mini-applications or mini-groupings in the Monitoring UI dashboard
that let the operator perform common tasks and provide the operator with fast
access to information and actions.
c. With a single click on an entity (e.g. door or camera) the specific widgets associated
to that entity appear and other non-relevant widgets disappear dynamically
(instantly). Widgets shall bring the operator information such as door status and
camera stream information, as well as user actions, such as door unlock, PTZ
controls, and more.
d. Specific widgets include those for a door, camera, alarm, zone, display tile, video
stream (statistics), PTZ camera, and more.
vi. Operator Workflows
a. A workflow shall be a sequence of operations an operator or administrator shall
execute to complete an activity. The “flow” relates to a clearly defined timeline or
sequence for executing the activity.
b. The Monitoring UI shall be equipped with consistent workflows for the ALPR, video,
and access control systems that it unifies.
c. Generating or printing a report, setting up or acknowledging an alarm, or creating an
incident report shall follow the same process (workflow) whether the operator is
working with video, ALPR, or access control, or with both video and access control.
vii. Each task within the Monitoring UI shall consist of one or more of the following items:
a. Event list.
b. Logical tree. Doors, cameras, zones, ALPR units, and elevators shall be grouped
under Areas in a hierarchical fashion.
c. Entities list of all entities being tracked.
d. Display tiles with various patterns (1 x 1, 2 x 2, and more).
e. Display tile menu with various commands related to cameras, doors, PTZ, and tile
controls.
f. Dashboard with widgets.
viii. The Monitoring UI shall support multiple event lists and display tile patterns, including:
a. Event/alarm list layout only.
b. Display tile layout only.
c. Display tile and alarm/event list combination.
b. Support for live video monitoring on each and every display tile within a task in the
user’s workspace.
c. The USP shall support uninterrupted video streaming. The CSA shall keep existing
video connections active in the event that an SSM (except Archiver) becomes
unavailable.
d. The ability to drag and drop a camera into a display tile for live viewing.
e. The ability to drag and drop a camera into a display tile for live viewing on an
analogue monitor connected to an IP hardware decoder (converting an IP encoded
stream into an analogue video signal).
f. The ability to drag and drop a camera from a map into a display tile for live viewing.
g. Support for digital zoom on live camera video streams.
h. The ability for audio communication with video units with audio input and output.
i. The ability to control pan-tilt-zoom, iris, focus, and presets.
j. The ability to bookmark important events for later retrieval on any archiving camera
and to uniquely name each bookmark in order to facilitate future searches.
k. The ability to start/stop recording on any camera in the system that is configured to
allow manual recording by clicking on a single button.
l. The ability to activate or de-activate viewing of all system events as they occur.
m. The ability to switch to instant replay of the video for any archiving camera with the
simple click of button.
n. The ability to take snapshots of live video and be able to save or print the snapshots.
o. The ability to view the same camera multiple times in different tiles.
xiv. The video playback (archive playing) capabilities of the Monitoring UI shall include:
a. Support for audio and video playback for any time span.
b. Support for video playback on each and every display tile.
c. The ability to instantly replay the video for any archiving camera with the simple click
of a button.
d. The ability to select between instant synch of all video streams in playback mode,
allowing operators to view events from multiple angles or across several camera
fields, or non-synchronous playback.
e. The ability to simultaneously view the same camera in multiple tiles at different time
intervals.
f. The ability to control playback with:
1. Pause.
2. Lock Speed.
3. Forward and Reverse Playback at: 1x, 2x, 4x, 6x, 8x, 10x, 20x, 40x, 100x.
4. Forward and Reverse Playback frame by frame.
5. Slow Forward and Reverse Playback at: 1/8x, 1/4x, 1/3x, 1/2x.
6. Loop playback between two time markers.
g. The ability to display a single timeline or one timeline for each selected video
stream, which would allow the operator to navigate through the video sequence by
simply clicking on any point in the timeline.
h. The ability to display the level of motion at any point on a timeline.
i. The ability to clearly display bookmarked events on the timeline(s).
j. The ability to query archived video using various search criteria, including, but not
limited to, time, date, camera, and area.
k. The tool necessary for searching video and associated audio based on user-defined
events or motion parameters.
l. The ability to define an area of the video field in which to search for motion as well
as define the amount of motion that will trigger search results. The Monitoring UI
shall then retrieve all archived video streams that contain motion that meets the
search parameters. There shall be a graphical timeline on which the time of each
search hit shall be indicated.
m. The ability to browse through a list of all bookmarks created on the system and
select any bookmarked event for viewing.
n. The ability to add bookmarks to previously archived video for easier searching and
retrieval.
o. Support for digital zoom on playback video streams.
p. Still image export to PNG, JPEG, GIF, and BMP format with Date and Time stamp,
and Camera Name on the image (snapshot).
q. Tools for exporting video and a self-contained video player on various media such
as USB keys or CD/DVD-ROM. This video player shall be easy to use without
training and shall still support reviewing video metadata, such as bookmark, or
navigating the video with functions like panoramic camera view de-warping.
r. Tools for exporting video sequences in standard video formats, such as ASF.
s. The ability to encrypt exported video files.
t. The ability for an operator to load previously exported video files from their computer
or network.
u. The ability for queries to be saved upon closing the CSA and reappear when the
application is reopened.
v. The ability to dynamically block, on demand, video stream dynamically to lower level
users to prevent access, for a specific time, to live and recorded video.
w. A tool for building and exporting a set of videos into a single container. This tool
shall allow the operator to build sequences of video to create a storyboard and allow
the export of synchronous cameras.
x. The ability to store the video export and still image export at a pre-defined storage
location.
y. An interface with the ability to list, search, and manipulate previously generated
video exports.
xv. Tracking
a. The USP shall permit the user to select multiple entities to monitor from the
Monitoring UI by adding the entities one by one to the tracking list.
b. The Monitoring UI shall provide the option to filter which events shall be displayed in
the display tile layout and/or event list layout.
c. It shall be possible to lock a Monitoring UI display tile so that it only tracks the
activity of a specific entity (e.g. a specific door or camera).
d. The user shall be able to drag and drop an event from an event list (or an alarm from
an alarm list) onto a display tile to view a license plate read, cardholder picture ID,
badge ID, or live/archived video, among other options.
e. Event, alarm, monitoring/tracking, and report lists shall contain cardholder pictures
where applicable.
f. The user shall be permitted to start or pause the viewing of events within each
display tile.
xvi. Display Tile Packing and Unpacking
a. The Monitoring UI shall support single-click unpacking and packing for ALPR hits,
ALPR reads, areas, doors, zones, camera sequences, and alarms.
b. The packing and unpacking of entities shall allow operators to quickly obtain
additional information and camera views of a specific entity.
c. The unpacking of an entity shall display associated entities. For example,
unpacking a door with multiple associated cameras shall display all cameras
associated with that door. Unpacking shall reconfigure the display tiles to be able to
display all associated entities. For example, unpacking a door (or a zone or alarm)
that is currently in a 1 x 1 tile configuration and that has 3 cameras tied to it will
create a 1 x 3 display tile arrangement for viewing all associated entities.
d. Packing will return the display to the original tile pattern.
digital process that is scalable to allow future expandability, and is simultaneously done on two
Archiver Servers, located in separate facilities. The entire recording and review process is
fully managed by the Video Management system.
Video Archiver Servers shall have that USP Client software applications installed along with
the Server role. (Security Center 5.4)
Standard of Acceptance: Genetec Security Center – Omnicast Archiver Role(s)
In order to efficiently maintain all VMS signs placed throughout a station, it is critical that PTZ
cameras be place so as to allow for the remote viewing of both sides of all VMS signs at a
station.
8.13.8.2 Interface with Other Subsystems
The CCTV System must interface with other subsystems to provide the required camera field
of view at the correct time. Interface must be provided to the video encoder/alarm unit (N.O.
dry contact closures) with the following subsystems:
Refer to Appendix A - Systems Interface Matrix, indicating the control and monitoring
interfacing requirements of all communications subsystems.
Each portal opening will require three (3) pairs of approved infrared sensors to trigger intrusion
alarms. Typically, the sensors are installed at heights of 2.74 m, 1.52 m and 0.61 m (9’, 5’ and
2’) above Top of Rail (TOR). These heights may require small adjustments on site and
therefore, the sensor installation should be flexible enough to accommodate small elevation
adjustments. If all three sensors are either activated or deactivated at the same time, a “No
Alarm” situation will be present. If any one or two sensors are activated, an “Intrusion Alarm”
situation would be triggered, sending an alarm through the Contacts and activating the nearest
exterior fixed and PTZ Cameras.
All video, control and alarm information will be transmitted through provided fibre optic cabling
to the Control Centre. The Control Centre will monitor the alarm situations and will be
required to contact ETS Security if a breach occurs. The system will be reset through the
BMS System.
8.13.10.2.2 Sustainability
i. The specified unit shall be manufactured in accordance with ISO 14001.
ii. The specified unit shall be compliant with the EU directives 2011/65/EU (RoHS) and
2012/19/EU (WEEE).
iii. The specified unit shall be compliant with the EU regulation 1907/2006 (REACH).
iv. The specified unit shall be PVC-free in accordance with IEC 61249-2-21.
v. The manufacturer shall have signed and support the UN Global Compact initiative as
defined by United Nations https://www.unglobalcompact.org/
8.13.10.2.3 Standards & Regulations
i. The specified unit shall meet product safety standards as defined in IEC/EN/UL 60950-1
ii. The specified unit shall meet product safety standards as defined in IEC/EN/UL 60950-22
iii. The camera shall meet relevant parts of SMPTE 296M (HDTV 720p)
iv. The camera shall meet relevant parts of SMPTE 274M (HDTV 1080p)
v. The camera shall meet ISO/IEC 14496-10 Advanced Video Coding (H.264)
vi. The specified unit shall carry the following EMC approvals:
a. EN 55022 Class B
b. EN 55024
c. FCC Part 15 - Subpart B
d. VCCI Class B
e. RCM AS/NZS CISPR 22 Class B
f. ICES-003 Class B
g. KCC KN32 Class B
h. KN35
vii. The camera shall meet the following mechanical environmental standards:
a. IEC/EN 60529 IP66/67
b. ISO 20653 IP6K9K
c. NEMA 250 Type 4X
d. IEC/EN 62262 IK10
e. IEC 60068-2-1
f. IEC 60068-2-2
g. IEC 60068-2-6
h. IEC 60068-2-14
i. IEC 60068-2-27
j. IEC 60068-2-78
viii. The camera shall meet the following railway environmental standards:
a. EN 50121-4
b. IEC 62236-4
ix. The camera shall meet the following standards:
a. IEEE 802.3af/802.3at (Power over Ethernet)
b. IEEE 802.1X (Authentication)
c. IPv4 (RFC 791)
d. IPv6 (RFC 2460)
e. QoS – DiffServ (RFC 2475)
8.13.10.2.4 Mechanics & environmental
i. The camera shall be manufactured with an IP66-, IP67-, IP6K9K- and NEMA 4X-rated,
IK10 impact-resistant casing with polycarbonate dome, aluminum base and
dehumidifying membrane.
ii. The camera shall operate in a temperature range of -40°C to +60°C (-40°F to +140°F).
iii. The camera shall operate in a humidity range of 10-100% RH (condensing).
8.13.10.2.7 Video
i. The camera shall provide simultaneous Motion JPEG and H.264 video streams.
ii. The camera shall be designed to provide at least two video streams in HDTV 1080p
(1920x1080) at up to 60 frames per second (60 Hz mode) or 50 frames per second (50
Hz mode) using H.264 or Motion JPEG.
iii. The camera shall be designed to provide 2 individually cropped out view areas.
iv. The camera shall provide both landscape format (4:3 and 16:9 aspect ratio) as well as
corridor format (3:4 and 9:16 aspect ratio).
v. The camera shall support H.264 Baseline, Main and High Profile.
vi. The H.264 implementation shall include both unicast and multicast functionality and
support Constant Bit Rate (CBR) as well as Variable Bit Rate (VBR).
vii. The camera shall support H.264 with automatic scene adaptive bitrate control.
viii. The camera shall for its H.264 implementation support scene adaptive bitrate control with
automatic dynamic ROI to reduce bitrate in un-prioritized regions in order to lowering
bandwidth and storage requirements.
8.13.10.2.8 Connectors
i. The camera shall be equipped with a RJ45 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX PoE Ethernet port.
8.13.10.2.11 Storage
i. The camera shall be equipped with a video buffer for saving pre- and post-alarm images
and shall have a microSD-card slot to support local storage of video.
ii. The camera shall support recording to network attached storage.
viii. The camera shall support time synchronization via NTP server.
8.13.10.2.14 Power
i. Power over Ethernet IEEE 802.3af/802.3at Type 1 Class 3
ii. Max 10.4 W
iii. Typical 4.5 W
8.13.10.2.15 Maintenance & service
i. The camera shall provide a log file, containing information about all users connecting to
the unit since last restart. The file shall include information about connecting IP address
and the time of connecting.
ii. The camera shall be monitored by a Watchdog functionality, which shall automatically re-
initiate processes or restart the unit if a malfunction is detected.
iii. The camera shall send a notification when the unit has re-booted and all services are
initialized.
8.13.10.2.16 API & applications
i. The unit shall contain a built-in web server making video, audio and configuration
available in a standard browser environment using HTTP.
ii. The camera shall be fully supported by open and published API (Application
Programmers Interface) providing necessary information for integration of functionality
into third party applications.
8.13.10.3 Fixed Camera Type 2
Type 2 cameras must be used in locations where lighting is more evenly controlled and
lighting conditions are more consistent. Cameras may still be exposed to extremely bright
light or glare and must adjust dynamically to these conditions. Type 2 cameras will not offer
the same sensitivity levels for low light conditions as those of Type 1 cameras. These
cameras will be adequate for use outdoors or where cameras may be exposed to the
elements, temperature fluctuations or moisture. Current specifications (as of August 2016)
are based on Axis Q35XX-VE Series with details for the Q3505-VE model detailed below:
8.13.10.3.1 Standards, Regulations & Recognitions
i. The camera shall be backed by a minimum of three-year manufacturer warranty.
ii. The manufacturer shall provide the option of extended warranty for the camera. The
optional extended warranty shall be available in two-year extension blocks for a total
warranty period of maximum five years.
iii. The contractor or designated subcontractor shall submit credentials of completed
manufacturer certification, verified by a third party organization, as proof of the
knowledge.
iv. The camera shall meet product safety standards as defined in IEC/EN/UL 60950-1
v. The camera shall meet product safety standards as defined in IEC/EN/UL 60950-22
vi. The camera shall meet ISO/IEC 14496-10 MPEG-4 Part 10, Advanced Video Coding
(H.264)
vii. The camera shall meet ISO/IEC 14496-2 (Profiles ASP and SP) (MPEG-4 Part 2)
viii. The camera shall meet SMPTE 296M (HDTV 720p)
ix. The camera shall meet SMPTE 274M (HDTV 1080p)
x. The camera shall meet ONVIF Profile S or ONVIF Version 1.01 or higher as defined by
the ONVIF organization.
xi. The camera shall carry the following EMC approvals:
a. EN55022 Class B
b. EN55024
c. FCC Part 15 - Subpart B Class A + B
d. VCCI Class B
e. C-tick AS/NZS CISPR22 Class B
f. ICES-003 Class B
g. KN22 Class B
h. KN24
xii. The camera shall meet the following standards:
a. IEEE 802.3af/802.3at (Power over Ethernet)
b. IEEE 802.1X (Authentication)
c. IPv4 (RFC 791)
d. IPv6 (RFC 2460)
e. QoS – DiffServ (RFC 2475)
xiii. The camera shall meet the following mechanical environmental standards:
a. IEC 60529 IP66/67
b. NEMA 250 Type 4X
c. IEC/EN 62262 IK10+ (50 J)
d. ISO 20653 IP6K9K
e. IEC 60068-2-1
f. IEC 60068-2-2
g. IEC 60068-2-6
h. IEC 60068-2-14
i. IEC 60068-2-27
j. IEC 60068-2-60
k. IEC 60068-2-78
xiv. The camera shall meet the following Railway environmental standards:
a. EN 50121-4
b. IEC 62236-4
d. Lens 22 mm - HDTV 1080p 50/60 fps: Color: 0.56 lux, B/W:0.11 lux
8.13.10.3.4 Image Control
i. The camera shall incorporate Automatic and Manual White Balance.
ii. The camera shall incorporate automatic and manually defined exposure zones.
iii. The camera shall support a configurable shutter in the range from 1/142850 s to 2 s in
HDTV 1080p 25/30 50/60 fps mode.
iv. The camera shall support a configurable shutter in the range from 1/142850 s to 2 s in
WUXGA (1920x1200) 25/30 fps mode.
v. The camera shall incorporate capture mode with the following settings:
a. HDTV1080p (1920 x 1080) with WDR: 25/30 fps with power line frequency 50/60 Hz
b. HDTV1080p (1920 x 1080) without WDR: 50/60 fps with power line frequency 50/60
Hz
c. WUXGA (1920 x 1200) without WDR: 25/30 fps with power line frequency 50/60 Hz
vi. The camera shall provide backlight compensation.
vii. The camera shall allow for rotation of the image in steps of 90º.
viii. The camera shall incorporate a function for optimization of low light behavior.
ix. The camera shall incorporate a function for Electronic Image Stabilization (EIS) for real-
time image stabilization.
x. The camera shall incorporate a function to manually correct barrel distortion, by using a
slider to correct distortion in the image.
8.13.10.3.5 Video
i. The camera shall provide simultaneous Motion JPEG and H.264 video streams.
ii. The camera shall be designed to provide at least two video streams in HDTV 1080p
(1920x1080) at up to 60 frames per second (60 Hz mode) or 50 frames per second (50
Hz mode).
iii. The camera shall support Baseline Profile H.264 encoding with motion estimation in up to
60 fps (60 Hz), 50 fps (50 Hz) in HDTV 1080p resolution.
iv. The camera shall support Main Profile H.264 encoding with motion estimation and
context-adaptive binary arithmetic coding (CABAC) in up to 60 fps (60 Hz), 50 fps (50 Hz)
in HDTV 1080p resolution.
v. The camera shall support High Profile H.264 encoding with motion estimation up to 50/60
fps in up to 60 fps (60 Hz), 50 fps (50 Hz) in HDTV 1080p resolution.
vi. The camera shall provide video in landscape format 4:3 and 16:9 as well as corridor
format 3:4 and 9:16.
vii. The H.264 implementation shall include both unicast and multicast functionality and
support Maximum Bit Rate (MBR) as well as Variable Bit Rate (VBR).
8.13.10.3.6 Audio
i. The camera shall support two-way full duplex audio.
ii. Input sources:
a. External microphone (balanced/unbalanced)
b. External line device
iii. Output sources:
a. External line device
iv. Encoding
The camera shall support:
a. AAC LC at 8/16 kHz
b. G.711 PCM at 8 kHz
v. The camera shall support High Profile H.264 encoding with motion estimation up to 50/60
fps in up to 60 fps (60 Hz), 50 fps (50 Hz) in HDTV 1080p resolution.
vi. The camera shall provide video in landscape format 4:3 and 16:9 as well as corridor
format 3:4 and 9:16.
vii. The H.264 implementation shall include both unicast and multicast functionality and
support Maximum Bit Rate (MBR) as well as Variable Bit Rate (VBR).
8.13.10.4.6 Audio
i. The camera shall support two-way full duplex audio.
ii. Input sources:
a. External microphone (balanced/unbalanced)
b. External line device
iii. Output sources:
a. External line device
iv. Encoding
The camera shall support:
a. AAC LC at 8/16 kHz
b. G.711 PCM at 8 kHz
c. G.726 ADPCM at 8 kHz
8.13.10.4.7 Connectors
i. The camera shall be equipped with a RJ45 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX PoE Ethernet port.
ii. The camera shall be equipped with two configurable inputs/outputs, configurable for in- or
output functionality.
iii. The camera shall be equipped with a 3.5 mm connector for Line out.
iv. The camera shall be equipped with a 3.5 mm connector for Line/Mic In.
8.13.10.4.8 PTZ functionality
i. The camera shall incorporate guard tour functionality.
ii. The camera shall incorporate preset positions functionality.
iii. The camera shall provide 3x optical and 2x digital zoom with 9 mm lens.
iv. The camera shall provide 2.4x optical and 2x digital zoom with 22 mm lens.
v. The camera shall provide control queue functionality.
vi. The camera shall provide On-Screen Directional Indicator (OSDI) functionality.
8.13.10.4.9 Event functionality
i. The camera shall be equipped with an integrated event functionality, which can be
trigged by:
a. Live Stream Accessed
b. Tampering
c. Video Motion Detection
d. Shock Detected
e. Audio Detection
f. Day/Night Mode
g. External Input
h. Temperature
i. Schedule
j. Manual Trigger/Virtual Inputs
k. PTZ functionality
l. Embedded third party applications
iii. The camera shall send a notification when the unit has re-booted and all services are
initialized.
8.13.10.4.15 API & applications
i. The unit shall contain a built-in web server making video, audio and configuration
available in a standard browser environment using HTTP.
ii. The camera shall be fully supported by open and published API (Application
Programmers Interface) providing necessary information for integration of functionality
into third party applications.
vi. The camera shall support H.264 with automatic scene adaptive bitrate control.
vii. The camera shall for its H.264 implementation support scene adaptive bitrate control with
automatic dynamic ROI to reduce bitrate in un-prioritized regions in order to lowering
bandwidth and storage requirements.
8.13.10.5.4 Pan Tilt functionality
i. The camera shall provide more than 255 manually set preset positions.
ii. The camera shall provide e-flip functionality, which will automatically rotate the image
180° electronically when following a moving object passing under the camera.
iii. The camera shall provide a guard tour functionality, which allows the dome to
automatically move between selected presets using an individual speed and viewing time
for each preset.
iv. The camera shall be able to record a custom PTZ tour, operated using an input device
such as a joystick, mouse or keyboard, and then use and recall this as a guard tour.
v. The camera shall be able to detect and automatically follow moving objects in the
cameras field of view.
vi. The camera shall provide On-screen directional indicator (OSDI) functionality.
vii. The camera shall be equipped with accurate high-speed pan-tilt functionality with 360°
endless pan range and a 180° tilt range.
viii. The camera shall provide pan and tilt speed between 0.05° - 450°/sec.
8.13.10.5.7 Security
i. To secure access to the unit as well as provided content, the unit shall support HTTPS,
SSL/TLS and IEEE802.1X authentication.
ii. The camera shall provide centralized certificate management, with both pre-installed CA
certificates and the ability to upload additional CA certificates. The certificates shall be
signed by an organization providing digital trust services.
iii. The camera shall support IP address filtering and include at least three different levels of
password security.
8.13.10.5.8 Product installation & maintenance
i. The camera shall include a customizable pixel counter functionality, identifying the size of
objects in number of pixels.
ii. The camera shall allow updates of the software (firmware) over the network, using FTP
or HTTP.
iii. The camera shall support time synchronization via NTP server.
iv. The camera shall provide a log file, containing information about all users connecting to
the unit since last restart. The file shall include information about connecting IP address
and the time of connecting.
v. The camera shall be monitored by a Watchdog functionality, which shall automatically re-
initiate processes or restart the unit if a malfunction is detected.
vi. The camera shall send a notification when the unit has re-booted and all services are
initialized.
8.13.10.5.9 API & applications
i. The unit shall contain a built-in web server making video, audio and configuration
available in a standard browser environment using HTTP.
ii. The camera shall be fully supported by open and published API (Application
Programmers Interface) providing necessary information for integration of functionality
into third party applications.
8.13.10.5.16 Sustainability
i. The specified unit shall be manufactured in accordance with ISO 14001.
ii. The specified unit shall be compliant with the EU directives 2011/65/EU (RoHS) and
2012/19/EU (WEEE).
iii. The specified unit shall be compliant with the EU regulation 1907/2006 (REACH).
iv. The specified unit shall be PVC-free in accordance with IEC 61249-2-21.
v. The manufacturer shall have signed and support the UN Global Compact initiative as
defined by United Nations https://www.unglobalcompact.org/
iii. The camera shall be designed to provide at least two video streams in HDTV 720p
(1280x720) at up to 60 frames per second (60 Hz mode) or 50 frames per second (50 Hz
mode) using H.264 or Motion JPEG.
iv. The camera shall support H.264 Baseline, Main and High Profile.
v. The H.264 implementation shall include both unicast and multicast functionality and
support Maximum Bit Rate (MBR) as well as Variable Bit Rate (VBR).
vi. The camera shall support H.264 with automatic scene adaptive bitrate control.
vii. The camera shall for its H.264 implementation support scene adaptive bitrate control with
automatic dynamic ROI to reduce bitrate in un-prioritized regions in order to lowering
bandwidth and storage requirements.
8.13.10.6.4 Pan Tilt functionality
i. The camera shall provide more than 255 manually set preset positions.
ii. The camera shall provide e-flip functionality, which will automatically rotate the image
180° electronically when following a moving object passing under the camera.
iii. The camera shall provide a guard tour functionality, which allows the dome to
automatically move between selected presets using an individual speed and viewing time
for each preset.
iv. The camera shall be able to record a custom PTZ tour, operated using an input device
such as a joystick, mouse or keyboard, and then use and recall this as a guard tour.
v. The camera shall be able to detect and automatically follow moving objects in the
cameras field of view.
vi. The camera shall provide On-screen directional indicator (OSDI) functionality.
vii. The camera shall be equipped with accurate high-speed pan-tilt functionality with 360°
endless pan range and a 180° tilt range.
viii. The camera shall provide pan and tilt speed between 0.05° - 450°/sec.
8.13.10.6.6 Storage
i. The camera shall be equipped with a video buffer for saving pre- and post-alarm images
and shall have a SD card slot to support local storage of video.
ii. The camera shall support recording to network attached storage.
8.13.10.6.7 Security
i. To secure access to the unit as well as provided content, the unit shall support HTTPS,
SSL/TLS and IEEE802.1X authentication.
ii. The camera shall provide centralized certificate management, with both pre-installed CA
certificates and the ability to upload additional CA certificates. The certificates shall be
signed by an organization providing digital trust services.
iii. The camera shall support IP address filtering and include at least three different levels of
password security.
8.13.10.6.8 Product installation & maintenance
i. The camera shall include a customizable pixel counter functionality, identifying the size of
objects in number of pixels.
ii. The camera shall allow updates of the software (firmware) over the network, using FTP
or HTTP.
iii. The camera shall support time synchronization via NTP server.
iv. The camera shall provide a log file, containing information about all users connecting to
the unit since last restart. The file shall include information about connecting IP address
and the time of connecting.
v. The camera shall be monitored by a Watchdog functionality, which shall automatically re-
initiate processes or restart the unit if a malfunction is detected.
vi. The camera shall send a notification when the unit has re-booted and all services are
initialized.
8.13.10.6.9 API & applications
i. The unit shall contain a built-in web server making video, audio and configuration
available in a standard browser environment using HTTP.
ii. The camera shall be fully supported by open and published API (Application
Programmers Interface) providing necessary information for integration of functionality
into third party applications.
iii. Cameras shall comply with relevant ONVIF profile as defined by the ONVIF Organization.
8.13.10.6.10 Network functionality
i. The camera shall support both static IP addresses and addresses from a DHCP-server.
ii. The camera shall support both IPv4 and IPv6.
iii. The camera shall incorporate support for Quality of Service (QoS).
iv. The camera shall incorporate support for Bonjour.
8.13.10.6.11 Other functionality
i. The camera shall provide text overlay ability, including date and time.
ii. The camera shall have the ability to apply a graphical image as an overlay image in the
video stream.
iii. The camera shall have the ability to provide up to 32 individual 3D privacy masks to the
image.
8.13.10.6.13 Connectors
i. The camera shall be equipped with a RJ45 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX PoE Ethernet port.
8.13.10.6.14 Power
i. 100-240 V AC / 50-60 Hz, max 60 W – provided to the camera through the network cable
by a separate injector, supplied with the camera.
8.13.10.6.15 Standards & Regulations
i. The specified unit shall meet product safety standards as defined in IEC/EN/UL 60950-1
ii. The specified unit shall meet product safety standards as defined in IEC/EN/UL 60950-22
iii. The camera shall meet relevant parts of SMPTE 296M (HDTV 720p)
iv. The camera shall meet relevant parts of SMPTE 274M (HDTV 1080p)
v. The camera shall meet ISO/IEC 14496-10 Advanced Video Coding (H.264)
vi. The specified unit shall carry the following EMC approvals:
a. EN 55022 Class A
b. EN 55024
c. FCC Part 15 - Subpart A
d. VCCI Class A
e. RCM AS/NZS CISPR 22 Class A
f. ICES-003 Class A
g. KCC KN32 Class A
h. KN35
vii. The camera shall meet the following mechanical environmental standards:
a. IEC/EN 60529 IP66
b. NEMA 250 Type 4X
c. NEMA TS-2-2003 v02.06 Subsection 2.2.7, 2.2.8, 2.2.9
d. IEC 62262 IK10
e. IEC 60721-4-3
f. IEC 60068-2-1
g. IEC 60068-2-2
h. IEC 60068-2-6
i. IEC 60068-2-14
j. IEC 60068-2-27
k. IEC 60068-2-30
l. IEC 60068-2-60
m. IEC 60068-2-78
n. ISO 4892-2
viii. The camera shall meet the following railway environmental standards:
a. EN 50121-4
b. IEC 62236-4
ix. The camera shall meet the following standards:
a. IEEE 802.1X (Authentication)
b. IPv4 (RFC 791)
c. IPv6 (RFC 2460)
d. QoS – DiffServ (RFC 2475)
8.13.10.6.16 Sustainability
i. The specified unit shall be manufactured in accordance with ISO 14001.
ii. The specified unit shall be compliant with the EU directives 2011/65/EU (RoHS) and
2012/19/EU (WEEE).
iii. The specified unit shall be compliant with the EU regulation 1907/2006 (REACH).
iv. The specified unit shall be PVC-free in accordance with IEC 61249-2-21.
v. The manufacturer shall have signed and support the UN Global Compact initiative as
defined by United Nations https://www.unglobalcompact.org/
vi. The dome must incorporate independent automatic Colour-to-Black & White switching
modes for automatic switchover from colour in daytime, to high sensitivity black and white
at night.
vii. The CCD must be a 1/4-inch image sensor with 724 x 494 effective pixels, providing 470-
line resolution.
viii. Colour mode sensitivity must be 0.008 foot-candles (0.08 lx) at 1/2-sec shutter speed;
ix. Black & White mode must be 0.0013 foot-candles (0.013 lx) at 1/2-sec shutter speed.
x. Signal to noise ratio must be 50 dB or greater
xi. Power requirements: 70 VA at 24 V AC
xii. Standard of Acceptance: Pelco Spectra III Model SD53VBW-PG-E1
In addition to the above listed camera, IP based cameras are currently being evaluated and
may be considered for installation in future projects.
8.13.10.8 Camera Lenses / Optics
All specified cameras include factory-installed lenses / optics which have been designed to
function correctly with the devices including all necessary feature support. Where applicable,
lens options, including specific focal-lengths, are to be selected specifically to suit the
installation and field-of-view requirements. No after-market lenses / optics are to be used on
new cameras.
During peak hour and special events, it is essential that LRT Operations use camera views to
determine passenger load requirements at selected stations in order to determine if additional
trains are required.
8.13.11.1 Security
Camera coverage is required for the following security sensitive areas:
i. Entrances to cash vaults (fixed)
ii. Fare equipment (may be either fixed camera or a PTZ camera preset position - must
provide a view of the front of the TVM)
iii. Platform areas
iv. Emergency telephones shall be clearly visible either in a fixed camera view or a PTZ
camera Preset position
v. Panic Buttons, where applicable, shall be clearly visible within either a fixed camera view
or in a PTZ camera Preset position
vi. Elevators require fixed camera coverage of each opening, as well as a fixed (wide-angle)
camera within the car
vii. Escalators require fixed camera coverage of the entire run in a single view as well as
both landings (top and bottom) in separate views – 3 cameras per escalator
viii. All entrance doors
ix. Washroom entrance doors (cameras to be fixed type) – must provide a clear view of the
door as well as the “Occupied” signage
x. Tunnel and Grade Separation portals
xi. Continuous coverage of pedway entrances and exits to all levels
xii. Continuous coverage of walkway entrances and exits to all levels
xiii. Continuous coverage of stairwell entrances and exits to all levels (cameras to be fixed
type)
xiv. Surface parking areas
xv. Parking Lot entrances and exits require fixed-view License Plate Recognition cameras
positioned to allow capture of vehicle license plates entering and exiting the lots
Coverage must be provided with the objective of eliminating all blind or hidden areas. The
appropriate infrastructure must be added to light standards to allow for possible camera
installation. Activity must be identifiable for a distance of up to 45 m.
Camera views of fare collection and fare paid areas are for the purpose of ensuring reliable
and free flowing fare collection and to detect any flow obstruction.
Alarms generated from emergency phones, emergency call stations, ticket vending machines,
vaults, elevators or washrooms must immediately display their respective camera views.
Security must be able to display and record simultaneously a minimum of five emergencies or
alarm situations. LRT Security requires the ability to quickly view any camera image on the
system and record if desired.
8.13.11.2 Operations
In addition to camera locations detailed for Security use, ETS has designated certain
operational areas which are to have coverage / visibility though the CCTV system.
i. PA/VMS Signs on LRT Platforms must have clear visibility of the entire sign face via a
PTZ camera – each side of double-faced signs, where applicable.
ii. Clock tower and Parking Lot signs must be visible via a PTZ camera.
iii. Certain Designated Employees Access doors or Entrances.
iv. Certain Areas wherein work is performed on sensitive equipment such as:
a. Substations (access and inner areas).
b. Communications Rooms (access and inner area).
iii. Installation of conduit and cable pathways must comply with Section 8.8 of these Design
Guidelines.
iv. Installation of associated electrical cabling for AC circuits must comply with the latest
editions of the Alberta Building Code, Canadian Electrical Code and Canadian Electrical
Safety Code.
8.14 PA/VMS
8.14.1 General
This section presents an overview of the existing LRT PA System on the entire LRT system.
The system consists of three parts: the amplifier and live announcement system, the train
arrival and scheduled message system and the automated public message and visual display
maintenance system. The first one is provided by OpenAccess from Australia, the second
one is provided by Thales in conjunction with the CBTC system and the last one is an in
house developed system.
The Guidelines presented here apply to the Bus Transit Center PA as well. The OpenAccess
system is to be used in all bus transit centers for audio because it can be integrated into the
same system as the LRT uses. The in house system controls all of the clock towers and
parking lot LED signs used in all transit centers.
The PA system is to provide the capability for the control center staff to make announcements
to patrons in all LRT stations and Bus Transit Centers. Interconnected to the PA system is the
VMS, which displays visual messages at LRT station platforms.
i. Ability to add new signs and amplifiers without involving the manufacturer or installer of
the system
ii. Ability to monitor the status of all signs, amplifiers, speaker health, and alert to problems
as soon as they are detected.
iii. Must have an open API that can used to access and push information between systems
as needed by third party systems.
iv. Must have as few components as possible and combine as many functions into a single
integrated unit per station.
v. Must have the ability to centrally maintain all end device configurations and be able to
push these out as needed.
vi. Must have the ability to verify and ensure the time displayed on all VMS signs is accurate
and automatically rectify and alert if the time is off.
vi. Overall system hum and noise to be lower than –70 dBm. Harmonic distortion to be less
than 2% measured at stated operating sound pressure levels and specified frequency
response.
vii. Provide PA system frequency response uniform from 200 Hz to 6000 Hz 2 dB, measured
with a 1/3 octave broadband signal.
viii. Provide Automatic Gain and Compression features to assure speech levels from
loudspeakers to public areas remain constant within 2 decibels SPL.
ix. The overall minimum performance value must be 0.55 or better on a Speech
Transmission Index (STI) scale.
8.14.6.3 Control Network
In order to ensure compatibility, new station or system modifications must be in accordance
with and fit into the existing system design concept as illustrated in Appendix C.
8.14.6.4 System Servers and Network Capacity
Servers and general capacity on the system must be sized to handle all the users, stations,
and other various equipment plus 20%. Messaging must not have a delay of more than 1
second, 1% of the time, from any terminal at peak usage. Message throughput must be
measured from the operator to message delivery at the desired location with all messages
being of the same priority.
8.14.8 Amplifiers
Amplifiers are required to provide suitable acoustic performance and sound pressure levels
(SPL) for intelligible voice announcements, as described by Section 8.14.6.2.
Audio amplifiers to be specified must have the following features:
i. Meet professional technical performance specifications.
ii. Provide overload protection and convection cooling (no cooling fan).
iii. Power rating is suitable for individual loudspeaker zones.
iv. Integrated 70 V constant line operation.
v. Ability to monitor the health of all connected speaker zones
vi. Integrated DSP and ambient noise sensing functions
vii. Integrated ability to play out messages
viii. Network connected, remotely manageable and configurable
ix. Connect to a central backend system that monitors all amplifiers on the system
Total number of amplifier output channels must equal or exceed the number of logical zones
within the station.
The loudspeaker circuit loading must be designed with a minimum 20% power margin. The
amplifier power distribution is to be 70 volt constant current method.
Standard of acceptance: Open Access Netspire Network Access Controller
8.14.9 Signs
8.14.9.1 Variable Message Signs
Variable Message Signs (VMS) are provided to augment the PA system with visual
messaging. In general, visual messaging must be coordinated with audio messaging to
improve intelligibility of messages for the general public and the hearing impaired community.
Additionally, VMS must be used for stored repetitive messaging, such as public service
announcements, or in neighborhoods where audio messaging is either not desirable or not
acceptable.
VMS messaging must be controlled from the overall PIDS system on an individual sign basis.
The same OWS must control both the PA and VMS, including the coordination of joint
messaging.
In order to remain consistent with the existing system signage, designs must use Daktronics
Galaxy 1000 Series displays with Venus 1500 Protocol, or approved equal, conforming to the
following:
i. 48 x 144 LED matrix
ii. Min Text Height 100 mm
iii. NEMA 4 Rated, Double-Faced Cabinet
iv. Cabinet Dimensions: 406 mm (16”)H x 1320 mm (52”)W x 36 mm(14”)D
v. Two (2) NEMA 4 Rated Gaskets for Power and Signals Knockouts
vi. Internal DSL/Ethernet Modem Mounting Bracket
vii. LED Colour: Amber with minimum life of 50,000 hours (50% of original brightness)
viii. Automatic ambient light compensation
ix. Provided with sunshield and glare resistant coating, as need
x. Five (5) Year Warranty
Each Daktronics sign installed at platform level must have a two controller design. One
controller used to control the upper two thirds of the sign and the second controller used to
control the bottom third of the sign. If the functionality of all pieces of the PA system described
above are integrated into one system, these signs could operate with one controller. This is
not the case today however.
In addition, to the signs on the platform, ETS uses three other sign types: Clock towers,
parking lots, and third-party advertising. These signs (except for the third party advertising)
are also Daktronics signs using Venus 1500 protocol. Spec sheets for the different sign types
used by ETS
8.14.9.2 Connectivity
At each station, the VMS signs must be connected via direct Cat 6 connections to the nearest
ETS network presence. The network device is then programmed with the PA/VMS service for
access to PA/VMS resources only. This configuration may be modified if the Communications
Room is centrally located on the platform or as approved by ETS staff.
8.14.9.3 Power Supply
8.14.9.3.1 Primary Power
All VMS must be provided from the station primary power supply. All VMS equipment power
must be on the same phase.
8.14.12 Microphones
All microphones to interface with the PA system must be PoE powered IP microphones.
These devices must integrate directly with the PA system and be monitored and configured
from a central system the same as the amplifiers.
8.15.1 General
The telephone systems to be installed on the LRT system are classified as follows:
i. Right-of Way (ROW) Phones
ii. Emergency Phones*
iii. Elevator Phones*
iv. Washroom Access Phones*
v. Information Phones*
vi. Public Pay Phones*
vii. Staff Service Phones
*Note: Phones available for public use are designated by asterisk.
remote switches. For phone service at stations not housing a PBX, a 200 pair copper cable
will be used between all stations to provide VF pathway to the nearest PBX.
This topology is in the process of being migrated to VoIP and this topology will need to be
updated in the design guidelines when the new topology is clear.
8.15.8 Redundancy
All backend servers that drive the phone system and emergency phones must be redundant
and provide a high level of availability. This must also extend to the PRI or VoIP trunk lines
that connect the system to the PSTN. The phone system is one of the most critical systems to
keep operating and must be a highly reliable and available solution.
8.15.9 Phones
8.15.9.1 Right of Way (ROW) Phones
ROW Phones (painted white) must be installed at nominal 350 m spacing along the LRT
corridor in the vicinity of LRT communication duct bank vaults. In the duct bank vault a 4 pair
armored telephone cable will be spliced into the main telephone trunk cable and pulled into
each ROW telephone set and terminated. Refer to Figure 8.2 for phone support stand detail
drawing. As the system migrates to VoIP phones, these installs can be paired with ROW
switches used for cameras at all crossings and intersections and use the same network
infrastructure to drive two different communications systems. Another possibility for these
phones is the use of powered fibre that can potentially bring any VoIP phone within 3 km of a
station back to the main communications room and centrally power the device from there.
ROW phones must also be installed at:
i. At each crossing controller.
ii. At tunnel portals, in tunnels and at each cross tunnel. A blue light is to be installed at
these phones.
Unless otherwise approved by ETS, the ROW phone must be heavy duty, weather proof, and
have an armored handset cord, Guardian Telecom Inc. (ACT-40) or approved equal.
Guardian makes a VoIP equivalent to this analog phone described here and this will likely be
the new standard once the VoIP system is in place.
If a ROW phone call is made to the ETS Control Centre, the call is recorded. If the ROW
phone call is to another ROW phone, the call is not recorded. Dial outside of the ETS phone
switch network is not to be permitted from ROW phones.
8.15.9.2 Call on Phones
Call on phones must be installed at the end of all station platforms (stainless steel, two per
station). For staff security, a mirror is to be installed on the inside of the door to the
compartment. This phone is to be a Guardian SCT-10 or approved equivalent. This phone
will also become the VoIP alternative once the VoIP system is in place.
8.16.1 General
This section presents the guidelines that must be followed in the design of the radio system for
future extensions to the Edmonton LRT System. It also provides an overview of the radio
system currently in use on the LRT System.
The Edmonton LRT System shares a radio system with the Edmonton Police Service and
Edmonton Emergency Response Department. The system is a 4 site, GPS Simulcast EDACS
trunked radio system employing 20 channels in the Public Safety band of the 800 MHz
spectrum. Edmonton LRT utilizes 38 talk groups to meet LRT wireless communications
requirements.
All channels are served by 4 full duplex transmitter repeater sites located throughout the City
of Edmonton. These four sites are connected in a microwave ring architecture that supports 8
T1 circuits and timing is synchronized through GPS. The EDACS system utilizes 3 T1 circuits
for voice, control, and SCADA monitoring of each remote transmitter facility. Tunnel Radiax
cable antenna systems are utilized to extend above ground coverage to all tunnel areas.
Extension of 800 MHz radio signals into Coliseum and Grandin LRT Stations is accomplished
by the utilization of a bi-directional amplifier (BDA) system.
The current system supports 20 channels and has capacity, when required, to be expanded to
24 channels. The frequencies are assigned between 821- 824 MHz and 866 - 869 MHz.
Because all channels in an EDACS system are shared by all users and allocated by a central
control system, talk groups are created to logically group radio users by function. ETS
currently has 38 talk groups of which 7 are dedicated for use by LRT operations, LRT
Inspectors, and LRT Maintenance. The other 31 are used by Security, Surface operations,
Surface Inspectors, and Surface Maintenance.
ETS is working closely with EPS and FRS to migrate from EDACS to the provincial AFRRCS
radio network. The new system changes the frequencies to the 700 MHz range and is based
on the P25 standard. It retains a lot of the same characteristics as the existing EDACS in that
it will be a trunked system and use talk groups as EDACS does. The biggest difference will be
the audio as P25 is all digital audio and EDACS is analog. This overview will be updated once
the migration has been completed within the next two years.
8.16.1.1 Definitions
Radio Repeater System is a duplex communications radio network employing sensitive
radio receivers and high power transmitters. Low power (3 watts typical) portable radio
signals are received by fixed receiver/transmitter base stations and rebroadcast to allow
communication between low power (portable) radios over a much wider area than
possible by direct portable to-portable radio communication.
Receiver Voting is a network of sensitive radio receivers, equipped with high gain
antennas, strategically located to ‘pick-up’ low power (portable) radio signals. The
receiver with the best signal is then selected or “voted” to be rebroadcast by a high power
repeater transmitter.
Bi-Directional Amplifier (BDA) is an alternate (duplex) frequency amplification system
employing narrow band amplifiers and filter networks, rather than radio repeaters, to allow
duplex communications to and from below ground (tunnels/stations) areas.
On-Frequency Repeaters (OFR) is a same frequency amplification system employing
wide band amplifiers and filter networks to allow same frequency communication to below
ground areas.
Grade-of-Service is a term referring to radio frequency (RF) signal level, reliability of
radio signal and the impact of this on the quality of audio for voice communication.
Global Positioning Satellite (GPS) is a network of satellites that provide time signals to
receivers on earth in order to synchronize clocks or compute a location.
Enhanced Digital Access Communication System (EDCAS) is a radio system that was
invented by General Electric and currently supported by M/A-COM / Harris.
8.16.6.2 Features
i. Voice
ii. PSTN
iii. I-Call
iv. Encryption
v. AES 256
vi. OTAR
vii. Limited data
viii. GPS Capable
ix. OTAP
8.16.6.3 Talkgroups
i. Logical grouping of users that need to communicate
ii. Talkgroups do not require dedicated channels
iii. Nearly 65K talkgroups possible on AFRRCS
iv. Agencies define their own talkgroups based on operational need
v. Talkgroups can be encrypted
vi. The system tracks the users in the group and where they are physically located
8.16.6.4 AFRRCS Network Security
i. The physical AFRRCS network links locations.
ii. Voice and data traffic traverse the network over virtual ‘tunnels’ using the Dynamic
Multipoint Virtual Private Network (DMVPN) technology.
iii. Tunnels of the DMVPN network utilize a security layer called Internet Protocol Security
(IPsec).
iv. IPsec is used for securing IP communications by authenticating and encrypting
communications.
v. The tunnel architecture is hub and spoke from the NSC’s to sites and a full mesh
between the NSC’s and VSAT hubs.
8.16.6.5 Encryption
i. AFRRCS supports AES 256 encryption
ii. Agencies determine talkgroups encrypted
iii. End User Radios must support encryption Managed thorough Key Management Facility
(KMF)
iv. Over the Air Rekeying (subject to operational approvals)
v. No encryption on CETs
8.16.8 Redundancy
As described in 8.18.6, network redundancy is achieved through having two different
connections to AFRRCS via different network providers. Redundancy should also extend to
the end device in the control room. Each console will have two Ethernet connections up
linking to different physical switches providing a redundant pathway in the event of an
interface failure or switch failure.
The AFRRCS network is also designed to have redundancy via two different network
providers for every radio tower site. Within the city of Edmonton, there will be four tower sites
providing a simulcast service to the city and creating redundancy for each other in the event of
a major failure at a tower site.
In addition, the underground BDA system will be designed with two donor antenna sites at
opposite ends of the LRT system and distribute the signals redundantly over fibre optic to
each BDA location along the line.
This only describes a few talk groups used by LRT. For a complete fleetmap, refer to the ETS
fleetmap spreadsheet that is available on request for use in designing radio communications
systems for ETS.
All talkgroups are managed by ETS communications and any changes or modifications can be
completed working in cooperation with the ETS communications group.
8.16.13 DAS
The DAS will utilize a hybrid Fibre and Coax infrastructure solution engineered in a redundant
configuration. The DAS receives RF signal from the base station or off-air BDA and
distributes the RF signal to antennas over either coaxial cable (Passive DAS) or fiber (Active
DAS).
With passive DAS, coaxial cable and other passive components, splitters and couplers are
used. Usually, a central headend BDA drives the passive DAS elements or leaky feeder cable
called Radiax.
Active DAS provides improved installation and maintenance benefits over Passive DAS, but
still poses some design challenges including limited range and increased system noise.
Active DAS is usually the preferred in-building wireless solution over passive DAS for larger
facilities such as airports, hospitals, stadiums, high-rises, subway systems and multi-building
campuses.
The ETS DAS shall meet the following basic requirements:
i. DAS System shall be compatible with all major access protocols used worldwide
including GPRS, EDGE, CDMA2000, 1xRTT and W-CDMA, LTE., LTE-U
ii. DAS will cover a min RF frequency range of 700 MHz to 1900 MHz
iii. DAS System shall include software configurable frequency configuration, system gain
and RAU output power.
iv. DAS System shall support industry standard cabling options.
v. DAS System shall support a modular and scalable topology of system equipment.
vi. DAS System shall be deployable in environments with potentially high levels of RF
interference while maintaining acceptable levels of operational reliability.
vii. DAS System shall not require separate power connections to the unit’s antennas.
viii. DAS System shall be CUL, CSA approved.
ix. The installed DAS shall not interfere with ETS operations and equipment, or with any
other existing RF systems within the ETS LRT System, and shall satisfy the following
signal coverage requirement:
a. Signal coverage of 95% or better in public and non-public areas inside the stations
and inside the tunnels.
8.16.14 BDAs
Today, the BDA system consists of approximately 14 BDA locations throughout the city of
Edmonton’s Transit facilities. These systems have been installed in locations that have been
identified as having poor coverage for radio units especially portable radios. The primary
location for this system is the underground tunnels downtown and any other low lying areas
surrounded by concrete. Each of these sites has its own donor antenna on the surface
pointed at the downtown tower site and the signals are redistributed internally via radiax cable.
None of these sites are managed remotely and the only indication of issues is when trains or
personnel report issues.
Going forward, this system will be replaced to accommodate the P25 system and new
frequency band that will be used by AFRRCS. As part of the upgrade, new radiax will be
installed in the tunnels and designed to effectively cover the space. As well, the system will
be fibre fed from two donor locations to ensure reliability and the cleanest signal possible.
Every BDA will also be connected to the ETS network for remote diagnostics and monitoring
of every device. This will allow for proactive alerting of potential issues that can be rectified
before they become bigger issues.
8.17.1 Conventions
The signals network is based off of similar conventions to the main ETS network. Two new
types of switch names were introduced to distinguish these switches from the main network.
These names are Signals Room Switch (SRS) and Territory Ring Switch (TRS) and are used
based on where the switch is located in the architecture.
8.17.2 Architecture
The signals network is made up of a pair of switches in each of the 8 signal rooms in the
system. These 16 switches form a large ring that uses a Ruggedcom ring management
protocol to achieve 50 ms failover in the event of a switch failure in the ring. Each signal room
then has a local ring that connects to single switches at each wayside case in the field. These
cases control crossings and other signal devices within a small area of the case and relay that
information back to the main signal rooms for master control and monitoring. These wayside
case exist in the territory controlled by the signal room that they connect to. Therefore, the
switches in these subrings are referred to as territory ring switches.
At Churchill station, there is a single signals firewall that is used for all monitoring of the
signals devices from the main ETS network to ensure uptime and availability of all switches.
There is one VLAN defined in all the switches for management of every device that is exposed
to the ETS communications network and the untagged traffic is for VLC to VLC
communications.
8.17.4 Redundancy
All signal switches are connected in a layer 2 ring using a Ruggedcom proprietary ring
management protocol that can heal the ring within 50 ms. As this is migrated to MPLS, a
similar architecture will be maintained but the device used will be different and there will be
more failover paths than a single ring will allow for.
8.18.2 Architecture
The traction power network consists of three separate networks. One is a ring that starts at
Churchill and picks up the five southernmost substations on the Capital line. In addition to
this, Churchill and the entire Metro line are connected to this network. This network has a
gateway and a fibre connection to EPCOR in Churchill station. All the rest of the substations
in the system are connected on the second network which is via ISDN lines from the
substations to EPCOR. The final network type is a linear line of switches to interconnect the
transfer trip signaling from adjacent substations.
8.18.6 Redundancy
The SCADA network has ring redundancy but the transfer trip network does not. This is
something that will be incorporated into future designs using MPLS as well for one converged
architecture and network.
The overall objective of the Wi-Fi network is to provide reliable “best efforts” wireless
communications for the general public and ETS personnel in both underground and surface
LRT station platforms and transit centres. The following guidelines apply:
i. Wi-Fi wireless communications technologies and station infrastructure must be
investigated to support the relevant subsystem connectivity requirements. The objective
is to avoid the need to add surface conduits and network wiring after the stations have
been completed.
ii. The system architecture will utilize a dual radio Wireless Access Point (WAP) solution
capable of supporting 802.11 a/b/g @ 2.4 GHz and 802.11 a/n @ 5 GHz. The
technology selected must also be capable of supporting the latest 802.11ac higher
bandwidth protocols.
iii. All Wi-Fi network communications subsystems must provide redundancy and survivability
in the event of failures and outages.
connectivity requirements. Deployment locations within the station footprint will require
consultation with the third party.
8.19.4.4 Other third party
Other third party opportunities will surface as the ETS LRT system scales to include more
stations and transport of more people. In order to support increasing third party opportunities,
the communication system infrastructure design at future LRT stations and transit centres
should consider:
i. Increased conduit infrastructure, conduit size and fill ratios at the LRT stations.
ii. Enhanced Wi-Fi wireless capacity with secure and segregated SSID’s for third party
access.
iii. Increased capacity in the fibre network backbone.
iv. Potential to scale the security and CCTV network to support the additional third party
traffic.
a. Submit to the consultant or City technical representative ninety (90) days prior to the
schedule "date of Substantial Completion", a comprehensive installation / start-up
testing schedule identifying all activities to take place. Include draft forms to
demonstrate intended performance for each and every system. Information will
include but not be limited to the following:
1. Date of test.
2. Individual involved.
3. System being tested.
4. Description of functionality of the system.
5. Demonstration of proper operation.
6. Revise the draft forms to the City consultant's satisfaction.
7. Provide two (2) copies of certificates of all factory and site testing in complete
detail bearing in each case the seal of the Engineer responsible for the tests.
8. Submit all test results for City representative or consultant's review.
9. All equipment or system deficiencies identified by factory or site testing
procedures, to be corrected by the Contractor prior to obtaining a "Certificate of
Substantial Completion".
10. Complete acceptance and close-out documentation package to be created and
submitted for City representative or consultant's review. Final System
Operation and Maintenance manual will be required for each system. See
Section 8.21 for greater detail.
11. Contractor shall provide an appropriate training program for designated City
Operations personnel in order to accomplish and understand all aspects of the
specific system operation. Training plan to be submitted for City representative
or consultant's review.
back to the owner. Throughout the duration of the project the City consultant or technical
representative will periodically review the status of project record drawings.
n. The equipment list shall include make, model, serial number, electrical
characteristics.
o. The systems operating manual shall be prepared by contractor.
p. The systems operating manual shall be sub-divided into system sections. Each
system section shall contain:
1. The Telecom and electrical design intent.
2. The system location and areas served by each system.
3. Equipment included in each system.
4. Operation of each system in the normal and emergency modes.
5. Any Operator parameters.
6. Trouble shooting recommendations.
7. System schematics or logic diagrams.
COMMUNICATIONS
CCTV
Cameras X CCTV X
Recorders X CCTV X
Video encoder X CCTV X
Alarm interface unit X CCTV X Telephone, BMS, Fares
TELEPHONE
Emergency phone X X Phone Switch X CCTV
Emergency push button X CCTV X
Info phone X Phone Switch X
ROW/Operator phone X Phone Switch X
Washroom access phone X Phone Switch X
Elevator phone X Phone Switch X
PA/VMS
Server X X CBTC
RADIO
N/A
ELECTRICAL
STATIONS
Interior/exterior lighting X BMS X Motion Detector/Photocell
Motion detectors X BMS X CCTV
Fire alarm zones X BMS X
Fire alarm trouble X BMS X
Space temperature sensor
X BMS X
(underground stations only)
Door strikes X C-Cure X CCTV
Door monitoring X C-Cure X CCTV
Sprinkler system X X
Heat tracing X BMS X
Infra-red com. Ht'g X BMS X
Bldg space temperature X X BMS X
Vaults X C-Cure X CCTV
FARE EQUIPMENT
Ticket vending machines X CDCIS X BMS, CCTV
Ticket validators N/A
TUNNELS
Space temperature sensor X BMS X
Heat tracing X BMS X
Heaters X X BMS
Intrusion detection X BMS X CCTV
MECHANICAL
Vent fans X BMS X
Escalators X BMS X
Elevators X BMS X
Pumps X BMS X* X * Sump pumps only
Dampers X BMS X
AHU X X BMS X
Shelter heaters X BMS
NOTES:
1. The purpose of the Matrix is to identify all of the major LRT functions, by element, that are controlled and monitored centrally and by what system.
2. Functions and elements for some items can be further categorized by facility type.
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
COMMUNICATIONS & CONTROL
APPLICABLE INDUSTRY STANDARDS AND CODES
CAN/CSA/SAFETY
2017 National Electrical Safety Code® CAN/CSA-C22.2 NO. 0-10 (2015)
(NESC®), ANSI-C2
Canadian Electrical Code (CEC), 23rd edition C22.2 NO. 65-13 (2013)
(2015)
C22.1-12 (2012) CAN/CSA-B72-M87 (2013)
CENELEC - EN 50173-1 to -5 (2007) CENELEC - EN 50173-6 (2013)
NFPA 101: Life Safety Code (2015) NFPA 70: National Electrical Code (NEC)
(2017)
ISO/IEC/ELECTRICAL
Specifications and Drawings for 24.9/14.4 kV Specifications and Drawings for 12.5/7.2 kV
Line Construction (1998) Line Construction (2005)
Specifications and Drawings for Underground IEC 603-7
Electric Distribution (2000)
ISO/IEC JTC 1/SC 25/WG 3 N655 (Nov. 2001) ISO/IEC 11801 Edition 2.2 (2010)
ANSI/TIA
ANSI/TIA-568.1-D (Sept 2015) TIA-606-B (June 2012)
TIA-568-D.3 (Oct 2016) TIA-526-14-B (Oct 2010)
TIA/EIA-568-D (2015) ANSI/TIA-607-C (Nov 2015)
ANSI/TIA-569-A-1 to A-7 ANSI/TIA-758-B (Mar 2012)
TIA-569-D (Apr 2015) ANSI/TIA-942-A (Aug 2012)
TIA-569-D (Apr 2015) TIA-1152, Revision A (Nov 2016)
ICEA S-90-661 (June 2012) ANSI INCITS 455 (Sept 2009)
TIA-492AAAA, Revision B (Nov 2009) TIA/EIA-604 (Nov 1993)
TIA-492CAAA (May 1998) ANSI/INCITS 526 (Feb 2016)
ANSI/TIA/EIA-472DAAA ANSI/ICEA S-80-576
TIA-598-D (July 2014) ICEA S-83-596 (2016)
TIA-598-D (July 2014) ANSI/ICEA S-87-640 (Aug 2016)
th
ISA 99, 5 Edition
ANSI/ISA-TR99.00.01 (2007) ANSI/ISA-62443-1-1 (99.01.01) (2007)
ANSI/ISA-62443-2-1 (99.02.01) (2009) ANSI/ISA-TR62443-2-3 (2015)
ANSI/ISA-62443-3-3 (99.03.03) (2013)
BICSI
BICSI Telecommunications Distribution NECA/BICSI 568-2006
APPLICABLE INDUSTRY STANDARDS AND CODES
OTHERS
BBS-7239 Boeing Specification Support Methods Manual-latest edition, 5th edition
Standard (2016)
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
9.0 STRUCTURES
Page
9.1 GENERAL 1
9.1.1 Introduction 1
9.1.2 Applicable Codes, Standards, Practices and Reference Guidelines 1
9.1.3 Structure Categories 2
9.1.4 Load Factor Method for Design 2
9.1.5 Application of Loadings 2
9.2 BRIDGES 3
9.2.1 Dead Loads 3
9.2.2 Live Loads 4
9.2.3 Vertical Loads 4
9.2.4 Horizontal Loads 4
9.2.5 Derailment Loads 5
9.2.6 Longitudinal Forces Due to Acceleration/Deceleration and Rail Restraint 5
9.2.7 Centrifugal Forces 5
9.2.8 Vehicle Collision Loads 6
9.2.9 Vibration and Deflection Control 6
9.2.10 Fatigue 6
9.2.11 Thermal, Wind, Snow, Shrinkage, Creep Loading Considerations 6
9.2.12 Related Structural Considerations 6
9.2.13 Inspection and Maintenance Manual 7
9.3 BUILDINGS 8
9.3.1 Loads and Forces 8
9.3.2 Related Structural Considerations for Type II and Type III LRT Stations 8
9.4 RETAINING STRUCTURES 8
9.4.1 Loads and Forces and Related Considerations 8
9.5 EARTH EMBANKMENTS 9
9.6 NOISE ATTENUATION WALL 9
9.7 UNDERGROUND STRUCTURES 9
9.7.1 General 9
9.7.2 Type I Stations 10
9.7.3 Tunnels 10
9.7.4 Shafts and Cross-Connections 12
9.7.5 Cut and Cover 13
9.7.6 Portals 14
9.7.7 Temporary Live Loads 15
9.8 POTENTIAL IMPACTS ON STRUCTURES AND FACILITIES 15
9.8.1 Support General Requirements 15
9.8.2 Support Methods 16
9.9 STRUCTURAL REQUIREMENTS FOR CONSTRUCTING LRT TRACKS
OVER EXISTING UNDERGROUND STRUCTURES 17
9.10 PRIVATE DEVELOPMENT OVER EXISTING LRT UNDERGROUND
STRUCTURES 17
9.0 STRUCTURES
9.1 GENERAL
9.1.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the basic structural design guidelines, codes and standards references
that must be followed throughout the structural design process of LRT facilities. The various
types of structures that are generally incorporated as part of an LRT project, loading
conditions and their expected service life are discussed.
There may be cases where special design requirements are encountered not specifically
covered by these guidelines. In these instances the Consultant must seek appropriate
guidance on the design parameters from ETS.
9.1.2 Applicable Codes, Standards, Practices and Reference Guidelines
Codes and Standards
The structural design must conform to the most current edition of all applicable design codes
and standards documents as follows:
American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials (AASHTO)
American Concrete Institute (ACI)
Alberta Building Code (ABC)
American Railway Engineering & Maintenance of Way Association (AREMA)
Canadian Standards Association (CSA)
CSA S6 Package - Canadian Highway Design Code and
- Canadian Highway Bridge Design Code (CHBDC)
CSA A23.3 - Design of Concrete Structures
National Building Code of Canada (NBCC)
Design References
A number of the Edmonton design guidelines have been adopted from the design references
listed below. The Consultant should refer to these documents for additional information where
required.
Design Guideline for the Thermal Interactive Forces between Continuously Welded
Rail and the NJ TRANSIT LRT Aerial Structures – Parsons Brinckerhoff
Quade & Douglas, July 1995
Thermal Interaction between Continuously Welded Rail and Elevated Transit
Guideways – Hid N Grouni and Chris Sadler Structural Office Ontario Ministry
of Transportation and Communications
Standard Aerial Structures: Continuous Welded Rail/Aerial Structure Interactive
Behavior Report for Dallas Area Rapid Transit – Parsons Brinckerhoff Centec
Inc., and Deleuw Cather and Company, June 1988
Continuous Welded Rail Aerial Transit Structure Interactive Analysis – American
Transit Consultants September 1990
Practices
The document listed below provides the Designer with the guidelines and process for approval
and installation of planned infrastructure in LRT tunnels.
LRT Infrastructure in LRT Tunnels – ETS Standard Operating Procedure (SOP)
(most recent version)
For the condition when other vehicular traffic will also be operating on the LRT structure,
highway loads must also be applied to determine the most severe loading condition to be used
in the design of the structure.
It should be noted that LRT loadings are more characteristic of highway loadings than
standard heavy railway loadings. Typically, as part of the design process, the structural
designer will also apply the standard highway design loads to determine the most severe
loading condition. If the highway loading creates the most severe condition (as compared to
LRT loadings) the Consultant must first seek approval from ETS to use the highway loading as
the design basis.
Where tie and ballast track is used, the ballast shoulder must be retained by a curb or
equivalent structure. Drainage for the ballast must also be provided.
An allowance for walkways/refuge area must be incorporated into the design for the safety of
operations and maintenance personnel, and evacuated LRT passengers during emergency
situations (refer to Chapter 3 Clearances and Right-of-Way). A barrier rail mounted on a
parapet must be constructed on the outside edges of the bridge structure.
The design of the superstructure must meet the requirements of CAN/CSA S-6 for static
deflection due to live loading for bridges designated “with sidewalks for occasional pedestrian
use”. The deflection due to live load plus impact on members must not exceed 1/800 of span
for beams and for cantilever span the deflection should not exceed 1/300.
In addition to the forgoing the following must also be evaluated:
The vibration characteristics of the structure to determine that there is no danger of
resonance and to ensure compatibility with the structural design (refer to previous Section
9.2.9).
The dynamic loading imposed on the track and structure of a fully loaded vehicle coming
to a full emergency stop with all brakes on the LRV operative.
The fatigue conditions of the structure to satisfy the serviceability and durability
requirements (refer to previous Section 9.2.10).
The use of epoxy-coated reinforcement, cathodic protection, or other methods, for
reinforced structural elements that are susceptible to deterioration from corrosion.
The effects of significant air pressure differentials in the design of plenum walls.
All structures must be designed to minimize maintenance requirements. The following factors
should be taken into consideration during the design process:
Method of snow removal
Track maintenance requirements
Traction power and signal system requirements
The control of storm water run-off and its disposal
Corrosion protection measures
The following structural elements are to be included but are not necessarily limited to:
Deck
Girders
Expansion Joints
Bearing Units
Piers and/or columns
Abutments
Special protective measures if the piers or foundations are founded in water.
Connections
Members susceptible to cracking or deformation
The design must ensure that the critical elements of the structure are accessible for
inspection, maintenance and/or repair.
The draft manual will form a key component of the standard O & M Manual prepared by the
Contractor for the structure. (Refer to Chapter 1 General Section 1.7.2.1).
There is a need for the City’s Inspectors to understand the structural behavior of bridge
structure being designed. Additional instruction/training is to be provided by the Designer to
the City Inspectors, if deemed necessary.
9.3 BUILDINGS
9.3.1 Loads and Forces
Building structures must be designed to sustain the maximum dead and live loads that they
may be subjected to. This includes any erection loads that may occur during construction.
The loadings must conform to the requirements of the most current edition of ABC, where
applicable.
Refer to Chapter 19 Parkades, Section 19.3.7.2 for the live load conditions to be analyzed for
above grade parkade structures.
9.3.2 Related Structural Considerations for Type II and Type III LRT Stations
The platforms of Type II and Type III stations are constructed at grade. They are described in
Chapter 10 Stations and Ancillary Facilities. For the station platform height and edge
clearance dimensions, the Consultant should refer to Chapter 3 Clearances and Right-of-Way,
Section 3.3.4.3 and the applicable figures contained therein.
To avoid the possibility of resonant vibrations induced by pedestrian traffic, the natural
frequency of the unloaded structure must not be less than 2.0 cycles per second. To avoid
vibrations that might be objectionable to patrons, the calculated live load deflection must be
limited to 25 mm maximum.
The structures supporting elevators and escalators must be designed for the maximum dead
and live load capacity provided by the conveyance manufacturers.
For better control of shrinkage stresses and to minimize cracking in monolithically poured
concrete slabs and walls in the long linear platform structure, contraction joints must be
provided at spacing not exceeding 15 m. The reinforcing steel must be designed to handle
the calculated stresses.
9.4 RETAINING STRUCTURES
9.4.1 Loads and Forces and Related Considerations
Retaining walls must be designed to withstand earth and hydrostatic pressures, including any
live load surcharge and the dead weight of the wall. The geotechnical consultant must provide
the structural consultant with the soil parameters for determining the lateral earth pressure.
For retaining structures constructed immediately adjacent to the LRT trackway, the Consultant
must determine if the structure is within the soil pressure influence zone due to the LRV
loading. If applicable, use 20 kPa as the surcharge loading for the design of the retaining
structure
Any adjacent surface elements (such as traction power mast supports) that may exert a
surcharge loading on the retaining structure must also be considered.
Retaining walls constructed adjacent to the LRT track bed for the purpose of retaining fill or
cut slopes are to be designed in accordance with the soil parameters recommended by the
geotechnical consultant (refer to Figures 3.14 and 3.15).
When “Limit States Design Methods” are used for proportioning wall sections, the lateral earth
pressure load factor to be used is 1.5.
A drainage layer must be provided behind the wall to mitigate the build-up of hydrostatic
pressure. Both the water pressure and the lateral soil pressure must be considered in the
design.
The design / installation of proprietary support systems such as Reinforced Earth and
Mechanically Stabilized Walls, etc. must be reviewed and approved by ETS.
The retaining wall design should include consideration of appropriate wall face treatments for
aesthetics purposes. The top of the wall must be fenced to ensure public safety.
9.5 EARTH EMBANKMENTS
The surface of the embankment must be designed for erosion protection. Surface run-off
must be properly intercepted by a drainage system. The Consultant should refer the
embankment design criteria of AASHTO for further guidance.
9.6 NOISE ATTENUATION WALL
For at-grade sections of the LRT adjacent to existing or future noise sensitive receivers, such
as residential and institutional properties, etc., a noise wall or barrier may be required to
attenuate the noise created by the passage of the LRT trains.
Setback and spatial requirements for the wall structural elements must be considered in the
design. Refer to Chapter 3 Clearances and Right-of-Way, and the figures contained therein,
and Chapter 14 Impact Mitigation, Aesthetics and ROW, Section 14.2.
The noise wall design loadings must conform to the latest requirements of the applicable
codes and standards set out in Section 9.1.2
9.7 UNDERGROUND STRUCTURES
9.7.1 General
The Consultant will recommend to ETS the vertical and horizontal load combinations to be
considered in the design of underground structures. The design must minimize settlement or
soil uplift adjacent to the structures.
The degree of flotation at locations where a high water table is encountered must be checked.
The structure is to be designed so that the net downward load at all stages of construction or
operation is always exceeding the calculated uplift due to buoyancy by 10%.
The structural design consultant must use the specified LRV loadings, earth pressure,
hydrostatic pressure, overburden soil and surcharge and live loadings as required by
CAN/CSA S-6 and other applicable codes.
To confirm the basis for design instrumentation must be provided on all new tunnel
construction.
Waterproofing/Corrosion Protection
In general all tunnels, underground shafts and cavities should be sealed to prevent water
ingress and full water pressure head from occurring around the opening periphery. The
design measures should include a durable structural lining and the provision of a membrane
or other effective waterproofing system. Other measures such as the provision of channels to
intercept water seepage may also be considered if total water tightness is problematic and
cost prohibitive.
The design of the liner should include the provision of measures to prevent corrosion and
eliminate stray currents (refer to Chapter 13 Corrosion and Stray Current Control).
9.7.4 Shafts and Cross-Connections
9.7.4.1 Loads and Forces
Shaft and cross-connection linings must be designed to sustain all the overburden soil and live
loads and hydrostatic pressure with minimum Factor of Safety of 2.
Shafts inclined more than 45 degrees from the vertical must be designed on the basis of the
tunnel design pressure.
To promote water-tightness and structural integrity, joints that allow movement (construction,
expansion, contraction) should be carefully designed and located. At *locations where there
are major changes in the structure section, a construction joint should be provided.
*Note: Examples are - connecting a cut and cover structure to a station structure, or connecting a cut
and cover structure to an open cut structure.
Where a box section meets a station section, the connection should be designed either to
absorb any differential movements or to transmit the forces that may occur under any design
conditions. Again achieving water-tightness is of utmost importance.
To control shrinkage stresses, and thus minimize cracking, cast-in-place monolithically poured
concrete slabs and walls contraction joints should be provided at a maximum spacing of 15 m.
Construction joints must have reinforcing steel continuous across the joint, keys, roughened
surfaces, or other positive means of shear transfer in all exterior structural elements in contact
with soil or rock. Non-metallic water stops must be provided at the construction joint.
Temperature and shrinkage reinforcement must be installed continuously in all walls and slabs
of these underground structures.
Membrane waterproofing or similar approved systems should be provided over entire cut and
cover structures. Refer to Section 9.7.3.3 for other seepage control considerations. All
boundary condition details, such as flashing and laps must be carefully designed.
9.7.6 Portals
Tunnels and box section entrance portals must be designed in a manner that minimizes the
rate-of-change of pressure on an LRT train as it passes through the portal. The pressure rise
is a function of both the cross-sectional area of the portal entrance and the entrance speed of
the train. The higher the train speed the higher the pressure on the train. The length of the
transitional section also has to be factored in.
There are several acceptable approaches available for the design of the transition to the portal
as follows:
Flared Transition
The increase in cross-sectional area approximates the cross-section of a 6 degree conical
flare starting at the constant area section of the tunnel or box interface (portal end) and
extending through to the portal opening.
Tapered Slot
In this configuration, the top and vertical sides of the portal structure are designed without a
flare. A tapered slot is provided in the ceiling of the portal.
In general, the following conditions do not require special transition portal sections:
Tunnels less than 61 m in length
Portals at underground stations
Single track SEM tunnels with an LRT train design speed of 72 km/h or lower
Box sections and single track circular tunnels with an LRT train design speed of 64 km/h
or lower
Remedial support measures for adjacent buildings may be required when the following
conditions are evident:
The building extends significantly over the proposed LRT structure and must be
temporarily supported during construction and then is permanently underpinned.
The building is immediately adjacent to the LRT structure and requires underpinning. This
in turns acts as a retention structure for the sides of the LTR structure excavation.
The lowering of the ground water may cause settlement of buildings both adjacent to, or
some distance away from the cut and cover or tunneled excavation.
Historical or other sensitive buildings that are in close proximity and it has been deemed
necessary that temporary and / or permanent support measures are required.
9.8.2 Support Methods
Methods used to protect existing buildings or structures are influenced by local soil conditions
and the construction method to be utilized for the LRT structure. The geotechnical consultant
must be consulted and provide advice on the selection of the most appropriate method.
The typical support measures that are generally considered are described in the following
sections.
9.8.2.1 Piles
Piles used in the underpinning of building foundations, should, in general, extend below a
sloped line drawn from the side of the excavation at a point 1.0 m below sub-grade elevation
to the intersection with the vertical projection of the underpinned building foundation, or to
sound bearing material, whichever is greater. The slope of this line must be determined in
consultation with the geotechnical consultant.
9.8.2.2 Excavation Support
Under some soil conditions, the support system installed for the excavation will be sufficient to
protect light-weight structures.
Under heavier loading conditions the following methods may be considered as alternatives to
underpinning or to avoid settlement if dewatering is required:
Reinforced concrete cut-off wall, constructed in short clay-slurry-filled (slurry wall)
trenches.
Bored pile sections (tangent or secant pile walls) braced with preloaded struts
9.8.2.3 Bracing
A tight bracing system is required to minimize any movement of the temporary support. The
Consultant must indicate any special requirements and procedures for the installation and
removal of the support system.
9.8.2.4 Soil Stabilization
In general, the application of techniques such as freezing and chemical injection for the
stabilization of soil under buildings should be subject to a detailed analysis. Proposed
solutions using this technique must be reviewed with the geotechnical consultant. If the
proposed technique is considered to be a viable cost-effective solution, approval for its
implementation must first be obtained from ETS prior to the commencement of final design.
The Developer, and their consultants, are to familiarize themselves with the existing LRT
structure and services by conducting a thorough review of existing record drawings (where
available), including carrying out a non-destructive inspection as necessary. Responsibility for
verifying the existing information remains with the Developer and their consultants.
Specifically, a qualified registered professional engineer, retained by the Developer, must
carry out an analysis of the site that identifies the following:
Increases in the structural loading on the existing LRT structure and measures that are
required to support the additional loads.
Vibration impacts that may be detrimental to the existing facility or its operation and how
they can be mitigated.
Impacts that negatively affect the thermal or moisture resistance of the existing facility and
associated remedial measures that are required.
Impact on both LRT related buried utility services and other utility lines that may be in
close proximity to the structure.
Other factors that could affect the operations of the existing LRT facility in any other
manner.
In addition, the Developer is responsible for identifying the measures that are required to
ensure that the proposed development will not be affected by LRT operations (i.e. train
vibration, etc.) within the existing LRT facility.
All of these activities must be carried out in accordance with the latest applicable codes,
standards and regulations including the Alberta Building Code.
The Developer is responsible for providing drawings and related engineering and test results
to the City for the City’s review. All costs associated with the preparation of the forgoing
documents will be the Developer’s responsibility.
ETS, on behalf of the City, reserves the right to accept or reject the proposal of the developer.
The City may retain services of a qualified third party to undertake an independent
assessment to assist in making its decision. The costs of third party services would be borne
by the City.
If the development proposal is acceptable, the City will require the Developer to enter into a
Development Agreement specifying all terms and conditions pertaining to the proposal.
9.11 PRIVATE DEVELOPMENT UNDER EXISTING LRT TRACKS
Refer to the Design Guidelines given in Section 9.10. For the most part they are applicable to
this scenario as well.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
List of Figures
Figure 10.1 – Stair Detail
Figure 10.2 – Escalator Guard
Figure 10.3 – Platform Tactile Warning Strip
Figure 10.4 – Ticket Vending Machine
Figure 10.5 – Fare Validator Stand
Figure 10.6 – Ticket Vending Machine Anchoring Detail
Figure 10.7 – Bike Stand
Figure 10.8 – Typical Clock Tower
Figure 10.9 – Typical Information Panel Layout
Figure 10.10 – Garbage / Recycling Receptacle
Appendices
Appendix I – Basics for Platform Widths
Appendix I – Electrical/Mechanical Service Room Sizes
Appendix I – Risk Assessment Criteria for Placement of Garbage / Recycling
Receptacles
10.1 GENERAL
10.1.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the specific guidelines, and criteria that are needed by consultants to
carry out the preliminary and final design of the many components and elements of LRT
stations and other building-type structures on Edmonton’s LRT system.
Note: The standardization of elements and station identity are two important elements related to station
design. Design consultants are requested to inspect existing LRT stations to acquaint themselves with
these elements.
The emphasis placed in previous editions of the LRT guidelines was the presentation of
design guidelines and criteria for underground tunnels and complex underground and surface
stations.
For the foreseeable future, LRT extensions will be more “urban-style” in nature, as they will be
constructed on surface, beside, or within the medians of arterial roadways and adjacent to
established residential, commercial and institutional communities. Stations will be required to
be more “neighborhood” friendly with special attention placed on their careful integration into
adjacent communities. This edition of the Guidelines incorporates the design variances
approved and issues dealt with during the design phase of the NLRT extension to NAIT.
The following major topics are included in this chapter:
Applicable Codes, Standards and Related Guidelines
Definitions
Design Principles
Site, Access and Circulation
Structures and Shelters
Fare Collection Equipment
Station Amenities and Furniture Branding
Signage and Branding
Advertising
Materials and Finishes
For the details of the station electrical, mechanical and communication components the
Consultant should refer to the appropriate chapters in the Guidelines covering these topics as
indicated later in this chapter.
Other documents providing design guidelines and criteria, and standards for specific
components such as signage and graphics, transit centres etc. are also available for reference
during the engineering and design phase.
All disciplines are required to closely coordinate their design activities with each other to
ensure that the many different station elements are properly interfaced.
Loading zones at outlying stations must be provided for DATS and private vehicles
transporting persons with disabilities. The zones are to be located in close proximity to
the transit facility so that safe and convenient access is provided.
To limit potential liability due to possible increase in the potential for pedestrian accidents,
Park and Ride lots should not be separated from Stations by major roadways.
Access to transit centres should be controlled in such a manner as to prevent private
vehicular traffic from entering the bus transit operating areas.
The pedestrians' walk between access nodes and the station platform should be direct,
safe, convenient and as short as possible.
10.2.3 Accessibility
The application of design guidelines and criteria, standards and practices must
accommodate the needs of persons with physical, sensory, and mental disabilities.
Stations, and their approaches, must facilitate the barrier-free movement of passengers to
and from the LRV and other transportation modes in the most convenient and cost
effective manner possible.
A minimum of three (3) designated barrier-free parking spaces for the first 100 parking
stalls for self-drive persons with disabilities is to be provided at each Park and Ride lot. To
provide safe and convenient access, these stalls should be located in close proximity to
the station.
The Consultant should be proactive in the application of barrier-free standards to address
the accessibility concerns of persons with physical, sensory and mental disabilities and
should not wait for changes to the Building Codes.
The Advisory Board on Services for Persons with Disabilities must review station
preliminary and final design plans as they are developed
Refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility, for accessibility and barrier-free design guidelines and
criteria.
10.2.6 Architectural
The architectural concept of stations should reflect the attributes of simplicity, economy,
functionality, aesthetics, marketability, service-ability and safety and blend in with the local
styles of the adjacent community.
Create a civic architecture that is permanent, functional, has character and is pleasant, yet
maintains the *LRT system identity and overall line recognition.
*Note: ETS branding policy requires that standard signage and identification methods must be
used. Refer to Section 10.7.
Develop a family of station parts and amenities that are interchangeable but also allows
for the retention of the individual character of each neighborhood.
Provide an architectural and urban design framework that defines and encourages joint
development opportunities.
Materials used for station components and elements should be durable, easy to maintain
and should minimize life cycle maintenance costs.
Protect passengers from adverse weather conditions.
Protect passengers from conflicts with vehicular traffic.
Provide patron seating at shelters and other protected locations on the platform.
10.2.7 Lighting
The lighting colour spectrum should be as close to natural light as possible to bring out the
true colour of objects.
Lighting should be constant, uniform, and diffused. Glare should be minimized.
Lighting, particularly interior lighting, should be instant on to enable immediate recovery
after a power outage.
The lighting design must promote safety by identifying and properly illuminating areas and
elements of potential hazard.
Pedestrian access lighting should provide well-defined walkways, crosswalks, ramps,
stairs, and bridge corridors.
Platform edges, shelters, seating areas, fare collection equipment areas, ramps and
stairs, LRT and bus loading areas, pedestrian walkways and crossings, parking areas and
wayfinding signage must be appropriately illuminated.
Light trespass into adjacent neighborhoods areas should be minimized.
Light fixtures and standards should be incorporated into the architectural elements of the
stations as much as possible.
Design Guidelines for Lighting and recommended illumination levels are presented in Chapter
11, Electrical Systems Section 11.10.
10.2.8 Artwork
Artwork is to be incorporated into eligible public areas of LRT facilities in accordance with
the City’s Percent for Art Policy.
Artwork Guidelines are presented in Section 10.6.1.
10.2.9 Landscaping
Landscaping is to be in accordance with the LRT Planning Principles, meet the
requirements of the City of Edmonton Zoning By-law 12800. Locate trees and shrubs so
sightlines are not obscured or hiding places created.
Relocate trees and shrubs when practicable to do so. If they cannot be relocated, the
replacement value of the trees and shrubs must be borne by the LRT project budget.
Landscape Guidelines are presented in Chapter 14, Impact Mitigation, Aesthetics and ROW
Control, Section 14.3.
Accessibility. ETS has also developed additional requirements that must be considered.
These requirements are:
The provision of well lit, distinguishable, barrier-free walks and pathways
At least one barrier-free entrance provided at every station
Stations should strive for the same general layout features to permit patron familiarity
To access the station platform, persons with disabilities must be provided with the
following facilities:
o Ramps for Type II and III stations in accordance with guidelines in Section
10.3.4.1
o Elevators for Type I and Type II stations
In addition to the forgoing, the following features will be provided on the platform:
Audio train arrival announcements
TTY phone on platform of Type III station. TTY phone at concourse level of Type I and II
stations. All phones to be of low level height.
Low level Public Pay Phone(s) with variable volume level control.
Designated wheel chair stalls are required in platform shelters (the number of stalls to be
confirmed by ETS)
Platform / shelter seating to be provided with arm rests
Exits may converge in fire-protected corridors or zones provided that the units of exit width are
maintained for each occupancy (i.e. units are accumulated at merged exits). Due to design
limitations imposed on an underground structure, ideal locations for exits at street level on City
owned property are not always available.
In cases where exit routes are in or on private property, the following criteria must be
observed:
Agreements must be entered into between the property owner and the City.
Exit rights are required to be maintained at all times during station or underground
commercial operating hours.
In the event that re-development takes place, temporary exits must be provided pending
availability of permanent exits in the new facility.
Exit rights and agreements cannot expire on change of land or building ownership.
Appropriate cost sharing agreements will be established.
All agreements affecting the ABC requirements are to be irrevocable.
Security must be maintained for both the station premises and the privately owned
property.
The ABC must not be violated by any changes to structure location, mechanical and electrical
systems, etc.
10.3.4 Vertical Circulation
This section provides the basic guidelines for vertical circulation conditions relating to
passenger access to and from stations and to LRT trains. Each station will have specific
vertical circulation requirements based on station type, access requirements and grades
established as part of the overall site plan.
Access to stations and ancillary facilities is required to be barrier-free through the use of both
ramps and stairs.
The location of ramps and stair entrances are a function of surface street geometry, land use
requirements, ownership, access traffic needs and station external and internal integration
requirements.
10.3.4.1 Ramps
Generally, for Type lll stations, only ramp access is required at both ends of the platform for
public access. If space permits, also provide a stairway from the platform to ground level next
to the ramp.
Ramps should meet the following general requirements:
Provide a non-skid surface and a maximum 1:16 slope
Intermediate landings, or rest areas, a minimum of 1200 mm in length, are to be provided
every 9 m of ramp length. The Consultant must fully justify the deletion of the rest area
where the ramp slope is flatter than 1:20.
Changes in ramp grades are to be minimized.
A handrail is to be provided on both sides of ramp 860 mm 60 above ramp finished
surface. A bottom rail, no more than 75mm above finished floor height, is to be provided
to prevent a person’s foot from getting caught between the railing and post. Curbs are not
acceptable in cases where snow removal is required.
The minimum clear distance between the handrails must be 1.5 m to allow for the passing
of two wheelchairs. Motorized snow removal equipment accessing the ramps is 53.3 cm
in width.
Covered ramps are preferred. The provision of heated ramps will be evaluated on an
individual ramp basis for each station.
A grated drainable catchment basin is to be provided at the base of the ramp to trap grit, water
and snow. The Consultant should give consideration to the installation of engineered
prefabricated drain systems.
Standard of Acceptance: Polydrain ABT Inc.
ZURN Industries Inc.
For additional specific barrier-free requirements refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility and the
Alberta Barrier – Free Design Guidelines.
10.3.4.2 Stairs
The preferred rise / run dimensions for both interior and exterior stairways on the Edmonton
LRT System is 165 mm x 305 mm (including nosing) (refer to Figure 10.1 for stairway details).
For additional accessibility features refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility, Section 15.3.2.2.
In addition to ensuring that the applicable code requirements are met the following criteria is to
be incorporated into the interior and exterior stairway design.
Open risers are not permitted.
Continuous railings are to be provided on both sides of the stairs.
Stairs adjacent to an escalator must be parallel to the angle of inclination of the escalator
and sized to have landings at a common level.
A 100 mm wide sweep or cleaning trough on both sides of interior stairways is considered to
be a desirable feature for ease of cleaning.
The design of exterior stairway landing levels should include a grated drainable catchment
basin to trap grit, water and snow. The Consultant should give consideration to the installation
of engineered prefabricated drain systems.
Standard of Acceptance: Polydrain ABT Inc.
ZURN Industries Inc.
10.3.4.3 Railings
Railings on interior stairs should be stainless steel.
Interior stair railings should be 30 mm to 40 mm in diameter.
Railings are required at the platform ends. They should be set back a minimum of 300
mm from the edge of the platform
Vertical railing supports are to be welded flush to preinstalled embedded anchor plates.
It is preferred that exterior stair and ramp railings be galvanized. Other coatings are
acceptable as long as they are maintenance free.
For additional specific requirements refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility, Sections 15.3.2.1 and
15.3.2.3.
10.3.4.4 Escalators
Consideration to be given to operating environment and maintainability – entrance grating,
parts storage area, proximity to exterior doorways.
In general the incorporation of escalators into the design of stations with centre loading
platforms is to be based on the following:
Type I Stations
The minimum requirements are:
Two escalators from platform to concourse level
At least one escalator from concourse to street level
The width of passageways for public use will be determined by the calculation of the exiting
requirements. The minimal acceptable width of passageways for non-public use is 900 mm.
For some Type I and Type II station configurations it may be appropriate to consider heating
of public passageways. Also consider heating of non-public corridors accessing service areas
(refer to Chapter 12, Mechanical Systems, Section 12.5).
Public- Use Pedways (Overpass / Underpass)
The absolute minimum width is 4000 mm.
The minimum clear height should not be less than 2800 mm, excluding fixtures such as
lights, directional signage and other required installations.
LRT and pedway overpasses and underpasses must be sufficiently sloped towards drains
or the outdoors so that standing water does not occur.
10.4.1 Platform
The platform is the key main component of a station. Restrictions to the location of platforms
are governed by the station location as discussed in Section 10.3.1.
Platforms can contain a variety of elements such as passenger shelters, service rooms, fare
collection area and equipment, mobility impaired access equipment (elevators), information
signage and graphics, patron amenities etc.
10.4.1.2 Length
In general, the platform length is to be 123 m. This length is based on 5 car trains operating on
the system in the future. All Type I stations are to be constructed to their ultimate length of
123 m.
If staged, Type II and Type III platforms will be a minimum of 100 m long (to accommodate 4
car trains) with provision made for expansion to the 123 m ultimate length. Whether the
platform is to be staged or not will be determined during the preliminary engineering phase of
the development of the LRT alignment.
10.4.1.3 Width
The platform width (centre loading) will normally be 8.0 to 9.0 m. Reduced platform widths for
Type III stations may be allowed through the provision of ramps at both ends of the platform
and / or more flexible interpretations of the ABC code interpretations.
For information, the basis for the establishment of the platform widths and existing platform
widths on the Edmonton LRT system is provided in Appendix I.
Factors to Consider When Establishing the Width of Future Centre and Side Loading
Platforms
A tactile warning zone 915 mm wide is to be provided at the platform edge (refer to
Section 10.4.1.6 and Figure 10.3).
A desirable minimum 2500 mm of clear space should be provided between the edge of
the platform and obstructions such as equipment, stairs, escalators, railings, and
structural columns. The absolute minimum clearance is 1700 mm (refer to Figure 3.9).
For centre loading configuration shelters, equipment and amenities are to be placed in the
centre portion of the platform.
For side loading configurations shelters, equipment and amenities are to be placed
adjacent to the back wall.
Egress / Exiting Requirements (refer to Section 10.3.3.2)
Stair widths are products of multiples of standard 550 mm units of exit as per the ABC and
escalators are built in standard widths.
Based on the forgoing (For Type I):
Centre loading platforms require a minimum of two exits (5.5 units of exit each x 2 = 11
units of exit)
5.5 units x 550 is equivalent to 3.025 m of width at each end
Each side loading platform requires a minimum of two exits into each or a total of four
exits (3 units x 4 = 12 units of exit)
3 units x 550 mm is equivalent to 1650 mm x 2 = 3.3 m of width each side
10.4.1.4 Platform Height
To handle passenger boarding and alighting from Edmonton’s high-level loading SD LRV’s the
finished platform height above top of rail for all station Types must be -890 mm +5/-15 mm
(refer to Figure 3.9)
10.4.1.5 Platform Drainage
For Type I stations the platform finished surface cross-slope can be flat. The longitudinal
grade will be the same as the track grade (refer to Chapter 4 Track Alignment Section
4.3.2.2).
For Type II and Type III stations the platform finish surface should be crowned at the center,
sloping at a minimum of 2.0% grade to the outer edges allowing water to runoff onto the
trackway.
Floor colour and texture must be different from the flooring in the areas approaching the
platform.
A tactile warning strip providing a minimum width of 915 mm and comprised of ADA
compliant truncated dome detectable warning surface is to be placed along the trackside
edge of the platform.
Measured from the edge of platform the warning strip consists of: 300 mm unglazed anti-slip
ribbed edge tile; 600 mm ceramic warning tile with a raised dot profile (refer to Figure 10.3).
Standard of Acceptance: Station Stop Ceramiche Caesar
Detailed finish guidelines for platform floors and other floor areas are provided in Section
10.11.4.1
For additional visibility at the platform edge provide the following:
Lighting fixtures installed at the ceiling or underside of the roof structure casting
continuous lighting on the platform edge warning strip is a requirement for Type I and
Type ll stations.
For Type III stations platform lighting requirements will be evaluated on a station to station
basis.
The use of tube-type lighting is not permitted.
For Type III stations (no roof over the trackway) (refer to Figure 3.23) the minimum distance
from top of rail to the underside of the catenary contact wire support is 4800 mm.
10.4.1.9 Trackway Drainage
In Type II and Type III stations, perforated drainage pipe is to be installed on the outside of the
track along the inside of the station wall or ballast curb to divert water runoff from the platform
away from the station footprint (refer to Chapter 12 Mechanical Systems, Section 12.7).
10.4.1.10 Service Outlets
Service outlets required for power, water, and vacuum systems are as follows:
Electrical – provide 15 A/120 V split receptacles at 20 m intervals under both sides of the
platform overhang.
Electrical – provide 15 A/120 V split receptacles at all landings of stairs and escalators.
Electrical – provide twist lock receptacles at locations that are accessible by the public.
Vacuum outlets (galvanized steel) - provide at 20 m spacing under both sides of the
platform overhang (refer to Chapter 12 Mechanical Systems, Section 12.3.1.9 and Figure
12.1).
Water Hose Bibs – provide one (1) tamper proof hose bib near the center of the platform
in Type II and III stations only. If the central location is not feasible, provide a bib at both
ends of the platform.
10.4.1.11 Service/Maintenance Personnel Access Requirements
A minimum of two (2) parking stalls for City operations and maintenance service vehicles are
required at each station in close proximity to a station entrance. Refer to Section 10.4.4.4 for
parking requirements when staff is housed at a station.
Stairway access from the platform to track level must be provided at each end of the platform
for Type I and II stations. For Type I stations, concrete steps should be used. Steel ladder
rung steps should be provided on Type II stations. Ramps for emergency egress by the public
also may be provided. To discourage general use by the public, access must be secured by a
gated barrier. A gate at the platform centre is preferred rather than a swinging gate at the
edge.
10.4.1.12 Platform Crawl Space
The underside of the platform for all station types must be designed to provide an accessible
crawl space for inspection/maintenance purposes. A hatch or doorway at track level is the
preferred access method. The provision of a man-hole type access from the platform finish
surface should be avoided. Lighting adequate for routine maintenance and inspections along
with adequate ventilation must also be provided.
Additional requirements include:
The provision of drains to intercept any penetrating water
The placement of a minimal lift (50 mm approx.) of concrete on any exposed soil within
the basement area to reduce the potential for mould formation.
10.4.1.13 Platform Basement Level
Space limitations on the platform level of Type ll and lll stations may require the examination
of providing a basement to house some or all of the service areas that are required. The
placement of electrical and communication rooms in a basement is not acceptable unless
assurance can be provided by the Designer that water will not be able to enter those areas.
All other options must be fully evaluated (economically and functionally) and compared to this
configuration during preliminary engineering. If a basement is to be provided, only stairway
access is required for Type lll stations. Elevator access may also be a means of access if
included in the design of a Type ll station.
10.4.2 Roofs
Roof structures will be different for each station type as follows:
10.4.2.1 Type I Stations
All existing underground stations are constructed under existing roadways. The station roofs
must be designed to carry the road slab above.
Special waterproofing measures (membranes etc) must be designed and incorporated into the
roof elements to prevent water leakage into the underground station from damaging structural
and finish components (refer Section 10.12.1)
The Consultant must evaluate the need for a designed roof access system (refer to Section
10.4.2.4).
10.4.2.4 Fall Protection Measures
For Type II and Type III roof structures that require ongoing cleaning and inspection for
maintenance purposes the Consultant must consider the incorporation of an engineered fall
protection system, where fall protection is required.
Approved systems are available and should be reviewed by the Consultant for
applicability.
The fall protection system must be designed by a specialist consultant with proven
expertise in the design of fall protection systems.
Convenient and safe access measures and devices, including the provision of a roof
access hatch for service personnel must be considered in the design.
10.4.3 Sheltered Enclosures
10.4.3.1 Entranceways
Sheltered entranceways should be designed to reflect existing adjacent development yet still
maintain the Edmonton LRT system identity. The design should take into account the following
requirements:
Be clearly identified with appropriate signage.
Floors in Type I and II stations must be sloped towards the street to prevent the entry of
water from the outside sidewalk.
Runoff water from roofs must be directed away from the station entry sidewalk to prevent
ice build-up and slippery conditions.
For situations where down-ramps or stairways end near a below grade entranceway
drains must be installed in front of the entranceway doors (refer to Section 10.3.4.1 for
acceptable drainage systems.
Type I and Type II station entranceways must be equipped with lockable self-closing
doors to provide security and prevent the entry of rain and snow.
Overhead electric infrared, gas space heaters, steam or hot water piping and forced air
are acceptable heating methods for Type I and Type II station entranceways.
Incorporate the provisions of the Alberta Barrier-Free Design Guide.
In addition to the forgoing refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility, Section 15.3.2.6 for additional
accessibility features.
For the construction of Type I, or below grade Type II and III entranceways, techniques must
be utilized that will prevent structural damage due to the penetration of ground water.
Specifically these techniques should:
Minimize differential settlements between the entranceway and the station substructures.
Maintain the integrity of the waterproofing membrane between the two substructures.
10.4.3.2 Shelters on Platforms
Sheltered enclosures, preferably with roofs, to protect waiting patrons from wind, rain and
snow must be provided on all Type lll station platforms. Shelters or vestibules may also be
required on Type ll “enclosed” platforms.
The number of shelters to be provided and their size will be dependent on the following
factors:
Degree of overhead protection.
Orientation of the platform to prevailing winds.
Whether the station is adjacent to a Transit Centre and whether the Transit Centre is
designed to accommodate High Speed Transit or regular bus transit.
Projected Transit Centre passenger loadings.
Whether the platform is staged (i.e. to be expanded to a full 5-car length at a later date).
Area required for signage, fare equipment and communication devices.
Amount of interior bench seating including the provision of spaces for persons in
wheelchairs required.
Bench seating should also to be placed in open platform areas subject to space
availability. Further details on benches are provided in Section 10.6.5.1.
The following features must be considered in the design development:
Heated shelters are preferred.
Both overhead electric infrared and gas heaters are acceptable as heating devices,
however gas is preferred if the shelter has no roof. If gas heaters are selected they must
have burners that will resist wind blow-out. Heaters will be automatic thermostatically
controlled by the BMS system including manual override control (refer to Chapter 8,
Communications, Section 8.3.5.16).
Consideration should also be given to the placement of heaters in other areas of the
platform waiting area particularly in the vicinity of fare equipment.
Where stairs, escalators and elevators are provided, enclosures or shelters should be
incorporated into the platform design to keep these conveyances free from intrusion from
snow, ice, rain and wind (refer to Section 10.4.2.2).
Roofed shelters should include heat traced gutters and downspouts (hidden from view)
tied into platform.
Shelter walls should be made flush with the platform (no air gap). Provision must be
made to ensure drainability (for cleaning).
10.5.1 General
The Edmonton LRT System uses a Proof of Payment fare system. The fare collection system
is comprised of ticket vending and validation equipment and a computerized data collection
and information system.
Passengers purchase tickets and passes from ticket vending machines located within the LRT
stations. Pre-purchased tickets or tickets purchased from other locations must be validated by
ticket validating machines, that are also located within the stations.
All fare collection equipment within each station is inter-connected to form a local area
network. Data is transmitted to a central computer located at the D.L. MacDonald LRT
Maintenance facility via the LRT fibre optic network. This computerized system is called the
Central Data Collection and Information System (CDCIS).
Fare enforcement is carried out by ETS Security Officers who randomly check passengers on
trains and in Station “Fare Paid Areas”. ETS Security Officers may also conduct a fare
payment check of all passengers as they exit the station platform.
All fare collection equipment is designed, tendered and installed under the direction of ETS.
ETS will provide the station consultant with final design details such as location, spatial
requirements, fastener details and power or other hook-up requirements early in the design
phase, prior to specification development.
10.5.2 Fare Equipment Types
Ticket Vending Machine (TVM)
The ticket vending machine (TVM) dispenses both tickets and passes (when purchase is
made by coins or bills). Each machine is normally ready to respond to a customer selection
when it is in the ready state. A programmable display screen and pushbuttons are provided for
the customers to complete a transaction. An ATM style display screen directs the customer
through the steps of the transaction via pushbuttons located beside the screen. The TVM
cabinet includes a lighting valence to illuminate the front of the machine.
Capable of detecting basic internal malfunctions and annunciates failures to the CDCIS
via an adjacent TVM.
Communicates with an adjacent TVM to receive clock synchronization and configuration
parameters.
Alerts customers of a malfunction by a visual out-of-service annunciator.
Ticket Validators are a readily accessible to persons with disabilities in accordance with the
ADA provisions (also refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility, Section 15.3.3.7).
Refer to Figure 10.5 for details of the stand that supports the Validator.
10.6.1 Artwork
The City of Edmonton has adopted C458C “Art in Public Places Policy” for incorporating
artwork in public areas of LRT facilities.
The Sustainable Development Department administers the Art in Public Places Program.
Through the Edmonton Arts Council, they will oversee the selection of the Artist and Artwork.
The Consultant and the Artist will coordinate their activities to ensure that the criteria and
restrictions for the placement of artwork as listed below are adhered to:
Does not adversely affect pedestrian flow patterns
Does not cause areas of concealment for people to hide behind
Does not cause the opportunity to gain access to restricted areas (i.e. do not locate in
such a manner as to allow climbing to areas not normally accessible to the public)
Does not pose a risk of injury to the public (example: sharp points, slip/fall hazard, etc.)
Does not block security camera viewing areas
Does not interfere with the effectiveness of the PA System
Does not block access to Fare Collection Equipment, Information Panels or Emergency
Phones
Must meet fire codes with respect to flammability, off-gassing, etc
Must be vandal resistant
A minimum 3050 mm clearance from the 600 V overhead catenary must be maintained
Must not be located within the dynamic clearance envelop of the LRT trains
Must not interfere with the operation and serviceability of the station
Must meet all building codes
Must not be incorporated into temporary structures, hoardings etc.
10.7.2 Branding
The objective of the ETS branding program is to enhance ETS’s corporate identity by
providing a consistent visual image as well as to enhance the total customer experience by
providing customer focused passenger comfort and convenience amenities.
Primary visual branding is achieved through the use of corporate colours in materials and
finishes, ETS logo signage and clock towers.
ETS Corporate Colours
Incorporate, where appropriate, ETS’s blue and silver corporate colours into the architectural
features of each station. The use of corporate colours however needs to be balanced with the
overall architectural treatment of each station. A primary design objective is to give each
station a unique appearance so that passengers can view them as recognizable stops, while
at the same time being recognizable as an ETS facility.
ETS Logo
Locate large scale high visibility “ETS” logo/brand signage on station exterior walls.
Preference is to be given to locations adjacent building entrance points, and large scale walls
or flat surfaces facing public approaches. Suitable locations are to be determined jointly by the
Consultant and ETS. Logo details will be provided by ETS.
All branding signage must include the following:
Anodized, chrome plated or powder coated metal lettering pinned to the building surface.
Diffused halo LED lighting placed behind the lettering.
Sign transformers and electrical access located inside the building.
Clock Tower
The installation of a clock tower in a highly visible location is required at all LRT stations.
Clock towers must utilize GPS technology and digital components for time accuracy and low
maintenance. Electrical service will be required with the controller placed in the electrical
room. Space permitting, a small scale tower should also be located on the station platform.
If a Transit Centre is located adjacent to the station, the main (large scale) clock tower must
be located on the Transit Centre island. The Consultant in conjunction with ETS will
determine the location.
The clock tower must be constructed to the approved and accepted design/engineering
standards as supplied by the City of Edmonton.
Comfort and Convenience Amenities
Customer comfort and convenience amenities as listed below are provided in LRT stations as
part of the ETS branding program. Additional amenities may be provided if proven
technologically and economically justified. Section references are noted for amenities
discussed elsewhere in these Guidelines.
Environment - Refer to Chapter 1 Section 1.1.6 Sustainable Building Policy.
Platform Roofs and Sheltered Enclosures - Refer to Sections 10.4.2 and 10.4.3 for
Platform roofs and sheltered enclosures respectively.
Platform Seating - Refer to Sections 10.6.5.1.
Public Washrooms - Refer to Section 10.4.4.5.
Transit Fare Products - Refer to Section 10.5 for current Fare Equipment technology.
Future enhancements will be made as the need dictates.
Platform Time Display – In addition to the clock tower on or adjacent to the platform, time
will be displayed digitally by Variable Message Signs (VMS) mounted overhead along the
platform. Typically six (6) signs are installed, three on each side of the platform. They are
10.10 COMMUNICATIONS
For design guidelines pertaining to the communications systems requirements for a LRT
station the consultant is directed to Chapter 8, Communications and Control.
There are a number of different phone systems that are installed in a station. Guidelines for
the various systems are provided in Section 8.15 of the Communications and Control chapter.
Several of these systems, Right-of-Way (refer to Figure 8.2), Emergency (refer to Figure 8.3),
Information (refer to Figure 10.9), and Pay Phones are all located on the platform or in other
public areas of the station.
All phones available for use by the public must meet the requirements of the Alberta Barrier-
Free Design Guide (also refer to Chapter 15, Accessibility, Sections 15.3.3.5 and 15.3.3.6)
masonry, wood and plastic and related finishes, are based on past experience derived from
previous LRT construction in Edmonton.
The quality and character of materials used and final finishes provided in the station
construction directly affects the image and long term maintenance requirements of each
facility. Simple, durable materials in small manageable sizes, with long-standing availability,
installed to facilitate easy replacement, can diminish the impact of damage and maintenance
while balancing the character and visual quality of each station.
When specifying manufactured items or materials, preference should be given to standard off-
the-shelf items available from more than one supplier, over custom-made or single-source
items.
As poorly maintained property is more prone to vandalism, material selection should be based
on minimizing repair time so that stations never appear to be under-used or unattended.
When specifying finish, size, colour, pattern or composition, slight variations in appearance
should be allowed so less costly products or materials of equal quality can be utilized.
when wet. This is particularly important at stairs, elevators, and other areas near station
entrances including platform areas.
Corrosion Resistance – because of moisture and the electrical currents involved in LRT
operations, special consideration must be given to prevention of corrosion. Non-corrosive
metals should be utilized when possible or required.
Grounding – elements deemed to be an electrical hazard must be grounded.
Compatibility – selected materials should be compatible with the Edmonton area climate
and consistent with existing materials within the station vicinity. Materials for structures
should harmonize with existing facilities on a site-specific basis.
Availability – selection of materials should permit competitive bidding and emphasize
regional products and processes over those not available locally.
Fire resistance – “flame spread” ratings must conform to the National and Alberta Building
Codes.
Finish Materials – dense, hard, nonporous materials should be used in all applications.
Finish materials should be corrosion, acid, and alkali resistant and must be compatible
with chemical compounds required for maintenance.
Detailing – detailing of finishes should avoid unnecessary surfaces which may collect dirt
and complicate cleaning. Wall surfaces must be vertical and flush allowing for texture. All
edge and finish materials should be detailed, incorporating joints and textures that reduce
the requirements for true, visually perfect installation over long distances.
Waterproofing – all finish materials in underground spaces as well as those areas
exposed to rain or snow, must be selected and detailed with proper attention to
waterproofing, cavity walls, drainage, and venting. All drainage cavities should have
cleanout provisions.
Texture – materials within reach of passengers should be easily cleaned, with a finish to
prevent or conceal scratching, soiling, and minor damage.
Graffiti – graffiti proofing products should be used to protect surfaces susceptible to
graffiti.
Exposed concrete floor surfaces not exposed to public pedestrian traffic should be steel
trowelled. Platforms and other pedestrian traffic areas with exposed concrete should be
broom finished.
All concrete surfaces should be sealed to prevent dusting. Concrete sealers must be
carefully chosen to reflect the service condition. Certain sealers used in floor joints are
susceptible to damage by cleaning machinery. Other sealers to vertical joints are
susceptible to removal by vandals and should, if possible, be concealed by cover strips.
Concrete sealers used on platforms should be a two-part acrylic or water based densifier
and finish product. The preferred product must be confirmed with Facility Maintenance
Services prior to application.
Exposed concrete floors in service, and equipment rooms, hallways and common areas
should have a non-metallic, abrasion resistant floor hardener finish.
Concrete testing will be carried out by an independent testing agency retained by the City.
10.11.2.2 Pre-cast Concrete
Pre-cast concrete components are not recommended for interior architectural finishes,
because of size and weight, and the difficulty involved in the replacement of components.
Minimum 28 day concrete compressive strength for precast elements must be not less
than 35 MPA.
Pre-cast concrete must be erected in accordance with clearly defined standards set out by
the consultant responsible for the work.
Pre-cast concrete components are only to be manufactured by a company with CSA-A25
certification.
As a minimum, the Consultant should specify the following:
o cement, aggregate reinforcing or any materials incorporated into the pre-cast
elements
o the class of finish required
o direct the successful subcontractor to present samples of the designed pre-cast
component
o dimensional tolerances clearly shown in the details
o responsibility for all caulking, sealing, grouting, and other associated operations
10.11.2.3 Masonry
Concrete block is preferred as the wall construction within service areas and rooms. If
cost justified, Spectra Glaze block can be considered as an alternate to tile in public
areas.
All masonry wall construction around heated service rooms must be cavity insulated.
The responsibility for masonry cleaning must be clearly specified.
Through-the-wall exterior masonry units must not be used.
Through-the-wall and weep flashings must be used to intercept and guide moisture to the
exterior.
The Consultant must pay particular attention to flashing requirements. The objective is to
eliminate staining due to water flowing from windowsills or other horizontal components.
The construction details of walls required as fire separations must be completely detailed
on the design drawings including gap closure details at wall perimeters and wall to ceiling
junctions.
Expansion and construction joints must be incorporated in masonry wall construction in
accordance with standard practice.
The Consultant must ensure that compressor and other noise generating rooms are
adequately soundproofed.
The same manufacturer’s brands and sources of mortar materials should be used for
entire project in order to maintain uniformity of mix and colouration.
10.11.2.4 Metals
Rugged methods of fastening such as heavy-duty Hilti type anchorages, rather than
concealment, should be used when architectural elements anchorage and bolting are
subject to rough usage and vandalism.
Galvanized metals should be used where the metals are exposed to the elements or to
water.
Stainless steel or other like materials should be used in areas where there is public
access. Some examples are washrooms and walls in elevators and exterior handrails.
The Consultant must, by specification, confirm with the Canadian Welding Bureau
(C.W.B.) that all fabricators have C.W.B. certification.
10.11.2.5 Wood
The allowable moisture content, stress grades, species, and grading of all lumbers must
be specified.
Wood must not be used in unprotected exterior areas or areas subject to exposure to wet
conditions.
Commonly available stock items should be used to the greatest degree possible.
Requirements for special exposed and concealed fixing devices and their arrangement
must be clearly detailed and specified.
The re-use of salvaged framing materials is not encouraged. This should be specified.
The placement of wood or wood glulam structural support members that is reachable by
the public should be avoided.
10.11.2.6 Architectural Wood work (including Millwork)
Architectural woodwork finishes should be low maintenance.
10.11.2.7 Plastics
Laminated plastics can be used in high maintenance areas such as washrooms and
elevators. Its use in exterior, wet, and areas prone to vandalism however, will be
discretionary.
Waterproof adhesives must be used in all locations.
10.11.2.8 Expansion Control
Surfaces of expansion joints exposed to pedestrian traffic must be provided with a non-
slip finish. Review and approval of the design by ETS is required.
10.11.3 Colour
Material colours should be in harmony with the surrounding area. Colour selection should
favor materials that are light and reflective to assist in maintaining desired illumination levels.
They should however, be of sufficient contrast and accent to provide visual interest, and
warmth and still be able to conceal minor soiling.
The use of paint, stains, and coatings should be minimized.
10.11.4 Finishes
In general, all finishes are required to meet the performance standards stated in Section
10.11.1.
For Type I stations, all architecturally finished systems must be accessible from the rear for
ease of maintenance.
10.11.4.1 Floor Finishes
General
Platform floor finish general guidelines are outlined in Section 10.4.1.6.
Flooring should be easy to maintain, age resistant, acid proof, shock resistant, slip resistant,
and able to handle high traffic loads. Slip resistance must be confirmed by field-testing a
sample panel of the tiling prior to its use being confirmed. This panel will become a reference
for acceptance of the tiles used in the installation.
Acceptable finishes or finish products for all floor areas in and immediately adjacent to all
station types are presented in the following table:
Area Acceptable
Platform Concrete with light to medium
broomed finish
Quarry Tile
Ceramic Tile (colour through non-
glazed)
Public Corridors and Passageways Concrete with broomed finish
Quarry Tile
Ceramic Tile
Specialized coloured non-slip coating
Ramps - Interior As per Corridors/Passageways
Exposed conduits, pipes and other mechanical and electrical equipment. All mechanical
and electrical, piping, ductwork and conduit must be identified, marked with symbols, and
colour-coded.
*Handrails, fencing, exterior architectural metals.
As a general rule, the surfaces of all materials.
*Note: Exterior handrails should be stainless steel or galvanized. Painted exterior handrails require
repainting on an annual basis.
10.11.5 Specialties
This section lists a variety of specialty elements that are generally provided in LRT stations. A
number of the elements that were listed in this category in the previous edition of the LRT
Design Guidelines are now addressed in other sections of this chapter (refer to references).
General
Access doors, opening front panels and the like, must be secure from vandalism when
closed and be designed to remain in the open position for maintenance purposes.
Front panels and cabinet assemblies generally should be rigid and free from rattles or
loose seals and easily accessible for maintenance.
All suspended units must be firmly secured and braced and if possible, be locate above
normal reach.
Exterior units must be weather tight.
Louvers and Vents
The use of architectural aluminum or steel louvers in public areas should be encouraged.
All louvers and vents must be firmly anchored into mounting frames to prevent vandalism
and interference.
Stainless Steel Components
Stainless steel alloys for architectural components and hardware must be of grade SAE
316 (L) or better.
For interior use where there is minimal contact with moisture or chlorides, a 180-Grit finish
or better must be used.
For exterior use where there will be exposure to moisture or possible exposure to
chlorides, a 280-Grit finish or better must be used.
Elements Addressed Elsewhere
Clock Tower (refer to Section 10.7)
Plastic Laminate Toilet Partition (refer to Section 10.11.2.7)
Access Flooring (refer to Section 10.11.4.1)
by the building code). Where applicable, mullion dimensions must be adequate to allow
for the mounting of any required electrified control devices.
All doors equipped with electrified security devices I.e. electric strike, door contact, sensor
must be operated at 12 vdc only.
All exterior doors must be equipped with remote locking with the default position locked
when not powered.
All doors should have stainless steel kick plates.
All exterior doors must be fitted with heavy duty stainless steel continuous hinges (i.e.
piano hinges) to maximize life and wear resistance.
In areas where wind loads on exterior doors may be substantial, consideration should be
given to limiting the door height to seven (7) feet.
Labeled doors will be hollow metal.
The use of special doors must be reviewed and approved by ETS early in the design phase
and prior to specification development.
Card Access System (C-Cure)
Public access and service room doors as designated by the City are to be fitted with conduit,
wire and hardware as per City requirements for connection to card readers that are supplied
and installed by the City. A board is to be installed by the Contractor in the Communication
room to accommodate the wiring and control devices that are required for the system. Refer
to Chapter 8 Communications and Control Section 8.19.1 Security System.
Standard Steel Doors
Interior doors must be a minimum of 45 mm thick, 900 x 2100 mm commercial grade flush
and seamless.
Exterior doors must be a minimum of 45 mm thick, 900 x 2100 mm thermally insulated
commercial grade flush and seamless.
A minimum 100 mm stile should be used where glazing occurs.
Steel doors with welded frames must be used for all door openings except where allowed
for in aluminum doors and frames as discussed below.
Must meet fire code provisions.
Standard Steel Frames
Pressed steel door frames must be used throughout. The use of knock down frames are not
permitted.
The Consultant must also specify the following:
Large openings are to be equipped with a structural sub-frame to provide rigidity.
Welded joints are acceptable
Door mutes are to be provided.
Use thermal-broken frames at exterior door openings.
Provide positive weather-stripping at exterior openings.
Detailing should encourage the use of locally manufactured door frames from standard
shape components.
Aluminum Doors and Frames
As indicated above, if aluminum doors and frames are to be used it should only be in low
traffic and ancillary areas and only when authorized by ETS. They must meet the following
criteria:
Doors will be 45 mm thick, 900 x 2100 commercial series designed for heavy commercial
use.
Provide a minimum 100 mm stile
10.11.6.4 Glazing
The Consultant must review the use and application of glazing options (tempered or laminated
safety glass, plexi-glass, curtain walls) with ETS early in the design phase of the project, prior
to specification development.
General Requirements
Tempered float plate glass or wired glass must be used in all public areas.
Interior glazing will be taped by the dry method.
Thermally sealed, double glazed windows should be used with protective channel edges.
Neoprene glazing splines will be used where possible.
All sealed units must be covered by a non-diminishing minimum ten (10) year warranty
against film formation or dust collection on the internal glass surfaces.
Glazed Curtain Walls
Only proven curtain wall systems will be used that can accommodate expansion and
contraction without damage to the components structure or it’s adverse weather – resistance
capability.
Curtain wall systems should conform to the rain-screen principal.
Only thermal-broken sections can be used.
Aluminum finishes must be similar to those required for aluminum doors and windows.
10.11.7 Hardware
The Consultant must review and coordinate all door and related hardware requirements,
including, but not limited to locksets, door closers, overhead door holders, door hold openers,
stops, panic devices hinges, keying, and lock cylinders with ETS early in the design phase of
the project, prior to specification development.
All hardware must be specified as heavy duty and commercial grade.
10.11.7.1 Locksets
Standard mortise locksets must be used which are capable of accepting standard cylinders.
Locksets must be coordinated with the existing locking system and confirmed with ETS prior
to specification development.
10.11.7.2 Door Closers
Concealed closures (any type) must not be used unless specifically approved by ETS.
They should not allow the door to open more than 90°.
Closures with projecting arms should be avoided as they are prone to vandalism.
Standard of Acceptance: LCN 4041
10.11.7.3 Overhead Door Openers
Acceptable overhead door openers should be used on all entrance doorways and public
corridor smoke or fire doors.
10.11.7.4 Door Hold Openers
Magnetic hold openers must be installed on public corridor smoke or fire doors. Hold
openers may also be required in other areas. Each location / condition will be assessed
individually by the Consultant and ETS.
Floor or wall mounted hold open devices are preferred as compared to concealed types or
types incorporated into the door closer.
By code, hold openers must be connected to the fire-alarm system.
The device must be connected to the BMS for locking and unlocking.
10.11.7.5 Stops
Floor mounted door stops are acceptable for utility room doors. This type should not be
installed in areas of high pedestrian traffic flows where they pose a trip hazard, unless there
are no other options.
10.11.7.6 Panic Devices
The installation of panic devices on a bank of doors will be governed by code. Only the
minimum number of panic devices should be installed. Where a bank of doors needs to be
keyed they will be all keyed with the same key.
Must be the type in which the action is controlled from the interior with a special key.
Vertical rod panic devices are generally not acceptable. Vertical mullions are preferred in
lieu of vertical rod employment. Concealed vertical rods are preferred where panic
devices with vertical rods must be used.
Bolt sockets must be the spring-loaded self-cleaning type.
Standard of Acceptance: Von Duprin Series 9900
10.11.7.7 Hinges
The selection of hinges should be based on the following criteria:
Durability and the ability to handle high traffic volumes and rough usage.
Provides a heavy-duty ball bearing mechanism.
Have provided superior performance on existing LRT facilities.
Standard of Acceptance Stanley, Hugar, Von Duprin
Continuous hinges should be used on exterior entrance doors.
10.11.7.8 Keying
The Consultant’s responsibilities with respect to keying are:
The provision of keyways that is unique to ETS and the City of Edmonton.
Ensuring the coordination with the ETS General Master Key (GMK) System
Confirming uniformity with ETS before installation.
Ensuring that the specifications state that the master keys will not be issued to anyone on
the building site.
The Consultant will also ensure that the Contractor provides the following:
Temporary or construction cylinders to be used during construction.
Assembles all change keys with numbers corresponding to the appropriate key or keys
after the locks and cylinders are installed.
10.11.8 Gates (Type I and II Stations)
Gates are to be installed at both ends of the platform to deter the public from accessing the
track level from the platform. Notwithstanding, the public must be able to use the gate to exit
the platform in the case of an emergency.
10.11.9 Office Furnishings
Office type furniture, such as desks or chairs may be required for certain service rooms in
stations. These requirements will be determined by ETS on an individual station basis.
10.12.3 Above Grade Structures (Type I Entranceways, Type II and III Roofs)
Non – Metal Roof Structures
The following are the general requirements for membranes installed on non-metal roof
structures:
10.12.4 Drainage
Numerous references have been made to drainage requirements throughout this chapter. For
additional guidelines refer to Chapter 12, Mechanical Systems, Section 12.7.
10.13 ADVERTISING
10.13.1 General
The provision and installation of advertising signage in or adjacent to LRT Stations is generally
the responsibility of an Advertising firm under contract to and the direction of ETS.
The station design consultant, in conjunction with ETS, early in the design phase and prior to
specification development, will determine the possible locations suitable for advertising based
on the criteria presented below. Once the final locations have been selected the Consultant
will ensure that design drawings clearly specify anchorage and electrical locations and
requirements.
Advertising must meet the following general requirements:
Does not conflict, by placement or treatment with, or take priority over, system information
signage.
Be carefully located so that it does not obstruct, cause distraction or impede patron
movement; or conflict with legibility of emergency exits or equipment.
Be located so that it does not obstruct CCTV coverage of the facility.
Be considered as a design element rather than random displays.
Be compatible as much as possible with the architectural theme/features of the station.
Preferably, be placed so that a power shutdown of the 600V overhead catenary is not
required when installing ad or maintaining the signage fixtures.
Conform to all applicable codes.
10.13.4 Lighting
Existing ambient station lighting should be adequate for most advertising. If lighting is
deemed necessary, it should be identified as early as possible in the station preliminary
design process in order that the electrical requirements can be determined and specified.
* Equipment sizing requirements by Signals provider may facilitate smaller room size engineered to
suit.
Note: TBD – To be Determined by Consultant
Enclosed spaces Alcoves/vestibules X receptacle not visible to pedestrians; poor blast dispersion
Note 1: In general, Edmonton's LRT system currently is at a low risk level to the threat of an explosive event. The risk is mitigated by the use of clear plastic
receptacles placed in highly visible areas.
Chapter 11 – Revision Tracking Form
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
List of Figures
Figure 11.1 - Typical Communication Ductbank
Figure 11.2 - Typical Power and Catenary Ductbank
Figure 11.3 - Vault Detail
Figure 11.4 - Typical Pullboxes
11.1 GENERAL
11.1.1 Introduction
This chapter provides the design guidelines for the electrical systems for all LRT facilities and
components including those located in the ROW other than the power that is required to
propel the LRV’s (refer to Chapter 6, Traction Power).
The major topics included in this chapter are system loadings and power characteristics,
electrical equipment and materials, lighting, including emergency lighting, grounding and
ground fault protection, fire alarm and detection systems, conduits and combined ductbanks.
For the design of all electrical systems, it is incumbent upon the Consultant to utilize
sustainable design elements including LEED protocol where applicable and practical. Refer to
Chapter 1 Section 1.1.6 regarding the City Sustainable Building Policy #C532.
11.1.2 Abbreviations
CDP - Central Distribution Panel
EM - Emergency
EMT - Electrical Metallic Tubing
HID - High Intensity Discharge
AHJ - Authority Having Jurisdiction
LEED - Leadership in Energy and Environmental Design
MDP - Main Distribution Panel
MUT - Multi-use Trail
PDC - Power Distribution Centre
PMG - Permanent Magnet Generator
*ROW - Right-of-Way
RSC Rigid Steel Conduit
RTO - Motor Thermister Relay
THD - Total Harmonic Distribution
TP - Traction Power
ULC - Underwriter’s Laboratories of Canada
UPS - Uninterruptible Power Supply
*Note: ROW is defined as the area within which the LRT trackway and all its related system elements
and facilities are placed. It is defined by a legal boundary or limits referred to as the LRT ROW Limit.
The Consultant should refer to Chapter 3 Clearances and Right-of-Way, Section 3.2.3 for other ROW
related definitions.
11.1.3 Applicable Codes, Regulations, Standards, Practices, Reference Guidelines
Unless stated otherwise, all design activities, equipment and material selection must conform
or exceed the requirements of the latest editions of all applicable federal, provincial, and
municipal codes and regulations.
Codes, Regulations, Standards
Alberta Building Code (ABC)
Alberta Electrical and Communication Utility Code (AECUC)
Alberta Electrical Code Regulation (AECR)
American National Standards Institution (ANSI)
Alberta Safety Code Act (ASCA)
Being capable of withstanding rough usage and vandalism common to public facilities.
Being resistant to the efforts of unauthorized personnel attempting to remove (theft)
installed equipment during and after construction.
When used in similar applications, devices and materials should be standardized as much as
possible throughout the LRT system.
All materials to be utilized must have prior CSA approval. If CSA approval has not been
obtained then approval for its use must be sought from ETS and/or the AHJ.
During the design, the consultant should determine a spare parts list for each component, and
discuss with ETS for agreement.
11.5.2 Identification
11.5.2.1 General
Colour coding, identification and methods of paint finishes to electrical equipment must be
specified and carefully supervised during construction.
All electrical fittings, supports, hanger rods, pullboxes, channel frames, conduit racks, outlet
boxes, brackets, clamps, etc. must have a hot dipped galvanized finish or powder coat enamel
paint finish over a corrosion-resistant primer.
All enclosures located outdoors or in a tunnel or grade separation must be made of stainless
steel. All fittings, covers, bolts and hinges associated with these enclosures must be made of
stainless steel.
All interior panelboards, distribution centers, motor control centers, transformers, etc., must be
factory finished in alkyd high gloss enamel applied over corrosion-resistant primer.
Note: Matte or flat type finish paint is not acceptable.
The extent of tagging of electrical equipment and systems must be discussed in detail with the
ETS and AM&PW Facility Maintenance personnel prior to specifying.
11.5.2.2 Colour Coding of Systems Elements
System colours including all associated equipment enclosures, terminations and pullboxes
should be as follows:
Above 750V grey RAL 7035
347/600V sand CIL-BH-355-7
120/208V grey CIL-BH-94222
Fire Alarm red CIL-BH-94351
Telephone/Data blue CIL-BH-878-9
PA/VMS blue
CCTV yellow
Low voltage switching black enamel
Emergency power pullboxes, etc. must be clearly labeled with 25 mm “EM” stenciled red
letters over the system colour.
Transformer enclosures are to be finished in accordance with primary voltage colour as
outlined above.
11.5.2.3 Colour Coding of Conductors
Conductors must be colour coded throughout the facility with the same colour applying to the
same phase throughout. Colour coding must be by insulation colour or permanently applied
colour banding at all distribution centres and panels in accordance with the following:
Equipment bonding conductor - green
Transformers are to be located away from any critical low noise areas and must be mounted
on neoprene-steel-neoprene vibration isolation pads with flexible conduit connections. In
addition, they should have the following features:
Dry type construction
TP1 “Energy Star” and C802.2 compliant or rated
High voltage transformers are to be provided with core and coil temperature gauge and
alarms.
High Voltage transformers to be in compliance with EPCOR Customer Connection Guide
requirements.
Note: Confirm additional requirements with University of Alberta Utilities if the project comes under their
direct jurisdiction. University of Alberta Utilities transformer standard is “Cast-Coil” type transformer for
primary voltage applications. This standard is only applicable to installations where the University of
Alberta Utilities operates and maintains the equipment.
Heat rejection rates must be determined for all transformers. The cooling requirements for all
transformers must be coordinated with the mechanical design consultant.
11.6.3 Disconnect Switches and Fuses
Disconnect switches, complete with lock off means, are to be provided for all motors. Fused
disconnect switches are discouraged. The use of circuit breakers should be utilized, if
required.
Three phase disconnect switches are to be quick make, quick break, three pole, three or four
wire complete with bonding lug. In general, the enclosures are to be of type EEMAC 1. In
some installation situations special enclosures may be required.
The maximum length of liquid tight flexible conduit from the disconnect switch to the electrical
apparatus is 1 m. If TECK 90 cabling is utilized, cable length is not an issue. Approved TECK
90 gland type connectors are to be utilized for all TECK 90 cabling applications. Flexible
conduit (clamp type) connectors are not approved for TECK 90 cabling applications.
All disconnect switches are to be suitably labeled with lamicoid labels that includes the motor,
voltage and service source identification (refer to Section 11.5.2).
11.7 EMERGENCY POWER SYSTEMS
Emergency power sources should be selected on the basis of type of system (sensitivity),
reliability and most economic life cycle cost. Sources include:
Uninterruptible Power System (UPS)
Central battery system (battery packs)
*Second utility power source
Standby fixed mounted diesel engine generator system
Portable generator
*Note: A redundant power source should only be selected if it can be demonstrated that a failure of the
primary utility service will affect the secondary utility service.
In the event of outage, or loss of normal/utility power, Emergency Power Systems must be
designed to provide power to systems such as communications and control, signals, stations
and ancillary facilities, traction power equipment (controls, relaying, SCADA, communication
equipment, and alarm functions) all areas in accordance with the following general guidelines:
If two utility feeds with independent transformers are provided with an automatic transfer
then a 2 hour UPS (based on peak operation) is required. The automatic transfer set
needs to be alarmed on BMS.
If two utility feeds are provided to one transformer, it is not classified as redundant as
there is a single point of failure.
If an emergency generator set is available with is own transformer then a 2 hour UPS
(based on peak operation) is required. The generator set needs to be alarmed on BMS.
If no secondary backup is available then 8 hours of UPS backup is required.
Type I and II passenger stations must have dual redundancy.
On other passenger stations redundancy can be provided by a plug for the portable
generator set provided the capacity of the portable generator is large enough to handle
the essential services of emergency lights, CCTV, fire alarms, PA, TVM, BMS, smart
cards, and signals equipment, if any.
Backup power is to also include switch machines, switch blowers, crossing warning
systems, TVM, smart cards, CCTV (this includes cameras, recorders, network
infrastructure etc).
11.7.1 Manual Transfer Switch
Manual transfer switches are only permitted for installation to accommodate portable
generators. The manual transfer switch must be able to inhibit, alert and alarm against phase
rotation errors. The manual transfer switch must be interlocked with the normal power supply.
An interlock on the normal power supply must be opened before the manual transfer switch
can be closed into the emergency power supply.
11.7.2 Automatic Transfer Switch
In all cases where a standby generator is permanently located at a site and is operational, a
contactor or circuit breaker type CSA approved transfer switch should be used. Molded case
switches with integral protection are acceptable.
Transfer switches should:
Utilize electronic control circuitry for system operation and monitoring.
Contain a microprocessor based transfer logic controller.
Be open transition – break-before-make operation type.
Be equipped with a bypass switch feature.
Be of 3-pole design for switching the current carrying conductors of each phase.
Be designed to avoid nuisance tripping of the ground fault protection schemes.
11.7.3 Standby Rated Fixed Mounted Generators
11.7.3.1 General
Standby rated fixed generators must be installed in Type I stations to provide emergency
power in the event of a power failure. In general, permanent emergency generators should
also be installed in Type II stations; however, this requirement will be reviewed on a station by
station basis at the outset of preliminary design.
Portable generator(s) will be made available by ETS to provide emergency power to Type III
stations in the event of a power failure (refer to Section 11.7.3.4).
11.7.3.2 Standby rated fixed Generators
Generators and day tanks must be located in a dedicated room within the traction power
substation or similar building. Generators must not be located in the same room as the
traction power equipment.
The fuel tank must be sized to hold sufficient fuel for the generator to run for at least 24 hours
without re-fueling, or for as many hours that do not exceed the maximum fuel tank capacity
allowed in the installation code for oil burining equipment.
The tank must not be buried. The room and generator footprint should be sized to allow for a
generator that meets the needs of the station with an allowance for future loads.
Features
Standby rated emergency generators must have the following features:
Are diesel engine driven alternator PMG types.
Muffler systems are to be critical residential rated.
Fuel oil storage to be sized to a minimum life safety systems loading. Do not oversize fuel
storage capacity. ETS will provide additional direction for operations loading
requirements.
A fuel fill alarm station for fuel storage tank refueling.
An electronic level control systems, integrated into the BMS (i.e. Siemens Miltonic 4 to
20ma level device or equal).
A mechanical float fuel storage oil level indicator.
Air ventilation dampers are to default to open should the BMS fail and the generator
starts, but does not transfer. This is to ensure the generator remains operational should a
power failure occur during cold weather.
Equipped with electronic governor and a microprocessor based control system capable of
integration into the BMS.
Engine oil heater must be controlled by thermostat and de-energized when engine is
running.
Exhausting Requirements
The generator exhaust pipe insulation must be rated for the maximum exhaust gas
temperature and covered with aluminum jacket.
Suitable insulation and air pocket (thimble) must be provided to prevent heat damage from
exhaust stack.
Where the exhaust stack comes out at street level, the architectural features should be
compatible with the surroundings.
Exhaust ports at street level must be shielded to ensure that the hot piping and exhaust
gases do not endanger the public. The prevailing winds are to be considered when
locating the exhaust pipe. Exhaust pipe must be arranged in such a way that it will not
collect rain water.
If required and recommended by the manufacturer the exhaust pipe muffler drain,
complete with an isolation valve, must be connected to the nearest floor drain.
Fuel Storage Requirements
Fuel oil storage tank is to be double walled welded steel or contained with seal tight sheet
metal fabrication, or equal material. Wherever possible, incorporate the tank into the
generator frame. The tanks are to contain leak detection contacts. The leak detection
contacts must be connected to the BMS to provide an alarm condition.
All tanks are to have a mechanical visual level indication at the tank and high/low level
alarms both at street level and at the operators control terminal in the ETS Control Centre
at Churchill Station. The low level alarm must be at a level that will allow six (6) hours of
generator run time. Six (6) hours low fuel level alarm must be in addition to the 24 hour
generator running time fuel capacity.
Tanks are to be equipped with 4 to 20 mA level controller and connected to the BMS.
The fuel filling station must be equipped with an audible alarm system to advise the
refueling agent when the tanks are full.
Fuel Oil and Fuel Oil Vent Line Requirements
Mechanical and tripping hazard protection of fuel lines from the storage tank to the
generator engine is to be provided.
Fuel tanks that are located in underground rooms must have fill and vent lines piped to
street level.
Fill pipes and spouts, vent pipes and level indicators must be located above sidewalk level
to prevent water leaking into the station and ensure accessibility even with snow cover.
Strive to minimize as much as practicable the length of piping from the fuelling location to
the fuel tank.
Remote fueling lines must be fitted with drain valves for water condensation.
Access to the fuel spout for the fueling truck should be convenient.
Fuel spout must have a lockable lid to prevent unauthorized access.
Fuel oil fill lines must be schedule 40 steel pipe.
Fuel oil vent lines must be screwed fittings.
Valves and unions must be provided to isolate the tank and allow for full tank drainage.
Vent pipe to be equipped with a mechanical whistle.
The fill pipe hose connections are to be coordinated with ETS.
Requirements for Generator Room
The room housing the generator must incorporate the following spill retention measures:
A concrete or concrete block curb dike. The storage area is to be sized to accommodate
the entire contents of the fuel tank plus 25% freeboard.
The perimeter sealed with a hydrocarbon rated sealant at the joints between the walls and
floor.
The entire room floor, including the sides and top of the dike curb, is to be sealed with a
two-part hydrocarbon rated membrane.
Standby Rated Fixed Mounted Generator Sizing
The size of the generator will be based upon the values of the following loads, which are either
mandated or recommended to be on emergency power:
Signals equipment
Communication equipment
Emergency Exit Lighting
Fire alarm
UPS
Station emergency lighting
Ticket Vending Machines, Validators and Smart Card Readers
CCTV equipment
BMS Panel
Security Panel
PA/VMS
Critical HVAC equipment
Sump Pumps
*Elevators
*Note: Full operation of elevators is preferable. As a minimum elevators need to have automatic
lowering to lowest publically accessible floor with the doors opening and remaining in the open position.
11.7.4 Portable Generators
In LRT stations (and platforms) where permanent emergency generators are not provided, a
manual transfer and an emergency power distribution system must be provided. The manual
transfer switch must be serviced from a remote located emergency power receptacle complete
with over-current protection, reverse rotation protection and weatherproof receptacle. ETS will
provide a portable generator during extended outages. The receptacle and manual transfer
switch must be compatible with the ETS supplied portable generator. The output of the
portable generator is 600 Vac, 3 phase, 4 wire, 60 KVA.
Upon request, ETS will provide the required pin and sleeve designation of the fixed mounted
outlet that will be used as the portal to connect the portable generator to the emergency
distribution system.
The emergency power tie-in assembly including generator receptacle must be located
adjacent to the platform and have sufficient space adjacent to it to house the generator without
unduly impeding pedestrian and vehicular traffic or causing a safety hazard.
The manual transfer must be designed using a kirk key system or approved equivalent to
prevent accidental interconnection of the portable generator and utility lines.
11.8 ELECTRICAL HEAT TRACE SYSTEMS
11.8.1 General Requirements
Heat tracing is to be provided for the following elements when exposed to temperatures below
freezing:
Eavestroughs
Roof drains
Rain water leaders
Gutters
Drainage troughs at portal entrances
Drainage catchments at pedestrian ramps and stairs
Water Lines
Sanitary drain lines
Storm water drain lines
Dry line sprinkler drop valves (where the potential for freezing exists).
Heat tracing must be provided where it is determined that sufficiently low temperatures will be
present to cause ice build-up within the track drainage trenches located in underground
structures.
All heat tracing systems must be designed for remote operation by the BMS control system.
11.8.2 Cables
Heat tracing cables must meet the following requirements:
Are self regulating heating cables for freeze protection on pipes and drains.
Are mineral insulated style with stainless steel or alloy 825 sheath for installation when
embedded in concrete.
The recommended voltage rating is either 120V or 208V.
Have cold leads of sufficient length to run from in feed points to power connection boxes.
11.8.3 Control Panels and Accessories
A zone control system is to be provided by the heat tracing control panel. Control panels are
to utilize microprocessor controls systems monitored and controlled by the BMS.
The control panel and associated heat tracing equipment consists of the following:
Ground fault sensing element
Control transformer
Multi-pole heating contactor
Freeze protection thermostat complete with sensor
Snow sensor to detect falling or blowing snow
Gutter ice sensor to detect freezing in gutters and downspouts
The provision of spare zones for future expansion of retail space or additional services.
The provision of a manual pull-station at each entrance and exit.
Manual pull-stations in public areas must have covers to prevent vandalism and misuse.
The provision of an exterior audible and visual indicator at each building.
All fire detectors, unless disqualified by the environment in which they are placed, are to
be of the addressable type.
11.10 LIGHTING
The lighting guidelines presented in this section are intended to outline the functional
requirements for site areas, pedways, stations and related service areas, tunnels, portals,
open trackway (ROW), MUTS and transit parking, including park and ride areas.
Conformance to these guidelines is necessary to ensure lighting levels are adequate and the
intended quality, convenience, efficiency and system safety requirements are provided.
Ease of maintenance should be a primary consideration in the selection of lighting systems
and devices.
11.10.1 General Design Objectives
Provide lighting systems that have good colour rendition and are of high quality suitable
for hard usage applications.
Select a luminaire with high efficiency to take the best advantage of the efficient source.
Select readily available, low maintenance luminaires that have a long life.
Luminaires are to be selected that will suit not only the environment in to which they are
placed but also be effective against vandalism and theft.
Luminaires should have UV stabilized polycarbonate diffusers, i.e. Lexan or equivalent.
Glass luminaries are acceptable for luminaires that are out of harms way.
Lighting design principles for LRT stations are presented in Chapter 10 Stations and Ancillary
Facilities, Section 10.2.7. All or part of these principles, can also be applied to other
components of the LRT system that requires lighting.
Refer to the City Road and Walkway Lighting Manual for lighting standards related to these
facilities.
11.10.2 Performance Standards
All luminaires should be commercial/industrial quality.
All platform, tunnel, underpasses and exterior luminaires (ROW) should be IP 66 rated.
The average to minimum uniformity ratio for interior lighting should not exceed 3 to 1.
For exterior path and roadway lighting, the minimum uniformity ratio should be 6 to 1.
All hinging mechanisms must be metallic (plastic is not permitted).
11.10.3 Standard Lighting Elements/Fixtures
11.10.3.1 Lighting Sources
In general, LED lights are the preferred lighting source. In some instances, other lighting
sources could be considered. The designer shall provide recommendations for lighting
sources.
Guards should be used to protect lighting in areas where there is potential for vandalism or
breakage (public use areas, low mounting heights in utility areas).
The light source selected should be based on application, lamp life, source lumen efficacy,
ease of maintenance, color spectrum and illumination control (photometric data).
A white light source is required to provide improved visibility and color rendering on LRT
platforms. All lighting on the LRT platform to must be supplied from an uninterruptible power
supply (UPS). Light tube lighting is not permitted.
Consideration should be given to protecting overhead lighting in public areas from falling by
means of a safety chain fastened to the roof or ceiling. Factors to consider in determining if a
chain is required include: type of luminarie, its location, potential for vibration etc.
11.10.3.2 Lighting Ballast
High efficiency electronic ballasts are to be used with THD<20%. Pulse magnetic ballasts
are to be used for HID lighting systems.
Ballasts should be readily accessible through the luminaire opening or remotely mounted
for ease of maintenance.
Where luminaries are not easily accessible (i.e. over stairwells), ballasts must be remote
mounted.
Closed units, such as sign boxes or display cases, must have adequate ventilation to
dissipate ballast and lamp heat.
11.10.4 Illumination Levels
In general, minimum lighting levels (except where otherwise noted) should be maintained at
900 mm above the finished floor level of the facility or area being lit. All lighting levels
provided in the following tables are in *Lux.
*Note: Lux is the SI unit of illuminance. 1 Lux = 0.0929 foot-candles
The following minimum illumination levels have been established as a result of the experience
gained by ETS during the entire LRT operating period in Edmonton. Higher levels in public
circulation areas are preferred.
Station Interior
Average
Location Minimum Lux Emergency
1
Public Circulation Areas 200 10
2
Platforms 200 10
Platform Shelters 200 10
Stairs, Ramps, Escalators 200 10
Elevators 400 10
Service Rooms 500 10
Washrooms 300 10
1
Public Circulation Areas include passageways, pedway structures,entranceways,
mezzanine levels, ticketing areas
2
Type I, II, III station platforms
Refer to Chapter 19 for lighting levels in open style Parkade structures.
Exterior Areas
Average
Location Minimum Lux Emergency
Stairs 55 N/A
Walkways/Ramps 25 N/A
Private Vehicle/Taxi Drop-off 25 N/A
Surface Parking Lots 25 N/A
Transit Centre Shelter Island *20 N/A
*Source: Transit Centre Design Guidelines
Trackway
¹Lighting within tunnels should be able to provide for safe egress in an emergency situation and sufficient
illumination levels for operational and maintenance purposes.
²The Consultant should review the lighting upgrade completed for the Belgravia Road Underpass and
utilize it as the guide for daytime light levels.
Tunnel - Portal Transition
Special consideration must be given at the tunnel entrances to provide for the transition of
lighting levels from daylight to darkness. The length of threshold/transition lighting should be
based on LRV operating speeds and the corresponding safe stopping distance. The
Consultant must review the following documents and take into account the given criteria in
their lighting design.
Edmonton Transit System LRT Portal Lighting Study – April 2003
American National Standard Practice for Tunnel Lighting – ANSI/IESNA RP-22-96
Other
*Note: Refer to SS Electrical Equipment Engineering Design Manual, Section 10.0 Building Services
For additional guidelines and requirements, the Consultant should refer to the IES Lighting
Handbook. The Consultant must coordinate with ETS operations personnel to verify that the
proposed lighting levels are acceptable and appropriate for the application.
Connect the various miscellaneous bonding pigtails except for catenary masts to the ROW
ground conductors. The ground conductors are not required to be tied to any of the concrete
reinforcing steel unless it is shown in a Corrosion Report that this will be necessary. All
connections are to be made using compression connectors. Ground/Bond conductors are not
required within the concrete of duct banks.
For the catenary masts with feeders, there will be two ground grids per each catenary base:
one ground grid for catenary pole grounding and the other for lightning protection grounding.
The two ground grids must be separated by at least 2 m.
For the catenary must with no feeders, there will be only one ground grid per catenary base.
This ground grid will be for catenary pole grounding .
All miscellaneous metallic objects ( rail lubricator cabinet, hand rail, etc) within 2 m from the
catenary mast are to be connected to the catenary mast ground grid.
Ductbanks and conduits provide a common, coordinated, protected electrical routing for the
cable interconnections required for, and associated with, the operation and control of the LRT
system.
Typically four (4) ductbank systems are provided:
ROW Communications & Signals (CCTV, PA, Antennae, BMS, SCADA, Signals)
Catenary Power – refers to the traction power feeds and returns between the TPSS’s and
the overhead catenary
ROW Power – AC Power for trackway devices
High Voltage Utility Power (Utility Service Provider power supply to TPSS)
Ductbanks are constructed within the LRT ROW (preferably along side the trackway) with
cable vaults or pullboxes provided intermittently along the length of the duct bank (refer to
following sections for spacing requirements).
If possible, or as required by Code, the four ductbank systems should be kept separate.
Separation of the concrete encased duct banks must meet Code requirements. Routing and
placement should follow good engineering practices.
Catenary power ducts and underground cables are generally located in the vicinity of
substations and LRT stations.
LRT stations and tunnels contain many areas that can differ in temperature. This can cause
potential condensation problems that must be considered in the design.
Duct drainage is an important consideration in duct bank design. Duct banks (except for ROW
Electrica) must be sloped to vaults/pullboxes to prevent water traps. From these locations it is
preferable to provide drain connections to nearby drainage systems. However, Row Electrical
power duct banks are not required to slope to ROW Electrical power pullboxes for drainage
due to the design and size limitation of the pulbox.
In addition to the applicable codes listed in Section 11.1.3 refer to the following:
Utility Service Provider’s utility standards for additional criteria related to high voltage
applications and duct type.
Signals Engineering Standards Manual Section 5.0, for additional criteria related to
signals cabling and conduit.
Chapter 6, Traction Power for the guidelines pertaining to conduit runs to and within the
TP substation.
For additional criteria on traction power underground feeder duct construction refer to the
Overhead TP Manual Section 2.18.
11.13.1.1 ROW Communications & Signals
A network of ductbanks is required for the connection of cables between Signal and
Communication rooms and to related field devices along the LRT right of way.
A maximum spacing of 200 m is preferred between vaults and pullboxes.
Splicing of copper communications cabling within the cable vaults may be permitted, if
approved by ETS, and a LRT Station is not in the immediate vicinity. All backbone fiber
cables are to be routed between stations with no splices or terminations occurring. All splices
and terminations are to be done at the LRT station communications room.
Underground ductbanks must be constructed of concrete encased conduit type DB2 or
equivalent and reinforced with steel in accordance with the following requirements:
For mainline ductbanks, the minimum configuration is 12 – 103mm ducts (refer to Figure
11.1).
11.13.2.3 Drainage
All ductbanks must be gravity-drained towards cable vaults and pull-boxes.
As much as practical, low spots in the ductbanks must not be allowed to develop. It is
preferable that all cable-vaults and pullboxes drain to an adjacent subdrain system (i.e. catch
basin leads, track drains). Integral dry well systems are acceptable only if the surrounding
terrain has good drainage and drainage to subdrains is not feasible.
Sump pumps are to be installed in manholes located in tunnels or grade separations as
required if they cannot be drained into a subdrain system.
11.13.2.4 Branch Ducts
It is preferred that concrete encased branch ducts for stub points and branch lines be
constructed with the main duct system, where possible. All conduits crossing a roadway are
to be encased in concrete and at a depth where damage to the conduits will not occur.
11.13.3.6 Raceways
Rigid galvanized steel conduit must be used in all exposed raceway installations, and in
tunnels.
PVC or DB2 conduit may be used within concrete or PVC when located below grade. PVC
conduit emerging from grade or from concrete and routing on the surface must be converted
to rigid steel. The transition from PVC to rigid steel to be done with a coupling that is then
covered in a heat shrink sleeve and taped. The transition must take place before emerging
from grade or from concrete. PVC conduit emerging from grade but routing directly into an
enclosure does not require transitioning to rigid steel conduit.
EMT conduit should be used as the principle raceway within the TPSS. No plastic pipe is to
be used within the TPSS. Plastic pipe emerging within the TPSS is to be converted to either
rigid steel or EMT. Metal conduit must be bonded to ground using the correct sized bonding
cable for protection.
All conduits in raceway installations should be provided with supports not more than 3 m apart
from each other. The supports used in raceway installations can either be clamps for wall-
mounted conduits, or trapeze-type racks.
12.6.2 Table Added Type II & III shelters and crawl space.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
12.1 GENERAL
12.1.1 Introduction
This chapter outlines the design guidelines for the mechanical infrastructure components and
elements for LRT structures and facilities including tunnels, underground and surface LRT
stations and open right-of-way. The topics in order of presentation are as follows:
Mechanical systems components including piping and equipment
Fire protection measures including fire hose and sprinkler systems
Heating
Ventilation
Controls
Drainage
Post construction standard documentation requirements are addressed in detail in Chapter 1
General, Section 1.7.
12.1.2 Applicable Codes, Regulations and Standards and Reference Guidelines
Unless stated otherwise, all material and equipment selection must conform to, or exceed the
requirements of the latest editions of all applicable federal, provincial and municipal codes and
regulations. Consideration should also be given to pending code changes and adoption of
new code standards.
ABC - Alberta Building Code
ASCA - Alberta Safety Code Act
AWWA - American Water Works Association
CGC - Canadian Gas Code
CPC - Canadian Plumbing Code
NBC - National Building Code of Canada
NFPA - National Fire Protection Association including NFPA 130 Standard for
Fixed Guideway Transit and Passenger Rail Systems
OHSA - Occupational health and Safety Act
12.1.3 Definitions
Water distribution is defined as the conveyance of water from the water service provider to
LRT stations, buildings and other related consumption and service points.
Waste return is the collection and conveyance of storm drainage from LRT facilities and the
LRT right-of-way to the public storm sewer system and sanitary sewage from LRT stations,
buildings, underground structures and tunnel(s) to the public sanitary sewer system.
12.2 GENERAL DESIGN GUIDELINES
All plumbing and drainage systems should be designed to meet the following functional
requirements:
Piping in station and ancillary areas should be run as directly as possible (i.e. run parallel
to, and at right angles, to walls and partitions). Multiple pipes should be grouped in
parallel lines. Where required, sleeves should be provided in structure walls to allow for
future piping.
The domestic water service connection to each facility should be sized to meet the project
total peak demand. Each service must have a main shut-off valve and a backflow
preventer.
The location of all supports or hangers anchored to the steel roof decking must be coordinated
with the facility prime consultant.
12.3.1.5 Sleeves
Sleeves must be large enough for movement and the provision of continuous insulation.
The location of sleeves through concrete decks and walls are to be coordinated with the
structural consultant and the facility prime consultant.
12.3.1.6 Seals
Modular mechanical type seals must be used on penetrations through mechanical room
walls/floors/ceilings and through foundation walls to inside space.
Pipe bridges on building services must be used where services penetrate foundation walls and
more than 1 m in width of fill is to be provided around the foundation.
Outlets are to be located at 20 m intervals under both sides the station platform and 350 mm
back from the platform edge (refer to Chapter 10 Stations and Ancillary Facilities, Section
10.4.1.10). An outlet should be provided in the central fan room (Type I stations) for cleaning
of fan chamber.
Clean out plugs are to be provided at the ends of horizontal mains and branches.
Main vacuum lines (i.e. headers) that provide connection to station outlets must run parallel to
the track under the cantilevered part of the platform in the refuge area (refer to Figure 12.1).
Headers must be installed on the outside of the station bearing wall fixed to the underside of
the station platform. They must have only one point of entry into the station building on each
side. For ease of future maintenance, vacuum lines should not be installed within confined
space areas or crawl spaces.
The vacuum lines must be designed to minimize abrasive wear of the pipes and fittings.
Accordingly, 90° short elbows or TY’s with short radii must not be used. When designing 90°
directional changes, long radius elbows and TY’s with a 45° offset in the direction of flow must
be utilized with the maximum T radius practicable. This applies to locations along the headers
that connect to outlets and locations that breech into the station’s interior.
Cleanouts must be supplied at both ends of vacuum line headers.
Refer to Section 12.3.4 for the central vacuum system guidelines.
12.3.1.10 Valves
All isolation valves must be located in accessible locations, away from high voltage lines or
equipment.
Hand-wheel gear operated valves must be used on all fire-line isolation applications and be
ULC approved.
The accepted practice is to provide a fire alarm system within the station area but not within
underground tunnels. Therefore, supervised devices should be provided in station areas and
chains with locks for all tunnel sections.
Fire-line hand wheel gear operated valves are required to be locked in the open position.
Locks are to be provided by ETS. If chain is required to lock the valves open, the chain
should be provided under the Mechanical Division 15 contract.
In a propylene glycol charged sprinkler system or wherever other systems are tied into the
domestic supply lines, an appropriate reduced pressure back-flow device must be installed as
approved by the AHJ.
It is preferred that a zonal system be established for each level of a station (a minimum of two
zones per level) in order that the entire system need not to be drained when localized
maintenance or systems changes are required.
Isolation valves and unions are to be provided, as required, to isolate equipment, so that
*entire systems do not have to be drained to remove failed components.
*Note: It is preferred that two (2) zones per floor be provided.
In the event of an over pressure condition discharge, collection barrels for the pressure relief
valves (minimum barrel size 205 L (45 imp gal.) are to be provided.
12.3.1.11 Piping Identification
Exposed piping must be painted/designated in accordance with applicable codes and City of
Edmonton standards as presented in the following Tables 12.1 and 12.2. The mechanical
design consultant must forward the painting requirements to the Project Office for review and
approval prior to specification development.
Banding
1. Red - to indicate extremely hazardous material
2. Orange - to indicate mildly hazardous material
3. Blue - to indicate non-hazardous material
Note: Colour numbers used are as designated in Canadian Government Specification No. 1-GP-12C.
Table 12.1 – Piping Colour Codes
Oxygen Orange O2
Natural Gas Orange Natural Gas
Vacuum Aluminum Blue Vac.
Compressed Air White None 7 psi Air
Distilled Water Green Blue Dist. Water
Drinking Water Light Blue None None
Domestic Cold Water Light Blue None Cold Water
Domestic Hot Water Green Orange Hot Water
(140-250ºF)
Domestic Hot Water Return Green Blue Hot Wtr.R.
(Below 140ºF)
Heating Hot Water Yellow Red 200ºFF Heat. Water
(Over 250ºF)
12.3.3.2 Generators
Permanent generators have been installed in Type I stations to provide emergency power in
the event of a power failure. The requirement for generators in Type II stations on future
extensions to the LRT System will be determined on a station to station basis. In general
permanent generators will not be installed in Type II and III stations. The generator size and
requirements for ventilation and fuel oil requirements must be reviewed with the electrical
consultant.
The following requirements should be considered when specifying generators:
Ventilation must incorporate exhaust air dampers, return air dampers, outdoor air intake
dampers and a minimum combustion air damper. Exhaust, return and outdoor air
dampers to modulate as controlled by a space temperature sensor.
Residential areas require a detailed review for noise control. Muffler systems must be
able to meet the noise levels restrictions required by the surrounding neighborhood.
Install vibration isolators on the muffler piping and spring isolators on the hangers for the
exhaust pipe to accommodate vibration and expansion and contraction.
Refer to Chapter 11 Electrical Systems, Sections 11.7.3 and 11.7.4 for additional generator
guidelines.
12.3.3.3 Domestic Water Heaters
Hot water is to be supplied by standard commercial grade domestic hot water heaters at
locations to be determined by ETS. In general, the locations are limited to washrooms and
custodial service rooms.
The following features/installations are required:
The provision of a fire proof drip tray and self-contained shut down device for the water
and power to the heater. The self-contained shut down device is to be mounted in the
drip tray.
The provision of easy access for replacement.
The provision of floor drains in close proximity to the hot water heater to accommodate
drainage from pressure relief valves.
Electric domestic hot water heaters must meet the requirements of CSA C22-110 and
CSA C191
12.3.3.4 Backflow Preventers
Backflow preventers must be installed on potable water systems in LRT facilities in
accordance with the following requirements:
Be located maximum of 2 m above floor level to ensure that convenient access is
provided.
If reduced pressure principal backflow preventers are to be installed, a drain line to
nearest funnel floor drain must be provided. The air gap funnel assembly must have anti
splash components to prevent water spray in the event of a discharge (to prevent water
build-up on floor and the creation of areas where slippage could occur).
The device assembly must meet the AWWA requirements and CSA B64 standards.
Types and location to be in accordance with codes, authorities having jurisdiction and
AWWA guidelines.
Backflow preventer assemblies must be tested and verified in accordance with the
requirements of authorities having jurisdiction. Certification sheets for insertion into O & M
manuals must be provided.
12.3.3.5 Equipment Bases
All major equipment items must be mounted on reinforced concrete housekeeping bases.
Control components
Sizes to be 600 mm x 600 mm minimum.
Provide UL-listed fire rated access doors installed in rated walls and ceilings.
12.3.3.7 Equipment Identification
Identify all equipment excluding pipe and duct with mechanically fastened lamacoid plates
having 6 mm minimum letter size. Identification must match as built drawings equipment
name and number.
Identify electric starting switches, thermostats controlling motors, remote push button stations,
and controls equipment supplies under this division with lamacoid plates having 6 mm (¼”)
minimum letter size. Identification to state equipment controlled and match to control shop
drawing identification numbers.
All mechanical equipment, including valves, must have identification tags indicating the
following:
Equipment ID Number
Electrical disconnect location
Equipment use
12.3.4 Vacuum System
A central vacuum system must be provided in each station to facilitate the cleaning of the
platform and adjacent trackway area.
To provide easy access for the track mounted equipment that will be handling the dust
collection barrels, the vacuum system equipment components should be placed in a separate
room that it is at track level or is accessible by elevator to the track level. The placement of
electrical or communications equipment or panels in this room should be avoided due to the
potential for dust spill-over.
The ceiling of the room should provide sufficient height to accommodate a hopper style tubular
bag separator. The separator straddles one of the 205 liter dust collection barrels.
The floor area of the room should be adequate to allow for the servicing and maintenance of
the equipment from all four sides including space for an extra collection barrel. If the provision
of adequate access space is a space design issue, as an absolute minimum, access must be
provided to at least two sides, subject to the manufacturer’s verification.
The following devices must be provided as part of the vacuum system:
HEPA filter system
HEPA filter gauge – indicates when the filter requires changing.
Electronic Monitoring Bleed Control (EMBC) – if an overload condition is created it will
transmit a signal to the valve to allow more air in or it will turn off the system to protect the
motor.
The Circuit Transformer (CT) must be housed in a metal junction box separate from the
vacuum starter.
The CT and vacuum starter must be mounted with in the vicinity of the EMBC.
Components, panels and breakers must be properly labeled.
Standard of Acceptance: Spencer Turbine Components including:
Tubular Bag Separator - Spencer TH 820 AA or equivalent
HEPA Filter System
12.5 HEATING
Heating systems are required in specified areas or rooms of stations for passenger comfort or
to meet personnel and equipment functional requirements. Refer to the table contained in
Section 12.6.2 for the areas to be heated and the level of heating to be provided.
Both overhead electric infrared, gas infrared heaters or gas fired furnaces are acceptable
installations subject to the conditions stated in Chapter 10 Stations and Ancillary Facilities,
Section 10.4.3. Baseboard heating units being considered for public areas must be proven to
be safe and vandal-proof. Shelter heating, if the halogen type, must be controlled by
occupancy sensors.
Heating systems must conform to the regulations of the Alberta Building Code and all other
applicable codes in force or pending.
12.6 VENTILATION & SMOKE CONTROL
12.6.1 General
The two major types of ventilation systems that are in existence within Edmonton’s
underground tunnel and station system are:
Base tunnel and underground (Type I) stations ventilation system.
The objective of this system is to provide an acceptable level of environmental quality for
LRT passengers and service personnel carrying out their responsibilities in these areas.
Heating at portals may also be required where the stack effect is a concern and freezing
conditions may result in damage to LRT structures and equipment. Each location must be
evaluated on an individual basis.
Emergency tunnel and station ventilation system.
This system must be capable of handling emergency situations such as a fire in a tunnel
or station.
Ventilation systems for surface (Type II and III) stations are not normally required except for
specified service rooms that form part of the station.
Air conditioning in LRT facilities is not normally provided except in special situations to deal
with high heat levels generated by certain equipment. Air conditioning may be provided
within service rooms housing UPS systems to maintain the room temperature below 25°C.
The power supply for the cooling system for the communication room, signal room, and main
electrical room must be provided by the emergency generator. Ventilation in crawl spaces
must be equipped with switches which allow fresh air fans to operate on a timer of up to one
hour.
The ventilation of the tunnel systems is achieved by three methods:
The “piston” effect action of the LRV’s moving through the tunnels. The piston effect will
provide the ventilation under normal conditions. Blockage ratio, impedance, and the
speed of the train will be utilized in the design of this ventilation.
The forced air fan smoke removal systems.
The *natural stack effect.
*Note: The design of the underground ventilation system must always consider the natural stack effect,
which is dependent on the exterior air temperature and the temperature inside the tunnels.
Emergency ventilation of underground stations is primarily achieved by the forced air fan
smoke removal system.
Ground level access locations must have the provision to prevent the premature closure of
doors when trains enter and leave the station, which could cause injury to LRT patrons.
Dampers and fans that are designated to respond to emergency conditions are automatically
controlled from the ETS Control Centre at Churchill Station. Manual override control is also to
be provided at the station. The manual override control arrangement should be verified by
ETS.
Under the condition of no piston effect, the forced air system must be able to purge the
emergency area at a rate approved by the Emergency Response Department. Additions to
the existing ventilation system must be compatible and totally integrated to the existing
system.
Fans designated for the control and direction of air flow are required to be:
Reversible under emergency conditions with full reversing within 30 seconds.
Sized to provide air velocity of a minimum 60 m/minute in all tunnels leading from a
station.
Fan and drive components must be complete with internal brakes to ensure fans are at
zero speed before starting and/or change of air flow direction.
During the design process, and as required, the mechanical design consultant must
coordinate with the appropriate City of Edmonton Departments to ensure the proper operation
and control of smoke removal in an emergency condition.
Heating, ventilation and air conditioning (HVAC) systems must conform to the regulations of
the Alberta Building Code and all other applicable codes in force or pending.
For insulation requirements refer to Section 12.3.2.
12.6.2 Ventilation and Heating Criteria
If it is not practical to discharge exhaust systems outside underground structures, they should
be discharged into a well-ventilated area remote from any public areas. Whenever possible,
exhaust from public washrooms and battery rooms should be exhausted outside.
During the design process, the consultant shall consider the alternate uses for rooms in LRT
facilities, and design ventilation and heating for such uses. The consultant must coordinate
with the appropriate City of Edmonton departments to verify these considerations. Rooms in
LRT facilities must be ventilated and heated in accordance with the criteria shown in the
following table:
Main station fans must be able to operate under plug reverse conditions, and run at 100%
volume forward and reverse.
All motors to high efficiency rated, and inverted duty rated for variable speed drive
applications.
All variable speed drive applications, especially those deployed for emergency track
ventilation, must be equipped with 100% manual bypass motor contactor-soft start
systems.
All fan motors over 20 kW must have thermistor winding over-temperature protection.
Reversible fans must have electric or mechanical braking to prevent damage to fan and
motor. They are not, however, required with variable speed drive applications.
Allowable noise levels due to fan operations are:
- A maximum of 50 dBA when measured outside of the mechanical room.
- A maximum of 56 dBA outside of the station adjacent to the plenum.
12.6.4 Alarms and Controls
Design guidelines for mechanical control systems are presented in Chapter 8
Communications and Control Section 8.3, Building Monitoring System.
12.6.5 Metering (Water and Gas)
If water and gas service is required at a station then the service should be metered. The
meter should be located inside the station where possible.
Integrated or adjacent stand-a-lone traction power substations require their own separate
service meters, if applicable.
12.7 DRAINAGE
12.7.1 General
Drainage systems are classed as either storm or sanitary facilities.
Design of drainage measures is required for the following major LRT components:
Open or surface LRT right-of-way.
Underground structures (tunnels, Type I stations).
Building structures (Type II and Type III stations and Traction Power substations, etc.).
LRT and pedway overpasses and underpasses.
Roadways and parking lots including sidewalks, walkways, multi-use trails when located
with the LRT ROW.
LRT directly related landscaped areas.
Drainage for LRT facilities and installations that are directly exposed to the elements is
classed as storm drainage and is normally discharged into a storm sewer. This includes run-
off from open ditches, roofs, roadway and parking lots, underpasses, aerial structures and
embankments, etc.
Sub-surface drainage on open track sections, retaining walls, and abutments should discharge
into an adjacent storm sewer, if available.
Drainage from a building structure plumbing fixtures, floor drains and infiltrated water is
classed as sanitary drainage and must be designed to discharge into a sanitary sewer. This
includes drainage from underground tunnels and the trackway through Type I stations.
Sanitary drainage must not be permitted to enter the track drainage system.
trains to continue to operate during periods of heavy rainfall. If feasible, retention ditches or
ponds should be provided.
The location and requirements for catch basins and manholes must be checked with the
AM&PW Drainage Branch.
Underground and Surface Structures
The Consultant should assume that the walls of the underground structures cannot be
effectively waterproofed and that water infiltration will occur.
Water infiltration through roofs and side walls must be controlled through the provision of sub-
drains and pressure relief weep drains near the trackway level.
If necessary, backflow preventers and other suitable measures to protect the facility or
installation from water intrusion, should be provided.
The outflow from gravity pumps and sump pumps discharging on to track level must be
controlled so that the discharge can be directed into any or all of the tunnel drain-ways.
All areas having a fire protection sprinkler system or fire hoses must have sufficient capability
to drain the area should activation occur.Heat tracing of piped drainage systems must be
provided as required to ensure proper functioning of the system (refer to Section 12.2).
12.7.3 Drains
Types of drain fittings that are acceptable are:
Catchbasin frame and grate
Floor drain
Cleanouts
A minimum 150 mm diameter floor drain with sediment trap must be provided.
12.7.4 Pumping Stations
Pumping stations and sump pumps will only be permitted under extreme circumstances. Their
installation will require the prior approval of ETS.
If sump pumps are to be installed, they should meet the requirements as outlined in Section
12.3.3.1.
12.8 COMMISSIONING AND TESTING
Commissioning and testing is to be carried out in accordance with the overall commissioning
plan and program (refer to Chapter 1 General, Section 1.6). Activation requirements are
outlined in Section 1.6.2.
12.9 PREVENTATIVE MAINTENANCE
The Consultant must coordinate with ETS to ensure that the ETS computerized maintenance
program is modified to include all new equipment and related procedures.
The following must be provided:
Maintenance and lubrication schedules for major components. Schedules to include daily,
weekly, monthly, semi-annual and yearly checks and tasks.
Procedures describing the maintenance tasks required for typical equipment such as
bearings, drives, motors and filters.
This information will be compiled for all typical equipment separate from shop drawings.
A
-
DETAIL A (TYP)
SECTION B-B
B B
D
-
DETAIL C
C
-
NOTE:
- ALL PIPE AND FITTINGS ARE 2 1/8" DIAMETER.
- 11 GAUGE TUBING AND 16 GAUGE FITTINGS.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
13.1 GENERAL
13.1.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the design guidelines related to the provision of corrosion control
measures. Corrosion control measures are required to minimize stray current leakage and
prevent premature corrosion failures on the LRT system fixed components including surface
structures, above ground and below ground structures and adjacent facilities along the LRT
corridor.
In the Edmonton LRT System the rails of the track system act as the negative side of an
electrical circuit in the traction power network. The positive side is the overhead contact wire
system or catenary. The catenary carries the *DC electrical current from the substation to the
LRV. The track carries the return current to the substation. This is typical of most electrified
rail systems, including heavy rail.
Electrical currents can leak out of the circuit and escape into the soil to find the path of least
resistance (if the resistance is lower than the rail) through any available conductor back to the
substation. These paths may be buried utility pipelines and cables, other structures (i.e.
bridges, buildings) containing metal, or be the soil itself. Stray currents from the positive side
of the circuit are generally very small. The current from the negative (track) side tends to be
larger due to the proximity of the track to the ground. If the electrical continuity of the track
structure is poor, more electricity will return as stray current than through the running rails.
Corrosion on the surface of a conductor results when electric current leaves the conductor and
returns to the soil. If left uncontrolled stray currents can be *detrimental for a number of LRT
components.
*Note: AC systems do not experience this problem
In summary, it is important to identify the leakage path and to mitigate by electrical isolation
and the provision of suitable protection such as sacrificial metals or coatings.
Corrosion control systems should be economical to install, operate, and maintain.
13.1.2 Definitions
Corrosion is defined as the destruction or deterioration of a material because of reaction with
its environment. Corrosion of metallic structures is an “electrochemical” process that usually
involves small amounts of direct electrical current (dc). It is an “electro” process because of
the flow of electrical current. It is a “chemical” process because of the chemical reaction that
occurs on the surface and corrodes the metal.
Cathodic Protection is the prevention of electrochemical corrosion of a metallic structure by
causing the structure to act as the cathode rather than the anode of and electrochemical cell.
This is done by applying a direct current to the metal to be protected and to another metal that
acts as a sacrificial anode.
Stray Current refers to extraneous direct currents in the earth. For LRT facilities it implies rail
current leakage to its surroundings. Stray currents produce corrosive reactions in LRT
structures and facilities and in adjacent utilities. Stray currents place a minimal electrical
charge on metallic objects that can oxidize or corrode the object through electrochemical
means.
Stray Current Corrosion Control applies to measures installed with the traction power
system and trackwork to assure that stray earth traction currents do not exceed maximum
acceptable levels. These levels are based on system characteristics and the characteristics of
underground structures.
Soil and Water Corrosion Control applies to systems or measures installed to mitigate
corrosion caused by soil/rock and groundwater.
Atmospheric Corrosion Control applies to systems or measures installed to mitigate
corrosion caused by local climatological conditions and air pollutants. Materials and coatings
can be used to significantly decrease atmospheric corrosion rates.
13.1.3 Scope
The emphasis in these guidelines is on soil and stray current corrosion. Atmospheric
corrosion is not as problematic in the Edmonton area as it may be in other areas.
Corrosion control design guidelines should encompass all engineering disciplines applied to
the any LRT project. Therefore the engineering and design of corrosion control measures
must be coordinated with the trackwork, civil / structural, traction power, signals,
communications, electrical, mechanical, and utility designs.
13.1.4 Objectives
The application of these design guidelines is intended to meet the following objectives:
Realize the design life of system facilities by avoiding premature failure caused by
corrosion.
Provide continuity of operations by reducing or eliminating corrosion related failures of
systems and subsystems.
Minimize annual operating and maintenance costs associated with material deterioration.
Minimize detrimental effects to adjacent privately-owned facilities and structures as may
be caused by stray earth currents from LRT operations.
The basic requirements for the control of stray currents are as follows:
Ability to operate the mainline LRT system with no direct or indirect electrical connections
between the positive and negative traction power distribution circuits and ground.
Design the traction power system and trackwork to minimize stray earth currents during
normal revenue operations.
Protective measures such as cathodic protection and induced currents can be applied, if
applicable, to ensure that stray currents are maintained within the acceptable range for the
structure being protected.
Stray current monitoring along the track should be installed in order to verify that the rails are
insulated from the ground and to detect any leakage of stray current.
Running Rails
The mainline running rails, including special trackwork, grade crossings and all ancillary
system connections, should be designed to have a minimum, uniformly distributed, in-service
track-to-earth resistance.
Appropriately designed insulating track fastening devices, such as insulated tie plates,
insulated rail clips, direct fixation fasteners or other approved methods should be used.
Ballast and sub-ballast construction for ballasted track must meet the provisions of Chapter 5
Trackwork, Sections 5.6.4 and 5.6.5.
The top of the ballast material should be a minimum of *25 mm below the bottom of all metallic
surfaces i.e. the rail and all track fastening components in electrical contact with the rail.
*Yard track should be electrically insulated from mainline and shop tracks by use of insulated
rail joints in both rails.
*Note: Denver RTD and Seattle Link systems also uses this guideline. This provision is to ensure that
parked vehicles will not electrically connect the shop track or mainline track to the yard track for periods
of time longer than that required to move a vehicle into or out of the yard.
Ancillary Systems
Switch machines, signalling devices, train communication systems, and other devices or
systems which may contact the rails should be electrically isolated from earth by the use of
dielectric materials.
Electrical Continuity
The mainline running rails must be constructed as an electrically continuous power distribution
circuit through the use of rail joint bonds, impedance bonds, continuously welded rail, or a
combination of the three.
13.3.1.3 Water Drainage
Below grade sections must be designed to:
Prevent water from dropping or running onto the running rails and related rail
appurtenances
Prevent the accumulation of freestanding water.
Water drainage systems for sections exposed to the environment must be designed to prevent
water accumulation from contacting the rails and rail appurtenances.
The Consultant should refer to Chapter 12, Mechanical Systems, Section 12.7 for the Design
Guidelines for drainage.
13.3.2 LRT Fixed Facilities
13.3.2.1 Aerial Structures
Column and Bearing Assemblies with Direct Fixation Track
This section applies to aerial structures and bridges that use a column and bearing assembly
that can be electrically insulated from deck or girder reinforcing steel and will have insulated
trackwork construction.
Provide electrical continuity of top layer reinforcing steel in the deck/girder by welding all
longitudinal lap splices.
Electrically interconnect all top layer longitudinal reinforcing steel by welding to transverse
collector bars installed at breaks in longitudinal reinforcing steel, such as at expansion
joints, hinges, and at abutments. Connect collector bars installed on each side of a break
with a minimum of two cables.
The number, location and earth resistance of the ground electrode system must be
determined on an individual structure basis.
Provide test facilities at each end of the structure and at intermediate locations to maintain
a maximum spacing of 155 m between test points. The facilities will house test wires from
the collector grid and ground electrode system, if present.
Electrically isolate the reinforcing steel in the deck and superstructure steel from columns,
abutments and other grounded elements. Isolation can be established through the use of
insulating elastomeric bearing pads, dielectric sleeves and washers for anchor bolts and
dielectric coatings on selected components.
If the electrical isolation of reinforcing steel in the deck and superstructure steel from
columns, abutments, and other grounded elements cannot be obtained, then the electrical
continuity of metallic components within these latter elements should be established by
appropriate welding and bonding procedures.
All copper to steel weld locations (bond cables) should be coated with a cold applied, fast
drying mastic consisting of bituminous resins and solvents.
13.3.2.2 Underground Structures
It is recommended that reinforcing steel in underground structure (tunnels and stations) inverts
be designed to be electrically continuous in accordance with the following general
requirements:
The longitudinal lap splices in the top layer of the first-pour reinforcing steel be welded.
All longitudinal members to a transverse (collector) member at intervals not exceeding
155 m should be welded. This included at electrical (physical) breaks in the longitudinal
reinforcing steel (i.e. at expansion joints).
Test facilities should be installed at each end of Type I station platforms and at every collector
bar. Each facility to consist of insulated copper wires, conduits and enclosures terminated at
an accessible location.
Soil conditions and environmental corrosivity should be evaluated to determine the need for
the application of a barrier coating. If soils are deemed to be highly corrosive apply a coating
in accordance with Section 13.2.5.1. Also refer to Section 13.4.
Corrosion control methods selected should include consideration of the following:
Internal and external coatings
Segment bonding
Test electrodes
Cathodic protection test ports
The structure cross section should include space for a cathodic protection rectifier, distribution
conduit and power supply.
13.3.2.3 OCS Mast Foundation Grounding
All metallic components inclusive of the pole base-plate, that will be partially embedded or
come in contact with concrete surfaces, should be coated with a sacrificial or barrier coating.
The sacrificial coating must be applied to the entire component. The barrier coating should
extend a minimum of 150 mm into the concrete and a minimum of 13 mm above the surface of
the concrete.
All copper to steel weld locations (bond cables) should be coated with a cold applied, fast
drying mastic consisting of bituminous resins and solvents.
13.3.2.4 Utility Structures
All piping and conduit must be non-metallic, unless metallic facilities are required for
engineering purposes. No special provisions are required if non-metallic materials are used.
Metallic Facilities (System Wide)
Pressure or non-pressure piping exposed within crawl spaces or embedded in concrete
inverts do not require special provisions.
Pressure piping that penetrates station walls must be electrically insulated from the external
piping to which it connects wall reinforcing steel, and from watertight wall sleeves.
Metallic Facilities (Yard)
Tracks in yards are grounded. Metallic piping in yards must be adequately protected from
corrosion. Protective measures are to be jointly determined by ETS and the Utility Service
Provider.
13.3.3 Facilities Owned by Others
13.3.3.1 Utility Relocations
Corrosion control requirements for buried utilities installed by the utility provider as part of LRT
construction must be the responsibility of the individual utility provider. Minimum stray current
corrosion control criteria, when guidance is requested by the utility provider, should be in
accordance with the following Section 13.3.3.2.
Relocated or replaced utilities, installed by the LRT project contractor must be installed in
accordance with the utility owner specifications. The following are the minimum provisions
applicable to ferrous and reinforced concrete pressure piping. Other materials and structures
will require individual review.
Electrical continuity through the installation of insulated copper wires across all
mechanical joints for which electrical continuity cannot be assured.
Electrical access to the utility structure via the installed test facilities.
The need for additional measures, such as electrical isolation, application of a protective
coating system, installation of cathodic protection, or any combination of the preceding,
should be based on the characteristics of the specific structure and should not adversely
effect the existing performance within the environment.
13.3.3.2 Existing Utility Structures
The need for stray current monitoring stations will be jointly determined by ETS and the utility
provider. If the utility provider requires assistance, the following minimum provisions can be
suggested.
Test facilities may be installed at select locations for the purpose of evaluating stray earth
current effects during start-up and revenue operations. The suggested guidelines for
location of test facilities are as follows:
.1 At all utility crossings with the system, and on structures that are within 90 m and
parallel to the system right-of-way.
.2 At locations on specific utility structures that are within 90 m of the system traction
power substations.
13.4.6 Sealants
All crevices should be sealed with a polysulfide, polyurethane or silicone sealant.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
14.1 GENERAL
14.1.1 Scope
This chapter provides the design guidelines for the following:
Measures that can be implemented to mitigate the impacts that LRT can have on adjacent
communities.
Aesthetic treatment including landscaping along the LRT ROW and around stations.
The control and protection of the LRT ROW.
“The City of Edmonton will seek to achieve a projected attenuated noise level below 65 dBA
*Leq24, or as low as technically, administratively, and economically practical, with an objective
of achieving noise level of 60 dBA Leq24, where any transportation facility (major arterial
roadway, light rail transit, or future high speed transit) is proposed to be built or upgraded
through or adjacent to a developed residential area. Funding for noise attenuation, where
appropriate, and subject to availability, is considered in the cost of the project”.
*Leq (Equivalent Continuous Sound Level) is defined as a calculated sound level over the
measured time period that has the same acoustical energy as the actual fluctuating sound
levels that occurred during the same period. It is a single number descriptor commonly used
for environmental noise measurements.
The Consultant should refer to the Stantec Noise Position Paper for additional data derived
from an environmental noise model study that was carried out for the South LRT Extension.
14.2.1.3 Vibration
Vibration can be caused by the movement of LRT trains along the tracks and LRT
construction activities. Refer to Chapter 2 Vehicles, for a brief discussion on the degree of
vibration generated by LRV’s. The Consultant should also refer to the ACI Residential
Vibration Monitoring and Assessment Study for the results of vibration monitoring and the
prediction of vibration levels in the McKernan and Belgravia communities.
To be effective, the medium selected for a noise wall preferably should have sound absorption
characteristics, and must be placed in the line of sight between the noise source and the point
of observation.
The placement of trees and shrubs alone is not an acceptable medium for reducing noise.
The location, size and spatial requirements of the installation will be determined during
preliminary engineering phase of the design activities.
Structural design considerations for noise walls are outlined in Chapter 9 Structures, Section
9.6.
14.3.2.3 Maintenance
Maintenance must be considered in all aspects of LRT landscape. Low maintenance will
reduce long-term costs, help provide an enduring landscape and provide long term fiscal
responsibility.
The LRT corridor and its landscape components must:
Be durable, functional and able to withstand heavy use and potential vandalism;
Be compatible with local climatic conditions. Considerations must be given to the
environmental conditions (wind, sun, shade, snowdrifting, aspect and moisture regime) of
the sites and their effect on the hard and soft landscape. Site specific conditions will have
to be considered;
Meet the City of Edmonton standards for road right-of-way planting requirements; and
Accommodate typical City of Edmonton maintenance practices.
14.3.2.4 Neighborhood Integration and Impact Mitigation
Along the LRT corridor, integration of the LRT landscape and mitigation of impacts in the
surrounding community will perpetuate and enhance the existing neighbourhood flavour and
identity.
The LRT corridor and its landscape components must:
Identify and reflect the character/theme of the neighbourhoods that it moves through by
utilizing similar landscape architectural streetscape elements;
Protect, retain and /or reuse as much of the existing hard and soft landscape as possible;
Where possible, reconstruct distributed landscapes to a condition similar to pre-LRT
development and/or as negotiated through the stakeholder process;
Provide replacement compensation of permanently removed hard and soft landscape with
other landscaping within the neighbourhood as negotiated through the stakeholder
process;
Maintain, facilitate and/or integrate major pedestrian movement systems, i.e.
neighbourhood paths and major walkways;
Maintain, facilitate and allow ease of movement of other modes of neighbourhood traffic,
i.e. bicycle, etc.; and
Satisfy the requirements of the Corporate Tree Management Policy and Bylaw 7829
concerning Boulevards, Flankages, Utility Lots and Boulevard Trees within the City of
Edmonton.
14.3.2.5 Buffering
Landscape components used for screening or buffering of impacts of the LRT may help satisfy
resident needs and help maintain the character of the remaining neighbourhood.
14.3.2.6 Aesthetics
The LRT development must be attractive and visually pleasing to the general public.
Landscape may be used to soften and enhance the visual character of the LRT corridor and
present a positive image to attract ridership while retaining safety and security.
The LRT and its landscape components must:
Recognize and provide visual interest for all seasons through the use of a variety of
materials, color, etc.;
Provide a sense of unity for the corridor with the use of similar materials and theme;
Provide a sense of scale appropriate for the corridor and the adjacent land uses.
Landscaping may be used to reduce the scale of retaining wall, fencing, overpasses,
parking lots, etc. or provide a more intimate scale to a space for meeting or seating areas;
Define special sites and uses such as schools, major intersections, commercial, etc.;
Enhance and define the uses of the adjacent sites;
Frame important views, neighbourhood identity features and landmarks to increase their
significance;
Selectivity screen views and facilities to reduce their impact on the adjacent community;
Integrate the corridor, stations and platforms into the neighbourhood within the use of
similar materials and design theme;
Incorporate significant existing site features such as signage, buildings and existing plant
materials into the landscape; and
Provide orientation in the neighbourhood and within the LRT corridor.
14.3.2.7 Fiscal Responsibility
The LRT landscape development must meet the established budget for the project. All design
must:
Show fiscal responsibility;
Produce an enduring, long lived development within the community;
Recognize the interconnection of site design and facility maintenance operations; and
Minimize impacts but maximize the value received for the dollars expended.
Preference will be given to development which retains community stability and meets the
budget.
14.3.2.8 Public Involvement
The LRT landscape development must incorporate a comprehensive public involvement
process (refer to Ch. 1 General Section 1.2.1) for each geographic location. This process, at a
minimum, must address the statement of principles of LRT planning and the landscape design
principles listed above and allow for public input on the following:
Safety concerns and issues;
Retention or modification of existing landscape themes, i.e. naturalized or formal
landscape, paving, etc.;
Desired pedestrian and vehicular movement patterns;
Desired visual screening/buffering of adjacent land uses;
Existing views to be retained, enhanced or screened;
Existing features/landmarks to be retained, enhanced or screened;
Potential location(s) of compensatory landscape;
Neighbourhood identity and character;
City standards and maintenance requirements;
Other site specific issues; and
14.4.1 Fencing
14.4.1.1 Exclusive, Semi-Exclusive Use ROW
All ROW in this operating category must be fenced to provide protection for the public.
Normal fencing requirements will be heavy-duty chain link barrier fencing. The absolute
minimum fence height is 1.2 m with a height of 1.8 m being typical. Fencing will generally be
parallel to the track and located within the defined ROW. The Consultant should refer to the
figures in Chapter 3, Clearances and Right-of-Way for further details.
Where aesthetics and community standards demand, other types of protection such as
wooden, steel or concrete barriers, pipe rail, bollard and chain, or hedgerows may be
considered. The location and type of barrier fence will be determined on a case-by-case
basis.
Where necessary, gates that can be locked must be installed to provide access to the ROW
by maintenance or emergency personnel and equipment. The locations should include direct
access to all surface trackway turnouts. This requirement is also applicable to Section
14.4.1.2.
14.4.1.2 Shared Use ROW
Where the LRT alignment is located in a shared use ROW, the installation of fencing or
barriers may be somewhat limited due to the roadway and pedestrian movements, and related
crossing requirements. Each section of the LRT alignment must be analyzed carefully to
determine feasible fencing or barrier locations.
14.4.1.3 Type II and III Stations
If practicable, fencing/barriers should be installed adjacent to surface LRT stations to prevent
pedestrians from accessing the tracks except at controlled crossing areas.
The following factors should be considered when developing the fence/barrier location plan:
Safety of pedestrians including persons with disabilities.
Station platform access
Grade crossing configuration and related control measures (refer to Chapter 18 Street
Design, Section 18.5, Grade Crossing Safety)
14.4.1.4 Drop-Off and Parking Areas
Fencing or barriers should be considered for locations where there is the potential vehicular/
pedestrian conflict, or security may become an issue (refer to Chapter 18 Street Design,
Section 18.7).
14.4.1.5 Tunnel Portals/Overpass Structures
Fencing should be considered for areas around tunnel portals and on bridges for use by
pedestrians crossing over the LRT trackway. The objective is to discourage persons from
dropping or throwing objects onto the LRT ROW.
In areas where pedestrians come into close proximity to the overhead catenary system, a
protective shroud must be installed over the contact wires. The mesh in the shroud should be
closely spaced to prevent any contact with the energized conductors (refer to Chapter 6
Traction Power, Figure 6.8).
14.4.1.6 Related Fencing Requirements
Vehicle service, maintenance and storage areas must be secured by a perimeter fence.
All fencing with a metal component to be located in areas where pedestrian movements occur
must be grounded.
14.4.1.7 Standards Reference Documents
Standards for Screen, Uniform and Solid fences are provided in Volume 5 Section 10
Landscaping, of the City Design Standards.
The specification for steel chain link fencing is given in Volume 5, Section 02821. For chain
link fence details, refer to Drawings 9450, 9452, and 9454.
Refer to Chapter 5 Trackwork, Figure 5.29 for the typical detail of bollard and chain (two
chains) fencing mounted on ballast curb. Where a bus stop is located immediately adjacent to
the LRT right-of-way, and bollard and chain is utilized, three (3) chains along the length of the
stop.
14.4.2 Signage
Signage indicating that trespassing is prohibited on the LRT ROW should be erected at all
locations where the public can gain access. Typical locations include road and pedestrian
grade crossings and at stations. Other specific signage may be required at designated
locations.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
15.0 ACCESSIBILITY
Page
15.0 ACCESSIBILITY 1
15.1 GENERAL 1
15.1.1 Introduction 1
15.1.2 Abbreviations, Acronyms 1
15.1.3 Definitions 1
15.1.4 Applicable Codes, Standards, Practices 2
15.1.5 Design References 2
15.1.6 Accessibility Features/ABC References 2
15.2 ACCESSIBILITY POLICIES 2
15.2.1 Policy C463 – Accessibility to City of Edmonton Owned and Occupied
Buildings 3
15.2.2 ETS Accessible Transit Instruction 4
15.2.3 Stakeholder Groups 5
15.3 LRT STATION DESIGN 5
15.3.1 Accessibility Principles 5
15.3.2 Interior Accessible Routes 5
15.3.3 Platform, Public Areas and Amenities 10
15.4 STATION EXTERIOR AREAS 13
15.4.1 Exterior Accessible Routes 13
15.4.2 Passenger Loading Zones 14
15.4.3 Parking Lots 15
15.5 TRANSIT CENTRES 15
15.6 SAFETY AND SECURITY 15
List of Appendices
15.0 ACCESSIBILITY
15.1 GENERAL
15.1.1 Introduction
This chapter is a consolidation of the accessibility and barrier-free design criteria to be applied
to the interior of LRT stations, their entranceways, station site access routes, and vehicular
parking and drop-off areas adjacent to a station.
This chapter also provides a summary of the City and ETS Policy statements on accessibility,
and definitions that are commonly used. It also indicates that Edmonton City Council has
established an Advisory Board with the mandate to review LRT facility plans at the various
stages of design development.
The purpose of consolidating these guidelines into one chapter is to provide design
consultants and ETS and other City staff with one location within the Guidelines where most
references to barrier-free guidelines and requirements can be found without having to search
through the full text of several chapters of these guidelines (also refer to Section 15.1.6).
15.1.2 Abbreviations, Acronyms
CSA Canadian Standards Association
TAC Transportation Association of Canada
TCRP Transit Cooperative Research Program
TTY Text telephone for the hearing impaired
US DOT United States Department of Transportation
15.1.3 Definitions
Accessibility is the design and construction in and adjacent to a building, including the
building site and adjacent public ways, which allows ease of movement and safety for all
employees, citizens, visitors and others, including persons with disabilities. To ensure
accessibility for persons with disabilities, the building including the building site and adjacent
public ways, shall be barrier-free and shall incorporate principles of barrier-free design
(Source: City Policy C463).
Barrier-Free is a feature of a building and its related facilities whereby it can be approached,
entered and use by persons with physical, mental or sensory disabilities. (Source: City Policy
C463)
Barrier-Free Design is the incorporation and utilization of design principles to construct an
environment that is functional, safe, and convenient for all users, including those with any type
of disability. (Source: City Policy C463).
Note: Barrier-free design is also referred to as Universal Design.
Barrier-Free Design Guide is a design guide respecting the minimum building requirements
for disabled persons in the most current Alberta Building Code in force in the Province of
Alberta. (Source: City Policy C463)
Disabilities are physical, mental or sensory conditions, which require barrier-free buildings
that can be easily approached, entered and used. (Source: City Policy C463)
Mobility Challenged are persons with disabilities, elderly persons, families with children or
persons with temporary impairments or disabilities. (Source: ETS Transit Accessible
Instruction)
Mobility Aids/Equipment means a wheelchair, walker, crutches, assistance dogs, strollers,
scooters, canes and oxygen tanks. (Source: ETS Transit Accessible Instruction)
“Barrier-free design will be undertaken for all sites and as determined by the stakeholder
involvement process. The design must utilize the following documents or resources to ensure
a barrier-free design:
Advisory Board on Services for Persons with Disabilities
Barrier-Free Design Guide, Barrier-Free Design Advisory Committee of the Safety
Codes Council and Alberta Municipal Affairs
City Policy C463
Universal Design for Barrier-Free Park Development”
15.2.1 Policy C463 – Accessibility to City of Edmonton Owned and Occupied
Buildings
This policy states, in part:
“The City of Edmonton is committed that all persons will have reasonable access to
City of Edmonton owned and occupied buildings. Reasonable access should be
provided to all persons, including persons with disabilities. This applies whether the
person is an employee, citizen, visitor, official or other.”
The main purpose of the policy is to ensure that over time, City owned and occupied buildings
are safely useable for and provide reasonable access to persons with disabilities. All new
building construction is subject to the provisions of the policy.
A key component of the policy was the establishment of the “Advisory Board on Services for
Persons with Disabilities” with the mandate to promote recognition of entitlements and service
needs of Edmontonians with disabilities, by facilitating changes in city policy and practice.
Edmonton City Council appoints the Board members.
As one of the stakeholders, a Board responsibility is the review of city projects for reasonable
access at each of the following five project stages:
Project/program development
Design development drawings
Tender development
Substantial completion
Commissioning
Another key component of the policy is a manual titled “Manual for Accessibility to City of
Edmonton Owned and Occupied Buildings”. This manual outlines the specific procedures and
requirements for Policy C463. Section 10 of the manual, Requirements for Reasonable
Access, states that “the requirements of the Alberta Building Code shall form the basis of the
requirements of the manual”.
The Barrier-Free Design Guide was prepared by the Barrier-Free Design Advisory Committee
of the Safety Codes Council, with the assistance of Alberta Municipal Affairs. It was
developed to assist designers, consultants, builders and other Building Code users in meeting
barrier-free design standards and principles. It forms the appendix to the Manual for
Accessibility to City of Edmonton Owned and Occupied Buildings. In accordance with City
policy the Barrier-Free Design Guide must be used as the main reference in the
implementation of the provisions of the ABC.
City Policy C-466, Integration of Persons with Disabilities, has also been adopted by City
Council. In part, the policy has been put into place to ensure that the planning, development
and provision of civic services to persons with disabilities is in full consideration of their needs
and the range of their abilities.
At least one handrail at the side of a ramp must extend not less than 300 mm beyond the
top and bottom of the ramp. (ABC 3.4.6.4). Handrails should be terminated by returning
the ends into the wall or downwards to reduce the possibility of catching clothing on the
ends of the handrail.
A clearance not less than 40 mm must be provided between the handrail and any wall to
which it is fastened. (ABC 3.6.4.6)). This should be increased to 60 mm where a rough
texture is used.
15.3.2.2 Stairs
In general stairs must have the following features:
Treads to be of non-slip surfaces and rounded nosings.
A distinct visual contrast between the treads and the risers are to be provided including
tactile warning cues for the visually impaired.
The color of the stairway should be different than the surfaces it leads to and from.
Open risers are not permitted.
Continuous railings are to be provided on both sides of the stairs.
Specific accessible requirements for stairs are:
The preferred step run is 305 mm. The absolute minimum run is 280 mm (ABC
3.4.6.7(1)).
The preferred step rise is 165 mm. The acceptable range is 125 mm to 180 mm (ABC
3.4.6.7(2)).
Treads and landings of interior and exterior stairs must have a slip resistant finish or
provided with slip resistant strips that extend not more than 1 mm above the surface. A
slightly more abrasive surface than the one being walked on is all that is needed in most
cases (ABC 3.4.6.1(1)).
Treads and landings of exterior exit stairs more than 10 m high must be designed to be
free of ice and snow accumulations (ABC 3.4.6.1(2)).
Open risers should be avoided where possible. They can be awkward for persons
equipped with foot or leg braces (ABC 3.4.6.7).
Step nosings must have either a radius or a bevel between 8 mm and 13 mm in the
horizontal dimension. Nosings that are not properly raked should be avoided as they can
cause problems for people using braces where a foot must be dragged up each step
(ABC 3.4.6.7).
Nosing of stairs should be of a contrasting colour with respect to the treads and risers
(ABC 3.4.6.7).
The front edge of stair treads in exits and public access to exits must be at right angle to
the direction of exit travel (ABC 3.4.6.7).
15.3.2.3 Railings
Specific accessible requirements for railings are:
Exit ramps and stairways must have a handrail on at least one side and on both sides if
1100 mm or more in width. (ABC 3.4.6.4(1))
If the exit ramp of stairway width is greater than 2200 mm then there must be one or more
intermediate handrails that are continuous between landings and located so that there will
not be more than 1650 mm between handrails. (ABC 3.4.6.4(2))
Handrails must be continuously graspable along their entire length. (ABC 3.4.6.4(3))
Handrails must have a circular cross section with an outside diameter between 30 and 50
mm. Any non-circular shape must have a 100 to 155 mm perimeter with the largest cross-
sectional dimension not more than 57 mm. (ABC 3.4.6.4(3)). A circular cross-section of
less than 40 mm is preferred.
Handrails on stairs must be 865 to 965 mm vertically from the stair nosing. (ABC
3.6.4.6(4))
At least one handrail should be continuous through the length of the stairway including
landings except where interrupted by a door or newels at changes in direction. (ABC
3.4.6.4). Continuous handrails are relied on by the blind or visually impaired to guide them
on stairways. Continuous handrails also assist the elderly.
Handrails must be terminated in a manner which will not obstruct pedestrian travel or
create a hazard. (ABC 3.4.6.4(6)). At least one handrail at the side of a stairway must
extend not less than 300 mm beyond the top and bottom of the stairway (ABC 3.4.6.4 (7)).
Handrails should be terminated by returning the ends into the wall or downwards to
reduce the possibility of loose clothing being caught on the end of the handrail.
A clearance distance of not less than 40 mm must be provided between the handrail and
any wall to which it is fastened. (ABC 3.4.6.4 (8)). This should be increased to 60 mm
where the wall has a rough texture.
15.3.2.4 Escalators
In general escalators must have:
A high contrasting edging
A warning buzzer if the emergency stop button is being accessed
Under-lit stairs
15.3.2.5 Passenger Elevators
In general elevators must have the following features:
The location must be clearly identified by signage
The floor covering must be slip-resistant and permit easy movement by persons in
wheelchairs.
Upon entering an elevator the controls must be readily available to the person in a
wheelchair.
Braille floor indicators
Protruding buttons
Oversized lit floor call buttons with braille
Floor arrival tones
Handrails
Infra-red beam curtain to prevent doors from closing against a person or object
Emergency phones to the ETS Control Centre (hands free direct dial phones with Braille
and lit call connect indicator).
Security features (refer to Chapter 10 and Chapter 16)
Specific accessible requirements are:
If there is one or more elevators in a building all stories must be served by at least one
elevator sized to accommodate a stretcher 2010 mm long by 610 mm wide. The elevator
meeting this requirement must be clearly marked on the main level of the building (ABC
3.5.4.1(1)). The minimum inside dimensions will be 2032 mm x 1295 mm.
The preferred elevator size is 2032 mm x *1500 mm as this allows a wheelchair to turn
around with ease.
*Note: To allow a wheelchair to turn around with ease it is preferred that an area of 1500 mm by 1500
mm be provided.
Emergency controls and door operating buttons must be grouped together at the bottom
of the control panel. The alarm and emergency stop button must not be less than 890 mm
above the floor. The highest car control button should not be higher than 1370 mm above
the floor. Other controls may be located where it is convenient to do so.
Must be equipped with a telephone connected with the ETS PABX System operated out of
the ETS Control Centre. The phone should not be located at a mounting height lower than
the lowest push buttons and no higher than 1220 mm from the floor. The phone cabinet
can be located opposite the control push buttons. It must be identified by the international
symbol for telephones in a contrasting colour. The symbols must be at least 38 mm in
height and raised at least 0.75 mm. Telephones must be equipped with a volume control.
Automatic leveling is provided to within 13 mm of the floor level
Minimum door clear width of 910 mm.
Door reopening device is required in case the car door is obstructed and must be capable
of sensing an object at 125 mm and 735 mm above the floor without requiring contact for
activation.
Door-opening devices must remain effective for not less than 20 seconds.
The allowable minimum door delay is 4 seconds from the time the doors start to open to
the time they start to close if it is a hallway call and 3 seconds if it is an elevator call. This
time may be reduced if after operation of the door close button.
Elevator controls must be readily available from a wheelchair upon entering an elevator.
Floor registration buttons are to be a minimum 19 mm in size and can be raised, flush or
recessed. The full recessed depth when depressed must not be more than 10 mm.
Arabic numerals must be to the left of the floor buttons and on a contrasting colour
background. Markings must be at least 16 mm high and raised at least 0.75 mm. The
raised markings may be on the buttons.
Visual and momentary audible indication must be provided to show each call registered.
The visual indication can be extinguished when the call is answered.
A lit elevator position indicator must be provided to indicate the floor the elevator is
stopped at or passing. It must be on a contrasting colour background and at least 16 mm
in height.
Handrails must be provided at a height of 800 mm to 920 mm and spaced 35mm to 45
mm from the wall.
The illumination level at the elevator control panel must be at least 100 lux.
Hallway call buttons must be located 1070 + - 25 mm above the floor and must be at least
20 mm in size and mounted one above the other. A visual indication must be provided that
will extinguish when the call is answered.
A lit elevator position indicator must be provided in the hallway to indicate the floor the
elevator is stopped at or passing. It must be on a contrasting colour background and at
least 60 mm in the smallest direction. An audible signal must be provided when the
elevator stops at the landing (once for up; twice for down).
15.3.2.6 Entranceways, Doors and Gates
In general, a station or a transit facility must:
Provide at least one barrier-free entrance (ABC 3.8.1.2)
The barrier-free entrance will incorporate automatic door(s). It is preferable that automatic
doors slide open parallel with the wall rather than open toward or away from the
pedestrian line of travel.
Automatic doors to be identified with the international symbol for accessibility
The identification of entrances should be done by using contrasting colours for door
frames, handles, etc.
Entrances must be well lit.
The lighting color spectrum should be as close to natural light as possible to bring out the
true color of objects.
Lighting should be constant, uniform, and diffused. Glare should be minimized.
Lighting, particularly interior lighting, should be instant-on to enable immediate recovery
after a power outage.
The lighting design must promote safety by identifying and properly illuminating areas and
elements of potential hazard.
Pedestrian access lighting should provide well-defined walkways, crosswalks, ramps,
stairs and bridge corridors.
Platform edges, shelters, seating areas, fare collection equipment areas, ramps and
stairs, LRT and bus loading areas, pedestrian walkways and crossings, parking areas and
wayfinding signage must be appropriately illuminated.
Light trespass into adjacent neighborhoods areas should be minimized.
Light fixtures and standards should be incorporated into the architectural elements of the
stations as much as possible.
Care should be taken in the design to avoid “light pollution”.
Light fixtures, luminaries, and related equipment should be selected on the basis of:
maximizing standardization across the system, cost effectiveness, durability, ease of
maintenance and energy efficiency.
The Design Guidelines for Lighting are presented in Chapter 11 Electrical Systems, Section
11.10.
The following illumination levels are taken from the Lighting Guidelines given in Chapter 11,
Section 11.10.4.
Station Platforms – 200 lux minimum
Stair nosings - 200 lux minimum
Elevator cabs - 400 lux minimum
Exterior walkways/ramps – 25 lux minimum
Exterior Stairs – 55 lux minimum
Passenger loading zones and parking lots – 20 lux minimum
Emergency lighting in tunnels including catwalks – 10 lux minimum
Changes in lighting levels of more than 100 to 300 lux range from one area to the next should
be avoided.
Several of the reference documents listed in Section 15.1.5 provides suggestions on
illumination levels and should be reviewed by the Consultant. For example, Going Places –
Access Needs of Visually Impaired Travelers in Transportation Facilities recommends that the
IES suggested levels be increased by 25 to 50%.
15.4 STATION EXTERIOR AREAS
15.4.1 Exterior Accessible Routes
In general, exterior routes such as sidewalks, ramps, pathways etc. will have the following
accessible features:
Provide well-lit, distinguishable barrier-free pathway(s) leading to each barrier-free facility
entrance.
Finish surfaces to be slip resistant
The pathways will incorporate ramp access where stairs are otherwise suitable
Curb ramps must be installed at roadway intersections adjacent to LRT stations, provide
ramps at all four corners as well as the access points to the platform.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
16.1 GENERAL
16.1.1 Introduction
The primary purpose of this chapter is the presentation of principles, guidelines and required
safety and security measures for LRT passengers, service and maintenance staff in the
following LRT facilities:
Stations
Exterior site areas including walks/pathways, parking, and drop-off areas
LRT ROW
LRV’s
The security of LRT facilities and equipment, including the prevention of losses through
burglary, damage and vandalism are addressed, in part, by the surveillance measures
outlined in Section 16.4.
LRT systems fire/life safety requirements as a result of building code requirements (exiting,
fire alarm / detection, smoke removal systems, sprinklers, train control) are addressed in other
chapters or by direction to an applicable code.
Safety requirements related to traction power, signals, facility structural, electrical, and
mechanical design, and barrier-free design are addressed in the chapters covering those
particular topics in the Guidelines.
ETS has initiated the APTA developed and sponsored Safety Management Audit Program.
Details of the Audit Program goals are provided in Chapter 1 General, Section 1.5.
Transit Security Best Practices Review: A Strategic Approach for the Future - LEA
Consulting, June 2004
*Note: Moving Forward document provides a Personal Security Minimum Criteria List.
Reduce Isolation
Bus stops and LRT entrances, where possible, should not be adjacent to isolated areas such
as large parking lots, vacant land, alleys, ravines, or buildings set back from the street.
*Bus Shelter Design
Design to reduce the possibility of entrapment. Provide vandal resistant material.
*Note: These guidelines apply to shelters on Type III station platforms as well.
Lighting
Areas adjacent to transit stops should be well lit, however shelters should not be over-lit such
that they make the users feel uncomfortable.
Maintenance
Shelters and transit stops should be well maintained.
Formal Surveillance
Measures should be taken to improve the ability of transit drivers to respond to dangerous
situations, e.g. through two way communications or a panic alert button. Drivers should be
trained to respond to emergencies.
All LRT stations should have video, CCTV, and / or other forms of formal surveillance.
Patrols
Transit Security personnel and Police should be made aware of problematic transit stations or
stops.
16.2.3 LRT Facility Interior and Exterior Access Routes and Areas
16.2.3.1 Sightlines
It is important to be able to clearly see what is ahead along a given travel route. The line of
sight should not be interrupted by sharp corners, walls, earth berms, fences, bushes, garbage
cans, signs, or pillars. Where grade separation and landscape screens may be required for
functional or aesthetic reasons, they should be assessed against the potential for risk to
personal safety.
Factors to consider are:
Ensure sightlines are considered from appropriate heights and angles including
pedestrian (adult or child), vehicle or wheelchair heights.
Visibility – unobscured landscaping, open perimeters edges, see-through structures
Dead-ends must be avoided at all times.
16.2.3.2 Predictable Routes, Entrapment Areas, and Isolation Points
Predictable routes offer no escape alternatives for pedestrians. An attacker can predict where
pedestrians will end up once they are on the path. Examples of predicable routes are
pedestrian tunnels, overpasses, escalators and staircases. Predictable routes are of particular
concern when they are isolated or when they terminate in entrapment areas. Entrapment
spots can be small, confined areas near or adjacent to well-traveled routes that are shielded
on three sides by some barrier, such as walls or bushes. Isolated areas can be those that
have limited activity such as parking lots, parkades and pathways.
Factors to consider are:
Ensure visibility by providing clear sight lines
Introduce surveillance measures
16.4.1 Surveillance
Surveillance measures, both formal and informal are used to manage and maintain security.
Natural surveillance should be encouraged through the placement of physical elements,
activities and people to maximize visibility in accordance with the principles and criteria
provided earlier in this chapter.
Formal surveillance including communication equipment is also necessary and should
complement and improve upon the natural surveillance system.
16.4.1.1 ETS Control Centre
The communications hub for the Edmonton LRT System is the ETS Control Centre located at
Churchill Station. It houses the amalgamated functions of LRT Operations, Bus Operations
and Security to allow for the efficient dispatching of staff resources. Formal surveillance is
performed from this location. Chapter 8, Communications and Control provides the design
guidelines for the ETS Control Centre.
16.4.1.2 CCTV
The Edmonton LRT System is equipped with a closed circuit television surveillance system
that assists in the management of train operations, public safety and security. It is comprised
of video imaging, processing, display, and recording equipment along with its own dedicated
video transmission system. Cameras are remotely controlled from the security area located at
the ETS Control Centre.
The CCTV surveillance system serves two distinct functions defined as follows:
Operational needs are those requirements deemed necessary for the safe and orderly
dispatch of passengers. Monitoring is carried out for the purpose of ensuring the safe
movement of people in both normal and crush conditions.
Security needs are those requirements deemed necessary for protection of assets, prevention
of vandalism, and the safe passage of passengers and the general public.
Camera coverage is required for the following security sensitive areas:
Entrances to cash vaults
Fare equipment
Continuous coverage of all platform areas
Emergency telephones
Elevator / escalators
All entrance doors
Washroom entrance doors
Tunnel portals
Continuous coverage of pedway entrances and exits to all levels
Continuous coverage of walkway entrances and exits to all levels
Continuous coverage of stairwell entrances and exits to all levels
Camera coverage should be provided with the objective of eliminating all blind or hidden
areas.
Station approach access routes and adjacent parking and loading areas also require
coverage. The appropriate infrastructure should be added to light standards to allow for
possible camera installation. Activity should be identifiable for a distance of up to 45 m.
Chapter 8, Communications and Control, Section 8.9 CCTV, provides the guidelines and
criteria to be used in the design of the Closed Circuit Television System for future LRT
extensions along with an overview of the existing system and related components.
16.4.1.3 Telephone Systems
The following telephone systems are provided on the Edmonton LRT System and are
available for public use:
Local Phones
Emergency Phones
Elevator Emergency Phones
Washroom Access Phones
Information Phones
Public Pay Phones
Emergency Phones are generally located on the station platforms next to information panels,
seating areas and elevators, on station mezzanine levels in paid fare areas close to
information panels and fare equipment.
Emergency phones must be readily identifiable through the use of high visibility color/lettering/
markings. Each phone has a direct connection to the ETS Control Centre and is monitored by
CCTV. When a call is placed a video recording is activated at the Control Centre.
Direct access Pay Phones are located in the proof of payment areas of a station. They
provide coin free calling button access to 911, 611, 411, 0 and ETS Security at ETS Control
Centre.
Chapter 8, Communications and Control, Section 8.6,Telephone Systems, provides the
guidelines and criteria to be used in the design of the Telephone System for future LRT
extensions.
16.4.2 Stations/Facilities
16.4.2.1 Architectural Treatment
The choice of surface treatments and construction materials should take into consideration
safety, budget, practicality and maintenance. In general:
Materials should be resistant to damage.
Consideration should be given to textured surfaces to discourage graffiti.
Wall materials should be utilitarian but not be so rough that they could cause injury to
individuals.
Low ceilings should be avoided, they are easily damaged and vandalized.
Reference should also be made to Chapter 10, Stations and Ancillary Facilities (Section
10.2.6 for additional architectural principles and Section 10.11 for materials and finishes), and
Chapter 15 - Accessibility.
16.4.2.2 Corridors/Passageways/Entranceways
Refer to Section 16.2.3 for sightline and entrapment requirements.
16.4.2.3 Exiting
All emergency exiting must conform to the latest editions of the National Building Code and
the Alberta Building Code. For other exiting considerations refer to Chapter 10, Stations and
Ancillary Facilities, Section 10.3.3.
16.4.2.4 Non Public Restricted Zones
Prevent public access to potentially unsafe areas through the provision of:
Gates, fences
Locking gates/remote controlled doors with status indicators
Intrusion alarms, motion sensors/detectors
Increased gradients (steepen areas) to prevent climbing
Landscaped and/or appropriate surface treatment to separate and delineate travel corridor
C-Cure door access System – refer to Chapter 8, Section 8.4 Security
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
17.0 UTILITIES
Page
17.0 UTILITIES 1
17.1 GENERAL 1
17.1.1 Introduction 1
17.1.2 Applicable Codes, Standards, Practices and Reference Guidelines 1
17.1.3 Ownership 1
17.2 GENERAL DESIGN GUIDELINES 3
17.2.1 All Utilities 3
17.2.2 Utilities Impacted by LRT Construction 3
17.3 RESPONSIBILITIES AND COORDINATION REQUIREMENTS 4
17.3.1 Process Overview 4
17.3.2 LRT Utility Design Consultant 4
17.4 NOTICE REQUIREMENTS 6
17.5 LRT UTILITIES 6
17.5.1 General 6
17.5.2 Utility Service Connection 6
17.5.3 Utility Placement At-Grade Trackway 6
17.5.4 Utility Placement in Underground Tunnels or Structures 6
17.0 UTILITIES
17.1 GENERAL
17.1.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the design guidelines for the following:
The relocation, adjustment, or abandonment of existing utilities within existing or proposed
LRT right-of-ways.
The placement of new utilities across or adjacent to the LRT ROW.
The placement of utility services that are required for the operation of any new or
upgraded LRT facility.
Utilities include those that are owned by the City of Edmonton civic departments, public utility
corporations, private companies, other governmental agencies, and utility services to adjacent
private properties.
17.1.3 Ownership
17.1.3.1 Utility Type/Owner Agency
The following are the majority of the utility service providers within the City boundaries as of
the date of the issuance of this edition of the Design Guidelines.
All abandoned utilities beneath the trackway should be removed. If they cannot be
removed they must be abandoned appropriately for the type of utility such that the safety
or stability of the LRT line is not compromised.
Future utility crossings could be bored. However, due to limited ROW availability it is
recommended that consideration be given to the provision of ducts for future utility
installations if the future utility crossing location has been fixed.
Where possible, utilities should be constructed with non-conductive materials (refer to
Chapter 13, Corrosion and Stray Current Control).
Pipelines carrying water, oil, gas, highly flammable, volatile, or other pressurized
substances are to be suitably cased, or bridged over with a structural concrete slab. If
they are encased, the casing material must also be designed to withstand LRT loadings
and should employ appropriate cathodic and corrosion protection devices.
Any utility servicing private property within the zone of influence should not be interrupted.
If temporary service has to be provided it should be installed so as to be permanent at the
completion of LRT construction.
New installation of any existing utilities should be designed to provide service equal to that
offered by the existing installation.
No betterment of the service is to be provided unless specifically directed by LRT D&C.
Where the LRT tracks cross power transmission lines, railway, gas, oil, or other high-
pressure pipelines, a crossing agreement must be obtained. Further detail on this
requirement is provided in Volume 1 of the City Design Standards. Refer to Section
17.3.2.1.
17.3 RESPONSIBILITIES AND COORDINATION REQUIREMENTS
17.3.1 Process Overview
On behalf of ETS, all utilities affected by LRT construction or that are required to service LRT
facilities, will be coordinated by the LRT Project Office through the Utility Design Consultant
and the respective utility service provider.
The utility documentation, coordination and design review process will generally be as follows:
Notification to Utility Companies of the proposed LRT Right of Way.
The identification and documentation of all abandoned, existing, and proposed utilities
within the immediate vicinity of the LRT corridor as per Section 17.3.2.1. Identification of
proposed utilities within the corridor and within the sphere of influence of the corridor is
also required.
The LRT Utility Design Consultant in consultation with the applicable utility must identify
those utilities that may be impacted by LRT construction and prepare proposals for their
relocation in accordance with these design guidelines for submission to the utility owner.
Video inspection to determine the condition of active storm and sanitary lines affected by
LRT development should be considered.
The utility service provider will review the Utility Design Consultant’s utility record plan and
relocation proposal and will provide comments, suggestions, or present alternatives back
to the Utility Design Consultant.
The Utility Design Consultant must review all utility service provider’s comments. A
composite utility plan will be developed showing the proposed utility relocation alignments
and orientations. This plan is to be reviewed again with each utility service provider.
Each utility service provider will review and respond to the Utility Design Consultant with
either acceptance of the proposed alignments and orientations or a submittal of a request
for further alterations. Upon acceptance the utility service provider will sign-off the plan.
The signed off plan will be submitted by the Utility Design Consultant to the City ROW
Management Office who will in turn issue a ULA number in accordance with ULA
requirements.
The Utility Design Consultant will issue a final composite utility plan showing the proposed
locations and orientations of all relocated and new utilities.
- Data and documentation of proposed utilities within the corridor and within the sphere
of influence of the corridor that may be affected by LRT construction.
- Determination of the responsibility for relocation costs and notice timeline
requirements (as per existing agreements with the City).
Major property owners adjacent to the LRT construction may have to be contacted to
obtain available utility service documentation that is unavailable from the utility service
owner.
Utilities that are within the Impacted by LRT Construction zone that will require relocation
are to be identified as soon as possible during this phase of the work. The removal
process to be employed in the abandoned facility should also be determined at this phase
of work.
Verification by field survey of critical elevations and locations of existing utilities must be
completed.
Right-of-way or easements required to relocate or install new utilities to service proposed
LRT facilities must be identified.
Preliminary cost estimates for relocated utilities and LRT facility services must be
prepared.
The City has developed procedures that are to be followed for the protection of utilities and the
crossing of high-pressure pipelines. Where applicable, the Consultant must take these
procedures into consideration during the utility design process. These procedures can be
found in Volume 1 of the City Design Standards as follows:
Procedures for Crossing High Pressure Pipelines – Section 01561
Procedures for Protection Existing Utilities and Structures – Section 01562
17.3.2.2 Final Design Phase
The Utility Design Consultant must clearly and correctly identify the following information on
the final design drawings for:
Relocation of Existing Utilities
Utilities retained in place and in service during and following LRT construction.
Utilities that will be restored upon completion of LRT construction.
Utilities permanently relocated beyond the immediate limits of LRT construction.
Utilities that have been abandoned in place, or are to be abandoned and removed.
Final plan and profiles including any special protection measures required.
All right-of-ways, existing and proposed, and all easements, existing and proposed.
Construction Cost estimates and Schedule
Utilities Required to Service the LRT Facility
Final plans and profiles of proposed utility including any special protective measures
required.
Construction Cost estimates and Schedule
The Utility Design Consultant must refer to the appropriate sections of the City’s Design
Standards for design related criteria for drainage, water, street-lighting (includes drawings),
and power (includes drawings), facilities and appurtenances.
There may be instances whereby the utility service provider will assume the responsibility for
final design. This should be verified at the time the utility service provider is initially contacted.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
List of figures
Figure 18.1 - Pedestrian Controls Decision Tree
Figure 18.2 - Four Lane Cross-section All Pedestrian Crossings
Figure 18.3 - Four Lane Cross-section Pedestrian Crossing One Side Only
Figure 18.4 - Four Lane Cross-section No Pedestrian Crossings
Figure 18.5 - Section Widened for LRT Station Pedestrian Crossings One Side Only
Figure 18.6 - Section Widened for LRT Station No Pedestrian Crossings
18.1 GENERAL
18.1.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the guidelines that are needed by the roadway design consultants to
carry out the preliminary and final design of changes to existing roadways and related facilities
that may be impacted by the construction of LRT facilities. Included are recommended
guidelines for grade crossings. In addition, the guidelines are also applicable to new roadway
construction, including surface parking facilities that are to be constructed as part of the LRT
project.
The geometric and pavement design of all public streets and roadways must be approved by
the City Transportation Services Department (refer to Section 18.1.4).
18.1.2 Abbreviations
AASHTO - American Association of State Highway and Transportation
Officials
FHA - Federal Highway Administration
MUTCD - Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices
OSCAM - On-Street Construction and Maintenance
TAC - Transportation Association of Canada
TCRP - Transit Cooperative Research Program
18.2.7 Landscaping
LRT corridor and station landscaping guidelines are presented in Chapter 14, Section 14.5 of
these guidelines. For streets landscaping design criteria, refer to Volume 5 of the City Design
Standards.
18.4.2 Crosswalks
Crosswalks should be provided at all intersections adjacent to LRT stations. In some
instances mid-block crossings may be warranted.
Pedestrian crossing gates should be designed to discourage persons from jumping over
or crawling under.
Pedestrian swing gates and crossing gates design should raise “awareness of danger”
and/or “awareness of a safe area” near trains.
Provision of a clearing (refuge) zone between the gates and the track with clear visibility
by the Train Operator.
Ensure that the crossing controls allow enough time to complete crossings safely with
special attention to the predominant user in the area.
Pedestrian mirrors or stainless steel type sign outside to assist with line of sight.
Directional audible warning devices with messages that trains are approaching (both
directions).
Consideration for specific needs relevant to location of school or special needs crossings.
Ramping should avoid rounded edges; squared corners are preferred as they provide
direction for visually impaired.
Width considerations to accommodate motorized wheelchairs/scooters.
Standardized location of activated crossing signals in proximity to the crossing location.
Active Warning Devices – Use both visual and audio devices in conjunction with the swing
gates.
A pedestrian service phase long enough to allow pedestrians to cross both sides of the
roadway including the median, if feasible.
Countdown timers on pedestrian signal heads.
Pedestrian refuge trapezoidal area – minimum of 1.5 m to 2.5 m by 3.0 m wide between
swing gates and the edge of the roadway at the median.
Locate the cross-walks as close to the intersection as possible; avoid skew angle
crosswalks, where possible and avoid changes in crosswalk orientation with intersections.
Use “Signals Stop Line” signs to designate stop bar locations.
For open crossings or controlled by a crossing arm provide a *detectable warning strip
coloured yellow with STOP written on the approach side.
For crossings with pull (swing) gates provide a *detectable warning strip coloured yellow.
*Note: Refer to Chapter 5 Trackwork, Section 5.5.2 and Figures 5.22A TO 5.22D incl. for
further details regarding the layout and construction of the warning strips.
Taxi
Bus / DATS Drop-off on street adjacent to the station
Park and Ride facility
Bus Drop-off from a Transit Centre located adjacent to a station
Transit Centre combined with a Park and Ride facility
Parking for City service vehicles must be provided (refer to Section 18.7.3.5 and Chapter 10,
Section 10.4.4). Manoeuvrability of emergency vehicles may also be a design consideration.
18.7.2.1 Entrance Roadways
The design of roadway entrances to station sites that interface with bus transit centres,
park-and-ride facilities and vehicular drop-off areas must take into consideration adjacent land
uses. Where possible, avoid large unplanted or paved areas that are out of scale with those
uses. In addition, the design should take into consideration the following requirements:
Avoid direct access from a major roadway. A secondary road from the main road to
access the forgoing facilities, should be provided.
Direct access from residential streets should be avoided, where possible.
The entrance roadway should be designed to provide sufficient storage to meet the
expected peak period transit ridership and avoid having vehicular traffic backing up onto
the public street.
Avoid conflicts between the entrance road, pedestrian and bicycle flow corridors and
access points.
Strive to provide more than one entrance roadway to large parking areas (more than 1000
stalls).
Entrance roadway design must be in accordance with the City Design Standards.
The vehicular movements within the parking area can be dispersed by the strategic placement
of entrances, exits and aisles.
If the normal aisle standards provide inadequate vehicle circulation, additional two-way or one-
way circulation roadways should be provided. Minimum widths are:
Two-way circulation road – 7.3 m
One-way circulation road – 5.5 m
18.7.3.3 Aisles and Parking Stalls
Aisles should be aligned to facilitate convenient pedestrian movement toward the station.
Strive to keep the aisle length less than 122 m.
Aisle width – 7 m minimum.
Stalls dimensions are: 2.6 m wide by 5.5 m in length minimum for 90 degree angle
parking. If they are adjacent to landscaped areas, with no obstructions, consideration can
be given to reducing the width by 0.6 m.
At the head of the parking stall, the horizontal clearance required must be 0.75 m from the
front face of the curb to any obstruction.
At the sides of stalls, if adjacent to wall or raised planters, provide an additional 0.3 m
minimum clearance.
Dead-end aisles must be avoided.
Light Standards or landscaping should be considered in areas where a parking stall cannot be
placed.
18.7.3.6 Signage
Parking lot signage must conform to the requirements of the Light Rail Transit Graphic
Standards Manual.
18.10 FENCING
Fencing is required around surface parking lots for security and to provide safe passage for
pedestrians. It must be designed and installed in accordance with the guidelines presented in
Chapter 14, Section 14.4.1 and the standards given in the City Design Standards.
1
CITY OF EDMONTON – LRT DESIGN GUIDELINES
19.0 PARKADES
Page
19.0 PARKADES 1
19.1 GENERAL 1
19.1.1 Introduction 1
19.1.2 Abbreviations and Definitions 1
19.1.3 Applicable Codes, Standards, Practices, and Reference Guidelines 1
19.2 FUNCTIONAL DESIGN OF PARKADES 2
19.2.1 Usage Projections 2
19.2.2 Required Level-of-Service 2
19.2.3 Accessibility for Persons with Disabilities 2
19.2.4 Emergency Access 2
19.2.5 Street Access 3
19.2.6 Access Control Devices 3
19.2.7 Above vs. Below Ground Structure 3
19.2.8 Vehicular Circulation 4
19.2.9 Parking Geometry and Layout 4
19.2.10 Pedestrian Circulation 5
19.3 BUILDING REQUIREMENTS 6
19.3.1 Classification 6
19.3.2 Required Service Areas 6
19.3.3 Architectural Finishes and Landscaping 6
19.3.4 Mechanical Requirements 7
19.3.5 Electrical Requirements 7
19.3.6 Communication Requirements 7
19.3.7 Structural Requirements 7
19.3.8 Drainage 8
19.3.9 Maintenance and Operation Considerations 8
19.4 SECURITY 9
19.4.1 Safety Audit 9
19.4.2 Passive Security 9
19.4.3 Active Security 10
19.5 SIGNAGE, GRAPHICS, AND PAVEMENT MARKINGS 12
19.5.1 General 12
19.5.2 Signage 12
19.5.3 Graphics and Painting 12
19.5.4 Pavement Markings 12
List of Appendices
Appendix 1 – Parkades Level of Service
19.0 PARKADES
19.1 GENERAL
19.1.1 Introduction
This chapter presents the basic guidelines for the design of park and ride parkades for the
LRT System. The Guidelines presented in this chapter are limited to parkades only. They are
not applicable to surface parking lots, which are presented previously in Chapter 18, Streets
Design. Furthermore, this chapter focuses on free stranding parking structures as opposed to
parking under buildings. These guidelines present the criteria needed by Designers to
complete the preliminary and final design of parkades.
LOS Level-of-Service
NPA National Parking Association
PCC Parking Consultants Council
UV Ultra-Violet
Definitions:
Access Controls consist of two primary components - parking access controls and revenue
controls. Parking access controls regulate the vehicles entering and exiting the structure.
These can include but are not limited to automatic gates, manually-operated gates, etc.
Revenue controls facilitate the collection of parking fees (if required). These devices can
include ticket booths, ticket machines, etc.
Level-of-Service (LOS) is a method of determining the quality of transportation infrastructure.
Primary qualitative factors taken into consideration are speed, time, and ease of use.
Open-Air Storey is a floor that has at least 25% of its exterior perimeter wall open to the
outdoors that allows for air to flow across the entire storey, (based on ABC criteria).
Parkades are structures located near or adjacent to LRT stations. Their primary function is to
provide vehicle parking for LRT patrons who are riding the LRT to and from work, shopping or
major sporting events. They are also referred to as parking structures or parking facilities.
Reference Guidelines
At the head of the parking stall, the horizontal clearance between the front face of the
curb/wheel-stop to any obstruction must be a minimum of 0.9 m.
At the side of a parking stall adjacent to wall, raised planters, or any other obstructions,
provide an additional 0.3 m minimum clearance beyond the width of the parking stall.
Aisle widths must be a minimum of 5.5 m for one-way traffic and 7.0 m for two-way traffic.
19.2.9.2 Stall Layout
Parking must be provided by Straight parking stalls for areas where there is two-way traffic
flow and by Angled parking stalls for areas where there is one-way traffic flow.
Accessible parking should be located close to elevators, to means of disabled access, to
station entrances, to pedestrian walkways, to pedestrian circulation routes, etc.
Parking of over-height vans should be limited to the ground floor level.
A minimum of four (4) parking stalls must be reserved and labeled for City Operations and
Maintenance service vehicles adjacent to a station entrance. At least one (1) parking stall
must be reserved and labeled near each exit/entrance having a control booth or room.
19.2.9.3 Overhead Clearances
In general, an overhead clearance of 2.75 m or greater throughout the facility is preferred.
Provision must also be made to provide clearance for maintenance and tow trucks to all levels
(refer to Section 19.2.4). Access by emergency vehicles may be a consideration as well. The
true vehicle clearance is most critical at ramp transitions and must be checked against the
allowable overhead clearances.
Headache bars must be provided at all entrances/exits and at any change in vertical clearance
throughout the parking structure. The purpose of the bars is to provide an advance warning to
vehicle drivers of the height restrictions and to protect the structure from damage caused by
over-sized vehicles. Headache bars, as well as all connections and hardware, must be
designed for the appropriate wind loads and a vehicle impact load of 1.5kN.
Non-slip surfaces should be installed on stairs and in elevator lobby areas (refer to Chapter 10
Stations and Ancillary Facilities, Section 10.11.4.1).
19.3 BUILDING REQUIREMENTS
19.3.1 Classification
Parkades must be designed for a 75 year service life. According to the ABC they are
classified as Group F, Division 3 structures. The City prefers that the parking structure is
designed such that no fire protection and mechanical ventilation systems are required.
Therefore in accordance with the ABC:
Each storey can be considered an open-air storey,
The building is of non-combustible construction,
The building is less than 22 m high (measured from the grade to the ceiling of the top
storey),
The building area is less than 10 000 m2,
No part of the floor area is greater than 60 m from an exterior wall opening.
- According to the ABC, a uniformly distributed load of 2.4 kPa is considered for
passenger cars.
A gravity concentrated load on the floor.
- Individual concentrated loads as per Clause 4.1.6.10 of the ABC.
- A gravity concentrated load on the floor surface of 20 kN is applied over an area
of 13 000 mm2. This load represents the load applied by a hydraulic jack while
lifting a portion of the weight of a 3 600 kg vehicle over the approximate area of a
jack. This point load may influence local connections but should not be assumed
to act throughout a floor. Pattern loading should not be considered.
A horizontal concentrated load on any barriers or vertical elements.
In addition, the Designer must provide loading allowances for snow removal equipment, and
snow piling, including the provision for snow removal by means of a snow chute (refer to
Section 19.3.9).
19.3.7.3 Durability
The concrete design must meet the following:
19.3.8 Drainage
The drainage system must meet the requirements of CAN/CSA S413 and Chapter 18 Streets
Design, Section 18.7.3.8. including the pertinent provisions of Volume 3 of the City Design
Standards.
Water at design peak flow must be prevented from spreading a horizontal distance greater
than 610 mm from the face of any curbs, walls, or other vertical barrier. The design must
prevent storm water from flowing into stairwell and elevator openings and should limit the
ingress of precipitation into the interior of the structure, where possible.
19.4 SECURITY
Security of patrons in parking facilities is of paramount importance to the City. The Designer
must refer to Chapter 16 Safety and Security, and Clause 54.7 of City Bylaw 12800 for safety
and security requirements.
19.4.2.1 Lighting
Lighting is a highly important form of passive security.
The lighting requirements for a “B” LOS according to *RP-20 Lighting for Parking Facilities by
IESNA must be met throughout the structure for safety purposes as follows:
Provision of well-lit and uniform light levels throughout the structure including edges of
parking stalls and driving aisles
Night-time lighting levels must be high enough to allow the parkade patron to detect,
recognize, and identify objects and events without causing glare
Minimize glare by careful selection and positioning of fixtures.
Avoid shadows created by weak and uneven lighting
Avoid spotlighting points, which leaves surrounding areas dark
Each device must have a direct connection to the ETS Control Centre located at Churchill
Station and must be monitored by CCTV. When the device is activated a video recording is
activated at the ETS Control Centre.
19.5.2 Signage
Exterior parkade identification signs should be visible to passing motorists.
Provide each parkade entrance with customer information signage i.e. displaying
operational hours etc.
Should be provided to direct pedestrians to means of egress including stairways and
elevators.
Locate signs at all decision points to direct drivers to available parking and exits. This will
assist the vehicle driver in effective decision making and circulating efficiently.
Illuminate signs that are critical to the operation of the parking facility during the night-time
hours, so that they are visible to vehicular and pedestrian traffic.
Should be UV resistant and non-corrosive.
Roadway designers have developed a system based on the degree of congestion that is
acceptable to vehicle drivers. They have classified conditions by Levels of Service (LOS). As
congestion increases LOS decreases.
As it is an extension of the road transportation system in a community, the LOS approach for
parking facilities has also been adopted by the National Parking Association. Adapting a LOS
approach for parking facility design permits qualitative measures of such factors as:
Freedom to maneuver
Delay
Safety
Driving comfort
Convenience
The LOS approach is applicable to a number of parking design considerations including:
Entry/exits
Geometrics
Flow capacity
Travel distance
Spaces passed
Turning radii
Floor slopes
*Parkades Level of Service Criteria
*Parking Structures - Anthony P. Chrest, Mary S. Smith, Sam Bhuyan ISBN 0-442-20655-0. LOS based
on PCC of the NPA recommendations.
Factors to Consider in Selecting a LOS
If the Parkade Owner wants a more comfortable design as a marketing feature then LOS
B or LOS A is applied. If parkade cost is a more paramount consideration and the
parkade does not require superior comfort, then LOS D or C should be used.
A lower LOS would may be appropriate as long as reasonable traffic flows and stall widths
appropriate for an this type of parkade can be maintained. However, if paid parking is
contemplated a lower LOS may not be acceptable.